]> code.delx.au - gnu-emacs/blob - doc/misc/org.texi
7890d0d92395bc49daf4d71f1972fb20bcc44d92
[gnu-emacs] / doc / misc / org.texi
1 \input texinfo
2 @c %**start of header
3 @setfilename ../../info/org
4 @settitle The Org Manual
5 @set VERSION 7.9.2 (GNU Emacs 24.3)
6
7 @c Use proper quote and backtick for code sections in PDF output
8 @c Cf. Texinfo manual 14.2
9 @set txicodequoteundirected
10 @set txicodequotebacktick
11
12 @c Version and Contact Info
13 @set MAINTAINERSITE @uref{http://orgmode.org,maintainers webpage}
14 @set AUTHOR Carsten Dominik
15 @set MAINTAINER Carsten Dominik
16 @set MAINTAINEREMAIL @email{carsten at orgmode dot org}
17 @set MAINTAINERCONTACT @uref{mailto:carsten at orgmode dot org,contact the maintainer}
18 @c %**end of header
19 @finalout
20
21
22 @c -----------------------------------------------------------------------------
23
24 @c Macro definitions for commands and keys
25 @c =======================================
26
27 @c The behavior of the key/command macros will depend on the flag cmdnames
28 @c When set, commands names are shown. When clear, they are not shown.
29
30 @set cmdnames
31
32 @c Below we define the following macros for Org key tables:
33
34 @c orgkey{key} A key item
35 @c orgcmd{key,cmd} Key with command name
36 @c xorgcmd{key,cmd} Key with command name as @itemx
37 @c orgcmdnki{key,cmd} Like orgcmd, but do not index the key
38 @c orgcmdtkc{text,key,cmd} Like orgcmd,special text instead of key
39 @c orgcmdkkc{key1,key2,cmd} Two keys with one command name, use "or"
40 @c orgcmdkxkc{key1,key2,cmd} Two keys with one command name, but
41 @c different functions, so format as @itemx
42 @c orgcmdkskc{key1,key2,cmd} Same as orgcmdkkc, but use "or short"
43 @c xorgcmdkskc{key1,key2,cmd} Same as previous, but use @itemx
44 @c orgcmdkkcc{key1,key2,cmd1,cmd2} Two keys and two commands
45
46 @c a key but no command
47 @c Inserts: @item key
48 @macro orgkey{key}
49 @kindex \key\
50 @item @kbd{\key\}
51 @end macro
52
53 @macro xorgkey{key}
54 @kindex \key\
55 @itemx @kbd{\key\}
56 @end macro
57
58 @c one key with a command
59 @c Inserts: @item KEY COMMAND
60 @macro orgcmd{key,command}
61 @ifset cmdnames
62 @kindex \key\
63 @findex \command\
64 @iftex
65 @item @kbd{\key\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command\}
66 @end iftex
67 @ifnottex
68 @item @kbd{\key\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command\})
69 @end ifnottex
70 @end ifset
71 @ifclear cmdnames
72 @kindex \key\
73 @item @kbd{\key\}
74 @end ifclear
75 @end macro
76
77 @c One key with one command, formatted using @itemx
78 @c Inserts: @itemx KEY COMMAND
79 @macro xorgcmd{key,command}
80 @ifset cmdnames
81 @kindex \key\
82 @findex \command\
83 @iftex
84 @itemx @kbd{\key\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command\}
85 @end iftex
86 @ifnottex
87 @itemx @kbd{\key\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command\})
88 @end ifnottex
89 @end ifset
90 @ifclear cmdnames
91 @kindex \key\
92 @itemx @kbd{\key\}
93 @end ifclear
94 @end macro
95
96 @c one key with a command, bit do not index the key
97 @c Inserts: @item KEY COMMAND
98 @macro orgcmdnki{key,command}
99 @ifset cmdnames
100 @findex \command\
101 @iftex
102 @item @kbd{\key\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command\}
103 @end iftex
104 @ifnottex
105 @item @kbd{\key\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command\})
106 @end ifnottex
107 @end ifset
108 @ifclear cmdnames
109 @item @kbd{\key\}
110 @end ifclear
111 @end macro
112
113 @c one key with a command, and special text to replace key in item
114 @c Inserts: @item TEXT COMMAND
115 @macro orgcmdtkc{text,key,command}
116 @ifset cmdnames
117 @kindex \key\
118 @findex \command\
119 @iftex
120 @item @kbd{\text\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command\}
121 @end iftex
122 @ifnottex
123 @item @kbd{\text\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command\})
124 @end ifnottex
125 @end ifset
126 @ifclear cmdnames
127 @kindex \key\
128 @item @kbd{\text\}
129 @end ifclear
130 @end macro
131
132 @c two keys with one command
133 @c Inserts: @item KEY1 or KEY2 COMMAND
134 @macro orgcmdkkc{key1,key2,command}
135 @ifset cmdnames
136 @kindex \key1\
137 @kindex \key2\
138 @findex \command\
139 @iftex
140 @item @kbd{\key1\} @ @r{or} @ @kbd{\key2\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command\}
141 @end iftex
142 @ifnottex
143 @item @kbd{\key1\} @ @r{or} @ @kbd{\key2\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command\})
144 @end ifnottex
145 @end ifset
146 @ifclear cmdnames
147 @kindex \key1\
148 @kindex \key2\
149 @item @kbd{\key1\} @ @r{or} @ @kbd{\key2\}
150 @end ifclear
151 @end macro
152
153 @c Two keys with one command name, but different functions, so format as
154 @c @itemx
155 @c Inserts: @item KEY1
156 @c @itemx KEY2 COMMAND
157 @macro orgcmdkxkc{key1,key2,command}
158 @ifset cmdnames
159 @kindex \key1\
160 @kindex \key2\
161 @findex \command\
162 @iftex
163 @item @kbd{\key1\}
164 @itemx @kbd{\key2\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command\}
165 @end iftex
166 @ifnottex
167 @item @kbd{\key1\}
168 @itemx @kbd{\key2\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command\})
169 @end ifnottex
170 @end ifset
171 @ifclear cmdnames
172 @kindex \key1\
173 @kindex \key2\
174 @item @kbd{\key1\}
175 @itemx @kbd{\key2\}
176 @end ifclear
177 @end macro
178
179 @c Same as previous, but use "or short"
180 @c Inserts: @item KEY1 or short KEY2 COMMAND
181 @macro orgcmdkskc{key1,key2,command}
182 @ifset cmdnames
183 @kindex \key1\
184 @kindex \key2\
185 @findex \command\
186 @iftex
187 @item @kbd{\key1\} @ @r{or short} @ @kbd{\key2\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command\}
188 @end iftex
189 @ifnottex
190 @item @kbd{\key1\} @ @r{or short} @ @kbd{\key2\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command\})
191 @end ifnottex
192 @end ifset
193 @ifclear cmdnames
194 @kindex \key1\
195 @kindex \key2\
196 @item @kbd{\key1\} @ @r{or short} @ @kbd{\key2\}
197 @end ifclear
198 @end macro
199
200 @c Same as previous, but use @itemx
201 @c Inserts: @itemx KEY1 or short KEY2 COMMAND
202 @macro xorgcmdkskc{key1,key2,command}
203 @ifset cmdnames
204 @kindex \key1\
205 @kindex \key2\
206 @findex \command\
207 @iftex
208 @itemx @kbd{\key1\} @ @r{or short} @ @kbd{\key2\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command\}
209 @end iftex
210 @ifnottex
211 @itemx @kbd{\key1\} @ @r{or short} @ @kbd{\key2\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command\})
212 @end ifnottex
213 @end ifset
214 @ifclear cmdnames
215 @kindex \key1\
216 @kindex \key2\
217 @itemx @kbd{\key1\} @ @r{or short} @ @kbd{\key2\}
218 @end ifclear
219 @end macro
220
221 @c two keys with two commands
222 @c Inserts: @item KEY1 COMMAND1
223 @c @itemx KEY2 COMMAND2
224 @macro orgcmdkkcc{key1,key2,command1,command2}
225 @ifset cmdnames
226 @kindex \key1\
227 @kindex \key2\
228 @findex \command1\
229 @findex \command2\
230 @iftex
231 @item @kbd{\key1\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command1\}
232 @itemx @kbd{\key2\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command2\}
233 @end iftex
234 @ifnottex
235 @item @kbd{\key1\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command1\})
236 @itemx @kbd{\key2\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command2\})
237 @end ifnottex
238 @end ifset
239 @ifclear cmdnames
240 @kindex \key1\
241 @kindex \key2\
242 @item @kbd{\key1\}
243 @itemx @kbd{\key2\}
244 @end ifclear
245 @end macro
246 @c -----------------------------------------------------------------------------
247
248 @iftex
249 @c @hyphenation{time-stamp time-stamps time-stamp-ing time-stamp-ed}
250 @end iftex
251
252 @c Subheadings inside a table.
253 @macro tsubheading{text}
254 @ifinfo
255 @subsubheading \text\
256 @end ifinfo
257 @ifnotinfo
258 @item @b{\text\}
259 @end ifnotinfo
260 @end macro
261
262 @copying
263 This manual is for Org version @value{VERSION}.
264
265 Copyright @copyright{} 2004-2012 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
266
267 @quotation
268 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
269 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3 or
270 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
271 Invariant Sections, with the Front-Cover texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
272 and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below. A copy of the license
273 is included in the section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation License.''
274
275 (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have the freedom to copy and
276 modify this GNU manual. Buying copies from the FSF supports it in
277 developing GNU and promoting software freedom.''
278
279 This document is part of a collection distributed under the GNU Free
280 Documentation License. If you want to distribute this document
281 separately from the collection, you can do so by adding a copy of the
282 license to the document, as described in section 6 of the license.
283 @end quotation
284 @end copying
285
286 @dircategory Emacs editing modes
287 @direntry
288 * Org Mode: (org). Outline-based notes management and organizer
289 @end direntry
290
291 @titlepage
292 @title The Org Manual
293
294 @subtitle Release @value{VERSION}
295 @author by Carsten Dominik
296 with contributions by David O'Toole, Bastien Guerry, Philip Rooke, Dan Davison, Eric Schulte, Thomas Dye and Jambunathan K.
297
298 @c The following two commands start the copyright page.
299 @page
300 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
301 @insertcopying
302 @end titlepage
303
304 @c Output the table of contents at the beginning.
305 @contents
306
307 @ifnottex
308 @node Top, Introduction, (dir), (dir)
309 @top Org Mode Manual
310
311 @insertcopying
312 @end ifnottex
313
314 @menu
315 * Introduction:: Getting started
316 * Document Structure:: A tree works like your brain
317 * Tables:: Pure magic for quick formatting
318 * Hyperlinks:: Notes in context
319 * TODO Items:: Every tree branch can be a TODO item
320 * Tags:: Tagging headlines and matching sets of tags
321 * Properties and Columns:: Storing information about an entry
322 * Dates and Times:: Making items useful for planning
323 * Capture - Refile - Archive:: The ins and outs for projects
324 * Agenda Views:: Collecting information into views
325 * Markup:: Prepare text for rich export
326 * Exporting:: Sharing and publishing of notes
327 * Publishing:: Create a web site of linked Org files
328 * Working With Source Code:: Export, evaluate, and tangle code blocks
329 * Miscellaneous:: All the rest which did not fit elsewhere
330 * Hacking:: How to hack your way around
331 * MobileOrg:: Viewing and capture on a mobile device
332 * History and Acknowledgments:: How Org came into being
333 * Main Index:: An index of Org's concepts and features
334 * Key Index:: Key bindings and where they are described
335 * Command and Function Index:: Command names and some internal functions
336 * Variable Index:: Variables mentioned in the manual
337
338 @detailmenu
339 --- The Detailed Node Listing ---
340
341 Introduction
342
343 * Summary:: Brief summary of what Org does
344 * Installation:: How to install a downloaded version of Org
345 * Activation:: How to activate Org for certain buffers
346 * Feedback:: Bug reports, ideas, patches etc.
347 * Conventions:: Typesetting conventions in the manual
348
349 Document structure
350
351 * Outlines:: Org is based on Outline mode
352 * Headlines:: How to typeset Org tree headlines
353 * Visibility cycling:: Show and hide, much simplified
354 * Motion:: Jumping to other headlines
355 * Structure editing:: Changing sequence and level of headlines
356 * Sparse trees:: Matches embedded in context
357 * Plain lists:: Additional structure within an entry
358 * Drawers:: Tucking stuff away
359 * Blocks:: Folding blocks
360 * Footnotes:: How footnotes are defined in Org's syntax
361 * Orgstruct mode:: Structure editing outside Org
362
363 Tables
364
365 * Built-in table editor:: Simple tables
366 * Column width and alignment:: Overrule the automatic settings
367 * Column groups:: Grouping to trigger vertical lines
368 * Orgtbl mode:: The table editor as minor mode
369 * The spreadsheet:: The table editor has spreadsheet capabilities
370 * Org-Plot:: Plotting from org tables
371
372 The spreadsheet
373
374 * References:: How to refer to another field or range
375 * Formula syntax for Calc:: Using Calc to compute stuff
376 * Formula syntax for Lisp:: Writing formulas in Emacs Lisp
377 * Durations and time values:: How to compute durations and time values
378 * Field and range formulas:: Formula for specific (ranges of) fields
379 * Column formulas:: Formulas valid for an entire column
380 * Editing and debugging formulas:: Fixing formulas
381 * Updating the table:: Recomputing all dependent fields
382 * Advanced features:: Field and column names, parameters and automatic recalc
383
384 Hyperlinks
385
386 * Link format:: How links in Org are formatted
387 * Internal links:: Links to other places in the current file
388 * External links:: URL-like links to the world
389 * Handling links:: Creating, inserting and following
390 * Using links outside Org:: Linking from my C source code?
391 * Link abbreviations:: Shortcuts for writing complex links
392 * Search options:: Linking to a specific location
393 * Custom searches:: When the default search is not enough
394
395 Internal links
396
397 * Radio targets:: Make targets trigger links in plain text
398
399 TODO items
400
401 * TODO basics:: Marking and displaying TODO entries
402 * TODO extensions:: Workflow and assignments
403 * Progress logging:: Dates and notes for progress
404 * Priorities:: Some things are more important than others
405 * Breaking down tasks:: Splitting a task into manageable pieces
406 * Checkboxes:: Tick-off lists
407
408 Extended use of TODO keywords
409
410 * Workflow states:: From TODO to DONE in steps
411 * TODO types:: I do this, Fred does the rest
412 * Multiple sets in one file:: Mixing it all, and still finding your way
413 * Fast access to TODO states:: Single letter selection of a state
414 * Per-file keywords:: Different files, different requirements
415 * Faces for TODO keywords:: Highlighting states
416 * TODO dependencies:: When one task needs to wait for others
417
418 Progress logging
419
420 * Closing items:: When was this entry marked DONE?
421 * Tracking TODO state changes:: When did the status change?
422 * Tracking your habits:: How consistent have you been?
423
424 Tags
425
426 * Tag inheritance:: Tags use the tree structure of the outline
427 * Setting tags:: How to assign tags to a headline
428 * Tag searches:: Searching for combinations of tags
429
430 Properties and columns
431
432 * Property syntax:: How properties are spelled out
433 * Special properties:: Access to other Org mode features
434 * Property searches:: Matching property values
435 * Property inheritance:: Passing values down the tree
436 * Column view:: Tabular viewing and editing
437 * Property API:: Properties for Lisp programmers
438
439 Column view
440
441 * Defining columns:: The COLUMNS format property
442 * Using column view:: How to create and use column view
443 * Capturing column view:: A dynamic block for column view
444
445 Defining columns
446
447 * Scope of column definitions:: Where defined, where valid?
448 * Column attributes:: Appearance and content of a column
449
450 Dates and times
451
452 * Timestamps:: Assigning a time to a tree entry
453 * Creating timestamps:: Commands which insert timestamps
454 * Deadlines and scheduling:: Planning your work
455 * Clocking work time:: Tracking how long you spend on a task
456 * Effort estimates:: Planning work effort in advance
457 * Relative timer:: Notes with a running timer
458 * Countdown timer:: Starting a countdown timer for a task
459
460 Creating timestamps
461
462 * The date/time prompt:: How Org mode helps you entering date and time
463 * Custom time format:: Making dates look different
464
465 Deadlines and scheduling
466
467 * Inserting deadline/schedule:: Planning items
468 * Repeated tasks:: Items that show up again and again
469
470 Clocking work time
471
472 * Clocking commands:: Starting and stopping a clock
473 * The clock table:: Detailed reports
474 * Resolving idle time:: Resolving time when you've been idle
475
476 Capture - Refile - Archive
477
478 * Capture:: Capturing new stuff
479 * Attachments:: Add files to tasks
480 * RSS Feeds:: Getting input from RSS feeds
481 * Protocols:: External (e.g., Browser) access to Emacs and Org
482 * Refiling notes:: Moving a tree from one place to another
483 * Archiving:: What to do with finished projects
484
485 Capture
486
487 * Setting up capture:: Where notes will be stored
488 * Using capture:: Commands to invoke and terminate capture
489 * Capture templates:: Define the outline of different note types
490
491 Capture templates
492
493 * Template elements:: What is needed for a complete template entry
494 * Template expansion:: Filling in information about time and context
495 * Templates in contexts:: Only show a template in a specific context
496
497 Archiving
498
499 * Moving subtrees:: Moving a tree to an archive file
500 * Internal archiving:: Switch off a tree but keep it in the file
501
502 Agenda views
503
504 * Agenda files:: Files being searched for agenda information
505 * Agenda dispatcher:: Keyboard access to agenda views
506 * Built-in agenda views:: What is available out of the box?
507 * Presentation and sorting:: How agenda items are prepared for display
508 * Agenda commands:: Remote editing of Org trees
509 * Custom agenda views:: Defining special searches and views
510 * Exporting Agenda Views:: Writing a view to a file
511 * Agenda column view:: Using column view for collected entries
512
513 The built-in agenda views
514
515 * Weekly/daily agenda:: The calendar page with current tasks
516 * Global TODO list:: All unfinished action items
517 * Matching tags and properties:: Structured information with fine-tuned search
518 * Timeline:: Time-sorted view for single file
519 * Search view:: Find entries by searching for text
520 * Stuck projects:: Find projects you need to review
521
522 Presentation and sorting
523
524 * Categories:: Not all tasks are equal
525 * Time-of-day specifications:: How the agenda knows the time
526 * Sorting of agenda items:: The order of things
527
528 Custom agenda views
529
530 * Storing searches:: Type once, use often
531 * Block agenda:: All the stuff you need in a single buffer
532 * Setting Options:: Changing the rules
533
534 Markup for rich export
535
536 * Structural markup elements:: The basic structure as seen by the exporter
537 * Images and tables:: Tables and Images will be included
538 * Literal examples:: Source code examples with special formatting
539 * Include files:: Include additional files into a document
540 * Index entries:: Making an index
541 * Macro replacement:: Use macros to create complex output
542 * Embedded @LaTeX{}:: LaTeX can be freely used inside Org documents
543
544 Structural markup elements
545
546 * Document title:: Where the title is taken from
547 * Headings and sections:: The document structure as seen by the exporter
548 * Table of contents:: The if and where of the table of contents
549 * Initial text:: Text before the first heading?
550 * Lists:: Lists
551 * Paragraphs:: Paragraphs
552 * Footnote markup:: Footnotes
553 * Emphasis and monospace:: Bold, italic, etc.
554 * Horizontal rules:: Make a line
555 * Comment lines:: What will *not* be exported
556
557 Embedded @LaTeX{}
558
559 * Special symbols:: Greek letters and other symbols
560 * Subscripts and superscripts:: Simple syntax for raising/lowering text
561 * @LaTeX{} fragments:: Complex formulas made easy
562 * Previewing @LaTeX{} fragments:: What will this snippet look like?
563 * CDLaTeX mode:: Speed up entering of formulas
564
565 Exporting
566
567 * Selective export:: Using tags to select and exclude trees
568 * Export options:: Per-file export settings
569 * The export dispatcher:: How to access exporter commands
570 * ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export:: Exporting to flat files with encoding
571 * HTML export:: Exporting to HTML
572 * @LaTeX{} and PDF export:: Exporting to @LaTeX{}, and processing to PDF
573 * DocBook export:: Exporting to DocBook
574 * OpenDocument Text export:: Exporting to OpenDocument Text
575 * TaskJuggler export:: Exporting to TaskJuggler
576 * Freemind export:: Exporting to Freemind mind maps
577 * XOXO export:: Exporting to XOXO
578 * iCalendar export:: Exporting in iCalendar format
579
580 HTML export
581
582 * HTML Export commands:: How to invoke HTML export
583 * HTML preamble and postamble:: How to insert a preamble and a postamble
584 * Quoting HTML tags:: Using direct HTML in Org mode
585 * Links in HTML export:: How links will be interpreted and formatted
586 * Tables in HTML export:: How to modify the formatting of tables
587 * Images in HTML export:: How to insert figures into HTML output
588 * Math formatting in HTML export:: Beautiful math also on the web
589 * Text areas in HTML export:: An alternative way to show an example
590 * CSS support:: Changing the appearance of the output
591 * JavaScript support:: Info and Folding in a web browser
592
593 @LaTeX{} and PDF export
594
595 * @LaTeX{}/PDF export commands::
596 * Header and sectioning:: Setting up the export file structure
597 * Quoting @LaTeX{} code:: Incorporating literal @LaTeX{} code
598 * Tables in @LaTeX{} export:: Options for exporting tables to @LaTeX{}
599 * Images in @LaTeX{} export:: How to insert figures into @LaTeX{} output
600 * Beamer class export:: Turning the file into a presentation
601
602 DocBook export
603
604 * DocBook export commands:: How to invoke DocBook export
605 * Quoting DocBook code:: Incorporating DocBook code in Org files
606 * Recursive sections:: Recursive sections in DocBook
607 * Tables in DocBook export:: Tables are exported as HTML tables
608 * Images in DocBook export:: How to insert figures into DocBook output
609 * Special characters:: How to handle special characters
610
611 OpenDocument Text export
612
613 * Pre-requisites for ODT export:: What packages ODT exporter relies on
614 * ODT export commands:: How to invoke ODT export
615 * Extending ODT export:: How to produce @samp{doc}, @samp{pdf} files
616 * Applying custom styles:: How to apply custom styles to the output
617 * Links in ODT export:: How links will be interpreted and formatted
618 * Tables in ODT export:: How Tables are exported
619 * Images in ODT export:: How to insert images
620 * Math formatting in ODT export:: How @LaTeX{} fragments are formatted
621 * Labels and captions in ODT export:: How captions are rendered
622 * Literal examples in ODT export:: How source and example blocks are formatted
623 * Advanced topics in ODT export:: Read this if you are a power user
624
625 Math formatting in ODT export
626
627 * Working with @LaTeX{} math snippets:: How to embed @LaTeX{} math fragments
628 * Working with MathML or OpenDocument formula files:: How to embed equations in native format
629
630 Advanced topics in ODT export
631
632 * Configuring a document converter:: How to register a document converter
633 * Working with OpenDocument style files:: Explore the internals
634 * Creating one-off styles:: How to produce custom highlighting etc
635 * Customizing tables in ODT export:: How to define and use Table templates
636 * Validating OpenDocument XML:: How to debug corrupt OpenDocument files
637
638 Publishing
639
640 * Configuration:: Defining projects
641 * Uploading files:: How to get files up on the server
642 * Sample configuration:: Example projects
643 * Triggering publication:: Publication commands
644
645 Configuration
646
647 * Project alist:: The central configuration variable
648 * Sources and destinations:: From here to there
649 * Selecting files:: What files are part of the project?
650 * Publishing action:: Setting the function doing the publishing
651 * Publishing options:: Tweaking HTML/@LaTeX{} export
652 * Publishing links:: Which links keep working after publishing?
653 * Sitemap:: Generating a list of all pages
654 * Generating an index:: An index that reaches across pages
655
656 Sample configuration
657
658 * Simple example:: One-component publishing
659 * Complex example:: A multi-component publishing example
660
661 Working with source code
662
663 * Structure of code blocks:: Code block syntax described
664 * Editing source code:: Language major-mode editing
665 * Exporting code blocks:: Export contents and/or results
666 * Extracting source code:: Create pure source code files
667 * Evaluating code blocks:: Place results of evaluation in the Org mode buffer
668 * Library of Babel:: Use and contribute to a library of useful code blocks
669 * Languages:: List of supported code block languages
670 * Header arguments:: Configure code block functionality
671 * Results of evaluation:: How evaluation results are handled
672 * Noweb reference syntax:: Literate programming in Org mode
673 * Key bindings and useful functions:: Work quickly with code blocks
674 * Batch execution:: Call functions from the command line
675
676 Header arguments
677
678 * Using header arguments:: Different ways to set header arguments
679 * Specific header arguments:: List of header arguments
680
681 Using header arguments
682
683 * System-wide header arguments:: Set global default values
684 * Language-specific header arguments:: Set default values by language
685 * Buffer-wide header arguments:: Set default values for a specific buffer
686 * Header arguments in Org mode properties:: Set default values for a buffer or heading
687 * Code block specific header arguments:: The most common way to set values
688 * Header arguments in function calls:: The most specific level
689
690 Specific header arguments
691
692 * var:: Pass arguments to code blocks
693 * results:: Specify the type of results and how they will
694 be collected and handled
695 * file:: Specify a path for file output
696 * file-desc:: Specify a description for file results
697 * dir:: Specify the default (possibly remote)
698 directory for code block execution
699 * exports:: Export code and/or results
700 * tangle:: Toggle tangling and specify file name
701 * mkdirp:: Toggle creation of parent directories of target
702 files during tangling
703 * comments:: Toggle insertion of comments in tangled
704 code files
705 * padline:: Control insertion of padding lines in tangled
706 code files
707 * no-expand:: Turn off variable assignment and noweb
708 expansion during tangling
709 * session:: Preserve the state of code evaluation
710 * noweb:: Toggle expansion of noweb references
711 * noweb-ref:: Specify block's noweb reference resolution target
712 * noweb-sep:: String used to separate noweb references
713 * cache:: Avoid re-evaluating unchanged code blocks
714 * sep:: Delimiter for writing tabular results outside Org
715 * hlines:: Handle horizontal lines in tables
716 * colnames:: Handle column names in tables
717 * rownames:: Handle row names in tables
718 * shebang:: Make tangled files executable
719 * eval:: Limit evaluation of specific code blocks
720 * wrap:: Mark source block evaluation results
721
722 Miscellaneous
723
724 * Completion:: M-TAB knows what you need
725 * Easy Templates:: Quick insertion of structural elements
726 * Speed keys:: Electric commands at the beginning of a headline
727 * Code evaluation security:: Org mode files evaluate inline code
728 * Customization:: Adapting Org to your taste
729 * In-buffer settings:: Overview of the #+KEYWORDS
730 * The very busy C-c C-c key:: When in doubt, press C-c C-c
731 * Clean view:: Getting rid of leading stars in the outline
732 * TTY keys:: Using Org on a tty
733 * Interaction:: Other Emacs packages
734 * org-crypt.el:: Encrypting Org files
735
736 Interaction with other packages
737
738 * Cooperation:: Packages Org cooperates with
739 * Conflicts:: Packages that lead to conflicts
740
741 Hacking
742
743 * Hooks:: How to reach into Org's internals
744 * Add-on packages:: Available extensions
745 * Adding hyperlink types:: New custom link types
746 * Context-sensitive commands:: How to add functionality to such commands
747 * Tables in arbitrary syntax:: Orgtbl for @LaTeX{} and other programs
748 * Dynamic blocks:: Automatically filled blocks
749 * Special agenda views:: Customized views
750 * Extracting agenda information:: Postprocessing of agenda information
751 * Using the property API:: Writing programs that use entry properties
752 * Using the mapping API:: Mapping over all or selected entries
753
754 Tables and lists in arbitrary syntax
755
756 * Radio tables:: Sending and receiving radio tables
757 * A @LaTeX{} example:: Step by step, almost a tutorial
758 * Translator functions:: Copy and modify
759 * Radio lists:: Doing the same for lists
760
761 MobileOrg
762
763 * Setting up the staging area:: Where to interact with the mobile device
764 * Pushing to MobileOrg:: Uploading Org files and agendas
765 * Pulling from MobileOrg:: Integrating captured and flagged items
766
767 @end detailmenu
768 @end menu
769
770 @node Introduction, Document Structure, Top, Top
771 @chapter Introduction
772 @cindex introduction
773
774 @menu
775 * Summary:: Brief summary of what Org does
776 * Installation:: How to install a downloaded version of Org
777 * Activation:: How to activate Org for certain buffers
778 * Feedback:: Bug reports, ideas, patches etc.
779 * Conventions:: Typesetting conventions in the manual
780 @end menu
781
782 @node Summary, Installation, Introduction, Introduction
783 @section Summary
784 @cindex summary
785
786 Org is a mode for keeping notes, maintaining TODO lists, and doing
787 project planning with a fast and effective plain-text system.
788
789 Org develops organizational tasks around NOTES files that contain
790 lists or information about projects as plain text. Org is
791 implemented on top of Outline mode, which makes it possible to keep the
792 content of large files well structured. Visibility cycling and
793 structure editing help to work with the tree. Tables are easily created
794 with a built-in table editor. Org supports TODO items, deadlines,
795 timestamps, and scheduling. It dynamically compiles entries into an
796 agenda that utilizes and smoothly integrates much of the Emacs calendar
797 and diary. Plain text URL-like links connect to websites, emails,
798 Usenet messages, BBDB entries, and any files related to the projects.
799 For printing and sharing of notes, an Org file can be exported as a
800 structured ASCII file, as HTML, or (TODO and agenda items only) as an
801 iCalendar file. It can also serve as a publishing tool for a set of
802 linked web pages.
803
804 As a project planning environment, Org works by adding metadata to outline
805 nodes. Based on this data, specific entries can be extracted in queries and
806 create dynamic @i{agenda views}.
807
808 Org mode contains the Org Babel environment which allows you to work with
809 embedded source code blocks in a file, to facilitate code evaluation,
810 documentation, and literate programming techniques.
811
812 Org's automatic, context-sensitive table editor with spreadsheet
813 capabilities can be integrated into any major mode by activating the
814 minor Orgtbl mode. Using a translation step, it can be used to maintain
815 tables in arbitrary file types, for example in @LaTeX{}. The structure
816 editing and list creation capabilities can be used outside Org with
817 the minor Orgstruct mode.
818
819 Org keeps simple things simple. When first fired up, it should
820 feel like a straightforward, easy to use outliner. Complexity is not
821 imposed, but a large amount of functionality is available when you need
822 it. Org is a toolbox and can be used in different ways and for different
823 ends, for example:
824
825 @example
826 @r{@bullet{} an outline extension with visibility cycling and structure editing}
827 @r{@bullet{} an ASCII system and table editor for taking structured notes}
828 @r{@bullet{} a TODO list editor}
829 @r{@bullet{} a full agenda and planner with deadlines and work scheduling}
830 @pindex GTD, Getting Things Done
831 @r{@bullet{} an environment in which to implement David Allen's GTD system}
832 @r{@bullet{} a simple hypertext system, with HTML and @LaTeX{} export}
833 @r{@bullet{} a publishing tool to create a set of interlinked webpages}
834 @r{@bullet{} an environment for literate programming}
835 @end example
836
837 @cindex FAQ
838 There is a website for Org which provides links to the newest
839 version of Org, as well as additional information, frequently asked
840 questions (FAQ), links to tutorials, etc. This page is located at
841 @uref{http://orgmode.org}.
842
843 @cindex print edition
844 The version 7.3 of this manual is available as a
845 @uref{http://www.network-theory.co.uk/org/manual/, paperback book from Network
846 Theory Ltd.}
847
848 @page
849
850
851 @node Installation, Activation, Summary, Introduction
852 @section Installation
853 @cindex installation
854 @cindex XEmacs
855
856 @b{Important:} @i{If you the version of Org that comes with Emacs or as a
857 XEmacs package, please skip this section and go directly to @ref{Activation}.
858 If you downloaded Org as an ELPA package, please read the instructions on the
859 @uref{http://orgmode.org/elpa.html, Org ELPA page}. To see what version of Org
860 (if any) is part of your Emacs distribution, type @kbd{M-x org-version} (if
861 your Emacs distribution does not come with Org, this function will not be
862 defined).}
863
864 Installation of Org mode uses a build system, which is described in more
865 detail on @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/dev/org-build-system.html, Worg}.
866
867 If you have downloaded Org from the Web as a distribution @file{.zip} or
868 @file{.tar.gz} archive, take the following steps to install it:
869
870 @itemize @bullet
871 @item Unpack the distribution archive.
872 @item Change into (@code{cd}) the Org directory.
873 @item Run @code{make help config}
874 and then check and edit the file @file{local.mk} if the default configuration
875 does not match your system. Set the name of the Emacs binary (likely either
876 @file{emacs} or @file{xemacs}), and the paths to the directories where local
877 Lisp and Info files will be installed. If the Emacs binary is not in your
878 path, give the full path to the executable. Avoid spaces in any path names.
879 @item Run @code{make config}
880 again to check the configuration.
881 @item Run @code{make install} or @code{sudo make install}
882 to build and install Org mode on your system.
883 @end itemize
884
885 If you use a cloned Git repository, then the procedure is slightly different.
886 The following description assumes that you are using the @code{master} branch
887 (where the development is done). You could also use the @code{maint} branch
888 instead, where the release versions are published, just replace @code{master}
889 with @code{maint} in the description below.
890
891 @itemize @bullet
892 @item Change into (@code{cd}) the Org repository.
893 @item Run @code{git checkout master}
894 to switch to the @code{master} branch of the Org repository.
895 @item Run @code{make help}
896 and then check and edit the file @file{local.mk}. You must set the name of
897 the Emacs binary (likely either @file{emacs} or @file{xemacs}), and the paths
898 to the directories where local Lisp and Info files will be installed. If the
899 Emacs binary is not in your path, you must give the full path to the
900 executable. Avoid spaces in any path names.
901 @item Run @code{make config}
902 to check the configuration.
903 @item Optionally run @code{make test}
904 to build Org mode and then run the full testsuite.
905 @item Run @code{make update2} or @code{make up2}
906 to update the Git repository and build and install Org mode. The latter
907 invocation runs the complete test suite before installation and installs only
908 if the build passes all tests.
909 @end itemize
910
911 If you don't have access to the system-wide directories and you don't want to
912 install somewhere into your home directory, you can run Org directly from the
913 distribution directory or Org repository by compiling Org mode in place:
914
915 @itemize @bullet
916 @item Change into (@code{cd}) the Org repository.
917 @item Run @code{git checkout master}
918 to switch to the @code{master} branch of the Org repository.
919 @item Run @code{make compile}
920 @end itemize
921
922 Last but not least you can also run Org mode directly from an Org repository
923 without any compilation. Simply replace the last step in the recipe above
924 with @code{make uncompiled}.
925
926 Then add the following line to @file{.emacs}:
927
928 @example
929 (add-to-list 'load-path "~/path/to/orgdir/lisp")
930 @end example
931
932 @noindent
933 If you plan to use code from the @file{contrib} subdirectory without
934 compiling them, do a similar step for this directory:
935
936 @example
937 (add-to-list 'load-path "~/path/to/orgdir/contrib/lisp" t)
938 @end example
939
940 If you want to include those files with the build and install, please
941 customize the variable @code{ORG_ADD_CONTRIB} instead in your @code{local.mk}
942 file, for more details please see this
943 @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/dev/org-build-system.html#sec-4-1-2,
944 description on Worg}.
945
946 Installing Info files is system dependent, because of differences in the
947 @file{install-info} program. The Info documentation is installed together
948 with the rest of Org mode. If you don't install Org mode, it is possible to
949 install the Info documentation separately (you need to have
950 install-info@footnote{The output from install-info (if any) is system
951 dependent. In particular Debian and its derivatives use two different
952 versions of install-info and you may see the message:
953
954 @example
955 This is not dpkg install-info anymore, but GNU install-info
956 See the man page for ginstall-info for command line arguments
957 @end example
958
959 @noindent which can be safely ignored.}
960 on your system).
961
962 @example
963 make install-info
964 @end example
965
966 Do not forget to activate Org as described in the following section.
967 @page
968
969 @node Activation, Feedback, Installation, Introduction
970 @section Activation
971 @cindex activation
972 @cindex autoload
973 @cindex ELPA
974 @cindex global key bindings
975 @cindex key bindings, global
976 @findex org-agenda
977 @findex org-capture
978 @findex org-store-link
979 @findex org-iswitchb
980
981 Since Emacs 22.2, files with the @file{.org} extension use Org mode by
982 default. If you are using an earlier version of Emacs, add this line to your
983 @file{.emacs} file:
984
985 @lisp
986 (add-to-list 'auto-mode-alist '("\\.org\\'" . org-mode))
987 @end lisp
988
989 Org mode buffers need font-lock to be turned on - this is the default in
990 Emacs@footnote{If you don't use font-lock globally, turn it on in Org buffer
991 with @code{(add-hook 'org-mode-hook 'turn-on-font-lock)}}.
992
993 There are compatibility issues between Org mode and some other Elisp
994 packages, please take the time to check the list (@pxref{Conflicts}).
995
996 The four Org commands @command{org-store-link}, @command{org-capture},
997 @command{org-agenda}, and @command{org-iswitchb} should be accessible through
998 global keys (i.e., anywhere in Emacs, not just in Org buffers). Here are
999 suggested bindings for these keys, please modify the keys to your own
1000 liking.
1001 @lisp
1002 (global-set-key "\C-cl" 'org-store-link)
1003 (global-set-key "\C-cc" 'org-capture)
1004 (global-set-key "\C-ca" 'org-agenda)
1005 (global-set-key "\C-cb" 'org-iswitchb)
1006 @end lisp
1007
1008 @cindex Org mode, turning on
1009 With this setup, all files with extension @samp{.org} will be put
1010 into Org mode. As an alternative, make the first line of a file look
1011 like this:
1012
1013 @example
1014 MY PROJECTS -*- mode: org; -*-
1015 @end example
1016
1017 @vindex org-insert-mode-line-in-empty-file
1018 @noindent which will select Org mode for this buffer no matter what
1019 the file's name is. See also the variable
1020 @code{org-insert-mode-line-in-empty-file}.
1021
1022 Many commands in Org work on the region if the region is @i{active}. To make
1023 use of this, you need to have @code{transient-mark-mode}
1024 (@code{zmacs-regions} in XEmacs) turned on. In Emacs 23 this is the default,
1025 in Emacs 22 you need to do this yourself with
1026 @lisp
1027 (transient-mark-mode 1)
1028 @end lisp
1029 @noindent If you do not like @code{transient-mark-mode}, you can create an
1030 active region by using the mouse to select a region, or pressing
1031 @kbd{C-@key{SPC}} twice before moving the cursor.
1032
1033 @node Feedback, Conventions, Activation, Introduction
1034 @section Feedback
1035 @cindex feedback
1036 @cindex bug reports
1037 @cindex maintainer
1038 @cindex author
1039
1040 If you find problems with Org, or if you have questions, remarks, or ideas
1041 about it, please mail to the Org mailing list @email{emacs-orgmode@@gnu.org}.
1042 If you are not a member of the mailing list, your mail will be passed to the
1043 list after a moderator has approved it@footnote{Please consider subscribing
1044 to the mailing list, in order to minimize the work the mailing list
1045 moderators have to do.}.
1046
1047 For bug reports, please first try to reproduce the bug with the latest
1048 version of Org available---if you are running an outdated version, it is
1049 quite possible that the bug has been fixed already. If the bug persists,
1050 prepare a report and provide as much information as possible, including the
1051 version information of Emacs (@kbd{M-x emacs-version @key{RET}}) and Org
1052 (@kbd{M-x org-version @key{RET}}), as well as the Org related setup in
1053 @file{.emacs}. The easiest way to do this is to use the command
1054 @example
1055 @kbd{M-x org-submit-bug-report}
1056 @end example
1057 @noindent which will put all this information into an Emacs mail buffer so
1058 that you only need to add your description. If you re not sending the Email
1059 from within Emacs, please copy and paste the content into your Email program.
1060
1061 Sometimes you might face a problem due to an error in your Emacs or Org mode
1062 setup. Before reporting a bug, it is very helpful to start Emacs with minimal
1063 customizations and reproduce the problem. Doing so often helps you determine
1064 if the problem is with your customization or with Org mode itself. You can
1065 start a typical minimal session with a command like the example below.
1066
1067 @example
1068 $ emacs -Q -l /path/to/minimal-org.el
1069 @end example
1070
1071 However if you are using Org mode as distributed with Emacs, a minimal setup
1072 is not necessary. In that case it is sufficient to start Emacs as
1073 @code{emacs -Q}. The @code{minimal-org.el} setup file can have contents as
1074 shown below.
1075
1076 @example
1077 ;;; Minimal setup to load latest `org-mode'
1078
1079 ;; activate debugging
1080 (setq debug-on-error t
1081 debug-on-signal nil
1082 debug-on-quit nil)
1083
1084 ;; add latest org-mode to load path
1085 (add-to-list 'load-path (expand-file-name "/path/to/org-mode/lisp"))
1086 (add-to-list 'load-path (expand-file-name "/path/to/org-mode/contrib/lisp" t))
1087 @end example
1088
1089 If an error occurs, a backtrace can be very useful (see below on how to
1090 create one). Often a small example file helps, along with clear information
1091 about:
1092
1093 @enumerate
1094 @item What exactly did you do?
1095 @item What did you expect to happen?
1096 @item What happened instead?
1097 @end enumerate
1098 @noindent Thank you for helping to improve this program.
1099
1100 @subsubheading How to create a useful backtrace
1101
1102 @cindex backtrace of an error
1103 If working with Org produces an error with a message you don't
1104 understand, you may have hit a bug. The best way to report this is by
1105 providing, in addition to what was mentioned above, a @emph{backtrace}.
1106 This is information from the built-in debugger about where and how the
1107 error occurred. Here is how to produce a useful backtrace:
1108
1109 @enumerate
1110 @item
1111 Reload uncompiled versions of all Org mode Lisp files. The backtrace
1112 contains much more information if it is produced with uncompiled code.
1113 To do this, use
1114 @example
1115 C-u M-x org-reload RET
1116 @end example
1117 @noindent
1118 or select @code{Org -> Refresh/Reload -> Reload Org uncompiled} from the
1119 menu.
1120 @item
1121 Go to the @code{Options} menu and select @code{Enter Debugger on Error}
1122 (XEmacs has this option in the @code{Troubleshooting} sub-menu).
1123 @item
1124 Do whatever you have to do to hit the error. Don't forget to
1125 document the steps you take.
1126 @item
1127 When you hit the error, a @file{*Backtrace*} buffer will appear on the
1128 screen. Save this buffer to a file (for example using @kbd{C-x C-w}) and
1129 attach it to your bug report.
1130 @end enumerate
1131
1132 @node Conventions, , Feedback, Introduction
1133 @section Typesetting conventions used in this manual
1134
1135 @subsubheading TODO keywords, tags, properties, etc.
1136
1137 Org mainly uses three types of keywords: TODO keywords, tags and property
1138 names. In this manual we use the following conventions:
1139
1140 @table @code
1141 @item TODO
1142 @itemx WAITING
1143 TODO keywords are written with all capitals, even if they are
1144 user-defined.
1145 @item boss
1146 @itemx ARCHIVE
1147 User-defined tags are written in lowercase; built-in tags with special
1148 meaning are written with all capitals.
1149 @item Release
1150 @itemx PRIORITY
1151 User-defined properties are capitalized; built-in properties with
1152 special meaning are written with all capitals.
1153 @end table
1154
1155 Moreover, Org uses @i{option keywords} (like @code{#+TITLE} to set the title)
1156 and @i{environment keywords} (like @code{#+BEGIN_HTML} to start a @code{HTML}
1157 environment). They are written in uppercase in the manual to enhance its
1158 readability, but you can use lowercase in your Org files@footnote{Easy
1159 templates insert lowercase keywords and Babel dynamically inserts
1160 @code{#+results}.}
1161
1162 @subsubheading Keybindings and commands
1163 @kindex C-c a
1164 @findex org-agenda
1165 @kindex C-c c
1166 @findex org-capture
1167
1168 The manual suggests two global keybindings: @kbd{C-c a} for @code{org-agenda}
1169 and @kbd{C-c c} for @code{org-capture}. These are only suggestions, but the
1170 rest of the manual assumes that you are using these keybindings.
1171
1172 Also, the manual lists both the keys and the corresponding commands for
1173 accessing a functionality. Org mode often uses the same key for different
1174 functions, depending on context. The command that is bound to such keys has
1175 a generic name, like @code{org-metaright}. In the manual we will, wherever
1176 possible, give the function that is internally called by the generic command.
1177 For example, in the chapter on document structure, @kbd{M-@key{right}} will
1178 be listed to call @code{org-do-demote}, while in the chapter on tables, it
1179 will be listed to call @code{org-table-move-column-right}. If you prefer,
1180 you can compile the manual without the command names by unsetting the flag
1181 @code{cmdnames} in @file{org.texi}.
1182
1183 @node Document Structure, Tables, Introduction, Top
1184 @chapter Document structure
1185 @cindex document structure
1186 @cindex structure of document
1187
1188 Org is based on Outline mode and provides flexible commands to
1189 edit the structure of the document.
1190
1191 @menu
1192 * Outlines:: Org is based on Outline mode
1193 * Headlines:: How to typeset Org tree headlines
1194 * Visibility cycling:: Show and hide, much simplified
1195 * Motion:: Jumping to other headlines
1196 * Structure editing:: Changing sequence and level of headlines
1197 * Sparse trees:: Matches embedded in context
1198 * Plain lists:: Additional structure within an entry
1199 * Drawers:: Tucking stuff away
1200 * Blocks:: Folding blocks
1201 * Footnotes:: How footnotes are defined in Org's syntax
1202 * Orgstruct mode:: Structure editing outside Org
1203 @end menu
1204
1205 @node Outlines, Headlines, Document Structure, Document Structure
1206 @section Outlines
1207 @cindex outlines
1208 @cindex Outline mode
1209
1210 Org is implemented on top of Outline mode. Outlines allow a
1211 document to be organized in a hierarchical structure, which (at least
1212 for me) is the best representation of notes and thoughts. An overview
1213 of this structure is achieved by folding (hiding) large parts of the
1214 document to show only the general document structure and the parts
1215 currently being worked on. Org greatly simplifies the use of
1216 outlines by compressing the entire show/hide functionality into a single
1217 command, @command{org-cycle}, which is bound to the @key{TAB} key.
1218
1219 @node Headlines, Visibility cycling, Outlines, Document Structure
1220 @section Headlines
1221 @cindex headlines
1222 @cindex outline tree
1223 @vindex org-special-ctrl-a/e
1224 @vindex org-special-ctrl-k
1225 @vindex org-ctrl-k-protect-subtree
1226
1227 Headlines define the structure of an outline tree. The headlines in Org
1228 start with one or more stars, on the left margin@footnote{See the variables
1229 @code{org-special-ctrl-a/e}, @code{org-special-ctrl-k}, and
1230 @code{org-ctrl-k-protect-subtree} to configure special behavior of @kbd{C-a},
1231 @kbd{C-e}, and @kbd{C-k} in headlines.} @footnote{Clocking only works with
1232 headings indented less then 30 stars.}. For example:
1233
1234 @example
1235 * Top level headline
1236 ** Second level
1237 *** 3rd level
1238 some text
1239 *** 3rd level
1240 more text
1241
1242 * Another top level headline
1243 @end example
1244
1245 @noindent Some people find the many stars too noisy and would prefer an
1246 outline that has whitespace followed by a single star as headline
1247 starters. @ref{Clean view}, describes a setup to realize this.
1248
1249 @vindex org-cycle-separator-lines
1250 An empty line after the end of a subtree is considered part of it and
1251 will be hidden when the subtree is folded. However, if you leave at
1252 least two empty lines, one empty line will remain visible after folding
1253 the subtree, in order to structure the collapsed view. See the
1254 variable @code{org-cycle-separator-lines} to modify this behavior.
1255
1256 @node Visibility cycling, Motion, Headlines, Document Structure
1257 @section Visibility cycling
1258 @cindex cycling, visibility
1259 @cindex visibility cycling
1260 @cindex trees, visibility
1261 @cindex show hidden text
1262 @cindex hide text
1263
1264 Outlines make it possible to hide parts of the text in the buffer.
1265 Org uses just two commands, bound to @key{TAB} and
1266 @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} to change the visibility in the buffer.
1267
1268 @cindex subtree visibility states
1269 @cindex subtree cycling
1270 @cindex folded, subtree visibility state
1271 @cindex children, subtree visibility state
1272 @cindex subtree, subtree visibility state
1273 @table @asis
1274 @orgcmd{@key{TAB},org-cycle}
1275 @emph{Subtree cycling}: Rotate current subtree among the states
1276
1277 @example
1278 ,-> FOLDED -> CHILDREN -> SUBTREE --.
1279 '-----------------------------------'
1280 @end example
1281
1282 @vindex org-cycle-emulate-tab
1283 @vindex org-cycle-global-at-bob
1284 The cursor must be on a headline for this to work@footnote{see, however,
1285 the option @code{org-cycle-emulate-tab}.}. When the cursor is at the
1286 beginning of the buffer and the first line is not a headline, then
1287 @key{TAB} actually runs global cycling (see below)@footnote{see the
1288 option @code{org-cycle-global-at-bob}.}. Also when called with a prefix
1289 argument (@kbd{C-u @key{TAB}}), global cycling is invoked.
1290
1291 @cindex global visibility states
1292 @cindex global cycling
1293 @cindex overview, global visibility state
1294 @cindex contents, global visibility state
1295 @cindex show all, global visibility state
1296 @orgcmd{S-@key{TAB},org-global-cycle}
1297 @itemx C-u @key{TAB}
1298 @emph{Global cycling}: Rotate the entire buffer among the states
1299
1300 @example
1301 ,-> OVERVIEW -> CONTENTS -> SHOW ALL --.
1302 '--------------------------------------'
1303 @end example
1304
1305 When @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} is called with a numeric prefix argument N, the
1306 CONTENTS view up to headlines of level N will be shown. Note that inside
1307 tables, @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} jumps to the previous field.
1308
1309 @cindex show all, command
1310 @orgcmd{C-u C-u C-u @key{TAB},show-all}
1311 Show all, including drawers.
1312 @cindex revealing context
1313 @orgcmd{C-c C-r,org-reveal}
1314 Reveal context around point, showing the current entry, the following heading
1315 and the hierarchy above. Useful for working near a location that has been
1316 exposed by a sparse tree command (@pxref{Sparse trees}) or an agenda command
1317 (@pxref{Agenda commands}). With a prefix argument show, on each
1318 level, all sibling headings. With a double prefix argument, also show the
1319 entire subtree of the parent.
1320 @cindex show branches, command
1321 @orgcmd{C-c C-k,show-branches}
1322 Expose all the headings of the subtree, CONTENT view for just one subtree.
1323 @cindex show children, command
1324 @orgcmd{C-c @key{TAB},show-children}
1325 Expose all direct children of the subtree. With a numeric prefix argument N,
1326 expose all children down to level N@.
1327 @orgcmd{C-c C-x b,org-tree-to-indirect-buffer}
1328 Show the current subtree in an indirect buffer@footnote{The indirect
1329 buffer
1330 @ifinfo
1331 (@pxref{Indirect Buffers,,,emacs,GNU Emacs Manual})
1332 @end ifinfo
1333 @ifnotinfo
1334 (see the Emacs manual for more information about indirect buffers)
1335 @end ifnotinfo
1336 will contain the entire buffer, but will be narrowed to the current
1337 tree. Editing the indirect buffer will also change the original buffer,
1338 but without affecting visibility in that buffer.}. With a numeric
1339 prefix argument N, go up to level N and then take that tree. If N is
1340 negative then go up that many levels. With a @kbd{C-u} prefix, do not remove
1341 the previously used indirect buffer.
1342 @orgcmd{C-c C-x v,org-copy-visible}
1343 Copy the @i{visible} text in the region into the kill ring.
1344 @end table
1345
1346 @vindex org-startup-folded
1347 @cindex @code{overview}, STARTUP keyword
1348 @cindex @code{content}, STARTUP keyword
1349 @cindex @code{showall}, STARTUP keyword
1350 @cindex @code{showeverything}, STARTUP keyword
1351
1352 When Emacs first visits an Org file, the global state is set to
1353 OVERVIEW, i.e., only the top level headlines are visible. This can be
1354 configured through the variable @code{org-startup-folded}, or on a
1355 per-file basis by adding one of the following lines anywhere in the
1356 buffer:
1357
1358 @example
1359 #+STARTUP: overview
1360 #+STARTUP: content
1361 #+STARTUP: showall
1362 #+STARTUP: showeverything
1363 @end example
1364
1365 @cindex property, VISIBILITY
1366 @noindent
1367 Furthermore, any entries with a @samp{VISIBILITY} property (@pxref{Properties
1368 and Columns}) will get their visibility adapted accordingly. Allowed values
1369 for this property are @code{folded}, @code{children}, @code{content}, and
1370 @code{all}.
1371 @table @asis
1372 @orgcmd{C-u C-u @key{TAB},org-set-startup-visibility}
1373 Switch back to the startup visibility of the buffer, i.e., whatever is
1374 requested by startup options and @samp{VISIBILITY} properties in individual
1375 entries.
1376 @end table
1377
1378 @node Motion, Structure editing, Visibility cycling, Document Structure
1379 @section Motion
1380 @cindex motion, between headlines
1381 @cindex jumping, to headlines
1382 @cindex headline navigation
1383 The following commands jump to other headlines in the buffer.
1384
1385 @table @asis
1386 @orgcmd{C-c C-n,outline-next-visible-heading}
1387 Next heading.
1388 @orgcmd{C-c C-p,outline-previous-visible-heading}
1389 Previous heading.
1390 @orgcmd{C-c C-f,org-forward-same-level}
1391 Next heading same level.
1392 @orgcmd{C-c C-b,org-backward-same-level}
1393 Previous heading same level.
1394 @orgcmd{C-c C-u,outline-up-heading}
1395 Backward to higher level heading.
1396 @orgcmd{C-c C-j,org-goto}
1397 Jump to a different place without changing the current outline
1398 visibility. Shows the document structure in a temporary buffer, where
1399 you can use the following keys to find your destination:
1400 @vindex org-goto-auto-isearch
1401 @example
1402 @key{TAB} @r{Cycle visibility.}
1403 @key{down} / @key{up} @r{Next/previous visible headline.}
1404 @key{RET} @r{Select this location.}
1405 @kbd{/} @r{Do a Sparse-tree search}
1406 @r{The following keys work if you turn off @code{org-goto-auto-isearch}}
1407 n / p @r{Next/previous visible headline.}
1408 f / b @r{Next/previous headline same level.}
1409 u @r{One level up.}
1410 0-9 @r{Digit argument.}
1411 q @r{Quit}
1412 @end example
1413 @vindex org-goto-interface
1414 @noindent
1415 See also the variable @code{org-goto-interface}.
1416 @end table
1417
1418 @node Structure editing, Sparse trees, Motion, Document Structure
1419 @section Structure editing
1420 @cindex structure editing
1421 @cindex headline, promotion and demotion
1422 @cindex promotion, of subtrees
1423 @cindex demotion, of subtrees
1424 @cindex subtree, cut and paste
1425 @cindex pasting, of subtrees
1426 @cindex cutting, of subtrees
1427 @cindex copying, of subtrees
1428 @cindex sorting, of subtrees
1429 @cindex subtrees, cut and paste
1430
1431 @table @asis
1432 @orgcmd{M-@key{RET},org-insert-heading}
1433 @vindex org-M-RET-may-split-line
1434 Insert new heading with same level as current. If the cursor is in a plain
1435 list item, a new item is created (@pxref{Plain lists}). To force creation of
1436 a new headline, use a prefix argument. When this command is used in the
1437 middle of a line, the line is split and the rest of the line becomes the new
1438 headline@footnote{If you do not want the line to be split, customize the
1439 variable @code{org-M-RET-may-split-line}.}. If the command is used at the
1440 beginning of a headline, the new headline is created before the current line.
1441 If at the beginning of any other line, the content of that line is made the
1442 new heading. If the command is used at the end of a folded subtree (i.e.,
1443 behind the ellipses at the end of a headline), then a headline like the
1444 current one will be inserted after the end of the subtree.
1445 @orgcmd{C-@key{RET},org-insert-heading-respect-content}
1446 Just like @kbd{M-@key{RET}}, except when adding a new heading below the
1447 current heading, the new heading is placed after the body instead of before
1448 it. This command works from anywhere in the entry.
1449 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{RET},org-insert-todo-heading}
1450 @vindex org-treat-insert-todo-heading-as-state-change
1451 Insert new TODO entry with same level as current heading. See also the
1452 variable @code{org-treat-insert-todo-heading-as-state-change}.
1453 @orgcmd{C-S-@key{RET},org-insert-todo-heading-respect-content}
1454 Insert new TODO entry with same level as current heading. Like
1455 @kbd{C-@key{RET}}, the new headline will be inserted after the current
1456 subtree.
1457 @orgcmd{@key{TAB},org-cycle}
1458 In a new entry with no text yet, the first @key{TAB} demotes the entry to
1459 become a child of the previous one. The next @key{TAB} makes it a parent,
1460 and so on, all the way to top level. Yet another @key{TAB}, and you are back
1461 to the initial level.
1462 @orgcmd{M-@key{left},org-do-promote}
1463 Promote current heading by one level.
1464 @orgcmd{M-@key{right},org-do-demote}
1465 Demote current heading by one level.
1466 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{left},org-promote-subtree}
1467 Promote the current subtree by one level.
1468 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{right},org-demote-subtree}
1469 Demote the current subtree by one level.
1470 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{up},org-move-subtree-up}
1471 Move subtree up (swap with previous subtree of same
1472 level).
1473 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{down},org-move-subtree-down}
1474 Move subtree down (swap with next subtree of same level).
1475 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-w,org-cut-subtree}
1476 Kill subtree, i.e., remove it from buffer but save in kill ring.
1477 With a numeric prefix argument N, kill N sequential subtrees.
1478 @orgcmd{C-c C-x M-w,org-copy-subtree}
1479 Copy subtree to kill ring. With a numeric prefix argument N, copy the N
1480 sequential subtrees.
1481 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-y,org-paste-subtree}
1482 Yank subtree from kill ring. This does modify the level of the subtree to
1483 make sure the tree fits in nicely at the yank position. The yank level can
1484 also be specified with a numeric prefix argument, or by yanking after a
1485 headline marker like @samp{****}.
1486 @orgcmd{C-y,org-yank}
1487 @vindex org-yank-adjusted-subtrees
1488 @vindex org-yank-folded-subtrees
1489 Depending on the variables @code{org-yank-adjusted-subtrees} and
1490 @code{org-yank-folded-subtrees}, Org's internal @code{yank} command will
1491 paste subtrees folded and in a clever way, using the same command as @kbd{C-c
1492 C-x C-y}. With the default settings, no level adjustment will take place,
1493 but the yanked tree will be folded unless doing so would swallow text
1494 previously visible. Any prefix argument to this command will force a normal
1495 @code{yank} to be executed, with the prefix passed along. A good way to
1496 force a normal yank is @kbd{C-u C-y}. If you use @code{yank-pop} after a
1497 yank, it will yank previous kill items plainly, without adjustment and
1498 folding.
1499 @orgcmd{C-c C-x c,org-clone-subtree-with-time-shift}
1500 Clone a subtree by making a number of sibling copies of it. You will be
1501 prompted for the number of copies to make, and you can also specify if any
1502 timestamps in the entry should be shifted. This can be useful, for example,
1503 to create a number of tasks related to a series of lectures to prepare. For
1504 more details, see the docstring of the command
1505 @code{org-clone-subtree-with-time-shift}.
1506 @orgcmd{C-c C-w,org-refile}
1507 Refile entry or region to a different location. @xref{Refiling notes}.
1508 @orgcmd{C-c ^,org-sort}
1509 Sort same-level entries. When there is an active region, all entries in the
1510 region will be sorted. Otherwise the children of the current headline are
1511 sorted. The command prompts for the sorting method, which can be
1512 alphabetically, numerically, by time (first timestamp with active preferred,
1513 creation time, scheduled time, deadline time), by priority, by TODO keyword
1514 (in the sequence the keywords have been defined in the setup) or by the value
1515 of a property. Reverse sorting is possible as well. You can also supply
1516 your own function to extract the sorting key. With a @kbd{C-u} prefix,
1517 sorting will be case-sensitive.
1518 @orgcmd{C-x n s,org-narrow-to-subtree}
1519 Narrow buffer to current subtree.
1520 @orgcmd{C-x n b,org-narrow-to-block}
1521 Narrow buffer to current block.
1522 @orgcmd{C-x n w,widen}
1523 Widen buffer to remove narrowing.
1524 @orgcmd{C-c *,org-toggle-heading}
1525 Turn a normal line or plain list item into a headline (so that it becomes a
1526 subheading at its location). Also turn a headline into a normal line by
1527 removing the stars. If there is an active region, turn all lines in the
1528 region into headlines. If the first line in the region was an item, turn
1529 only the item lines into headlines. Finally, if the first line is a
1530 headline, remove the stars from all headlines in the region.
1531 @end table
1532
1533 @cindex region, active
1534 @cindex active region
1535 @cindex transient mark mode
1536 When there is an active region (Transient Mark mode), promotion and
1537 demotion work on all headlines in the region. To select a region of
1538 headlines, it is best to place both point and mark at the beginning of a
1539 line, mark at the beginning of the first headline, and point at the line
1540 just after the last headline to change. Note that when the cursor is
1541 inside a table (@pxref{Tables}), the Meta-Cursor keys have different
1542 functionality.
1543
1544
1545 @node Sparse trees, Plain lists, Structure editing, Document Structure
1546 @section Sparse trees
1547 @cindex sparse trees
1548 @cindex trees, sparse
1549 @cindex folding, sparse trees
1550 @cindex occur, command
1551
1552 @vindex org-show-hierarchy-above
1553 @vindex org-show-following-heading
1554 @vindex org-show-siblings
1555 @vindex org-show-entry-below
1556 An important feature of Org mode is the ability to construct @emph{sparse
1557 trees} for selected information in an outline tree, so that the entire
1558 document is folded as much as possible, but the selected information is made
1559 visible along with the headline structure above it@footnote{See also the
1560 variables @code{org-show-hierarchy-above}, @code{org-show-following-heading},
1561 @code{org-show-siblings}, and @code{org-show-entry-below} for detailed
1562 control on how much context is shown around each match.}. Just try it out
1563 and you will see immediately how it works.
1564
1565 Org mode contains several commands creating such trees, all these
1566 commands can be accessed through a dispatcher:
1567
1568 @table @asis
1569 @orgcmd{C-c /,org-sparse-tree}
1570 This prompts for an extra key to select a sparse-tree creating command.
1571 @orgcmd{C-c / r,org-occur}
1572 @vindex org-remove-highlights-with-change
1573 Prompts for a regexp and shows a sparse tree with all matches. If
1574 the match is in a headline, the headline is made visible. If the match is in
1575 the body of an entry, headline and body are made visible. In order to
1576 provide minimal context, also the full hierarchy of headlines above the match
1577 is shown, as well as the headline following the match. Each match is also
1578 highlighted; the highlights disappear when the buffer is changed by an
1579 editing command@footnote{This depends on the option
1580 @code{org-remove-highlights-with-change}}, or by pressing @kbd{C-c C-c}.
1581 When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix argument, previous highlights are kept,
1582 so several calls to this command can be stacked.
1583 @orgcmdkkc{M-g n,M-g M-n,next-error}
1584 Jump to the next sparse tree match in this buffer.
1585 @orgcmdkkc{M-g p,M-g M-p,previous-error}
1586 Jump to the previous sparse tree match in this buffer.
1587 @end table
1588
1589
1590 @noindent
1591 @vindex org-agenda-custom-commands
1592 For frequently used sparse trees of specific search strings, you can
1593 use the variable @code{org-agenda-custom-commands} to define fast
1594 keyboard access to specific sparse trees. These commands will then be
1595 accessible through the agenda dispatcher (@pxref{Agenda dispatcher}).
1596 For example:
1597
1598 @lisp
1599 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands
1600 '(("f" occur-tree "FIXME")))
1601 @end lisp
1602
1603 @noindent will define the key @kbd{C-c a f} as a shortcut for creating
1604 a sparse tree matching the string @samp{FIXME}.
1605
1606 The other sparse tree commands select headings based on TODO keywords,
1607 tags, or properties and will be discussed later in this manual.
1608
1609 @kindex C-c C-e v
1610 @cindex printing sparse trees
1611 @cindex visible text, printing
1612 To print a sparse tree, you can use the Emacs command
1613 @code{ps-print-buffer-with-faces} which does not print invisible parts
1614 of the document @footnote{This does not work under XEmacs, because
1615 XEmacs uses selective display for outlining, not text properties.}.
1616 Or you can use the command @kbd{C-c C-e v} to export only the visible
1617 part of the document and print the resulting file.
1618
1619 @node Plain lists, Drawers, Sparse trees, Document Structure
1620 @section Plain lists
1621 @cindex plain lists
1622 @cindex lists, plain
1623 @cindex lists, ordered
1624 @cindex ordered lists
1625
1626 Within an entry of the outline tree, hand-formatted lists can provide
1627 additional structure. They also provide a way to create lists of checkboxes
1628 (@pxref{Checkboxes}). Org supports editing such lists, and every exporter
1629 (@pxref{Exporting}) can parse and format them.
1630
1631 Org knows ordered lists, unordered lists, and description lists.
1632 @itemize @bullet
1633 @item
1634 @emph{Unordered} list items start with @samp{-}, @samp{+}, or
1635 @samp{*}@footnote{When using @samp{*} as a bullet, lines must be indented or
1636 they will be seen as top-level headlines. Also, when you are hiding leading
1637 stars to get a clean outline view, plain list items starting with a star may
1638 be hard to distinguish from true headlines. In short: even though @samp{*}
1639 is supported, it may be better to not use it for plain list items.} as
1640 bullets.
1641 @item
1642 @vindex org-plain-list-ordered-item-terminator
1643 @vindex org-alphabetical-lists
1644 @emph{Ordered} list items start with a numeral followed by either a period or
1645 a right parenthesis@footnote{You can filter out any of them by configuring
1646 @code{org-plain-list-ordered-item-terminator}.}, such as @samp{1.} or
1647 @samp{1)}@footnote{You can also get @samp{a.}, @samp{A.}, @samp{a)} and
1648 @samp{A)} by configuring @code{org-alphabetical-lists}. To minimize
1649 confusion with normal text, those are limited to one character only. Beyond
1650 that limit, bullets will automatically fallback to numbers.}. If you want a
1651 list to start with a different value (e.g., 20), start the text of the item
1652 with @code{[@@20]}@footnote{If there's a checkbox in the item, the cookie
1653 must be put @emph{before} the checkbox. If you have activated alphabetical
1654 lists, you can also use counters like @code{[@@b]}.}. Those constructs can
1655 be used in any item of the list in order to enforce a particular numbering.
1656 @item
1657 @emph{Description} list items are unordered list items, and contain the
1658 separator @samp{ :: } to distinguish the description @emph{term} from the
1659 description.
1660 @end itemize
1661
1662 Items belonging to the same list must have the same indentation on the first
1663 line. In particular, if an ordered list reaches number @samp{10.}, then the
1664 2--digit numbers must be written left-aligned with the other numbers in the
1665 list. An item ends before the next line that is less or equally indented
1666 than its bullet/number.
1667
1668 @vindex org-empty-line-terminates-plain-lists
1669 A list ends whenever every item has ended, which means before any line less
1670 or equally indented than items at top level. It also ends before two blank
1671 lines@footnote{See also @code{org-empty-line-terminates-plain-lists}.}. In
1672 that case, all items are closed. Here is an example:
1673
1674 @example
1675 @group
1676 ** Lord of the Rings
1677 My favorite scenes are (in this order)
1678 1. The attack of the Rohirrim
1679 2. Eowyn's fight with the witch king
1680 + this was already my favorite scene in the book
1681 + I really like Miranda Otto.
1682 3. Peter Jackson being shot by Legolas
1683 - on DVD only
1684 He makes a really funny face when it happens.
1685 But in the end, no individual scenes matter but the film as a whole.
1686 Important actors in this film are:
1687 - @b{Elijah Wood} :: He plays Frodo
1688 - @b{Sean Austin} :: He plays Sam, Frodo's friend. I still remember
1689 him very well from his role as Mikey Walsh in @i{The Goonies}.
1690 @end group
1691 @end example
1692
1693 Org supports these lists by tuning filling and wrapping commands to deal with
1694 them correctly@footnote{Org only changes the filling settings for Emacs. For
1695 XEmacs, you should use Kyle E. Jones' @file{filladapt.el}. To turn this on,
1696 put into @file{.emacs}: @code{(require 'filladapt)}}, and by exporting them
1697 properly (@pxref{Exporting}). Since indentation is what governs the
1698 structure of these lists, many structural constructs like @code{#+BEGIN_...}
1699 blocks can be indented to signal that they belong to a particular item.
1700
1701 @vindex org-list-demote-modify-bullet
1702 @vindex org-list-indent-offset
1703 If you find that using a different bullet for a sub-list (than that used for
1704 the current list-level) improves readability, customize the variable
1705 @code{org-list-demote-modify-bullet}. To get a greater difference of
1706 indentation between items and theirs sub-items, customize
1707 @code{org-list-indent-offset}.
1708
1709 @vindex org-list-automatic-rules
1710 The following commands act on items when the cursor is in the first line of
1711 an item (the line with the bullet or number). Some of them imply the
1712 application of automatic rules to keep list structure intact. If some of
1713 these actions get in your way, configure @code{org-list-automatic-rules}
1714 to disable them individually.
1715
1716 @table @asis
1717 @orgcmd{@key{TAB},org-cycle}
1718 @cindex cycling, in plain lists
1719 @vindex org-cycle-include-plain-lists
1720 Items can be folded just like headline levels. Normally this works only if
1721 the cursor is on a plain list item. For more details, see the variable
1722 @code{org-cycle-include-plain-lists}. If this variable is set to
1723 @code{integrate}, plain list items will be treated like low-level
1724 headlines. The level of an item is then given by the indentation of the
1725 bullet/number. Items are always subordinate to real headlines, however; the
1726 hierarchies remain completely separated. In a new item with no text yet, the
1727 first @key{TAB} demotes the item to become a child of the previous
1728 one. Subsequent @key{TAB}s move the item to meaningful levels in the list
1729 and eventually get it back to its initial position.
1730 @orgcmd{M-@key{RET},org-insert-heading}
1731 @vindex org-M-RET-may-split-line
1732 @vindex org-list-automatic-rules
1733 Insert new item at current level. With a prefix argument, force a new
1734 heading (@pxref{Structure editing}). If this command is used in the middle
1735 of an item, that item is @emph{split} in two, and the second part becomes the
1736 new item@footnote{If you do not want the item to be split, customize the
1737 variable @code{org-M-RET-may-split-line}.}. If this command is executed
1738 @emph{before item's body}, the new item is created @emph{before} the current
1739 one.
1740 @end table
1741
1742 @table @kbd
1743 @kindex M-S-@key{RET}
1744 @item M-S-RET
1745 Insert a new item with a checkbox (@pxref{Checkboxes}).
1746 @kindex S-@key{down}
1747 @item S-up
1748 @itemx S-down
1749 @cindex shift-selection-mode
1750 @vindex org-support-shift-select
1751 @vindex org-list-use-circular-motion
1752 Jump to the previous/next item in the current list@footnote{If you want to
1753 cycle around items that way, you may customize
1754 @code{org-list-use-circular-motion}.}, but only if
1755 @code{org-support-shift-select} is off. If not, you can still use paragraph
1756 jumping commands like @kbd{C-@key{up}} and @kbd{C-@key{down}} to quite
1757 similar effect.
1758 @kindex M-@key{up}
1759 @kindex M-@key{down}
1760 @item M-up
1761 @itemx M-down
1762 Move the item including subitems up/down@footnote{See
1763 @code{org-liste-use-circular-motion} for a cyclic behavior.} (swap with
1764 previous/next item of same indentation). If the list is ordered, renumbering
1765 is automatic.
1766 @kindex M-@key{left}
1767 @kindex M-@key{right}
1768 @item M-left
1769 @itemx M-right
1770 Decrease/increase the indentation of an item, leaving children alone.
1771 @kindex M-S-@key{left}
1772 @kindex M-S-@key{right}
1773 @item M-S-left
1774 @itemx M-S-right
1775 Decrease/increase the indentation of the item, including subitems.
1776 Initially, the item tree is selected based on current indentation. When
1777 these commands are executed several times in direct succession, the initially
1778 selected region is used, even if the new indentation would imply a different
1779 hierarchy. To use the new hierarchy, break the command chain with a cursor
1780 motion or so.
1781
1782 As a special case, using this command on the very first item of a list will
1783 move the whole list. This behavior can be disabled by configuring
1784 @code{org-list-automatic-rules}. The global indentation of a list has no
1785 influence on the text @emph{after} the list.
1786 @kindex C-c C-c
1787 @item C-c C-c
1788 If there is a checkbox (@pxref{Checkboxes}) in the item line, toggle the
1789 state of the checkbox. In any case, verify bullets and indentation
1790 consistency in the whole list.
1791 @kindex C-c -
1792 @vindex org-plain-list-ordered-item-terminator
1793 @item C-c -
1794 Cycle the entire list level through the different itemize/enumerate bullets
1795 (@samp{-}, @samp{+}, @samp{*}, @samp{1.}, @samp{1)}) or a subset of them,
1796 depending on @code{org-plain-list-ordered-item-terminator}, the type of list,
1797 and its indentation. With a numeric prefix argument N, select the Nth bullet
1798 from this list. If there is an active region when calling this, selected
1799 text will be changed into an item. With a prefix argument, all lines will be
1800 converted to list items. If the first line already was a list item, any item
1801 marker will be removed from the list. Finally, even without an active
1802 region, a normal line will be converted into a list item.
1803 @kindex C-c *
1804 @item C-c *
1805 Turn a plain list item into a headline (so that it becomes a subheading at
1806 its location). @xref{Structure editing}, for a detailed explanation.
1807 @kindex C-c C-*
1808 @item C-c C-*
1809 Turn the whole plain list into a subtree of the current heading. Checkboxes
1810 (@pxref{Checkboxes}) will become TODO (resp. DONE) keywords when unchecked
1811 (resp. checked).
1812 @kindex S-@key{left}
1813 @kindex S-@key{right}
1814 @item S-left/right
1815 @vindex org-support-shift-select
1816 This command also cycles bullet styles when the cursor in on the bullet or
1817 anywhere in an item line, details depending on
1818 @code{org-support-shift-select}.
1819 @kindex C-c ^
1820 @item C-c ^
1821 Sort the plain list. You will be prompted for the sorting method:
1822 numerically, alphabetically, by time, or by custom function.
1823 @end table
1824
1825 @node Drawers, Blocks, Plain lists, Document Structure
1826 @section Drawers
1827 @cindex drawers
1828 @cindex #+DRAWERS
1829 @cindex visibility cycling, drawers
1830
1831 @vindex org-drawers
1832 @cindex org-insert-drawer
1833 @kindex C-c C-x d
1834 Sometimes you want to keep information associated with an entry, but you
1835 normally don't want to see it. For this, Org mode has @emph{drawers}.
1836 Drawers need to be configured with the variable
1837 @code{org-drawers}@footnote{You can define additional drawers on a
1838 per-file basis with a line like @code{#+DRAWERS: HIDDEN STATE}}. Drawers
1839 look like this:
1840
1841 @example
1842 ** This is a headline
1843 Still outside the drawer
1844 :DRAWERNAME:
1845 This is inside the drawer.
1846 :END:
1847 After the drawer.
1848 @end example
1849
1850 You can interactively insert drawers at point by calling
1851 @code{org-insert-drawer}, which is bound to @key{C-c C-x d}. With an active
1852 region, this command will put the region inside the drawer. With a prefix
1853 argument, this command calls @code{org-insert-property-drawer} and add a
1854 property drawer right below the current headline. Completion over drawer
1855 keywords is also possible using @key{M-TAB}.
1856
1857 Visibility cycling (@pxref{Visibility cycling}) on the headline will hide and
1858 show the entry, but keep the drawer collapsed to a single line. In order to
1859 look inside the drawer, you need to move the cursor to the drawer line and
1860 press @key{TAB} there. Org mode uses the @code{PROPERTIES} drawer for
1861 storing properties (@pxref{Properties and Columns}), and you can also arrange
1862 for state change notes (@pxref{Tracking TODO state changes}) and clock times
1863 (@pxref{Clocking work time}) to be stored in a drawer @code{LOGBOOK}. If you
1864 want to store a quick note in the LOGBOOK drawer, in a similar way to state changes, use
1865
1866 @table @kbd
1867 @kindex C-c C-z
1868 @item C-c C-z
1869 Add a time-stamped note to the LOGBOOK drawer.
1870 @end table
1871
1872 @node Blocks, Footnotes, Drawers, Document Structure
1873 @section Blocks
1874
1875 @vindex org-hide-block-startup
1876 @cindex blocks, folding
1877 Org mode uses begin...end blocks for various purposes from including source
1878 code examples (@pxref{Literal examples}) to capturing time logging
1879 information (@pxref{Clocking work time}). These blocks can be folded and
1880 unfolded by pressing TAB in the begin line. You can also get all blocks
1881 folded at startup by configuring the variable @code{org-hide-block-startup}
1882 or on a per-file basis by using
1883
1884 @cindex @code{hideblocks}, STARTUP keyword
1885 @cindex @code{nohideblocks}, STARTUP keyword
1886 @example
1887 #+STARTUP: hideblocks
1888 #+STARTUP: nohideblocks
1889 @end example
1890
1891 @node Footnotes, Orgstruct mode, Blocks, Document Structure
1892 @section Footnotes
1893 @cindex footnotes
1894
1895 Org mode supports the creation of footnotes. In contrast to the
1896 @file{footnote.el} package, Org mode's footnotes are designed for work on a
1897 larger document, not only for one-off documents like emails. The basic
1898 syntax is similar to the one used by @file{footnote.el}, i.e., a footnote is
1899 defined in a paragraph that is started by a footnote marker in square
1900 brackets in column 0, no indentation allowed. If you need a paragraph break
1901 inside a footnote, use the @LaTeX{} idiom @samp{\par}. The footnote reference
1902 is simply the marker in square brackets, inside text. For example:
1903
1904 @example
1905 The Org homepage[fn:1] now looks a lot better than it used to.
1906 ...
1907 [fn:1] The link is: http://orgmode.org
1908 @end example
1909
1910 Org mode extends the number-based syntax to @emph{named} footnotes and
1911 optional inline definition. Using plain numbers as markers (as
1912 @file{footnote.el} does) is supported for backward compatibility, but not
1913 encouraged because of possible conflicts with @LaTeX{} snippets (@pxref{Embedded
1914 @LaTeX{}}). Here are the valid references:
1915
1916 @table @code
1917 @item [1]
1918 A plain numeric footnote marker. Compatible with @file{footnote.el}, but not
1919 recommended because something like @samp{[1]} could easily be part of a code
1920 snippet.
1921 @item [fn:name]
1922 A named footnote reference, where @code{name} is a unique label word, or, for
1923 simplicity of automatic creation, a number.
1924 @item [fn:: This is the inline definition of this footnote]
1925 A @LaTeX{}-like anonymous footnote where the definition is given directly at the
1926 reference point.
1927 @item [fn:name: a definition]
1928 An inline definition of a footnote, which also specifies a name for the note.
1929 Since Org allows multiple references to the same note, you can then use
1930 @code{[fn:name]} to create additional references.
1931 @end table
1932
1933 @vindex org-footnote-auto-label
1934 Footnote labels can be created automatically, or you can create names yourself.
1935 This is handled by the variable @code{org-footnote-auto-label} and its
1936 corresponding @code{#+STARTUP} keywords. See the docstring of that variable
1937 for details.
1938
1939 @noindent The following command handles footnotes:
1940
1941 @table @kbd
1942 @kindex C-c C-x f
1943 @item C-c C-x f
1944 The footnote action command.
1945
1946 When the cursor is on a footnote reference, jump to the definition. When it
1947 is at a definition, jump to the (first) reference.
1948
1949 @vindex org-footnote-define-inline
1950 @vindex org-footnote-section
1951 @vindex org-footnote-auto-adjust
1952 Otherwise, create a new footnote. Depending on the variable
1953 @code{org-footnote-define-inline}@footnote{The corresponding in-buffer
1954 setting is: @code{#+STARTUP: fninline} or @code{#+STARTUP: nofninline}}, the
1955 definition will be placed right into the text as part of the reference, or
1956 separately into the location determined by the variable
1957 @code{org-footnote-section}.
1958
1959 When this command is called with a prefix argument, a menu of additional
1960 options is offered:
1961 @example
1962 s @r{Sort the footnote definitions by reference sequence. During editing,}
1963 @r{Org makes no effort to sort footnote definitions into a particular}
1964 @r{sequence. If you want them sorted, use this command, which will}
1965 @r{also move entries according to @code{org-footnote-section}. Automatic}
1966 @r{sorting after each insertion/deletion can be configured using the}
1967 @r{variable @code{org-footnote-auto-adjust}.}
1968 r @r{Renumber the simple @code{fn:N} footnotes. Automatic renumbering}
1969 @r{after each insertion/deletion can be configured using the variable}
1970 @r{@code{org-footnote-auto-adjust}.}
1971 S @r{Short for first @code{r}, then @code{s} action.}
1972 n @r{Normalize the footnotes by collecting all definitions (including}
1973 @r{inline definitions) into a special section, and then numbering them}
1974 @r{in sequence. The references will then also be numbers. This is}
1975 @r{meant to be the final step before finishing a document (e.g., sending}
1976 @r{off an email). The exporters do this automatically, and so could}
1977 @r{something like @code{message-send-hook}.}
1978 d @r{Delete the footnote at point, and all definitions of and references}
1979 @r{to it.}
1980 @end example
1981 Depending on the variable @code{org-footnote-auto-adjust}@footnote{the
1982 corresponding in-buffer options are @code{fnadjust} and @code{nofnadjust}.},
1983 renumbering and sorting footnotes can be automatic after each insertion or
1984 deletion.
1985
1986 @kindex C-c C-c
1987 @item C-c C-c
1988 If the cursor is on a footnote reference, jump to the definition. If it is a
1989 the definition, jump back to the reference. When called at a footnote
1990 location with a prefix argument, offer the same menu as @kbd{C-c C-x f}.
1991 @kindex C-c C-o
1992 @kindex mouse-1
1993 @kindex mouse-2
1994 @item C-c C-o @r{or} mouse-1/2
1995 Footnote labels are also links to the corresponding definition/reference, and
1996 you can use the usual commands to follow these links.
1997 @end table
1998
1999 @node Orgstruct mode, , Footnotes, Document Structure
2000 @section The Orgstruct minor mode
2001 @cindex Orgstruct mode
2002 @cindex minor mode for structure editing
2003
2004 If you like the intuitive way the Org mode structure editing and list
2005 formatting works, you might want to use these commands in other modes like
2006 Text mode or Mail mode as well. The minor mode @code{orgstruct-mode} makes
2007 this possible. Toggle the mode with @kbd{M-x orgstruct-mode}, or
2008 turn it on by default, for example in Message mode, with one of:
2009
2010 @lisp
2011 (add-hook 'message-mode-hook 'turn-on-orgstruct)
2012 (add-hook 'message-mode-hook 'turn-on-orgstruct++)
2013 @end lisp
2014
2015 When this mode is active and the cursor is on a line that looks to Org like a
2016 headline or the first line of a list item, most structure editing commands
2017 will work, even if the same keys normally have different functionality in the
2018 major mode you are using. If the cursor is not in one of those special
2019 lines, Orgstruct mode lurks silently in the shadows. When you use
2020 @code{orgstruct++-mode}, Org will also export indentation and autofill
2021 settings into that mode, and detect item context after the first line of an
2022 item.
2023
2024 @node Tables, Hyperlinks, Document Structure, Top
2025 @chapter Tables
2026 @cindex tables
2027 @cindex editing tables
2028
2029 Org comes with a fast and intuitive table editor. Spreadsheet-like
2030 calculations are supported using the Emacs @file{calc} package
2031 (@pxref{Top, Calc, , calc, Gnu Emacs Calculator Manual}).
2032
2033 @menu
2034 * Built-in table editor:: Simple tables
2035 * Column width and alignment:: Overrule the automatic settings
2036 * Column groups:: Grouping to trigger vertical lines
2037 * Orgtbl mode:: The table editor as minor mode
2038 * The spreadsheet:: The table editor has spreadsheet capabilities
2039 * Org-Plot:: Plotting from org tables
2040 @end menu
2041
2042 @node Built-in table editor, Column width and alignment, Tables, Tables
2043 @section The built-in table editor
2044 @cindex table editor, built-in
2045
2046 Org makes it easy to format tables in plain ASCII@. Any line with @samp{|} as
2047 the first non-whitespace character is considered part of a table. @samp{|}
2048 is also the column separator@footnote{To insert a vertical bar into a table
2049 field, use @code{\vert} or, inside a word @code{abc\vert@{@}def}.}. A table
2050 might look like this:
2051
2052 @example
2053 | Name | Phone | Age |
2054 |-------+-------+-----|
2055 | Peter | 1234 | 17 |
2056 | Anna | 4321 | 25 |
2057 @end example
2058
2059 A table is re-aligned automatically each time you press @key{TAB} or
2060 @key{RET} or @kbd{C-c C-c} inside the table. @key{TAB} also moves to
2061 the next field (@key{RET} to the next row) and creates new table rows
2062 at the end of the table or before horizontal lines. The indentation
2063 of the table is set by the first line. Any line starting with
2064 @samp{|-} is considered as a horizontal separator line and will be
2065 expanded on the next re-align to span the whole table width. So, to
2066 create the above table, you would only type
2067
2068 @example
2069 |Name|Phone|Age|
2070 |-
2071 @end example
2072
2073 @noindent and then press @key{TAB} to align the table and start filling in
2074 fields. Even faster would be to type @code{|Name|Phone|Age} followed by
2075 @kbd{C-c @key{RET}}.
2076
2077 @vindex org-enable-table-editor
2078 @vindex org-table-auto-blank-field
2079 When typing text into a field, Org treats @key{DEL},
2080 @key{Backspace}, and all character keys in a special way, so that
2081 inserting and deleting avoids shifting other fields. Also, when
2082 typing @emph{immediately after the cursor was moved into a new field
2083 with @kbd{@key{TAB}}, @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} or @kbd{@key{RET}}}, the
2084 field is automatically made blank. If this behavior is too
2085 unpredictable for you, configure the variables
2086 @code{org-enable-table-editor} and @code{org-table-auto-blank-field}.
2087
2088 @table @kbd
2089 @tsubheading{Creation and conversion}
2090 @orgcmd{C-c |,org-table-create-or-convert-from-region}
2091 Convert the active region to table. If every line contains at least one
2092 TAB character, the function assumes that the material is tab separated.
2093 If every line contains a comma, comma-separated values (CSV) are assumed.
2094 If not, lines are split at whitespace into fields. You can use a prefix
2095 argument to force a specific separator: @kbd{C-u} forces CSV, @kbd{C-u
2096 C-u} forces TAB, and a numeric argument N indicates that at least N
2097 consecutive spaces, or alternatively a TAB will be the separator.
2098 @*
2099 If there is no active region, this command creates an empty Org
2100 table. But it is easier just to start typing, like
2101 @kbd{|Name|Phone|Age @key{RET} |- @key{TAB}}.
2102
2103 @tsubheading{Re-aligning and field motion}
2104 @orgcmd{C-c C-c,org-table-align}
2105 Re-align the table without moving the cursor.
2106 @c
2107 @orgcmd{<TAB>,org-table-next-field}
2108 Re-align the table, move to the next field. Creates a new row if
2109 necessary.
2110 @c
2111 @orgcmd{S-@key{TAB},org-table-previous-field}
2112 Re-align, move to previous field.
2113 @c
2114 @orgcmd{@key{RET},org-table-next-row}
2115 Re-align the table and move down to next row. Creates a new row if
2116 necessary. At the beginning or end of a line, @key{RET} still does
2117 NEWLINE, so it can be used to split a table.
2118 @c
2119 @orgcmd{M-a,org-table-beginning-of-field}
2120 Move to beginning of the current table field, or on to the previous field.
2121 @orgcmd{M-e,org-table-end-of-field}
2122 Move to end of the current table field, or on to the next field.
2123
2124 @tsubheading{Column and row editing}
2125 @orgcmdkkcc{M-@key{left},M-@key{right},org-table-move-column-left,org-table-move-column-right}
2126 Move the current column left/right.
2127 @c
2128 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{left},org-table-delete-column}
2129 Kill the current column.
2130 @c
2131 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{right},org-table-insert-column}
2132 Insert a new column to the left of the cursor position.
2133 @c
2134 @orgcmdkkcc{M-@key{up},M-@key{down},org-table-move-row-up,org-table-move-row-down}
2135 Move the current row up/down.
2136 @c
2137 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{up},org-table-kill-row}
2138 Kill the current row or horizontal line.
2139 @c
2140 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{down},org-table-insert-row}
2141 Insert a new row above the current row. With a prefix argument, the line is
2142 created below the current one.
2143 @c
2144 @orgcmd{C-c -,org-table-insert-hline}
2145 Insert a horizontal line below current row. With a prefix argument, the line
2146 is created above the current line.
2147 @c
2148 @orgcmd{C-c @key{RET},org-table-hline-and-move}
2149 Insert a horizontal line below current row, and move the cursor into the row
2150 below that line.
2151 @c
2152 @orgcmd{C-c ^,org-table-sort-lines}
2153 Sort the table lines in the region. The position of point indicates the
2154 column to be used for sorting, and the range of lines is the range
2155 between the nearest horizontal separator lines, or the entire table. If
2156 point is before the first column, you will be prompted for the sorting
2157 column. If there is an active region, the mark specifies the first line
2158 and the sorting column, while point should be in the last line to be
2159 included into the sorting. The command prompts for the sorting type
2160 (alphabetically, numerically, or by time). When called with a prefix
2161 argument, alphabetic sorting will be case-sensitive.
2162
2163 @tsubheading{Regions}
2164 @orgcmd{C-c C-x M-w,org-table-copy-region}
2165 Copy a rectangular region from a table to a special clipboard. Point and
2166 mark determine edge fields of the rectangle. If there is no active region,
2167 copy just the current field. The process ignores horizontal separator lines.
2168 @c
2169 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-w,org-table-cut-region}
2170 Copy a rectangular region from a table to a special clipboard, and
2171 blank all fields in the rectangle. So this is the ``cut'' operation.
2172 @c
2173 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-y,org-table-paste-rectangle}
2174 Paste a rectangular region into a table.
2175 The upper left corner ends up in the current field. All involved fields
2176 will be overwritten. If the rectangle does not fit into the present table,
2177 the table is enlarged as needed. The process ignores horizontal separator
2178 lines.
2179 @c
2180 @orgcmd{M-@key{RET},org-table-wrap-region}
2181 Split the current field at the cursor position and move the rest to the line
2182 below. If there is an active region, and both point and mark are in the same
2183 column, the text in the column is wrapped to minimum width for the given
2184 number of lines. A numeric prefix argument may be used to change the number
2185 of desired lines. If there is no region, but you specify a prefix argument,
2186 the current field is made blank, and the content is appended to the field
2187 above.
2188
2189 @tsubheading{Calculations}
2190 @cindex formula, in tables
2191 @cindex calculations, in tables
2192 @cindex region, active
2193 @cindex active region
2194 @cindex transient mark mode
2195 @orgcmd{C-c +,org-table-sum}
2196 Sum the numbers in the current column, or in the rectangle defined by
2197 the active region. The result is shown in the echo area and can
2198 be inserted with @kbd{C-y}.
2199 @c
2200 @orgcmd{S-@key{RET},org-table-copy-down}
2201 @vindex org-table-copy-increment
2202 When current field is empty, copy from first non-empty field above. When not
2203 empty, copy current field down to next row and move cursor along with it.
2204 Depending on the variable @code{org-table-copy-increment}, integer field
2205 values will be incremented during copy. Integers that are too large will not
2206 be incremented. Also, a @code{0} prefix argument temporarily disables the
2207 increment. This key is also used by shift-selection and related modes
2208 (@pxref{Conflicts}).
2209
2210 @tsubheading{Miscellaneous}
2211 @orgcmd{C-c `,org-table-edit-field}
2212 Edit the current field in a separate window. This is useful for fields that
2213 are not fully visible (@pxref{Column width and alignment}). When called with
2214 a @kbd{C-u} prefix, just make the full field visible, so that it can be
2215 edited in place. When called with two @kbd{C-u} prefixes, make the editor
2216 window follow the cursor through the table and always show the current
2217 field. The follow mode exits automatically when the cursor leaves the table,
2218 or when you repeat this command with @kbd{C-u C-u C-c `}.
2219 @c
2220 @item M-x org-table-import
2221 Import a file as a table. The table should be TAB or whitespace
2222 separated. Use, for example, to import a spreadsheet table or data
2223 from a database, because these programs generally can write
2224 TAB-separated text files. This command works by inserting the file into
2225 the buffer and then converting the region to a table. Any prefix
2226 argument is passed on to the converter, which uses it to determine the
2227 separator.
2228 @orgcmd{C-c |,org-table-create-or-convert-from-region}
2229 Tables can also be imported by pasting tabular text into the Org
2230 buffer, selecting the pasted text with @kbd{C-x C-x} and then using the
2231 @kbd{C-c |} command (see above under @i{Creation and conversion}).
2232 @c
2233 @item M-x org-table-export
2234 @findex org-table-export
2235 @vindex org-table-export-default-format
2236 Export the table, by default as a TAB-separated file. Use for data
2237 exchange with, for example, spreadsheet or database programs. The format
2238 used to export the file can be configured in the variable
2239 @code{org-table-export-default-format}. You may also use properties
2240 @code{TABLE_EXPORT_FILE} and @code{TABLE_EXPORT_FORMAT} to specify the file
2241 name and the format for table export in a subtree. Org supports quite
2242 general formats for exported tables. The exporter format is the same as the
2243 format used by Orgtbl radio tables, see @ref{Translator functions}, for a
2244 detailed description.
2245 @end table
2246
2247 If you don't like the automatic table editor because it gets in your
2248 way on lines which you would like to start with @samp{|}, you can turn
2249 it off with
2250
2251 @lisp
2252 (setq org-enable-table-editor nil)
2253 @end lisp
2254
2255 @noindent Then the only table command that still works is
2256 @kbd{C-c C-c} to do a manual re-align.
2257
2258 @node Column width and alignment, Column groups, Built-in table editor, Tables
2259 @section Column width and alignment
2260 @cindex narrow columns in tables
2261 @cindex alignment in tables
2262
2263 The width of columns is automatically determined by the table editor. And
2264 also the alignment of a column is determined automatically from the fraction
2265 of number-like versus non-number fields in the column.
2266
2267 Sometimes a single field or a few fields need to carry more text, leading to
2268 inconveniently wide columns. Or maybe you want to make a table with several
2269 columns having a fixed width, regardless of content. To set@footnote{This
2270 feature does not work on XEmacs.} the width of a column, one field anywhere
2271 in the column may contain just the string @samp{<N>} where @samp{N} is an
2272 integer specifying the width of the column in characters. The next re-align
2273 will then set the width of this column to this value.
2274
2275 @example
2276 @group
2277 |---+------------------------------| |---+--------|
2278 | | | | | <6> |
2279 | 1 | one | | 1 | one |
2280 | 2 | two | ----\ | 2 | two |
2281 | 3 | This is a long chunk of text | ----/ | 3 | This=> |
2282 | 4 | four | | 4 | four |
2283 |---+------------------------------| |---+--------|
2284 @end group
2285 @end example
2286
2287 @noindent
2288 Fields that are wider become clipped and end in the string @samp{=>}.
2289 Note that the full text is still in the buffer but is hidden.
2290 To see the full text, hold the mouse over the field---a tool-tip window
2291 will show the full content. To edit such a field, use the command
2292 @kbd{C-c `} (that is @kbd{C-c} followed by the backquote). This will
2293 open a new window with the full field. Edit it and finish with @kbd{C-c
2294 C-c}.
2295
2296 @vindex org-startup-align-all-tables
2297 When visiting a file containing a table with narrowed columns, the
2298 necessary character hiding has not yet happened, and the table needs to
2299 be aligned before it looks nice. Setting the option
2300 @code{org-startup-align-all-tables} will realign all tables in a file
2301 upon visiting, but also slow down startup. You can also set this option
2302 on a per-file basis with:
2303
2304 @example
2305 #+STARTUP: align
2306 #+STARTUP: noalign
2307 @end example
2308
2309 If you would like to overrule the automatic alignment of number-rich columns
2310 to the right and of string-rich column to the left, you can use @samp{<r>},
2311 @samp{<c>}@footnote{Centering does not work inside Emacs, but it does have an
2312 effect when exporting to HTML.} or @samp{<l>} in a similar fashion. You may
2313 also combine alignment and field width like this: @samp{<l10>}.
2314
2315 Lines which only contain these formatting cookies will be removed
2316 automatically when exporting the document.
2317
2318 @node Column groups, Orgtbl mode, Column width and alignment, Tables
2319 @section Column groups
2320 @cindex grouping columns in tables
2321
2322 When Org exports tables, it does so by default without vertical
2323 lines because that is visually more satisfying in general. Occasionally
2324 however, vertical lines can be useful to structure a table into groups
2325 of columns, much like horizontal lines can do for groups of rows. In
2326 order to specify column groups, you can use a special row where the
2327 first field contains only @samp{/}. The further fields can either
2328 contain @samp{<} to indicate that this column should start a group,
2329 @samp{>} to indicate the end of a column, or @samp{<>} (no space between @samp{<}
2330 and @samp{>}) to make a column
2331 a group of its own. Boundaries between column groups will upon export be
2332 marked with vertical lines. Here is an example:
2333
2334 @example
2335 | N | N^2 | N^3 | N^4 | sqrt(n) | sqrt[4](N) |
2336 |---+-----+-----+-----+---------+------------|
2337 | / | < | | > | < | > |
2338 | 1 | 1 | 1 | 1 | 1 | 1 |
2339 | 2 | 4 | 8 | 16 | 1.4142 | 1.1892 |
2340 | 3 | 9 | 27 | 81 | 1.7321 | 1.3161 |
2341 |---+-----+-----+-----+---------+------------|
2342 #+TBLFM: $2=$1^2::$3=$1^3::$4=$1^4::$5=sqrt($1)::$6=sqrt(sqrt(($1)))
2343 @end example
2344
2345 It is also sufficient to just insert the column group starters after
2346 every vertical line you would like to have:
2347
2348 @example
2349 | N | N^2 | N^3 | N^4 | sqrt(n) | sqrt[4](N) |
2350 |----+-----+-----+-----+---------+------------|
2351 | / | < | | | < | |
2352 @end example
2353
2354 @node Orgtbl mode, The spreadsheet, Column groups, Tables
2355 @section The Orgtbl minor mode
2356 @cindex Orgtbl mode
2357 @cindex minor mode for tables
2358
2359 If you like the intuitive way the Org table editor works, you
2360 might also want to use it in other modes like Text mode or Mail mode.
2361 The minor mode Orgtbl mode makes this possible. You can always toggle
2362 the mode with @kbd{M-x orgtbl-mode}. To turn it on by default, for
2363 example in Message mode, use
2364
2365 @lisp
2366 (add-hook 'message-mode-hook 'turn-on-orgtbl)
2367 @end lisp
2368
2369 Furthermore, with some special setup, it is possible to maintain tables
2370 in arbitrary syntax with Orgtbl mode. For example, it is possible to
2371 construct @LaTeX{} tables with the underlying ease and power of
2372 Orgtbl mode, including spreadsheet capabilities. For details, see
2373 @ref{Tables in arbitrary syntax}.
2374
2375 @node The spreadsheet, Org-Plot, Orgtbl mode, Tables
2376 @section The spreadsheet
2377 @cindex calculations, in tables
2378 @cindex spreadsheet capabilities
2379 @cindex @file{calc} package
2380
2381 The table editor makes use of the Emacs @file{calc} package to implement
2382 spreadsheet-like capabilities. It can also evaluate Emacs Lisp forms to
2383 derive fields from other fields. While fully featured, Org's implementation
2384 is not identical to other spreadsheets. For example, Org knows the concept
2385 of a @emph{column formula} that will be applied to all non-header fields in a
2386 column without having to copy the formula to each relevant field. There is
2387 also a formula debugger, and a formula editor with features for highlighting
2388 fields in the table corresponding to the references at the point in the
2389 formula, moving these references by arrow keys
2390
2391 @menu
2392 * References:: How to refer to another field or range
2393 * Formula syntax for Calc:: Using Calc to compute stuff
2394 * Formula syntax for Lisp:: Writing formulas in Emacs Lisp
2395 * Durations and time values:: How to compute durations and time values
2396 * Field and range formulas:: Formula for specific (ranges of) fields
2397 * Column formulas:: Formulas valid for an entire column
2398 * Editing and debugging formulas:: Fixing formulas
2399 * Updating the table:: Recomputing all dependent fields
2400 * Advanced features:: Field and column names, parameters and automatic recalc
2401 @end menu
2402
2403 @node References, Formula syntax for Calc, The spreadsheet, The spreadsheet
2404 @subsection References
2405 @cindex references
2406
2407 To compute fields in the table from other fields, formulas must
2408 reference other fields or ranges. In Org, fields can be referenced
2409 by name, by absolute coordinates, and by relative coordinates. To find
2410 out what the coordinates of a field are, press @kbd{C-c ?} in that
2411 field, or press @kbd{C-c @}} to toggle the display of a grid.
2412
2413 @subsubheading Field references
2414 @cindex field references
2415 @cindex references, to fields
2416
2417 Formulas can reference the value of another field in two ways. Like in
2418 any other spreadsheet, you may reference fields with a letter/number
2419 combination like @code{B3}, meaning the 2nd field in the 3rd row.
2420 @vindex org-table-use-standard-references
2421 However, Org prefers@footnote{Org will understand references typed by the
2422 user as @samp{B4}, but it will not use this syntax when offering a formula
2423 for editing. You can customize this behavior using the variable
2424 @code{org-table-use-standard-references}.} to use another, more general
2425 representation that looks like this:
2426 @example
2427 @@@var{row}$@var{column}
2428 @end example
2429
2430 Column specifications can be absolute like @code{$1},
2431 @code{$2},...@code{$@var{N}}, or relative to the current column (i.e., the
2432 column of the field which is being computed) like @code{$+1} or @code{$-2}.
2433 @code{$<} and @code{$>} are immutable references to the first and last
2434 column, respectively, and you can use @code{$>>>} to indicate the third
2435 column from the right.
2436
2437 The row specification only counts data lines and ignores horizontal separator
2438 lines (hlines). Like with columns, you can use absolute row numbers
2439 @code{@@1}, @code{@@2},...@code{@@@var{N}}, and row numbers relative to the
2440 current row like @code{@@+3} or @code{@@-1}. @code{@@<} and @code{@@>} are
2441 immutable references the first and last@footnote{For backward compatibility
2442 you can also use special names like @code{$LR5} and @code{$LR12} to refer in
2443 a stable way to the 5th and 12th field in the last row of the table.
2444 However, this syntax is deprecated, it should not be used for new documents.
2445 Use @code{@@>$} instead.} row in the table, respectively. You may also
2446 specify the row relative to one of the hlines: @code{@@I} refers to the first
2447 hline, @code{@@II} to the second, etc. @code{@@-I} refers to the first such
2448 line above the current line, @code{@@+I} to the first such line below the
2449 current line. You can also write @code{@@III+2} which is the second data line
2450 after the third hline in the table.
2451
2452 @code{@@0} and @code{$0} refer to the current row and column, respectively,
2453 i.e., to the row/column for the field being computed. Also, if you omit
2454 either the column or the row part of the reference, the current row/column is
2455 implied.
2456
2457 Org's references with @emph{unsigned} numbers are fixed references
2458 in the sense that if you use the same reference in the formula for two
2459 different fields, the same field will be referenced each time.
2460 Org's references with @emph{signed} numbers are floating
2461 references because the same reference operator can reference different
2462 fields depending on the field being calculated by the formula.
2463
2464 Here are a few examples:
2465
2466 @example
2467 @@2$3 @r{2nd row, 3rd column (same as @code{C2})}
2468 $5 @r{column 5 in the current row (same as @code{E&})}
2469 @@2 @r{current column, row 2}
2470 @@-1$-3 @r{the field one row up, three columns to the left}
2471 @@-I$2 @r{field just under hline above current row, column 2}
2472 @@>$5 @r{field in the last row, in column 5}
2473 @end example
2474
2475 @subsubheading Range references
2476 @cindex range references
2477 @cindex references, to ranges
2478
2479 You may reference a rectangular range of fields by specifying two field
2480 references connected by two dots @samp{..}. If both fields are in the
2481 current row, you may simply use @samp{$2..$7}, but if at least one field
2482 is in a different row, you need to use the general @code{@@row$column}
2483 format at least for the first field (i.e the reference must start with
2484 @samp{@@} in order to be interpreted correctly). Examples:
2485
2486 @example
2487 $1..$3 @r{first three fields in the current row}
2488 $P..$Q @r{range, using column names (see under Advanced)}
2489 $<<<..$>> @r{start in third column, continue to the one but last}
2490 @@2$1..@@4$3 @r{6 fields between these two fields (same as @code{A2..C4})}
2491 @@-1$-2..@@-1 @r{3 numbers from the column to the left, 2 up to current row}
2492 @@I..II @r{between first and second hline, short for @code{@@I..@@II}}
2493 @end example
2494
2495 @noindent Range references return a vector of values that can be fed
2496 into Calc vector functions. Empty fields in ranges are normally
2497 suppressed, so that the vector contains only the non-empty fields (but
2498 see the @samp{E} mode switch below). If there are no non-empty fields,
2499 @samp{[0]} is returned to avoid syntax errors in formulas.
2500
2501 @subsubheading Field coordinates in formulas
2502 @cindex field coordinates
2503 @cindex coordinates, of field
2504 @cindex row, of field coordinates
2505 @cindex column, of field coordinates
2506
2507 For Calc formulas and Lisp formulas @code{@@#} and @code{$#} can be used to
2508 get the row or column number of the field where the formula result goes.
2509 The traditional Lisp formula equivalents are @code{org-table-current-dline}
2510 and @code{org-table-current-column}. Examples:
2511
2512 @example
2513 if(@@# % 2, $#, string("")) @r{column number on odd lines only}
2514 $3 = remote(FOO, @@@@#$2) @r{copy column 2 from table FOO into}
2515 @r{column 3 of the current table}
2516 @end example
2517
2518 @noindent For the second example, table FOO must have at least as many rows
2519 as the current table. Note that this is inefficient@footnote{The computation time scales as
2520 O(N^2) because table FOO is parsed for each field to be copied.} for large
2521 number of rows.
2522
2523 @subsubheading Named references
2524 @cindex named references
2525 @cindex references, named
2526 @cindex name, of column or field
2527 @cindex constants, in calculations
2528 @cindex #+CONSTANTS
2529
2530 @vindex org-table-formula-constants
2531 @samp{$name} is interpreted as the name of a column, parameter or
2532 constant. Constants are defined globally through the variable
2533 @code{org-table-formula-constants}, and locally (for the file) through a
2534 line like
2535
2536 @example
2537 #+CONSTANTS: c=299792458. pi=3.14 eps=2.4e-6
2538 @end example
2539
2540 @noindent
2541 @vindex constants-unit-system
2542 @pindex constants.el
2543 Also properties (@pxref{Properties and Columns}) can be used as
2544 constants in table formulas: for a property @samp{:Xyz:} use the name
2545 @samp{$PROP_Xyz}, and the property will be searched in the current
2546 outline entry and in the hierarchy above it. If you have the
2547 @file{constants.el} package, it will also be used to resolve constants,
2548 including natural constants like @samp{$h} for Planck's constant, and
2549 units like @samp{$km} for kilometers@footnote{@file{constants.el} can
2550 supply the values of constants in two different unit systems, @code{SI}
2551 and @code{cgs}. Which one is used depends on the value of the variable
2552 @code{constants-unit-system}. You can use the @code{#+STARTUP} options
2553 @code{constSI} and @code{constcgs} to set this value for the current
2554 buffer.}. Column names and parameters can be specified in special table
2555 lines. These are described below, see @ref{Advanced features}. All
2556 names must start with a letter, and further consist of letters and
2557 numbers.
2558
2559 @subsubheading Remote references
2560 @cindex remote references
2561 @cindex references, remote
2562 @cindex references, to a different table
2563 @cindex name, of column or field
2564 @cindex constants, in calculations
2565 @cindex #+TBLNAME
2566
2567 You may also reference constants, fields and ranges from a different table,
2568 either in the current file or even in a different file. The syntax is
2569
2570 @example
2571 remote(NAME-OR-ID,REF)
2572 @end example
2573
2574 @noindent
2575 where NAME can be the name of a table in the current file as set by a
2576 @code{#+TBLNAME: NAME} line before the table. It can also be the ID of an
2577 entry, even in a different file, and the reference then refers to the first
2578 table in that entry. REF is an absolute field or range reference as
2579 described above for example @code{@@3$3} or @code{$somename}, valid in the
2580 referenced table.
2581
2582 @node Formula syntax for Calc, Formula syntax for Lisp, References, The spreadsheet
2583 @subsection Formula syntax for Calc
2584 @cindex formula syntax, Calc
2585 @cindex syntax, of formulas
2586
2587 A formula can be any algebraic expression understood by the Emacs
2588 @file{Calc} package. @b{Note that @file{calc} has the
2589 non-standard convention that @samp{/} has lower precedence than
2590 @samp{*}, so that @samp{a/b*c} is interpreted as @samp{a/(b*c)}.} Before
2591 evaluation by @code{calc-eval} (@pxref{Calling Calc from
2592 Your Programs, calc-eval, Calling Calc from Your Lisp Programs, calc, GNU
2593 Emacs Calc Manual}),
2594 variable substitution takes place according to the rules described above.
2595 @cindex vectors, in table calculations
2596 The range vectors can be directly fed into the Calc vector functions
2597 like @samp{vmean} and @samp{vsum}.
2598
2599 @cindex format specifier
2600 @cindex mode, for @file{calc}
2601 @vindex org-calc-default-modes
2602 A formula can contain an optional mode string after a semicolon. This
2603 string consists of flags to influence Calc and other modes during
2604 execution. By default, Org uses the standard Calc modes (precision
2605 12, angular units degrees, fraction and symbolic modes off). The display
2606 format, however, has been changed to @code{(float 8)} to keep tables
2607 compact. The default settings can be configured using the variable
2608 @code{org-calc-default-modes}.
2609
2610 @example
2611 p20 @r{set the internal Calc calculation precision to 20 digits}
2612 n3 s3 e2 f4 @r{Normal, scientific, engineering, or fixed}
2613 @r{format of the result of Calc passed back to Org.}
2614 @r{Calc formatting is unlimited in precision as}
2615 @r{long as the Calc calculation precision is greater.}
2616 D R @r{angle modes: degrees, radians}
2617 F S @r{fraction and symbolic modes}
2618 N @r{interpret all fields as numbers, use 0 for non-numbers}
2619 E @r{keep empty fields in ranges}
2620 L @r{literal}
2621 @end example
2622
2623 @noindent
2624 Unless you use large integer numbers or high-precision-calculation
2625 and -display for floating point numbers you may alternatively provide a
2626 @code{printf} format specifier to reformat the Calc result after it has been
2627 passed back to Org instead of letting Calc already do the
2628 formatting@footnote{The @code{printf} reformatting is limited in precision
2629 because the value passed to it is converted into an @code{integer} or
2630 @code{double}. The @code{integer} is limited in size by truncating the
2631 signed value to 32 bits. The @code{double} is limited in precision to 64
2632 bits overall which leaves approximately 16 significant decimal digits.}.
2633 A few examples:
2634
2635 @example
2636 $1+$2 @r{Sum of first and second field}
2637 $1+$2;%.2f @r{Same, format result to two decimals}
2638 exp($2)+exp($1) @r{Math functions can be used}
2639 $0;%.1f @r{Reformat current cell to 1 decimal}
2640 ($3-32)*5/9 @r{Degrees F -> C conversion}
2641 $c/$1/$cm @r{Hz -> cm conversion, using @file{constants.el}}
2642 tan($1);Dp3s1 @r{Compute in degrees, precision 3, display SCI 1}
2643 sin($1);Dp3%.1e @r{Same, but use printf specifier for display}
2644 vmean($2..$7) @r{Compute column range mean, using vector function}
2645 vmean($2..$7);EN @r{Same, but treat empty fields as 0}
2646 taylor($3,x=7,2) @r{Taylor series of $3, at x=7, second degree}
2647 @end example
2648
2649 Calc also contains a complete set of logical operations. For example
2650
2651 @example
2652 if($1<20,teen,string("")) @r{"teen" if age $1 less than 20, else empty}
2653 @end example
2654
2655 Note that you can also use two org-specific flags @code{T} and @code{t} for
2656 durations computations @ref{Durations and time values}.
2657
2658 @node Formula syntax for Lisp, Durations and time values, Formula syntax for Calc, The spreadsheet
2659 @subsection Emacs Lisp forms as formulas
2660 @cindex Lisp forms, as table formulas
2661
2662 It is also possible to write a formula in Emacs Lisp. This can be useful
2663 for string manipulation and control structures, if Calc's functionality is
2664 not enough.
2665
2666 If a formula starts with a single-quote followed by an opening parenthesis,
2667 then it is evaluated as a Lisp form. The evaluation should return either a
2668 string or a number. Just as with @file{calc} formulas, you can specify modes
2669 and a printf format after a semicolon.
2670
2671 With Emacs Lisp forms, you need to be conscious about the way field
2672 references are interpolated into the form. By default, a reference will be
2673 interpolated as a Lisp string (in double-quotes) containing the field. If
2674 you provide the @samp{N} mode switch, all referenced elements will be numbers
2675 (non-number fields will be zero) and interpolated as Lisp numbers, without
2676 quotes. If you provide the @samp{L} flag, all fields will be interpolated
2677 literally, without quotes. I.e., if you want a reference to be interpreted
2678 as a string by the Lisp form, enclose the reference operator itself in
2679 double-quotes, like @code{"$3"}. Ranges are inserted as space-separated
2680 fields, so you can embed them in list or vector syntax.
2681
2682 Here are a few examples---note how the @samp{N} mode is used when we do
2683 computations in Lisp:
2684
2685 @example
2686 @r{Swap the first two characters of the content of column 1}
2687 '(concat (substring $1 1 2) (substring $1 0 1) (substring $1 2))
2688 @r{Add columns 1 and 2, equivalent to Calc's @code{$1+$2}}
2689 '(+ $1 $2);N
2690 @r{Compute the sum of columns 1-4, like Calc's @code{vsum($1..$4)}}
2691 '(apply '+ '($1..$4));N
2692 @end example
2693
2694 @node Durations and time values, Field and range formulas, Formula syntax for Lisp, The spreadsheet
2695 @subsection Durations and time values
2696 @cindex Duration, computing
2697 @cindex Time, computing
2698 @vindex org-table-duration-custom-format
2699
2700 If you want to compute time values use the @code{T} flag, either in Calc
2701 formulas or Elisp formulas:
2702
2703 @example
2704 @group
2705 | Task 1 | Task 2 | Total |
2706 |---------+----------+----------|
2707 | 2:12 | 1:47 | 03:59:00 |
2708 | 3:02:20 | -2:07:00 | 0.92 |
2709 #+TBLFM: @@2$3=$1+$2;T::@@3$3=$1+$2;t
2710 @end group
2711 @end example
2712
2713 Input duration values must be of the form @code{[HH:MM[:SS]}, where seconds
2714 are optional. With the @code{T} flag, computed durations will be displayed
2715 as @code{HH:MM:SS} (see the first formula above). With the @code{t} flag,
2716 computed durations will be displayed according to the value of the variable
2717 @code{org-table-duration-custom-format}, which defaults to @code{'hours} and
2718 will display the result as a fraction of hours (see the second formula in the
2719 example above).
2720
2721 Negative duration values can be manipulated as well, and integers will be
2722 considered as seconds in addition and subtraction.
2723
2724 @node Field and range formulas, Column formulas, Durations and time values, The spreadsheet
2725 @subsection Field and range formulas
2726 @cindex field formula
2727 @cindex range formula
2728 @cindex formula, for individual table field
2729 @cindex formula, for range of fields
2730
2731 To assign a formula to a particular field, type it directly into the field,
2732 preceded by @samp{:=}, for example @samp{:=vsum(@@II..III)}. When you press
2733 @key{TAB} or @key{RET} or @kbd{C-c C-c} with the cursor still in the field,
2734 the formula will be stored as the formula for this field, evaluated, and the
2735 current field will be replaced with the result.
2736
2737 @cindex #+TBLFM
2738 Formulas are stored in a special line starting with @samp{#+TBLFM:} directly
2739 below the table. If you type the equation in the 4th field of the 3rd data
2740 line in the table, the formula will look like @samp{@@3$4=$1+$2}. When
2741 inserting/deleting/swapping column and rows with the appropriate commands,
2742 @i{absolute references} (but not relative ones) in stored formulas are
2743 modified in order to still reference the same field. To avoid this from
2744 happening, in particular in range references, anchor ranges at the table
2745 borders (using @code{@@<}, @code{@@>}, @code{$<}, @code{$>}), or at hlines
2746 using the @code{@@I} notation. Automatic adaptation of field references does
2747 of course not happen if you edit the table structure with normal editing
2748 commands---then you must fix the equations yourself.
2749
2750 Instead of typing an equation into the field, you may also use the following
2751 command
2752
2753 @table @kbd
2754 @orgcmd{C-u C-c =,org-table-eval-formula}
2755 Install a new formula for the current field. The command prompts for a
2756 formula with default taken from the @samp{#+TBLFM:} line, applies
2757 it to the current field, and stores it.
2758 @end table
2759
2760 The left-hand side of a formula can also be a special expression in order to
2761 assign the formula to a number of different fields. There is no keyboard
2762 shortcut to enter such range formulas. To add them, use the formula editor
2763 (@pxref{Editing and debugging formulas}) or edit the @code{#+TBLFM:} line
2764 directly.
2765
2766 @table @code
2767 @item $2=
2768 Column formula, valid for the entire column. This is so common that Org
2769 treats these formulas in a special way, see @ref{Column formulas}.
2770 @item @@3=
2771 Row formula, applies to all fields in the specified row. @code{@@>=} means
2772 the last row.
2773 @item @@1$2..@@4$3=
2774 Range formula, applies to all fields in the given rectangular range. This
2775 can also be used to assign a formula to some but not all fields in a row.
2776 @item $name=
2777 Named field, see @ref{Advanced features}.
2778 @end table
2779
2780 @node Column formulas, Editing and debugging formulas, Field and range formulas, The spreadsheet
2781 @subsection Column formulas
2782 @cindex column formula
2783 @cindex formula, for table column
2784
2785 When you assign a formula to a simple column reference like @code{$3=}, the
2786 same formula will be used in all fields of that column, with the following
2787 very convenient exceptions: (i) If the table contains horizontal separator
2788 hlines, everything before the first such line is considered part of the table
2789 @emph{header} and will not be modified by column formulas. (ii) Fields that
2790 already get a value from a field/range formula will be left alone by column
2791 formulas. These conditions make column formulas very easy to use.
2792
2793 To assign a formula to a column, type it directly into any field in the
2794 column, preceded by an equal sign, like @samp{=$1+$2}. When you press
2795 @key{TAB} or @key{RET} or @kbd{C-c C-c} with the cursor still in the field,
2796 the formula will be stored as the formula for the current column, evaluated
2797 and the current field replaced with the result. If the field contains only
2798 @samp{=}, the previously stored formula for this column is used. For each
2799 column, Org will only remember the most recently used formula. In the
2800 @samp{#+TBLFM:} line, column formulas will look like @samp{$4=$1+$2}. The
2801 left-hand side of a column formula can not be the name of column, it must be
2802 the numeric column reference or @code{$>}.
2803
2804 Instead of typing an equation into the field, you may also use the
2805 following command:
2806
2807 @table @kbd
2808 @orgcmd{C-c =,org-table-eval-formula}
2809 Install a new formula for the current column and replace current field with
2810 the result of the formula. The command prompts for a formula, with default
2811 taken from the @samp{#+TBLFM} line, applies it to the current field and
2812 stores it. With a numeric prefix argument(e.g., @kbd{C-5 C-c =}) the command
2813 will apply it to that many consecutive fields in the current column.
2814 @end table
2815
2816 @node Editing and debugging formulas, Updating the table, Column formulas, The spreadsheet
2817 @subsection Editing and debugging formulas
2818 @cindex formula editing
2819 @cindex editing, of table formulas
2820
2821 @vindex org-table-use-standard-references
2822 You can edit individual formulas in the minibuffer or directly in the
2823 field. Org can also prepare a special buffer with all active
2824 formulas of a table. When offering a formula for editing, Org
2825 converts references to the standard format (like @code{B3} or @code{D&})
2826 if possible. If you prefer to only work with the internal format (like
2827 @code{@@3$2} or @code{$4}), configure the variable
2828 @code{org-table-use-standard-references}.
2829
2830 @table @kbd
2831 @orgcmdkkc{C-c =,C-u C-c =,org-table-eval-formula}
2832 Edit the formula associated with the current column/field in the
2833 minibuffer. See @ref{Column formulas}, and @ref{Field and range formulas}.
2834 @orgcmd{C-u C-u C-c =,org-table-eval-formula}
2835 Re-insert the active formula (either a
2836 field formula, or a column formula) into the current field, so that you
2837 can edit it directly in the field. The advantage over editing in the
2838 minibuffer is that you can use the command @kbd{C-c ?}.
2839 @orgcmd{C-c ?,org-table-field-info}
2840 While editing a formula in a table field, highlight the field(s)
2841 referenced by the reference at the cursor position in the formula.
2842 @kindex C-c @}
2843 @findex org-table-toggle-coordinate-overlays
2844 @item C-c @}
2845 Toggle the display of row and column numbers for a table, using overlays
2846 (@command{org-table-toggle-coordinate-overlays}). These are updated each
2847 time the table is aligned; you can force it with @kbd{C-c C-c}.
2848 @kindex C-c @{
2849 @findex org-table-toggle-formula-debugger
2850 @item C-c @{
2851 Toggle the formula debugger on and off
2852 (@command{org-table-toggle-formula-debugger}). See below.
2853 @orgcmd{C-c ',org-table-edit-formulas}
2854 Edit all formulas for the current table in a special buffer, where the
2855 formulas will be displayed one per line. If the current field has an
2856 active formula, the cursor in the formula editor will mark it.
2857 While inside the special buffer, Org will automatically highlight
2858 any field or range reference at the cursor position. You may edit,
2859 remove and add formulas, and use the following commands:
2860 @table @kbd
2861 @orgcmdkkc{C-c C-c,C-x C-s,org-table-fedit-finish}
2862 Exit the formula editor and store the modified formulas. With @kbd{C-u}
2863 prefix, also apply the new formulas to the entire table.
2864 @orgcmd{C-c C-q,org-table-fedit-abort}
2865 Exit the formula editor without installing changes.
2866 @orgcmd{C-c C-r,org-table-fedit-toggle-ref-type}
2867 Toggle all references in the formula editor between standard (like
2868 @code{B3}) and internal (like @code{@@3$2}).
2869 @orgcmd{@key{TAB},org-table-fedit-lisp-indent}
2870 Pretty-print or indent Lisp formula at point. When in a line containing
2871 a Lisp formula, format the formula according to Emacs Lisp rules.
2872 Another @key{TAB} collapses the formula back again. In the open
2873 formula, @key{TAB} re-indents just like in Emacs Lisp mode.
2874 @orgcmd{M-@key{TAB},lisp-complete-symbol}
2875 Complete Lisp symbols, just like in Emacs Lisp mode.
2876 @kindex S-@key{up}
2877 @kindex S-@key{down}
2878 @kindex S-@key{left}
2879 @kindex S-@key{right}
2880 @findex org-table-fedit-ref-up
2881 @findex org-table-fedit-ref-down
2882 @findex org-table-fedit-ref-left
2883 @findex org-table-fedit-ref-right
2884 @item S-@key{up}/@key{down}/@key{left}/@key{right}
2885 Shift the reference at point. For example, if the reference is
2886 @code{B3} and you press @kbd{S-@key{right}}, it will become @code{C3}.
2887 This also works for relative references and for hline references.
2888 @orgcmdkkcc{M-S-@key{up},M-S-@key{down},org-table-fedit-line-up,org-table-fedit-line-down}
2889 Move the test line for column formulas in the Org buffer up and
2890 down.
2891 @orgcmdkkcc{M-@key{up},M-@key{down},org-table-fedit-scroll-down,org-table-fedit-scroll-up}
2892 Scroll the window displaying the table.
2893 @kindex C-c @}
2894 @findex org-table-toggle-coordinate-overlays
2895 @item C-c @}
2896 Turn the coordinate grid in the table on and off.
2897 @end table
2898 @end table
2899
2900 Making a table field blank does not remove the formula associated with
2901 the field, because that is stored in a different line (the @samp{#+TBLFM}
2902 line)---during the next recalculation the field will be filled again.
2903 To remove a formula from a field, you have to give an empty reply when
2904 prompted for the formula, or to edit the @samp{#+TBLFM} line.
2905
2906 @kindex C-c C-c
2907 You may edit the @samp{#+TBLFM} directly and re-apply the changed
2908 equations with @kbd{C-c C-c} in that line or with the normal
2909 recalculation commands in the table.
2910
2911 @subsubheading Debugging formulas
2912 @cindex formula debugging
2913 @cindex debugging, of table formulas
2914 When the evaluation of a formula leads to an error, the field content
2915 becomes the string @samp{#ERROR}. If you would like see what is going
2916 on during variable substitution and calculation in order to find a bug,
2917 turn on formula debugging in the @code{Tbl} menu and repeat the
2918 calculation, for example by pressing @kbd{C-u C-u C-c = @key{RET}} in a
2919 field. Detailed information will be displayed.
2920
2921 @node Updating the table, Advanced features, Editing and debugging formulas, The spreadsheet
2922 @subsection Updating the table
2923 @cindex recomputing table fields
2924 @cindex updating, table
2925
2926 Recalculation of a table is normally not automatic, but needs to be
2927 triggered by a command. See @ref{Advanced features}, for a way to make
2928 recalculation at least semi-automatic.
2929
2930 In order to recalculate a line of a table or the entire table, use the
2931 following commands:
2932
2933 @table @kbd
2934 @orgcmd{C-c *,org-table-recalculate}
2935 Recalculate the current row by first applying the stored column formulas
2936 from left to right, and all field/range formulas in the current row.
2937 @c
2938 @kindex C-u C-c *
2939 @item C-u C-c *
2940 @kindex C-u C-c C-c
2941 @itemx C-u C-c C-c
2942 Recompute the entire table, line by line. Any lines before the first
2943 hline are left alone, assuming that these are part of the table header.
2944 @c
2945 @orgcmdkkc{C-u C-u C-c *,C-u C-u C-c C-c,org-table-iterate}
2946 Iterate the table by recomputing it until no further changes occur.
2947 This may be necessary if some computed fields use the value of other
2948 fields that are computed @i{later} in the calculation sequence.
2949 @item M-x org-table-recalculate-buffer-tables
2950 @findex org-table-recalculate-buffer-tables
2951 Recompute all tables in the current buffer.
2952 @item M-x org-table-iterate-buffer-tables
2953 @findex org-table-iterate-buffer-tables
2954 Iterate all tables in the current buffer, in order to converge table-to-table
2955 dependencies.
2956 @end table
2957
2958 @node Advanced features, , Updating the table, The spreadsheet
2959 @subsection Advanced features
2960
2961 If you want the recalculation of fields to happen automatically, or if you
2962 want to be able to assign @i{names}@footnote{Such names must start by an
2963 alphabetic character and use only alphanumeric/underscore characters.} to
2964 fields and columns, you need to reserve the first column of the table for
2965 special marking characters.
2966
2967 @table @kbd
2968 @orgcmd{C-#,org-table-rotate-recalc-marks}
2969 Rotate the calculation mark in first column through the states @samp{ },
2970 @samp{#}, @samp{*}, @samp{!}, @samp{$}. When there is an active region,
2971 change all marks in the region.
2972 @end table
2973
2974 Here is an example of a table that collects exam results of students and
2975 makes use of these features:
2976
2977 @example
2978 @group
2979 |---+---------+--------+--------+--------+-------+------|
2980 | | Student | Prob 1 | Prob 2 | Prob 3 | Total | Note |
2981 |---+---------+--------+--------+--------+-------+------|
2982 | ! | | P1 | P2 | P3 | Tot | |
2983 | # | Maximum | 10 | 15 | 25 | 50 | 10.0 |
2984 | ^ | | m1 | m2 | m3 | mt | |
2985 |---+---------+--------+--------+--------+-------+------|
2986 | # | Peter | 10 | 8 | 23 | 41 | 8.2 |
2987 | # | Sam | 2 | 4 | 3 | 9 | 1.8 |
2988 |---+---------+--------+--------+--------+-------+------|
2989 | | Average | | | | 25.0 | |
2990 | ^ | | | | | at | |
2991 | $ | max=50 | | | | | |
2992 |---+---------+--------+--------+--------+-------+------|
2993 #+TBLFM: $6=vsum($P1..$P3)::$7=10*$Tot/$max;%.1f::$at=vmean(@@-II..@@-I);%.1f
2994 @end group
2995 @end example
2996
2997 @noindent @b{Important}: please note that for these special tables,
2998 recalculating the table with @kbd{C-u C-c *} will only affect rows that
2999 are marked @samp{#} or @samp{*}, and fields that have a formula assigned
3000 to the field itself. The column formulas are not applied in rows with
3001 empty first field.
3002
3003 @cindex marking characters, tables
3004 The marking characters have the following meaning:
3005 @table @samp
3006 @item !
3007 The fields in this line define names for the columns, so that you may
3008 refer to a column as @samp{$Tot} instead of @samp{$6}.
3009 @item ^
3010 This row defines names for the fields @emph{above} the row. With such
3011 a definition, any formula in the table may use @samp{$m1} to refer to
3012 the value @samp{10}. Also, if you assign a formula to a names field, it
3013 will be stored as @samp{$name=...}.
3014 @item _
3015 Similar to @samp{^}, but defines names for the fields in the row
3016 @emph{below}.
3017 @item $
3018 Fields in this row can define @emph{parameters} for formulas. For
3019 example, if a field in a @samp{$} row contains @samp{max=50}, then
3020 formulas in this table can refer to the value 50 using @samp{$max}.
3021 Parameters work exactly like constants, only that they can be defined on
3022 a per-table basis.
3023 @item #
3024 Fields in this row are automatically recalculated when pressing
3025 @key{TAB} or @key{RET} or @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} in this row. Also, this row
3026 is selected for a global recalculation with @kbd{C-u C-c *}. Unmarked
3027 lines will be left alone by this command.
3028 @item *
3029 Selects this line for global recalculation with @kbd{C-u C-c *}, but
3030 not for automatic recalculation. Use this when automatic
3031 recalculation slows down editing too much.
3032 @item
3033 Unmarked lines are exempt from recalculation with @kbd{C-u C-c *}.
3034 All lines that should be recalculated should be marked with @samp{#}
3035 or @samp{*}.
3036 @item /
3037 Do not export this line. Useful for lines that contain the narrowing
3038 @samp{<N>} markers or column group markers.
3039 @end table
3040
3041 Finally, just to whet your appetite for what can be done with the
3042 fantastic @file{calc.el} package, here is a table that computes the Taylor
3043 series of degree @code{n} at location @code{x} for a couple of
3044 functions.
3045
3046 @example
3047 @group
3048 |---+-------------+---+-----+--------------------------------------|
3049 | | Func | n | x | Result |
3050 |---+-------------+---+-----+--------------------------------------|
3051 | # | exp(x) | 1 | x | 1 + x |
3052 | # | exp(x) | 2 | x | 1 + x + x^2 / 2 |
3053 | # | exp(x) | 3 | x | 1 + x + x^2 / 2 + x^3 / 6 |
3054 | # | x^2+sqrt(x) | 2 | x=0 | x*(0.5 / 0) + x^2 (2 - 0.25 / 0) / 2 |
3055 | # | x^2+sqrt(x) | 2 | x=1 | 2 + 2.5 x - 2.5 + 0.875 (x - 1)^2 |
3056 | * | tan(x) | 3 | x | 0.0175 x + 1.77e-6 x^3 |
3057 |---+-------------+---+-----+--------------------------------------|
3058 #+TBLFM: $5=taylor($2,$4,$3);n3
3059 @end group
3060 @end example
3061
3062 @node Org-Plot, , The spreadsheet, Tables
3063 @section Org-Plot
3064 @cindex graph, in tables
3065 @cindex plot tables using Gnuplot
3066 @cindex #+PLOT
3067
3068 Org-Plot can produce 2D and 3D graphs of information stored in org tables
3069 using @file{Gnuplot} @uref{http://www.gnuplot.info/} and @file{gnuplot-mode}
3070 @uref{http://cars9.uchicago.edu/~ravel/software/gnuplot-mode.html}. To see
3071 this in action, ensure that you have both Gnuplot and Gnuplot mode installed
3072 on your system, then call @code{org-plot/gnuplot} on the following table.
3073
3074 @example
3075 @group
3076 #+PLOT: title:"Citas" ind:1 deps:(3) type:2d with:histograms set:"yrange [0:]"
3077 | Sede | Max cites | H-index |
3078 |-----------+-----------+---------|
3079 | Chile | 257.72 | 21.39 |
3080 | Leeds | 165.77 | 19.68 |
3081 | Sao Paolo | 71.00 | 11.50 |
3082 | Stockholm | 134.19 | 14.33 |
3083 | Morelia | 257.56 | 17.67 |
3084 @end group
3085 @end example
3086
3087 Notice that Org Plot is smart enough to apply the table's headers as labels.
3088 Further control over the labels, type, content, and appearance of plots can
3089 be exercised through the @code{#+PLOT:} lines preceding a table. See below
3090 for a complete list of Org-plot options. For more information and examples
3091 see the Org-plot tutorial at
3092 @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-tutorials/org-plot.html}.
3093
3094 @subsubheading Plot Options
3095
3096 @table @code
3097 @item set
3098 Specify any @command{gnuplot} option to be set when graphing.
3099
3100 @item title
3101 Specify the title of the plot.
3102
3103 @item ind
3104 Specify which column of the table to use as the @code{x} axis.
3105
3106 @item deps
3107 Specify the columns to graph as a Lisp style list, surrounded by parentheses
3108 and separated by spaces for example @code{dep:(3 4)} to graph the third and
3109 fourth columns (defaults to graphing all other columns aside from the @code{ind}
3110 column).
3111
3112 @item type
3113 Specify whether the plot will be @code{2d}, @code{3d}, or @code{grid}.
3114
3115 @item with
3116 Specify a @code{with} option to be inserted for every col being plotted
3117 (e.g., @code{lines}, @code{points}, @code{boxes}, @code{impulses}, etc...).
3118 Defaults to @code{lines}.
3119
3120 @item file
3121 If you want to plot to a file, specify @code{"@var{path/to/desired/output-file}"}.
3122
3123 @item labels
3124 List of labels to be used for the @code{deps} (defaults to the column headers
3125 if they exist).
3126
3127 @item line
3128 Specify an entire line to be inserted in the Gnuplot script.
3129
3130 @item map
3131 When plotting @code{3d} or @code{grid} types, set this to @code{t} to graph a
3132 flat mapping rather than a @code{3d} slope.
3133
3134 @item timefmt
3135 Specify format of Org mode timestamps as they will be parsed by Gnuplot.
3136 Defaults to @samp{%Y-%m-%d-%H:%M:%S}.
3137
3138 @item script
3139 If you want total control, you can specify a script file (place the file name
3140 between double-quotes) which will be used to plot. Before plotting, every
3141 instance of @code{$datafile} in the specified script will be replaced with
3142 the path to the generated data file. Note: even if you set this option, you
3143 may still want to specify the plot type, as that can impact the content of
3144 the data file.
3145 @end table
3146
3147 @node Hyperlinks, TODO Items, Tables, Top
3148 @chapter Hyperlinks
3149 @cindex hyperlinks
3150
3151 Like HTML, Org provides links inside a file, external links to
3152 other files, Usenet articles, emails, and much more.
3153
3154 @menu
3155 * Link format:: How links in Org are formatted
3156 * Internal links:: Links to other places in the current file
3157 * External links:: URL-like links to the world
3158 * Handling links:: Creating, inserting and following
3159 * Using links outside Org:: Linking from my C source code?
3160 * Link abbreviations:: Shortcuts for writing complex links
3161 * Search options:: Linking to a specific location
3162 * Custom searches:: When the default search is not enough
3163 @end menu
3164
3165 @node Link format, Internal links, Hyperlinks, Hyperlinks
3166 @section Link format
3167 @cindex link format
3168 @cindex format, of links
3169
3170 Org will recognize plain URL-like links and activate them as
3171 clickable links. The general link format, however, looks like this:
3172
3173 @example
3174 [[link][description]] @r{or alternatively} [[link]]
3175 @end example
3176
3177 @noindent
3178 Once a link in the buffer is complete (all brackets present), Org
3179 will change the display so that @samp{description} is displayed instead
3180 of @samp{[[link][description]]} and @samp{link} is displayed instead of
3181 @samp{[[link]]}. Links will be highlighted in the face @code{org-link},
3182 which by default is an underlined face. You can directly edit the
3183 visible part of a link. Note that this can be either the @samp{link}
3184 part (if there is no description) or the @samp{description} part. To
3185 edit also the invisible @samp{link} part, use @kbd{C-c C-l} with the
3186 cursor on the link.
3187
3188 If you place the cursor at the beginning or just behind the end of the
3189 displayed text and press @key{BACKSPACE}, you will remove the
3190 (invisible) bracket at that location. This makes the link incomplete
3191 and the internals are again displayed as plain text. Inserting the
3192 missing bracket hides the link internals again. To show the
3193 internal structure of all links, use the menu entry
3194 @code{Org->Hyperlinks->Literal links}.
3195
3196 @node Internal links, External links, Link format, Hyperlinks
3197 @section Internal links
3198 @cindex internal links
3199 @cindex links, internal
3200 @cindex targets, for links
3201
3202 @cindex property, CUSTOM_ID
3203 If the link does not look like a URL, it is considered to be internal in the
3204 current file. The most important case is a link like
3205 @samp{[[#my-custom-id]]} which will link to the entry with the
3206 @code{CUSTOM_ID} property @samp{my-custom-id}. Such custom IDs are very good
3207 for HTML export (@pxref{HTML export}) where they produce pretty section
3208 links. You are responsible yourself to make sure these custom IDs are unique
3209 in a file.
3210
3211 Links such as @samp{[[My Target]]} or @samp{[[My Target][Find my target]]}
3212 lead to a text search in the current file.
3213
3214 The link can be followed with @kbd{C-c C-o} when the cursor is on the link,
3215 or with a mouse click (@pxref{Handling links}). Links to custom IDs will
3216 point to the corresponding headline. The preferred match for a text link is
3217 a @i{dedicated target}: the same string in double angular brackets. Targets
3218 may be located anywhere; sometimes it is convenient to put them into a
3219 comment line. For example
3220
3221 @example
3222 # <<My Target>>
3223 @end example
3224
3225 @noindent In HTML export (@pxref{HTML export}), such targets will become
3226 named anchors for direct access through @samp{http} links@footnote{Note that
3227 text before the first headline is usually not exported, so the first such
3228 target should be after the first headline, or in the line directly before the
3229 first headline.}.
3230
3231 If no dedicated target exists, Org will search for a headline that is exactly
3232 the link text but may also include a TODO keyword and tags@footnote{To insert
3233 a link targeting a headline, in-buffer completion can be used. Just type a
3234 star followed by a few optional letters into the buffer and press
3235 @kbd{M-@key{TAB}}. All headlines in the current buffer will be offered as
3236 completions.}. In non-Org files, the search will look for the words in the
3237 link text. In the above example the search would be for @samp{my target}.
3238
3239 Following a link pushes a mark onto Org's own mark ring. You can
3240 return to the previous position with @kbd{C-c &}. Using this command
3241 several times in direct succession goes back to positions recorded
3242 earlier.
3243
3244 @menu
3245 * Radio targets:: Make targets trigger links in plain text
3246 @end menu
3247
3248 @node Radio targets, , Internal links, Internal links
3249 @subsection Radio targets
3250 @cindex radio targets
3251 @cindex targets, radio
3252 @cindex links, radio targets
3253
3254 Org can automatically turn any occurrences of certain target names
3255 in normal text into a link. So without explicitly creating a link, the
3256 text connects to the target radioing its position. Radio targets are
3257 enclosed by triple angular brackets. For example, a target @samp{<<<My
3258 Target>>>} causes each occurrence of @samp{my target} in normal text to
3259 become activated as a link. The Org file is scanned automatically
3260 for radio targets only when the file is first loaded into Emacs. To
3261 update the target list during editing, press @kbd{C-c C-c} with the
3262 cursor on or at a target.
3263
3264 @node External links, Handling links, Internal links, Hyperlinks
3265 @section External links
3266 @cindex links, external
3267 @cindex external links
3268 @cindex links, external
3269 @cindex Gnus links
3270 @cindex BBDB links
3271 @cindex IRC links
3272 @cindex URL links
3273 @cindex file links
3274 @cindex VM links
3275 @cindex RMAIL links
3276 @cindex WANDERLUST links
3277 @cindex MH-E links
3278 @cindex USENET links
3279 @cindex SHELL links
3280 @cindex Info links
3281 @cindex Elisp links
3282
3283 Org supports links to files, websites, Usenet and email messages,
3284 BBDB database entries and links to both IRC conversations and their
3285 logs. External links are URL-like locators. They start with a short
3286 identifying string followed by a colon. There can be no space after
3287 the colon. The following list shows examples for each link type.
3288
3289 @example
3290 http://www.astro.uva.nl/~dominik @r{on the web}
3291 doi:10.1000/182 @r{DOI for an electronic resource}
3292 file:/home/dominik/images/jupiter.jpg @r{file, absolute path}
3293 /home/dominik/images/jupiter.jpg @r{same as above}
3294 file:papers/last.pdf @r{file, relative path}
3295 ./papers/last.pdf @r{same as above}
3296 file:/myself@@some.where:papers/last.pdf @r{file, path on remote machine}
3297 /myself@@some.where:papers/last.pdf @r{same as above}
3298 file:sometextfile::NNN @r{file, jump to line number}
3299 file:projects.org @r{another Org file}
3300 file:projects.org::some words @r{text search in Org file}@footnote{
3301 The actual behavior of the search will depend on the value of
3302 the variable @code{org-link-search-must-match-exact-headline}. If its value
3303 is nil, then a fuzzy text search will be done. If it is t, then only the
3304 exact headline will be matched. If the value is @code{'query-to-create},
3305 then an exact headline will be searched; if it is not found, then the user
3306 will be queried to create it.}
3307 file:projects.org::*task title @r{heading search in Org file}
3308 file+sys:/path/to/file @r{open via OS, like double-click}
3309 file+emacs:/path/to/file @r{force opening by Emacs}
3310 docview:papers/last.pdf::NNN @r{open in doc-view mode at page}
3311 id:B7423F4D-2E8A-471B-8810-C40F074717E9 @r{Link to heading by ID}
3312 news:comp.emacs @r{Usenet link}
3313 mailto:adent@@galaxy.net @r{Mail link}
3314 vm:folder @r{VM folder link}
3315 vm:folder#id @r{VM message link}
3316 vm://myself@@some.where.org/folder#id @r{VM on remote machine}
3317 vm-imap:account:folder @r{VM IMAP folder link}
3318 vm-imap:account:folder#id @r{VM IMAP message link}
3319 wl:folder @r{WANDERLUST folder link}
3320 wl:folder#id @r{WANDERLUST message link}
3321 mhe:folder @r{MH-E folder link}
3322 mhe:folder#id @r{MH-E message link}
3323 rmail:folder @r{RMAIL folder link}
3324 rmail:folder#id @r{RMAIL message link}
3325 gnus:group @r{Gnus group link}
3326 gnus:group#id @r{Gnus article link}
3327 bbdb:R.*Stallman @r{BBDB link (with regexp)}
3328 irc:/irc.com/#emacs/bob @r{IRC link}
3329 info:org#External links @r{Info node link}
3330 shell:ls *.org @r{A shell command}
3331 elisp:org-agenda @r{Interactive Elisp command}
3332 elisp:(find-file-other-frame "Elisp.org") @r{Elisp form to evaluate}
3333 @end example
3334
3335 For customizing Org to add new link types @ref{Adding hyperlink types}.
3336
3337 A link should be enclosed in double brackets and may contain a
3338 descriptive text to be displayed instead of the URL (@pxref{Link
3339 format}), for example:
3340
3341 @example
3342 [[http://www.gnu.org/software/emacs/][GNU Emacs]]
3343 @end example
3344
3345 @noindent
3346 If the description is a file name or URL that points to an image, HTML
3347 export (@pxref{HTML export}) will inline the image as a clickable
3348 button. If there is no description at all and the link points to an
3349 image,
3350 that image will be inlined into the exported HTML file.
3351
3352 @cindex square brackets, around links
3353 @cindex plain text external links
3354 Org also finds external links in the normal text and activates them
3355 as links. If spaces must be part of the link (for example in
3356 @samp{bbdb:Richard Stallman}), or if you need to remove ambiguities
3357 about the end of the link, enclose them in square brackets.
3358
3359 @node Handling links, Using links outside Org, External links, Hyperlinks
3360 @section Handling links
3361 @cindex links, handling
3362
3363 Org provides methods to create a link in the correct syntax, to
3364 insert it into an Org file, and to follow the link.
3365
3366 @table @kbd
3367 @orgcmd{C-c l,org-store-link}
3368 @cindex storing links
3369 Store a link to the current location. This is a @emph{global} command (you
3370 must create the key binding yourself) which can be used in any buffer to
3371 create a link. The link will be stored for later insertion into an Org
3372 buffer (see below). What kind of link will be created depends on the current
3373 buffer:
3374
3375 @b{Org mode buffers}@*
3376 For Org files, if there is a @samp{<<target>>} at the cursor, the link points
3377 to the target. Otherwise it points to the current headline, which will also
3378 be the description@footnote{If the headline contains a timestamp, it will be
3379 removed from the link and result in a wrong link -- you should avoid putting
3380 timestamp in the headline.}.
3381
3382 @vindex org-link-to-org-use-id
3383 @cindex property, CUSTOM_ID
3384 @cindex property, ID
3385 If the headline has a @code{CUSTOM_ID} property, a link to this custom ID
3386 will be stored. In addition or alternatively (depending on the value of
3387 @code{org-link-to-org-use-id}), a globally unique @code{ID} property will be
3388 created and/or used to construct a link. So using this command in Org
3389 buffers will potentially create two links: a human-readable from the custom
3390 ID, and one that is globally unique and works even if the entry is moved from
3391 file to file. Later, when inserting the link, you need to decide which one
3392 to use.
3393
3394 @b{Email/News clients: VM, Rmail, Wanderlust, MH-E, Gnus}@*
3395 Pretty much all Emacs mail clients are supported. The link will point to the
3396 current article, or, in some GNUS buffers, to the group. The description is
3397 constructed from the author and the subject.
3398
3399 @b{Web browsers: W3 and W3M}@*
3400 Here the link will be the current URL, with the page title as description.
3401
3402 @b{Contacts: BBDB}@*
3403 Links created in a BBDB buffer will point to the current entry.
3404
3405 @b{Chat: IRC}@*
3406 @vindex org-irc-link-to-logs
3407 For IRC links, if you set the variable @code{org-irc-link-to-logs} to
3408 @code{t}, a @samp{file:/} style link to the relevant point in the logs for
3409 the current conversation is created. Otherwise an @samp{irc:/} style link to
3410 the user/channel/server under the point will be stored.
3411
3412 @b{Other files}@*
3413 For any other files, the link will point to the file, with a search string
3414 (@pxref{Search options}) pointing to the contents of the current line. If
3415 there is an active region, the selected words will form the basis of the
3416 search string. If the automatically created link is not working correctly or
3417 accurately enough, you can write custom functions to select the search string
3418 and to do the search for particular file types---see @ref{Custom searches}.
3419 The key binding @kbd{C-c l} is only a suggestion---see @ref{Installation}.
3420
3421 @b{Agenda view}@*
3422 When the cursor is in an agenda view, the created link points to the
3423 entry referenced by the current line.
3424
3425 @c
3426 @orgcmd{C-c C-l,org-insert-link}
3427 @cindex link completion
3428 @cindex completion, of links
3429 @cindex inserting links
3430 @vindex org-keep-stored-link-after-insertion
3431 Insert a link@footnote{ Note that you don't have to use this command to
3432 insert a link. Links in Org are plain text, and you can type or paste them
3433 straight into the buffer. By using this command, the links are automatically
3434 enclosed in double brackets, and you will be asked for the optional
3435 descriptive text.}. This prompts for a link to be inserted into the buffer.
3436 You can just type a link, using text for an internal link, or one of the link
3437 type prefixes mentioned in the examples above. The link will be inserted
3438 into the buffer@footnote{After insertion of a stored link, the link will be
3439 removed from the list of stored links. To keep it in the list later use, use
3440 a triple @kbd{C-u} prefix argument to @kbd{C-c C-l}, or configure the option
3441 @code{org-keep-stored-link-after-insertion}.}, along with a descriptive text.
3442 If some text was selected when this command is called, the selected text
3443 becomes the default description.
3444
3445 @b{Inserting stored links}@*
3446 All links stored during the
3447 current session are part of the history for this prompt, so you can access
3448 them with @key{up} and @key{down} (or @kbd{M-p/n}).
3449
3450 @b{Completion support}@* Completion with @key{TAB} will help you to insert
3451 valid link prefixes like @samp{http:} or @samp{ftp:}, including the prefixes
3452 defined through link abbreviations (@pxref{Link abbreviations}). If you
3453 press @key{RET} after inserting only the @var{prefix}, Org will offer
3454 specific completion support for some link types@footnote{This works by
3455 calling a special function @code{org-PREFIX-complete-link}.} For
3456 example, if you type @kbd{file @key{RET}}, file name completion (alternative
3457 access: @kbd{C-u C-c C-l}, see below) will be offered, and after @kbd{bbdb
3458 @key{RET}} you can complete contact names.
3459 @orgkey C-u C-c C-l
3460 @cindex file name completion
3461 @cindex completion, of file names
3462 When @kbd{C-c C-l} is called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix argument, a link to
3463 a file will be inserted and you may use file name completion to select
3464 the name of the file. The path to the file is inserted relative to the
3465 directory of the current Org file, if the linked file is in the current
3466 directory or in a sub-directory of it, or if the path is written relative
3467 to the current directory using @samp{../}. Otherwise an absolute path
3468 is used, if possible with @samp{~/} for your home directory. You can
3469 force an absolute path with two @kbd{C-u} prefixes.
3470 @c
3471 @item C-c C-l @ @r{(with cursor on existing link)}
3472 When the cursor is on an existing link, @kbd{C-c C-l} allows you to edit the
3473 link and description parts of the link.
3474 @c
3475 @cindex following links
3476 @orgcmd{C-c C-o,org-open-at-point}
3477 @vindex org-file-apps
3478 @vindex org-link-frame-setup
3479 Open link at point. This will launch a web browser for URLs (using
3480 @command{browse-url-at-point}), run VM/MH-E/Wanderlust/Rmail/Gnus/BBDB for
3481 the corresponding links, and execute the command in a shell link. When the
3482 cursor is on an internal link, this command runs the corresponding search.
3483 When the cursor is on a TAG list in a headline, it creates the corresponding
3484 TAGS view. If the cursor is on a timestamp, it compiles the agenda for that
3485 date. Furthermore, it will visit text and remote files in @samp{file:} links
3486 with Emacs and select a suitable application for local non-text files.
3487 Classification of files is based on file extension only. See option
3488 @code{org-file-apps}. If you want to override the default application and
3489 visit the file with Emacs, use a @kbd{C-u} prefix. If you want to avoid
3490 opening in Emacs, use a @kbd{C-u C-u} prefix.@*
3491 If the cursor is on a headline, but not on a link, offer all links in the
3492 headline and entry text. If you want to setup the frame configuration for
3493 following links, customize @code{org-link-frame-setup}.
3494
3495 @orgkey @key{RET}
3496 @vindex org-return-follows-link
3497 When @code{org-return-follows-link} is set, @kbd{@key{RET}} will also follow
3498 the link at point.
3499 @c
3500 @kindex mouse-2
3501 @kindex mouse-1
3502 @item mouse-2
3503 @itemx mouse-1
3504 On links, @kbd{mouse-2} will open the link just as @kbd{C-c C-o}
3505 would. Under Emacs 22 and later, @kbd{mouse-1} will also follow a link.
3506 @c
3507 @kindex mouse-3
3508 @item mouse-3
3509 @vindex org-display-internal-link-with-indirect-buffer
3510 Like @kbd{mouse-2}, but force file links to be opened with Emacs, and
3511 internal links to be displayed in another window@footnote{See the
3512 variable @code{org-display-internal-link-with-indirect-buffer}}.
3513 @c
3514 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-v,org-toggle-inline-images}
3515 @cindex inlining images
3516 @cindex images, inlining
3517 @vindex org-startup-with-inline-images
3518 @cindex @code{inlineimages}, STARTUP keyword
3519 @cindex @code{noinlineimages}, STARTUP keyword
3520 Toggle the inline display of linked images. Normally this will only inline
3521 images that have no description part in the link, i.e., images that will also
3522 be inlined during export. When called with a prefix argument, also display
3523 images that do have a link description. You can ask for inline images to be
3524 displayed at startup by configuring the variable
3525 @code{org-startup-with-inline-images}@footnote{with corresponding
3526 @code{#+STARTUP} keywords @code{inlineimages} and @code{inlineimages}}.
3527 @orgcmd{C-c %,org-mark-ring-push}
3528 @cindex mark ring
3529 Push the current position onto the mark ring, to be able to return
3530 easily. Commands following an internal link do this automatically.
3531 @c
3532 @orgcmd{C-c &,org-mark-ring-goto}
3533 @cindex links, returning to
3534 Jump back to a recorded position. A position is recorded by the
3535 commands following internal links, and by @kbd{C-c %}. Using this
3536 command several times in direct succession moves through a ring of
3537 previously recorded positions.
3538 @c
3539 @orgcmdkkcc{C-c C-x C-n,C-c C-x C-p,org-next-link,org-previous-link}
3540 @cindex links, finding next/previous
3541 Move forward/backward to the next link in the buffer. At the limit of
3542 the buffer, the search fails once, and then wraps around. The key
3543 bindings for this are really too long; you might want to bind this also
3544 to @kbd{C-n} and @kbd{C-p}
3545 @lisp
3546 (add-hook 'org-load-hook
3547 (lambda ()
3548 (define-key org-mode-map "\C-n" 'org-next-link)
3549 (define-key org-mode-map "\C-p" 'org-previous-link)))
3550 @end lisp
3551 @end table
3552
3553 @node Using links outside Org, Link abbreviations, Handling links, Hyperlinks
3554 @section Using links outside Org
3555
3556 You can insert and follow links that have Org syntax not only in
3557 Org, but in any Emacs buffer. For this, you should create two
3558 global commands, like this (please select suitable global keys
3559 yourself):
3560
3561 @lisp
3562 (global-set-key "\C-c L" 'org-insert-link-global)
3563 (global-set-key "\C-c o" 'org-open-at-point-global)
3564 @end lisp
3565
3566 @node Link abbreviations, Search options, Using links outside Org, Hyperlinks
3567 @section Link abbreviations
3568 @cindex link abbreviations
3569 @cindex abbreviation, links
3570
3571 Long URLs can be cumbersome to type, and often many similar links are
3572 needed in a document. For this you can use link abbreviations. An
3573 abbreviated link looks like this
3574
3575 @example
3576 [[linkword:tag][description]]
3577 @end example
3578
3579 @noindent
3580 @vindex org-link-abbrev-alist
3581 where the tag is optional.
3582 The @i{linkword} must be a word, starting with a letter, followed by
3583 letters, numbers, @samp{-}, and @samp{_}. Abbreviations are resolved
3584 according to the information in the variable @code{org-link-abbrev-alist}
3585 that relates the linkwords to replacement text. Here is an example:
3586
3587 @smalllisp
3588 @group
3589 (setq org-link-abbrev-alist
3590 '(("bugzilla" . "http://10.1.2.9/bugzilla/show_bug.cgi?id=")
3591 ("url-to-ja" . "http://translate.google.fr/translate?sl=en&tl=ja&u=%h")
3592 ("google" . "http://www.google.com/search?q=")
3593 ("gmap" . "http://maps.google.com/maps?q=%s")
3594 ("omap" . "http://nominatim.openstreetmap.org/search?q=%s&polygon=1")
3595 ("ads" . "http://adsabs.harvard.edu/cgi-bin/nph-abs_connect?author=%s&db_key=AST")))
3596 @end group
3597 @end smalllisp
3598
3599 If the replacement text contains the string @samp{%s}, it will be
3600 replaced with the tag. Using @samp{%h} instead of @samp{%s} will
3601 url-encode the tag (see the example above, where we need to encode
3602 the URL parameter.) Using @samp{%(my-function)} will pass the tag
3603 to a custom function, and replace it by the resulting string.
3604
3605 If the replacement text don't contain any specifier, it will simply
3606 be appended to the string in order to create the link.
3607
3608 Instead of a string, you may also specify a function that will be
3609 called with the tag as the only argument to create the link.
3610
3611 With the above setting, you could link to a specific bug with
3612 @code{[[bugzilla:129]]}, search the web for @samp{OrgMode} with
3613 @code{[[google:OrgMode]]}, show the map location of the Free Software
3614 Foundation @code{[[gmap:51 Franklin Street, Boston]]} or of Carsten office
3615 @code{[[omap:Science Park 904, Amsterdam, The Netherlands]]} and find out
3616 what the Org author is doing besides Emacs hacking with
3617 @code{[[ads:Dominik,C]]}.
3618
3619 If you need special abbreviations just for a single Org buffer, you
3620 can define them in the file with
3621
3622 @cindex #+LINK
3623 @example
3624 #+LINK: bugzilla http://10.1.2.9/bugzilla/show_bug.cgi?id=
3625 #+LINK: google http://www.google.com/search?q=%s
3626 @end example
3627
3628 @noindent
3629 In-buffer completion (@pxref{Completion}) can be used after @samp{[} to
3630 complete link abbreviations. You may also define a function
3631 @code{org-PREFIX-complete-link} that implements special (e.g., completion)
3632 support for inserting such a link with @kbd{C-c C-l}. Such a function should
3633 not accept any arguments, and return the full link with prefix.
3634
3635 @node Search options, Custom searches, Link abbreviations, Hyperlinks
3636 @section Search options in file links
3637 @cindex search option in file links
3638 @cindex file links, searching
3639
3640 File links can contain additional information to make Emacs jump to a
3641 particular location in the file when following a link. This can be a
3642 line number or a search option after a double@footnote{For backward
3643 compatibility, line numbers can also follow a single colon.} colon. For
3644 example, when the command @kbd{C-c l} creates a link (@pxref{Handling
3645 links}) to a file, it encodes the words in the current line as a search
3646 string that can be used to find this line back later when following the
3647 link with @kbd{C-c C-o}.
3648
3649 Here is the syntax of the different ways to attach a search to a file
3650 link, together with an explanation:
3651
3652 @example
3653 [[file:~/code/main.c::255]]
3654 [[file:~/xx.org::My Target]]
3655 [[file:~/xx.org::*My Target]]
3656 [[file:~/xx.org::#my-custom-id]]
3657 [[file:~/xx.org::/regexp/]]
3658 @end example
3659
3660 @table @code
3661 @item 255
3662 Jump to line 255.
3663 @item My Target
3664 Search for a link target @samp{<<My Target>>}, or do a text search for
3665 @samp{my target}, similar to the search in internal links, see
3666 @ref{Internal links}. In HTML export (@pxref{HTML export}), such a file
3667 link will become a HTML reference to the corresponding named anchor in
3668 the linked file.
3669 @item *My Target
3670 In an Org file, restrict search to headlines.
3671 @item #my-custom-id
3672 Link to a heading with a @code{CUSTOM_ID} property
3673 @item /regexp/
3674 Do a regular expression search for @code{regexp}. This uses the Emacs
3675 command @code{occur} to list all matches in a separate window. If the
3676 target file is in Org mode, @code{org-occur} is used to create a
3677 sparse tree with the matches.
3678 @c If the target file is a directory,
3679 @c @code{grep} will be used to search all files in the directory.
3680 @end table
3681
3682 As a degenerate case, a file link with an empty file name can be used
3683 to search the current file. For example, @code{[[file:::find me]]} does
3684 a search for @samp{find me} in the current file, just as
3685 @samp{[[find me]]} would.
3686
3687 @node Custom searches, , Search options, Hyperlinks
3688 @section Custom Searches
3689 @cindex custom search strings
3690 @cindex search strings, custom
3691
3692 The default mechanism for creating search strings and for doing the
3693 actual search related to a file link may not work correctly in all
3694 cases. For example, Bib@TeX{} database files have many entries like
3695 @samp{year="1993"} which would not result in good search strings,
3696 because the only unique identification for a Bib@TeX{} entry is the
3697 citation key.
3698
3699 @vindex org-create-file-search-functions
3700 @vindex org-execute-file-search-functions
3701 If you come across such a problem, you can write custom functions to set
3702 the right search string for a particular file type, and to do the search
3703 for the string in the file. Using @code{add-hook}, these functions need
3704 to be added to the hook variables
3705 @code{org-create-file-search-functions} and
3706 @code{org-execute-file-search-functions}. See the docstring for these
3707 variables for more information. Org actually uses this mechanism
3708 for Bib@TeX{} database files, and you can use the corresponding code as
3709 an implementation example. See the file @file{org-bibtex.el}.
3710
3711 @node TODO Items, Tags, Hyperlinks, Top
3712 @chapter TODO items
3713 @cindex TODO items
3714
3715 Org mode does not maintain TODO lists as separate documents@footnote{Of
3716 course, you can make a document that contains only long lists of TODO items,
3717 but this is not required.}. Instead, TODO items are an integral part of the
3718 notes file, because TODO items usually come up while taking notes! With Org
3719 mode, simply mark any entry in a tree as being a TODO item. In this way,
3720 information is not duplicated, and the entire context from which the TODO
3721 item emerged is always present.
3722
3723 Of course, this technique for managing TODO items scatters them
3724 throughout your notes file. Org mode compensates for this by providing
3725 methods to give you an overview of all the things that you have to do.
3726
3727 @menu
3728 * TODO basics:: Marking and displaying TODO entries
3729 * TODO extensions:: Workflow and assignments
3730 * Progress logging:: Dates and notes for progress
3731 * Priorities:: Some things are more important than others
3732 * Breaking down tasks:: Splitting a task into manageable pieces
3733 * Checkboxes:: Tick-off lists
3734 @end menu
3735
3736 @node TODO basics, TODO extensions, TODO Items, TODO Items
3737 @section Basic TODO functionality
3738
3739 Any headline becomes a TODO item when it starts with the word
3740 @samp{TODO}, for example:
3741
3742 @example
3743 *** TODO Write letter to Sam Fortune
3744 @end example
3745
3746 @noindent
3747 The most important commands to work with TODO entries are:
3748
3749 @table @kbd
3750 @orgcmd{C-c C-t,org-todo}
3751 @cindex cycling, of TODO states
3752 Rotate the TODO state of the current item among
3753
3754 @example
3755 ,-> (unmarked) -> TODO -> DONE --.
3756 '--------------------------------'
3757 @end example
3758
3759 The same rotation can also be done ``remotely'' from the timeline and
3760 agenda buffers with the @kbd{t} command key (@pxref{Agenda commands}).
3761
3762 @orgkey{C-u C-c C-t}
3763 Select a specific keyword using completion or (if it has been set up)
3764 the fast selection interface. For the latter, you need to assign keys
3765 to TODO states, see @ref{Per-file keywords}, and @ref{Setting tags}, for
3766 more information.
3767
3768 @kindex S-@key{right}
3769 @kindex S-@key{left}
3770 @item S-@key{right} @ @r{/} @ S-@key{left}
3771 @vindex org-treat-S-cursor-todo-selection-as-state-change
3772 Select the following/preceding TODO state, similar to cycling. Useful
3773 mostly if more than two TODO states are possible (@pxref{TODO
3774 extensions}). See also @ref{Conflicts}, for a discussion of the interaction
3775 with @code{shift-selection-mode}. See also the variable
3776 @code{org-treat-S-cursor-todo-selection-as-state-change}.
3777 @orgcmd{C-c / t,org-show-todo-tree}
3778 @cindex sparse tree, for TODO
3779 @vindex org-todo-keywords
3780 View TODO items in a @emph{sparse tree} (@pxref{Sparse trees}). Folds the
3781 entire buffer, but shows all TODO items (with not-DONE state) and the
3782 headings hierarchy above them. With a prefix argument (or by using @kbd{C-c
3783 / T}), search for a specific TODO@. You will be prompted for the keyword, and
3784 you can also give a list of keywords like @code{KWD1|KWD2|...} to list
3785 entries that match any one of these keywords. With a numeric prefix argument
3786 N, show the tree for the Nth keyword in the variable
3787 @code{org-todo-keywords}. With two prefix arguments, find all TODO states,
3788 both un-done and done.
3789 @orgcmd{C-c a t,org-todo-list}
3790 Show the global TODO list. Collects the TODO items (with not-DONE states)
3791 from all agenda files (@pxref{Agenda Views}) into a single buffer. The new
3792 buffer will be in @code{agenda-mode}, which provides commands to examine and
3793 manipulate the TODO entries from the new buffer (@pxref{Agenda commands}).
3794 @xref{Global TODO list}, for more information.
3795 @orgcmd{S-M-@key{RET},org-insert-todo-heading}
3796 Insert a new TODO entry below the current one.
3797 @end table
3798
3799 @noindent
3800 @vindex org-todo-state-tags-triggers
3801 Changing a TODO state can also trigger tag changes. See the docstring of the
3802 option @code{org-todo-state-tags-triggers} for details.
3803
3804 @node TODO extensions, Progress logging, TODO basics, TODO Items
3805 @section Extended use of TODO keywords
3806 @cindex extended TODO keywords
3807
3808 @vindex org-todo-keywords
3809 By default, marked TODO entries have one of only two states: TODO and
3810 DONE@. Org mode allows you to classify TODO items in more complex ways
3811 with @emph{TODO keywords} (stored in @code{org-todo-keywords}). With
3812 special setup, the TODO keyword system can work differently in different
3813 files.
3814
3815 Note that @i{tags} are another way to classify headlines in general and
3816 TODO items in particular (@pxref{Tags}).
3817
3818 @menu
3819 * Workflow states:: From TODO to DONE in steps
3820 * TODO types:: I do this, Fred does the rest
3821 * Multiple sets in one file:: Mixing it all, and still finding your way
3822 * Fast access to TODO states:: Single letter selection of a state
3823 * Per-file keywords:: Different files, different requirements
3824 * Faces for TODO keywords:: Highlighting states
3825 * TODO dependencies:: When one task needs to wait for others
3826 @end menu
3827
3828 @node Workflow states, TODO types, TODO extensions, TODO extensions
3829 @subsection TODO keywords as workflow states
3830 @cindex TODO workflow
3831 @cindex workflow states as TODO keywords
3832
3833 You can use TODO keywords to indicate different @emph{sequential} states
3834 in the process of working on an item, for example@footnote{Changing
3835 this variable only becomes effective after restarting Org mode in a
3836 buffer.}:
3837
3838 @lisp
3839 (setq org-todo-keywords
3840 '((sequence "TODO" "FEEDBACK" "VERIFY" "|" "DONE" "DELEGATED")))
3841 @end lisp
3842
3843 The vertical bar separates the TODO keywords (states that @emph{need
3844 action}) from the DONE states (which need @emph{no further action}). If
3845 you don't provide the separator bar, the last state is used as the DONE
3846 state.
3847 @cindex completion, of TODO keywords
3848 With this setup, the command @kbd{C-c C-t} will cycle an entry from TODO
3849 to FEEDBACK, then to VERIFY, and finally to DONE and DELEGATED@. You may
3850 also use a numeric prefix argument to quickly select a specific state. For
3851 example @kbd{C-3 C-c C-t} will change the state immediately to VERIFY@.
3852 Or you can use @kbd{S-@key{left}} to go backward through the sequence. If you
3853 define many keywords, you can use in-buffer completion
3854 (@pxref{Completion}) or even a special one-key selection scheme
3855 (@pxref{Fast access to TODO states}) to insert these words into the
3856 buffer. Changing a TODO state can be logged with a timestamp, see
3857 @ref{Tracking TODO state changes}, for more information.
3858
3859 @node TODO types, Multiple sets in one file, Workflow states, TODO extensions
3860 @subsection TODO keywords as types
3861 @cindex TODO types
3862 @cindex names as TODO keywords
3863 @cindex types as TODO keywords
3864
3865 The second possibility is to use TODO keywords to indicate different
3866 @emph{types} of action items. For example, you might want to indicate
3867 that items are for ``work'' or ``home''. Or, when you work with several
3868 people on a single project, you might want to assign action items
3869 directly to persons, by using their names as TODO keywords. This would
3870 be set up like this:
3871
3872 @lisp
3873 (setq org-todo-keywords '((type "Fred" "Sara" "Lucy" "|" "DONE")))
3874 @end lisp
3875
3876 In this case, different keywords do not indicate a sequence, but rather
3877 different types. So the normal work flow would be to assign a task to a
3878 person, and later to mark it DONE@. Org mode supports this style by adapting
3879 the workings of the command @kbd{C-c C-t}@footnote{This is also true for the
3880 @kbd{t} command in the timeline and agenda buffers.}. When used several
3881 times in succession, it will still cycle through all names, in order to first
3882 select the right type for a task. But when you return to the item after some
3883 time and execute @kbd{C-c C-t} again, it will switch from any name directly
3884 to DONE@. Use prefix arguments or completion to quickly select a specific
3885 name. You can also review the items of a specific TODO type in a sparse tree
3886 by using a numeric prefix to @kbd{C-c / t}. For example, to see all things
3887 Lucy has to do, you would use @kbd{C-3 C-c / t}. To collect Lucy's items
3888 from all agenda files into a single buffer, you would use the numeric prefix
3889 argument as well when creating the global TODO list: @kbd{C-3 C-c a t}.
3890
3891 @node Multiple sets in one file, Fast access to TODO states, TODO types, TODO extensions
3892 @subsection Multiple keyword sets in one file
3893 @cindex TODO keyword sets
3894
3895 Sometimes you may want to use different sets of TODO keywords in
3896 parallel. For example, you may want to have the basic
3897 @code{TODO}/@code{DONE}, but also a workflow for bug fixing, and a
3898 separate state indicating that an item has been canceled (so it is not
3899 DONE, but also does not require action). Your setup would then look
3900 like this:
3901
3902 @lisp
3903 (setq org-todo-keywords
3904 '((sequence "TODO" "|" "DONE")
3905 (sequence "REPORT" "BUG" "KNOWNCAUSE" "|" "FIXED")
3906 (sequence "|" "CANCELED")))
3907 @end lisp
3908
3909 The keywords should all be different, this helps Org mode to keep track
3910 of which subsequence should be used for a given entry. In this setup,
3911 @kbd{C-c C-t} only operates within a subsequence, so it switches from
3912 @code{DONE} to (nothing) to @code{TODO}, and from @code{FIXED} to
3913 (nothing) to @code{REPORT}. Therefore you need a mechanism to initially
3914 select the correct sequence. Besides the obvious ways like typing a
3915 keyword or using completion, you may also apply the following commands:
3916
3917 @table @kbd
3918 @kindex C-S-@key{right}
3919 @kindex C-S-@key{left}
3920 @kindex C-u C-u C-c C-t
3921 @item C-u C-u C-c C-t
3922 @itemx C-S-@key{right}
3923 @itemx C-S-@key{left}
3924 These keys jump from one TODO subset to the next. In the above example,
3925 @kbd{C-u C-u C-c C-t} or @kbd{C-S-@key{right}} would jump from @code{TODO} or
3926 @code{DONE} to @code{REPORT}, and any of the words in the second row to
3927 @code{CANCELED}. Note that the @kbd{C-S-} key binding conflict with
3928 @code{shift-selection-mode} (@pxref{Conflicts}).
3929 @kindex S-@key{right}
3930 @kindex S-@key{left}
3931 @item S-@key{right}
3932 @itemx S-@key{left}
3933 @kbd{S-@key{<left>}} and @kbd{S-@key{<right>}} and walk through @emph{all}
3934 keywords from all sets, so for example @kbd{S-@key{<right>}} would switch
3935 from @code{DONE} to @code{REPORT} in the example above. See also
3936 @ref{Conflicts}, for a discussion of the interaction with
3937 @code{shift-selection-mode}.
3938 @end table
3939
3940 @node Fast access to TODO states, Per-file keywords, Multiple sets in one file, TODO extensions
3941 @subsection Fast access to TODO states
3942
3943 If you would like to quickly change an entry to an arbitrary TODO state
3944 instead of cycling through the states, you can set up keys for single-letter
3945 access to the states. This is done by adding the selection character after
3946 each keyword, in parentheses@footnote{All characters are allowed except
3947 @code{@@^!}, which have a special meaning here.}. For example:
3948
3949 @lisp
3950 (setq org-todo-keywords
3951 '((sequence "TODO(t)" "|" "DONE(d)")
3952 (sequence "REPORT(r)" "BUG(b)" "KNOWNCAUSE(k)" "|" "FIXED(f)")
3953 (sequence "|" "CANCELED(c)")))
3954 @end lisp
3955
3956 @vindex org-fast-tag-selection-include-todo
3957 If you then press @kbd{C-c C-t} followed by the selection key, the entry
3958 will be switched to this state. @kbd{SPC} can be used to remove any TODO
3959 keyword from an entry.@footnote{Check also the variable
3960 @code{org-fast-tag-selection-include-todo}, it allows you to change the TODO
3961 state through the tags interface (@pxref{Setting tags}), in case you like to
3962 mingle the two concepts. Note that this means you need to come up with
3963 unique keys across both sets of keywords.}
3964
3965 @node Per-file keywords, Faces for TODO keywords, Fast access to TODO states, TODO extensions
3966 @subsection Setting up keywords for individual files
3967 @cindex keyword options
3968 @cindex per-file keywords
3969 @cindex #+TODO
3970 @cindex #+TYP_TODO
3971 @cindex #+SEQ_TODO
3972
3973 It can be very useful to use different aspects of the TODO mechanism in
3974 different files. For file-local settings, you need to add special lines
3975 to the file which set the keywords and interpretation for that file
3976 only. For example, to set one of the two examples discussed above, you
3977 need one of the following lines, starting in column zero anywhere in the
3978 file:
3979
3980 @example
3981 #+TODO: TODO FEEDBACK VERIFY | DONE CANCELED
3982 @end example
3983 @noindent (you may also write @code{#+SEQ_TODO} to be explicit about the
3984 interpretation, but it means the same as @code{#+TODO}), or
3985 @example
3986 #+TYP_TODO: Fred Sara Lucy Mike | DONE
3987 @end example
3988
3989 A setup for using several sets in parallel would be:
3990
3991 @example
3992 #+TODO: TODO | DONE
3993 #+TODO: REPORT BUG KNOWNCAUSE | FIXED
3994 #+TODO: | CANCELED
3995 @end example
3996
3997 @cindex completion, of option keywords
3998 @kindex M-@key{TAB}
3999 @noindent To make sure you are using the correct keyword, type
4000 @samp{#+} into the buffer and then use @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} completion.
4001
4002 @cindex DONE, final TODO keyword
4003 Remember that the keywords after the vertical bar (or the last keyword
4004 if no bar is there) must always mean that the item is DONE (although you
4005 may use a different word). After changing one of these lines, use
4006 @kbd{C-c C-c} with the cursor still in the line to make the changes
4007 known to Org mode@footnote{Org mode parses these lines only when
4008 Org mode is activated after visiting a file. @kbd{C-c C-c} with the
4009 cursor in a line starting with @samp{#+} is simply restarting Org mode
4010 for the current buffer.}.
4011
4012 @node Faces for TODO keywords, TODO dependencies, Per-file keywords, TODO extensions
4013 @subsection Faces for TODO keywords
4014 @cindex faces, for TODO keywords
4015
4016 @vindex org-todo @r{(face)}
4017 @vindex org-done @r{(face)}
4018 @vindex org-todo-keyword-faces
4019 Org mode highlights TODO keywords with special faces: @code{org-todo}
4020 for keywords indicating that an item still has to be acted upon, and
4021 @code{org-done} for keywords indicating that an item is finished. If
4022 you are using more than 2 different states, you might want to use
4023 special faces for some of them. This can be done using the variable
4024 @code{org-todo-keyword-faces}. For example:
4025
4026 @lisp
4027 @group
4028 (setq org-todo-keyword-faces
4029 '(("TODO" . org-warning) ("STARTED" . "yellow")
4030 ("CANCELED" . (:foreground "blue" :weight bold))))
4031 @end group
4032 @end lisp
4033
4034 While using a list with face properties as shown for CANCELED @emph{should}
4035 work, this does not always seem to be the case. If necessary, define a
4036 special face and use that. A string is interpreted as a color. The variable
4037 @code{org-faces-easy-properties} determines if that color is interpreted as a
4038 foreground or a background color.
4039
4040 @node TODO dependencies, , Faces for TODO keywords, TODO extensions
4041 @subsection TODO dependencies
4042 @cindex TODO dependencies
4043 @cindex dependencies, of TODO states
4044
4045 @vindex org-enforce-todo-dependencies
4046 @cindex property, ORDERED
4047 The structure of Org files (hierarchy and lists) makes it easy to define TODO
4048 dependencies. Usually, a parent TODO task should not be marked DONE until
4049 all subtasks (defined as children tasks) are marked as DONE@. And sometimes
4050 there is a logical sequence to a number of (sub)tasks, so that one task
4051 cannot be acted upon before all siblings above it are done. If you customize
4052 the variable @code{org-enforce-todo-dependencies}, Org will block entries
4053 from changing state to DONE while they have children that are not DONE@.
4054 Furthermore, if an entry has a property @code{ORDERED}, each of its children
4055 will be blocked until all earlier siblings are marked DONE@. Here is an
4056 example:
4057
4058 @example
4059 * TODO Blocked until (two) is done
4060 ** DONE one
4061 ** TODO two
4062
4063 * Parent
4064 :PROPERTIES:
4065 :ORDERED: t
4066 :END:
4067 ** TODO a
4068 ** TODO b, needs to wait for (a)
4069 ** TODO c, needs to wait for (a) and (b)
4070 @end example
4071
4072 @table @kbd
4073 @orgcmd{C-c C-x o,org-toggle-ordered-property}
4074 @vindex org-track-ordered-property-with-tag
4075 @cindex property, ORDERED
4076 Toggle the @code{ORDERED} property of the current entry. A property is used
4077 for this behavior because this should be local to the current entry, not
4078 inherited like a tag. However, if you would like to @i{track} the value of
4079 this property with a tag for better visibility, customize the variable
4080 @code{org-track-ordered-property-with-tag}.
4081 @orgkey{C-u C-u C-u C-c C-t}
4082 Change TODO state, circumventing any state blocking.
4083 @end table
4084
4085 @vindex org-agenda-dim-blocked-tasks
4086 If you set the variable @code{org-agenda-dim-blocked-tasks}, TODO entries
4087 that cannot be closed because of such dependencies will be shown in a dimmed
4088 font or even made invisible in agenda views (@pxref{Agenda Views}).
4089
4090 @cindex checkboxes and TODO dependencies
4091 @vindex org-enforce-todo-dependencies
4092 You can also block changes of TODO states by looking at checkboxes
4093 (@pxref{Checkboxes}). If you set the variable
4094 @code{org-enforce-todo-checkbox-dependencies}, an entry that has unchecked
4095 checkboxes will be blocked from switching to DONE.
4096
4097 If you need more complex dependency structures, for example dependencies
4098 between entries in different trees or files, check out the contributed
4099 module @file{org-depend.el}.
4100
4101 @page
4102 @node Progress logging, Priorities, TODO extensions, TODO Items
4103 @section Progress logging
4104 @cindex progress logging
4105 @cindex logging, of progress
4106
4107 Org mode can automatically record a timestamp and possibly a note when
4108 you mark a TODO item as DONE, or even each time you change the state of
4109 a TODO item. This system is highly configurable, settings can be on a
4110 per-keyword basis and can be localized to a file or even a subtree. For
4111 information on how to clock working time for a task, see @ref{Clocking
4112 work time}.
4113
4114 @menu
4115 * Closing items:: When was this entry marked DONE?
4116 * Tracking TODO state changes:: When did the status change?
4117 * Tracking your habits:: How consistent have you been?
4118 @end menu
4119
4120 @node Closing items, Tracking TODO state changes, Progress logging, Progress logging
4121 @subsection Closing items
4122
4123 The most basic logging is to keep track of @emph{when} a certain TODO
4124 item was finished. This is achieved with@footnote{The corresponding
4125 in-buffer setting is: @code{#+STARTUP: logdone}}
4126
4127 @lisp
4128 (setq org-log-done 'time)
4129 @end lisp
4130
4131 @noindent
4132 Then each time you turn an entry from a TODO (not-done) state into any
4133 of the DONE states, a line @samp{CLOSED: [timestamp]} will be inserted
4134 just after the headline. If you turn the entry back into a TODO item
4135 through further state cycling, that line will be removed again. If you
4136 want to record a note along with the timestamp, use@footnote{The
4137 corresponding in-buffer setting is: @code{#+STARTUP: lognotedone}}
4138
4139 @lisp
4140 (setq org-log-done 'note)
4141 @end lisp
4142
4143 @noindent
4144 You will then be prompted for a note, and that note will be stored below
4145 the entry with a @samp{Closing Note} heading.
4146
4147 In the timeline (@pxref{Timeline}) and in the agenda
4148 (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}), you can then use the @kbd{l} key to
4149 display the TODO items with a @samp{CLOSED} timestamp on each day,
4150 giving you an overview of what has been done.
4151
4152 @node Tracking TODO state changes, Tracking your habits, Closing items, Progress logging
4153 @subsection Tracking TODO state changes
4154 @cindex drawer, for state change recording
4155
4156 @vindex org-log-states-order-reversed
4157 @vindex org-log-into-drawer
4158 @cindex property, LOG_INTO_DRAWER
4159 When TODO keywords are used as workflow states (@pxref{Workflow states}), you
4160 might want to keep track of when a state change occurred and maybe take a
4161 note about this change. You can either record just a timestamp, or a
4162 time-stamped note for a change. These records will be inserted after the
4163 headline as an itemized list, newest first@footnote{See the variable
4164 @code{org-log-states-order-reversed}}. When taking a lot of notes, you might
4165 want to get the notes out of the way into a drawer (@pxref{Drawers}).
4166 Customize the variable @code{org-log-into-drawer} to get this behavior---the
4167 recommended drawer for this is called @code{LOGBOOK}@footnote{Note that the
4168 @code{LOGBOOK} drawer is unfolded when pressing @key{SPC} in the agenda to
4169 show an entry---use @key{C-u SPC} to keep it folded here}. You can also
4170 overrule the setting of this variable for a subtree by setting a
4171 @code{LOG_INTO_DRAWER} property.
4172
4173 Since it is normally too much to record a note for every state, Org mode
4174 expects configuration on a per-keyword basis for this. This is achieved by
4175 adding special markers @samp{!} (for a timestamp) or @samp{@@} (for a note
4176 with timestamp) in parentheses after each keyword. For example, with the
4177 setting
4178
4179 @lisp
4180 (setq org-todo-keywords
4181 '((sequence "TODO(t)" "WAIT(w@@/!)" "|" "DONE(d!)" "CANCELED(c@@)")))
4182 @end lisp
4183
4184 To record a timestamp without a note for TODO keywords configured with
4185 @samp{@@}, just type @kbd{C-c C-c} to enter a blank note when prompted.
4186
4187 @noindent
4188 @vindex org-log-done
4189 you not only define global TODO keywords and fast access keys, but also
4190 request that a time is recorded when the entry is set to
4191 DONE@footnote{It is possible that Org mode will record two timestamps
4192 when you are using both @code{org-log-done} and state change logging.
4193 However, it will never prompt for two notes---if you have configured
4194 both, the state change recording note will take precedence and cancel
4195 the @samp{Closing Note}.}, and that a note is recorded when switching to
4196 WAIT or CANCELED@. The setting for WAIT is even more special: the
4197 @samp{!} after the slash means that in addition to the note taken when
4198 entering the state, a timestamp should be recorded when @i{leaving} the
4199 WAIT state, if and only if the @i{target} state does not configure
4200 logging for entering it. So it has no effect when switching from WAIT
4201 to DONE, because DONE is configured to record a timestamp only. But
4202 when switching from WAIT back to TODO, the @samp{/!} in the WAIT
4203 setting now triggers a timestamp even though TODO has no logging
4204 configured.
4205
4206 You can use the exact same syntax for setting logging preferences local
4207 to a buffer:
4208 @example
4209 #+TODO: TODO(t) WAIT(w@@/!) | DONE(d!) CANCELED(c@@)
4210 @end example
4211
4212 @cindex property, LOGGING
4213 In order to define logging settings that are local to a subtree or a
4214 single item, define a LOGGING property in this entry. Any non-empty
4215 LOGGING property resets all logging settings to nil. You may then turn
4216 on logging for this specific tree using STARTUP keywords like
4217 @code{lognotedone} or @code{logrepeat}, as well as adding state specific
4218 settings like @code{TODO(!)}. For example
4219
4220 @example
4221 * TODO Log each state with only a time
4222 :PROPERTIES:
4223 :LOGGING: TODO(!) WAIT(!) DONE(!) CANCELED(!)
4224 :END:
4225 * TODO Only log when switching to WAIT, and when repeating
4226 :PROPERTIES:
4227 :LOGGING: WAIT(@@) logrepeat
4228 :END:
4229 * TODO No logging at all
4230 :PROPERTIES:
4231 :LOGGING: nil
4232 :END:
4233 @end example
4234
4235 @node Tracking your habits, , Tracking TODO state changes, Progress logging
4236 @subsection Tracking your habits
4237 @cindex habits
4238
4239 Org has the ability to track the consistency of a special category of TODOs,
4240 called ``habits''. A habit has the following properties:
4241
4242 @enumerate
4243 @item
4244 You have enabled the @code{habits} module by customizing the variable
4245 @code{org-modules}.
4246 @item
4247 The habit is a TODO item, with a TODO keyword representing an open state.
4248 @item
4249 The property @code{STYLE} is set to the value @code{habit}.
4250 @item
4251 The TODO has a scheduled date, usually with a @code{.+} style repeat
4252 interval. A @code{++} style may be appropriate for habits with time
4253 constraints, e.g., must be done on weekends, or a @code{+} style for an
4254 unusual habit that can have a backlog, e.g., weekly reports.
4255 @item
4256 The TODO may also have minimum and maximum ranges specified by using the
4257 syntax @samp{.+2d/3d}, which says that you want to do the task at least every
4258 three days, but at most every two days.
4259 @item
4260 You must also have state logging for the @code{DONE} state enabled
4261 (@pxref{Tracking TODO state changes}), in order for historical data to be
4262 represented in the consistency graph. If it is not enabled it is not an
4263 error, but the consistency graphs will be largely meaningless.
4264 @end enumerate
4265
4266 To give you an idea of what the above rules look like in action, here's an
4267 actual habit with some history:
4268
4269 @example
4270 ** TODO Shave
4271 SCHEDULED: <2009-10-17 Sat .+2d/4d>
4272 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-10-15 Thu]
4273 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-10-12 Mon]
4274 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-10-10 Sat]
4275 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-10-04 Sun]
4276 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-10-02 Fri]
4277 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-09-29 Tue]
4278 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-09-25 Fri]
4279 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-09-19 Sat]
4280 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-09-16 Wed]
4281 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-09-12 Sat]
4282 :PROPERTIES:
4283 :STYLE: habit
4284 :LAST_REPEAT: [2009-10-19 Mon 00:36]
4285 :END:
4286 @end example
4287
4288 What this habit says is: I want to shave at most every 2 days (given by the
4289 @code{SCHEDULED} date and repeat interval) and at least every 4 days. If
4290 today is the 15th, then the habit first appears in the agenda on Oct 17,
4291 after the minimum of 2 days has elapsed, and will appear overdue on Oct 19,
4292 after four days have elapsed.
4293
4294 What's really useful about habits is that they are displayed along with a
4295 consistency graph, to show how consistent you've been at getting that task
4296 done in the past. This graph shows every day that the task was done over the
4297 past three weeks, with colors for each day. The colors used are:
4298
4299 @table @code
4300 @item Blue
4301 If the task wasn't to be done yet on that day.
4302 @item Green
4303 If the task could have been done on that day.
4304 @item Yellow
4305 If the task was going to be overdue the next day.
4306 @item Red
4307 If the task was overdue on that day.
4308 @end table
4309
4310 In addition to coloring each day, the day is also marked with an asterisk if
4311 the task was actually done that day, and an exclamation mark to show where
4312 the current day falls in the graph.
4313
4314 There are several configuration variables that can be used to change the way
4315 habits are displayed in the agenda.
4316
4317 @table @code
4318 @item org-habit-graph-column
4319 The buffer column at which the consistency graph should be drawn. This will
4320 overwrite any text in that column, so it is a good idea to keep your habits'
4321 titles brief and to the point.
4322 @item org-habit-preceding-days
4323 The amount of history, in days before today, to appear in consistency graphs.
4324 @item org-habit-following-days
4325 The number of days after today that will appear in consistency graphs.
4326 @item org-habit-show-habits-only-for-today
4327 If non-nil, only show habits in today's agenda view. This is set to true by
4328 default.
4329 @end table
4330
4331 Lastly, pressing @kbd{K} in the agenda buffer will cause habits to
4332 temporarily be disabled and they won't appear at all. Press @kbd{K} again to
4333 bring them back. They are also subject to tag filtering, if you have habits
4334 which should only be done in certain contexts, for example.
4335
4336 @node Priorities, Breaking down tasks, Progress logging, TODO Items
4337 @section Priorities
4338 @cindex priorities
4339
4340 If you use Org mode extensively, you may end up with enough TODO items that
4341 it starts to make sense to prioritize them. Prioritizing can be done by
4342 placing a @emph{priority cookie} into the headline of a TODO item, like this
4343
4344 @example
4345 *** TODO [#A] Write letter to Sam Fortune
4346 @end example
4347
4348 @noindent
4349 @vindex org-priority-faces
4350 By default, Org mode supports three priorities: @samp{A}, @samp{B}, and
4351 @samp{C}. @samp{A} is the highest priority. An entry without a cookie is
4352 treated just like priority @samp{B}. Priorities make a difference only for
4353 sorting in the agenda (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}); outside the agenda, they
4354 have no inherent meaning to Org mode. The cookies can be highlighted with
4355 special faces by customizing the variable @code{org-priority-faces}.
4356
4357 Priorities can be attached to any outline node; they do not need to be TODO
4358 items.
4359
4360 @table @kbd
4361 @item @kbd{C-c ,}
4362 @kindex @kbd{C-c ,}
4363 @findex org-priority
4364 Set the priority of the current headline (@command{org-priority}). The
4365 command prompts for a priority character @samp{A}, @samp{B} or @samp{C}.
4366 When you press @key{SPC} instead, the priority cookie is removed from the
4367 headline. The priorities can also be changed ``remotely'' from the timeline
4368 and agenda buffer with the @kbd{,} command (@pxref{Agenda commands}).
4369 @c
4370 @orgcmdkkcc{S-@key{up},S-@key{down},org-priority-up,org-priority-down}
4371 @vindex org-priority-start-cycle-with-default
4372 Increase/decrease priority of current headline@footnote{See also the option
4373 @code{org-priority-start-cycle-with-default}.}. Note that these keys are
4374 also used to modify timestamps (@pxref{Creating timestamps}). See also
4375 @ref{Conflicts}, for a discussion of the interaction with
4376 @code{shift-selection-mode}.
4377 @end table
4378
4379 @vindex org-highest-priority
4380 @vindex org-lowest-priority
4381 @vindex org-default-priority
4382 You can change the range of allowed priorities by setting the variables
4383 @code{org-highest-priority}, @code{org-lowest-priority}, and
4384 @code{org-default-priority}. For an individual buffer, you may set
4385 these values (highest, lowest, default) like this (please make sure that
4386 the highest priority is earlier in the alphabet than the lowest
4387 priority):
4388
4389 @cindex #+PRIORITIES
4390 @example
4391 #+PRIORITIES: A C B
4392 @end example
4393
4394 @node Breaking down tasks, Checkboxes, Priorities, TODO Items
4395 @section Breaking tasks down into subtasks
4396 @cindex tasks, breaking down
4397 @cindex statistics, for TODO items
4398
4399 @vindex org-agenda-todo-list-sublevels
4400 It is often advisable to break down large tasks into smaller, manageable
4401 subtasks. You can do this by creating an outline tree below a TODO item,
4402 with detailed subtasks on the tree@footnote{To keep subtasks out of the
4403 global TODO list, see the @code{org-agenda-todo-list-sublevels}.}. To keep
4404 the overview over the fraction of subtasks that are already completed, insert
4405 either @samp{[/]} or @samp{[%]} anywhere in the headline. These cookies will
4406 be updated each time the TODO status of a child changes, or when pressing
4407 @kbd{C-c C-c} on the cookie. For example:
4408
4409 @example
4410 * Organize Party [33%]
4411 ** TODO Call people [1/2]
4412 *** TODO Peter
4413 *** DONE Sarah
4414 ** TODO Buy food
4415 ** DONE Talk to neighbor
4416 @end example
4417
4418 @cindex property, COOKIE_DATA
4419 If a heading has both checkboxes and TODO children below it, the meaning of
4420 the statistics cookie become ambiguous. Set the property
4421 @code{COOKIE_DATA} to either @samp{checkbox} or @samp{todo} to resolve
4422 this issue.
4423
4424 @vindex org-hierarchical-todo-statistics
4425 If you would like to have the statistics cookie count any TODO entries in the
4426 subtree (not just direct children), configure the variable
4427 @code{org-hierarchical-todo-statistics}. To do this for a single subtree,
4428 include the word @samp{recursive} into the value of the @code{COOKIE_DATA}
4429 property.
4430
4431 @example
4432 * Parent capturing statistics [2/20]
4433 :PROPERTIES:
4434 :COOKIE_DATA: todo recursive
4435 :END:
4436 @end example
4437
4438 If you would like a TODO entry to automatically change to DONE
4439 when all children are done, you can use the following setup:
4440
4441 @example
4442 (defun org-summary-todo (n-done n-not-done)
4443 "Switch entry to DONE when all subentries are done, to TODO otherwise."
4444 (let (org-log-done org-log-states) ; turn off logging
4445 (org-todo (if (= n-not-done 0) "DONE" "TODO"))))
4446
4447 (add-hook 'org-after-todo-statistics-hook 'org-summary-todo)
4448 @end example
4449
4450
4451 Another possibility is the use of checkboxes to identify (a hierarchy of) a
4452 large number of subtasks (@pxref{Checkboxes}).
4453
4454
4455 @node Checkboxes, , Breaking down tasks, TODO Items
4456 @section Checkboxes
4457 @cindex checkboxes
4458
4459 @vindex org-list-automatic-rules
4460 Every item in a plain list@footnote{With the exception of description
4461 lists. But you can allow it by modifying @code{org-list-automatic-rules}
4462 accordingly.} (@pxref{Plain lists}) can be made into a checkbox by starting
4463 it with the string @samp{[ ]}. This feature is similar to TODO items
4464 (@pxref{TODO Items}), but is more lightweight. Checkboxes are not included
4465 into the global TODO list, so they are often great to split a task into a
4466 number of simple steps. Or you can use them in a shopping list. To toggle a
4467 checkbox, use @kbd{C-c C-c}, or use the mouse (thanks to Piotr Zielinski's
4468 @file{org-mouse.el}).
4469
4470 Here is an example of a checkbox list.
4471
4472 @example
4473 * TODO Organize party [2/4]
4474 - [-] call people [1/3]
4475 - [ ] Peter
4476 - [X] Sarah
4477 - [ ] Sam
4478 - [X] order food
4479 - [ ] think about what music to play
4480 - [X] talk to the neighbors
4481 @end example
4482
4483 Checkboxes work hierarchically, so if a checkbox item has children that
4484 are checkboxes, toggling one of the children checkboxes will make the
4485 parent checkbox reflect if none, some, or all of the children are
4486 checked.
4487
4488 @cindex statistics, for checkboxes
4489 @cindex checkbox statistics
4490 @cindex property, COOKIE_DATA
4491 @vindex org-hierarchical-checkbox-statistics
4492 The @samp{[2/4]} and @samp{[1/3]} in the first and second line are cookies
4493 indicating how many checkboxes present in this entry have been checked off,
4494 and the total number of checkboxes present. This can give you an idea on how
4495 many checkboxes remain, even without opening a folded entry. The cookies can
4496 be placed into a headline or into (the first line of) a plain list item.
4497 Each cookie covers checkboxes of direct children structurally below the
4498 headline/item on which the cookie appears@footnote{Set the variable
4499 @code{org-hierarchical-checkbox-statistics} if you want such cookies to
4500 count all checkboxes below the cookie, not just those belonging to direct
4501 children.}. You have to insert the cookie yourself by typing either
4502 @samp{[/]} or @samp{[%]}. With @samp{[/]} you get an @samp{n out of m}
4503 result, as in the examples above. With @samp{[%]} you get information about
4504 the percentage of checkboxes checked (in the above example, this would be
4505 @samp{[50%]} and @samp{[33%]}, respectively). In a headline, a cookie can
4506 count either checkboxes below the heading or TODO states of children, and it
4507 will display whatever was changed last. Set the property @code{COOKIE_DATA}
4508 to either @samp{checkbox} or @samp{todo} to resolve this issue.
4509
4510 @cindex blocking, of checkboxes
4511 @cindex checkbox blocking
4512 @cindex property, ORDERED
4513 If the current outline node has an @code{ORDERED} property, checkboxes must
4514 be checked off in sequence, and an error will be thrown if you try to check
4515 off a box while there are unchecked boxes above it.
4516
4517 @noindent The following commands work with checkboxes:
4518
4519 @table @kbd
4520 @orgcmd{C-c C-c,org-toggle-checkbox}
4521 Toggle checkbox status or (with prefix arg) checkbox presence at point.
4522 With a single prefix argument, add an empty checkbox or remove the current
4523 one@footnote{`C-u C-c C-c' on the @emph{first} item of a list with no checkbox
4524 will add checkboxes to the rest of the list.}. With a double prefix argument, set it to @samp{[-]}, which is
4525 considered to be an intermediate state.
4526 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-b,org-toggle-checkbox}
4527 Toggle checkbox status or (with prefix arg) checkbox presence at point. With
4528 double prefix argument, set it to @samp{[-]}, which is considered to be an
4529 intermediate state.
4530 @itemize @minus
4531 @item
4532 If there is an active region, toggle the first checkbox in the region
4533 and set all remaining boxes to the same status as the first. With a prefix
4534 arg, add or remove the checkbox for all items in the region.
4535 @item
4536 If the cursor is in a headline, toggle checkboxes in the region between
4537 this headline and the next (so @emph{not} the entire subtree).
4538 @item
4539 If there is no active region, just toggle the checkbox at point.
4540 @end itemize
4541 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{RET},org-insert-todo-heading}
4542 Insert a new item with a checkbox. This works only if the cursor is already
4543 in a plain list item (@pxref{Plain lists}).
4544 @orgcmd{C-c C-x o,org-toggle-ordered-property}
4545 @vindex org-track-ordered-property-with-tag
4546 @cindex property, ORDERED
4547 Toggle the @code{ORDERED} property of the entry, to toggle if checkboxes must
4548 be checked off in sequence. A property is used for this behavior because
4549 this should be local to the current entry, not inherited like a tag.
4550 However, if you would like to @i{track} the value of this property with a tag
4551 for better visibility, customize the variable
4552 @code{org-track-ordered-property-with-tag}.
4553 @orgcmd{C-c #,org-update-statistics-cookies}
4554 Update the statistics cookie in the current outline entry. When called with
4555 a @kbd{C-u} prefix, update the entire file. Checkbox statistic cookies are
4556 updated automatically if you toggle checkboxes with @kbd{C-c C-c} and make
4557 new ones with @kbd{M-S-@key{RET}}. TODO statistics cookies update when
4558 changing TODO states. If you delete boxes/entries or add/change them by
4559 hand, use this command to get things back into sync.
4560 @end table
4561
4562 @node Tags, Properties and Columns, TODO Items, Top
4563 @chapter Tags
4564 @cindex tags
4565 @cindex headline tagging
4566 @cindex matching, tags
4567 @cindex sparse tree, tag based
4568
4569 An excellent way to implement labels and contexts for cross-correlating
4570 information is to assign @i{tags} to headlines. Org mode has extensive
4571 support for tags.
4572
4573 @vindex org-tag-faces
4574 Every headline can contain a list of tags; they occur at the end of the
4575 headline. Tags are normal words containing letters, numbers, @samp{_}, and
4576 @samp{@@}. Tags must be preceded and followed by a single colon, e.g.,
4577 @samp{:work:}. Several tags can be specified, as in @samp{:work:urgent:}.
4578 Tags will by default be in bold face with the same color as the headline.
4579 You may specify special faces for specific tags using the variable
4580 @code{org-tag-faces}, in much the same way as you can for TODO keywords
4581 (@pxref{Faces for TODO keywords}).
4582
4583 @menu
4584 * Tag inheritance:: Tags use the tree structure of the outline
4585 * Setting tags:: How to assign tags to a headline
4586 * Tag searches:: Searching for combinations of tags
4587 @end menu
4588
4589 @node Tag inheritance, Setting tags, Tags, Tags
4590 @section Tag inheritance
4591 @cindex tag inheritance
4592 @cindex inheritance, of tags
4593 @cindex sublevels, inclusion into tags match
4594
4595 @i{Tags} make use of the hierarchical structure of outline trees. If a
4596 heading has a certain tag, all subheadings will inherit the tag as
4597 well. For example, in the list
4598
4599 @example
4600 * Meeting with the French group :work:
4601 ** Summary by Frank :boss:notes:
4602 *** TODO Prepare slides for him :action:
4603 @end example
4604
4605 @noindent
4606 the final heading will have the tags @samp{:work:}, @samp{:boss:},
4607 @samp{:notes:}, and @samp{:action:} even though the final heading is not
4608 explicitly marked with those tags. You can also set tags that all entries in
4609 a file should inherit just as if these tags were defined in a hypothetical
4610 level zero that surrounds the entire file. Use a line like this@footnote{As
4611 with all these in-buffer settings, pressing @kbd{C-c C-c} activates any
4612 changes in the line.}:
4613
4614 @cindex #+FILETAGS
4615 @example
4616 #+FILETAGS: :Peter:Boss:Secret:
4617 @end example
4618
4619 @noindent
4620 @vindex org-use-tag-inheritance
4621 @vindex org-tags-exclude-from-inheritance
4622 To limit tag inheritance to specific tags, or to turn it off entirely, use
4623 the variables @code{org-use-tag-inheritance} and
4624 @code{org-tags-exclude-from-inheritance}.
4625
4626 @vindex org-tags-match-list-sublevels
4627 When a headline matches during a tags search while tag inheritance is turned
4628 on, all the sublevels in the same tree will (for a simple match form) match
4629 as well@footnote{This is only true if the search does not involve more
4630 complex tests including properties (@pxref{Property searches}).}. The list
4631 of matches may then become very long. If you only want to see the first tags
4632 match in a subtree, configure the variable
4633 @code{org-tags-match-list-sublevels} (not recommended).
4634
4635 @node Setting tags, Tag searches, Tag inheritance, Tags
4636 @section Setting tags
4637 @cindex setting tags
4638 @cindex tags, setting
4639
4640 @kindex M-@key{TAB}
4641 Tags can simply be typed into the buffer at the end of a headline.
4642 After a colon, @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} offers completion on tags. There is
4643 also a special command for inserting tags:
4644
4645 @table @kbd
4646 @orgcmd{C-c C-q,org-set-tags-command}
4647 @cindex completion, of tags
4648 @vindex org-tags-column
4649 Enter new tags for the current headline. Org mode will either offer
4650 completion or a special single-key interface for setting tags, see
4651 below. After pressing @key{RET}, the tags will be inserted and aligned
4652 to @code{org-tags-column}. When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix, all
4653 tags in the current buffer will be aligned to that column, just to make
4654 things look nice. TAGS are automatically realigned after promotion,
4655 demotion, and TODO state changes (@pxref{TODO basics}).
4656 @orgcmd{C-c C-c,org-set-tags-command}
4657 When the cursor is in a headline, this does the same as @kbd{C-c C-q}.
4658 @end table
4659
4660 @vindex org-tag-alist
4661 Org supports tag insertion based on a @emph{list of tags}. By
4662 default this list is constructed dynamically, containing all tags
4663 currently used in the buffer. You may also globally specify a hard list
4664 of tags with the variable @code{org-tag-alist}. Finally you can set
4665 the default tags for a given file with lines like
4666
4667 @cindex #+TAGS
4668 @example
4669 #+TAGS: @@work @@home @@tennisclub
4670 #+TAGS: laptop car pc sailboat
4671 @end example
4672
4673 If you have globally defined your preferred set of tags using the
4674 variable @code{org-tag-alist}, but would like to use a dynamic tag list
4675 in a specific file, add an empty TAGS option line to that file:
4676
4677 @example
4678 #+TAGS:
4679 @end example
4680
4681 @vindex org-tag-persistent-alist
4682 If you have a preferred set of tags that you would like to use in every file,
4683 in addition to those defined on a per-file basis by TAGS option lines, then
4684 you may specify a list of tags with the variable
4685 @code{org-tag-persistent-alist}. You may turn this off on a per-file basis
4686 by adding a STARTUP option line to that file:
4687
4688 @example
4689 #+STARTUP: noptag
4690 @end example
4691
4692 By default Org mode uses the standard minibuffer completion facilities for
4693 entering tags. However, it also implements another, quicker, tag selection
4694 method called @emph{fast tag selection}. This allows you to select and
4695 deselect tags with just a single key press. For this to work well you should
4696 assign unique letters to most of your commonly used tags. You can do this
4697 globally by configuring the variable @code{org-tag-alist} in your
4698 @file{.emacs} file. For example, you may find the need to tag many items in
4699 different files with @samp{:@@home:}. In this case you can set something
4700 like:
4701
4702 @lisp
4703 (setq org-tag-alist '(("@@work" . ?w) ("@@home" . ?h) ("laptop" . ?l)))
4704 @end lisp
4705
4706 @noindent If the tag is only relevant to the file you are working on, then you
4707 can instead set the TAGS option line as:
4708
4709 @example
4710 #+TAGS: @@work(w) @@home(h) @@tennisclub(t) laptop(l) pc(p)
4711 @end example
4712
4713 @noindent The tags interface will show the available tags in a splash
4714 window. If you want to start a new line after a specific tag, insert
4715 @samp{\n} into the tag list
4716
4717 @example
4718 #+TAGS: @@work(w) @@home(h) @@tennisclub(t) \n laptop(l) pc(p)
4719 @end example
4720
4721 @noindent or write them in two lines:
4722
4723 @example
4724 #+TAGS: @@work(w) @@home(h) @@tennisclub(t)
4725 #+TAGS: laptop(l) pc(p)
4726 @end example
4727
4728 @noindent
4729 You can also group together tags that are mutually exclusive by using
4730 braces, as in:
4731
4732 @example
4733 #+TAGS: @{ @@work(w) @@home(h) @@tennisclub(t) @} laptop(l) pc(p)
4734 @end example
4735
4736 @noindent you indicate that at most one of @samp{@@work}, @samp{@@home},
4737 and @samp{@@tennisclub} should be selected. Multiple such groups are allowed.
4738
4739 @noindent Don't forget to press @kbd{C-c C-c} with the cursor in one of
4740 these lines to activate any changes.
4741
4742 @noindent
4743 To set these mutually exclusive groups in the variable @code{org-tags-alist},
4744 you must use the dummy tags @code{:startgroup} and @code{:endgroup} instead
4745 of the braces. Similarly, you can use @code{:newline} to indicate a line
4746 break. The previous example would be set globally by the following
4747 configuration:
4748
4749 @lisp
4750 (setq org-tag-alist '((:startgroup . nil)
4751 ("@@work" . ?w) ("@@home" . ?h)
4752 ("@@tennisclub" . ?t)
4753 (:endgroup . nil)
4754 ("laptop" . ?l) ("pc" . ?p)))
4755 @end lisp
4756
4757 If at least one tag has a selection key then pressing @kbd{C-c C-c} will
4758 automatically present you with a special interface, listing inherited tags,
4759 the tags of the current headline, and a list of all valid tags with
4760 corresponding keys@footnote{Keys will automatically be assigned to tags which
4761 have no configured keys.}. In this interface, you can use the following
4762 keys:
4763
4764 @table @kbd
4765 @item a-z...
4766 Pressing keys assigned to tags will add or remove them from the list of
4767 tags in the current line. Selecting a tag in a group of mutually
4768 exclusive tags will turn off any other tags from that group.
4769 @kindex @key{TAB}
4770 @item @key{TAB}
4771 Enter a tag in the minibuffer, even if the tag is not in the predefined
4772 list. You will be able to complete on all tags present in the buffer.
4773 You can also add several tags: just separate them with a comma.
4774
4775 @kindex @key{SPC}
4776 @item @key{SPC}
4777 Clear all tags for this line.
4778 @kindex @key{RET}
4779 @item @key{RET}
4780 Accept the modified set.
4781 @item C-g
4782 Abort without installing changes.
4783 @item q
4784 If @kbd{q} is not assigned to a tag, it aborts like @kbd{C-g}.
4785 @item !
4786 Turn off groups of mutually exclusive tags. Use this to (as an
4787 exception) assign several tags from such a group.
4788 @item C-c
4789 Toggle auto-exit after the next change (see below).
4790 If you are using expert mode, the first @kbd{C-c} will display the
4791 selection window.
4792 @end table
4793
4794 @noindent
4795 This method lets you assign tags to a headline with very few keys. With
4796 the above setup, you could clear the current tags and set @samp{@@home},
4797 @samp{laptop} and @samp{pc} tags with just the following keys: @kbd{C-c
4798 C-c @key{SPC} h l p @key{RET}}. Switching from @samp{@@home} to
4799 @samp{@@work} would be done with @kbd{C-c C-c w @key{RET}} or
4800 alternatively with @kbd{C-c C-c C-c w}. Adding the non-predefined tag
4801 @samp{Sarah} could be done with @kbd{C-c C-c @key{TAB} S a r a h
4802 @key{RET} @key{RET}}.
4803
4804 @vindex org-fast-tag-selection-single-key
4805 If you find that most of the time you need only a single key press to
4806 modify your list of tags, set the variable
4807 @code{org-fast-tag-selection-single-key}. Then you no longer have to
4808 press @key{RET} to exit fast tag selection---it will immediately exit
4809 after the first change. If you then occasionally need more keys, press
4810 @kbd{C-c} to turn off auto-exit for the current tag selection process
4811 (in effect: start selection with @kbd{C-c C-c C-c} instead of @kbd{C-c
4812 C-c}). If you set the variable to the value @code{expert}, the special
4813 window is not even shown for single-key tag selection, it comes up only
4814 when you press an extra @kbd{C-c}.
4815
4816 @node Tag searches, , Setting tags, Tags
4817 @section Tag searches
4818 @cindex tag searches
4819 @cindex searching for tags
4820
4821 Once a system of tags has been set up, it can be used to collect related
4822 information into special lists.
4823
4824 @table @kbd
4825 @orgcmdkkc{C-c / m,C-c \\,org-match-sparse-tree}
4826 Create a sparse tree with all headlines matching a tags search. With a
4827 @kbd{C-u} prefix argument, ignore headlines that are not a TODO line.
4828 @orgcmd{C-c a m,org-tags-view}
4829 Create a global list of tag matches from all agenda files.
4830 @xref{Matching tags and properties}.
4831 @orgcmd{C-c a M,org-tags-view}
4832 @vindex org-tags-match-list-sublevels
4833 Create a global list of tag matches from all agenda files, but check
4834 only TODO items and force checking subitems (see variable
4835 @code{org-tags-match-list-sublevels}).
4836 @end table
4837
4838 These commands all prompt for a match string which allows basic Boolean logic
4839 like @samp{+boss+urgent-project1}, to find entries with tags @samp{boss} and
4840 @samp{urgent}, but not @samp{project1}, or @samp{Kathy|Sally} to find entries
4841 which are tagged, like @samp{Kathy} or @samp{Sally}. The full syntax of the search
4842 string is rich and allows also matching against TODO keywords, entry levels
4843 and properties. For a complete description with many examples, see
4844 @ref{Matching tags and properties}.
4845
4846
4847 @node Properties and Columns, Dates and Times, Tags, Top
4848 @chapter Properties and columns
4849 @cindex properties
4850
4851 A property is a key-value pair associated with an entry. Properties can be
4852 set so they are associated with a single entry, with every entry in a tree,
4853 or with every entry in an Org mode file.
4854
4855 There are two main applications for properties in Org mode. First,
4856 properties are like tags, but with a value. Imagine maintaining a file where
4857 you document bugs and plan releases for a piece of software. Instead of
4858 using tags like @code{:release_1:}, @code{:release_2:}, you can use a
4859 property, say @code{:Release:}, that in different subtrees has different
4860 values, such as @code{1.0} or @code{2.0}. Second, you can use properties to
4861 implement (very basic) database capabilities in an Org buffer. Imagine
4862 keeping track of your music CDs, where properties could be things such as the
4863 album, artist, date of release, number of tracks, and so on.
4864
4865 Properties can be conveniently edited and viewed in column view
4866 (@pxref{Column view}).
4867
4868 @menu
4869 * Property syntax:: How properties are spelled out
4870 * Special properties:: Access to other Org mode features
4871 * Property searches:: Matching property values
4872 * Property inheritance:: Passing values down the tree
4873 * Column view:: Tabular viewing and editing
4874 * Property API:: Properties for Lisp programmers
4875 @end menu
4876
4877 @node Property syntax, Special properties, Properties and Columns, Properties and Columns
4878 @section Property syntax
4879 @cindex property syntax
4880 @cindex drawer, for properties
4881
4882 Properties are key-value pairs. When they are associated with a single entry
4883 or with a tree they need to be inserted into a special
4884 drawer (@pxref{Drawers}) with the name @code{PROPERTIES}. Each property
4885 is specified on a single line, with the key (surrounded by colons)
4886 first, and the value after it. Here is an example:
4887
4888 @example
4889 * CD collection
4890 ** Classic
4891 *** Goldberg Variations
4892 :PROPERTIES:
4893 :Title: Goldberg Variations
4894 :Composer: J.S. Bach
4895 :Artist: Glen Gould
4896 :Publisher: Deutsche Grammophon
4897 :NDisks: 1
4898 :END:
4899 @end example
4900
4901 Depending on the value of @code{org-use-property-inheritance}, a property set
4902 this way will either be associated with a single entry, or the sub-tree
4903 defined by the entry, see @ref{Property inheritance}.
4904
4905 You may define the allowed values for a particular property @samp{:Xyz:}
4906 by setting a property @samp{:Xyz_ALL:}. This special property is
4907 @emph{inherited}, so if you set it in a level 1 entry, it will apply to
4908 the entire tree. When allowed values are defined, setting the
4909 corresponding property becomes easier and is less prone to typing
4910 errors. For the example with the CD collection, we can predefine
4911 publishers and the number of disks in a box like this:
4912
4913 @example
4914 * CD collection
4915 :PROPERTIES:
4916 :NDisks_ALL: 1 2 3 4
4917 :Publisher_ALL: "Deutsche Grammophon" Philips EMI
4918 :END:
4919 @end example
4920
4921 If you want to set properties that can be inherited by any entry in a
4922 file, use a line like
4923 @cindex property, _ALL
4924 @cindex #+PROPERTY
4925 @example
4926 #+PROPERTY: NDisks_ALL 1 2 3 4
4927 @end example
4928
4929 If you want to add to the value of an existing property, append a @code{+} to
4930 the property name. The following results in the property @code{var} having
4931 the value ``foo=1 bar=2''.
4932 @cindex property, +
4933 @example
4934 #+PROPERTY: var foo=1
4935 #+PROPERTY: var+ bar=2
4936 @end example
4937
4938 It is also possible to add to the values of inherited properties. The
4939 following results in the @code{genres} property having the value ``Classic
4940 Baroque'' under the @code{Goldberg Variations} subtree.
4941 @cindex property, +
4942 @example
4943 * CD collection
4944 ** Classic
4945 :PROPERTIES:
4946 :GENRES: Classic
4947 :END:
4948 *** Goldberg Variations
4949 :PROPERTIES:
4950 :Title: Goldberg Variations
4951 :Composer: J.S. Bach
4952 :Artist: Glen Gould
4953 :Publisher: Deutsche Grammophon
4954 :NDisks: 1
4955 :GENRES+: Baroque
4956 :END:
4957 @end example
4958 Note that a property can only have one entry per Drawer.
4959
4960 @vindex org-global-properties
4961 Property values set with the global variable
4962 @code{org-global-properties} can be inherited by all entries in all
4963 Org files.
4964
4965 @noindent
4966 The following commands help to work with properties:
4967
4968 @table @kbd
4969 @orgcmd{M-@key{TAB},pcomplete}
4970 After an initial colon in a line, complete property keys. All keys used
4971 in the current file will be offered as possible completions.
4972 @orgcmd{C-c C-x p,org-set-property}
4973 Set a property. This prompts for a property name and a value. If
4974 necessary, the property drawer is created as well.
4975 @item C-u M-x org-insert-drawer
4976 @cindex org-insert-drawer
4977 Insert a property drawer into the current entry. The drawer will be
4978 inserted early in the entry, but after the lines with planning
4979 information like deadlines.
4980 @orgcmd{C-c C-c,org-property-action}
4981 With the cursor in a property drawer, this executes property commands.
4982 @orgcmd{C-c C-c s,org-set-property}
4983 Set a property in the current entry. Both the property and the value
4984 can be inserted using completion.
4985 @orgcmdkkcc{S-@key{right},S-@key{left},org-property-next-allowed-value,org-property-previous-allowed-value}
4986 Switch property at point to the next/previous allowed value.
4987 @orgcmd{C-c C-c d,org-delete-property}
4988 Remove a property from the current entry.
4989 @orgcmd{C-c C-c D,org-delete-property-globally}
4990 Globally remove a property, from all entries in the current file.
4991 @orgcmd{C-c C-c c,org-compute-property-at-point}
4992 Compute the property at point, using the operator and scope from the
4993 nearest column format definition.
4994 @end table
4995
4996 @node Special properties, Property searches, Property syntax, Properties and Columns
4997 @section Special properties
4998 @cindex properties, special
4999
5000 Special properties provide an alternative access method to Org mode features,
5001 like the TODO state or the priority of an entry, discussed in the previous
5002 chapters. This interface exists so that you can include these states in a
5003 column view (@pxref{Column view}), or to use them in queries. The following
5004 property names are special and (except for @code{:CATEGORY:}) should not be
5005 used as keys in the properties drawer:
5006
5007 @cindex property, special, ID
5008 @cindex property, special, TODO
5009 @cindex property, special, TAGS
5010 @cindex property, special, ALLTAGS
5011 @cindex property, special, CATEGORY
5012 @cindex property, special, PRIORITY
5013 @cindex property, special, DEADLINE
5014 @cindex property, special, SCHEDULED
5015 @cindex property, special, CLOSED
5016 @cindex property, special, TIMESTAMP
5017 @cindex property, special, TIMESTAMP_IA
5018 @cindex property, special, CLOCKSUM
5019 @cindex property, special, CLOCKSUM_T
5020 @cindex property, special, BLOCKED
5021 @c guessing that ITEM is needed in this area; also, should this list be sorted?
5022 @cindex property, special, ITEM
5023 @cindex property, special, FILE
5024 @example
5025 ID @r{A globally unique ID used for synchronization during}
5026 @r{iCalendar or MobileOrg export.}
5027 TODO @r{The TODO keyword of the entry.}
5028 TAGS @r{The tags defined directly in the headline.}
5029 ALLTAGS @r{All tags, including inherited ones.}
5030 CATEGORY @r{The category of an entry.}
5031 PRIORITY @r{The priority of the entry, a string with a single letter.}
5032 DEADLINE @r{The deadline time string, without the angular brackets.}
5033 SCHEDULED @r{The scheduling timestamp, without the angular brackets.}
5034 CLOSED @r{When was this entry closed?}
5035 TIMESTAMP @r{The first keyword-less timestamp in the entry.}
5036 TIMESTAMP_IA @r{The first inactive timestamp in the entry.}
5037 CLOCKSUM @r{The sum of CLOCK intervals in the subtree. @code{org-clock-sum}}
5038 @r{must be run first to compute the values in the current buffer.}
5039 CLOCKSUM_T @r{The sum of CLOCK intervals in the subtree for today.}
5040 @r{@code{org-clock-sum-today} must be run first to compute the}
5041 @r{values in the current buffer.}
5042 BLOCKED @r{"t" if task is currently blocked by children or siblings}
5043 ITEM @r{The headline of the entry.}
5044 FILE @r{The filename the entry is located in.}
5045 @end example
5046
5047 @node Property searches, Property inheritance, Special properties, Properties and Columns
5048 @section Property searches
5049 @cindex properties, searching
5050 @cindex searching, of properties
5051
5052 To create sparse trees and special lists with selection based on properties,
5053 the same commands are used as for tag searches (@pxref{Tag searches}).
5054 @table @kbd
5055 @orgcmdkkc{C-c / m,C-c \,org-match-sparse-tree}
5056 Create a sparse tree with all matching entries. With a
5057 @kbd{C-u} prefix argument, ignore headlines that are not a TODO line.
5058 @orgcmd{C-c a m,org-tags-view}
5059 Create a global list of tag/property matches from all agenda files.
5060 @xref{Matching tags and properties}.
5061 @orgcmd{C-c a M,org-tags-view}
5062 @vindex org-tags-match-list-sublevels
5063 Create a global list of tag matches from all agenda files, but check
5064 only TODO items and force checking of subitems (see variable
5065 @code{org-tags-match-list-sublevels}).
5066 @end table
5067
5068 The syntax for the search string is described in @ref{Matching tags and
5069 properties}.
5070
5071 There is also a special command for creating sparse trees based on a
5072 single property:
5073
5074 @table @kbd
5075 @orgkey{C-c / p}
5076 Create a sparse tree based on the value of a property. This first
5077 prompts for the name of a property, and then for a value. A sparse tree
5078 is created with all entries that define this property with the given
5079 value. If you enclose the value in curly braces, it is interpreted as
5080 a regular expression and matched against the property values.
5081 @end table
5082
5083 @node Property inheritance, Column view, Property searches, Properties and Columns
5084 @section Property Inheritance
5085 @cindex properties, inheritance
5086 @cindex inheritance, of properties
5087
5088 @vindex org-use-property-inheritance
5089 The outline structure of Org mode documents lends itself to an
5090 inheritance model of properties: if the parent in a tree has a certain
5091 property, the children can inherit this property. Org mode does not
5092 turn this on by default, because it can slow down property searches
5093 significantly and is often not needed. However, if you find inheritance
5094 useful, you can turn it on by setting the variable
5095 @code{org-use-property-inheritance}. It may be set to @code{t} to make
5096 all properties inherited from the parent, to a list of properties
5097 that should be inherited, or to a regular expression that matches
5098 inherited properties. If a property has the value @samp{nil}, this is
5099 interpreted as an explicit undefine of the property, so that inheritance
5100 search will stop at this value and return @code{nil}.
5101
5102 Org mode has a few properties for which inheritance is hard-coded, at
5103 least for the special applications for which they are used:
5104
5105 @cindex property, COLUMNS
5106 @table @code
5107 @item COLUMNS
5108 The @code{:COLUMNS:} property defines the format of column view
5109 (@pxref{Column view}). It is inherited in the sense that the level
5110 where a @code{:COLUMNS:} property is defined is used as the starting
5111 point for a column view table, independently of the location in the
5112 subtree from where columns view is turned on.
5113 @item CATEGORY
5114 @cindex property, CATEGORY
5115 For agenda view, a category set through a @code{:CATEGORY:} property
5116 applies to the entire subtree.
5117 @item ARCHIVE
5118 @cindex property, ARCHIVE
5119 For archiving, the @code{:ARCHIVE:} property may define the archive
5120 location for the entire subtree (@pxref{Moving subtrees}).
5121 @item LOGGING
5122 @cindex property, LOGGING
5123 The LOGGING property may define logging settings for an entry or a
5124 subtree (@pxref{Tracking TODO state changes}).
5125 @end table
5126
5127 @node Column view, Property API, Property inheritance, Properties and Columns
5128 @section Column view
5129
5130 A great way to view and edit properties in an outline tree is
5131 @emph{column view}. In column view, each outline node is turned into a
5132 table row. Columns in this table provide access to properties of the
5133 entries. Org mode implements columns by overlaying a tabular structure
5134 over the headline of each item. While the headlines have been turned
5135 into a table row, you can still change the visibility of the outline
5136 tree. For example, you get a compact table by switching to CONTENTS
5137 view (@kbd{S-@key{TAB} S-@key{TAB}}, or simply @kbd{c} while column view
5138 is active), but you can still open, read, and edit the entry below each
5139 headline. Or, you can switch to column view after executing a sparse
5140 tree command and in this way get a table only for the selected items.
5141 Column view also works in agenda buffers (@pxref{Agenda Views}) where
5142 queries have collected selected items, possibly from a number of files.
5143
5144 @menu
5145 * Defining columns:: The COLUMNS format property
5146 * Using column view:: How to create and use column view
5147 * Capturing column view:: A dynamic block for column view
5148 @end menu
5149
5150 @node Defining columns, Using column view, Column view, Column view
5151 @subsection Defining columns
5152 @cindex column view, for properties
5153 @cindex properties, column view
5154
5155 Setting up a column view first requires defining the columns. This is
5156 done by defining a column format line.
5157
5158 @menu
5159 * Scope of column definitions:: Where defined, where valid?
5160 * Column attributes:: Appearance and content of a column
5161 @end menu
5162
5163 @node Scope of column definitions, Column attributes, Defining columns, Defining columns
5164 @subsubsection Scope of column definitions
5165
5166 To define a column format for an entire file, use a line like
5167
5168 @cindex #+COLUMNS
5169 @example
5170 #+COLUMNS: %25ITEM %TAGS %PRIORITY %TODO
5171 @end example
5172
5173 To specify a format that only applies to a specific tree, add a
5174 @code{:COLUMNS:} property to the top node of that tree, for example:
5175
5176 @example
5177 ** Top node for columns view
5178 :PROPERTIES:
5179 :COLUMNS: %25ITEM %TAGS %PRIORITY %TODO
5180 :END:
5181 @end example
5182
5183 If a @code{:COLUMNS:} property is present in an entry, it defines columns
5184 for the entry itself, and for the entire subtree below it. Since the
5185 column definition is part of the hierarchical structure of the document,
5186 you can define columns on level 1 that are general enough for all
5187 sublevels, and more specific columns further down, when you edit a
5188 deeper part of the tree.
5189
5190 @node Column attributes, , Scope of column definitions, Defining columns
5191 @subsubsection Column attributes
5192 A column definition sets the attributes of a column. The general
5193 definition looks like this:
5194
5195 @example
5196 %[@var{width}]@var{property}[(@var{title})][@{@var{summary-type}@}]
5197 @end example
5198
5199 @noindent
5200 Except for the percent sign and the property name, all items are
5201 optional. The individual parts have the following meaning:
5202
5203 @example
5204 @var{width} @r{An integer specifying the width of the column in characters.}
5205 @r{If omitted, the width will be determined automatically.}
5206 @var{property} @r{The property that should be edited in this column.}
5207 @r{Special properties representing meta data are allowed here}
5208 @r{as well (@pxref{Special properties})}
5209 @var{title} @r{The header text for the column. If omitted, the property}
5210 @r{name is used.}
5211 @{@var{summary-type}@} @r{The summary type. If specified, the column values for}
5212 @r{parent nodes are computed from the children.}
5213 @r{Supported summary types are:}
5214 @{+@} @r{Sum numbers in this column.}
5215 @{+;%.1f@} @r{Like @samp{+}, but format result with @samp{%.1f}.}
5216 @{$@} @r{Currency, short for @samp{+;%.2f}.}
5217 @{:@} @r{Sum times, HH:MM, plain numbers are hours.}
5218 @{X@} @r{Checkbox status, @samp{[X]} if all children are @samp{[X]}.}
5219 @{X/@} @r{Checkbox status, @samp{[n/m]}.}
5220 @{X%@} @r{Checkbox status, @samp{[n%]}.}
5221 @{min@} @r{Smallest number in column.}
5222 @{max@} @r{Largest number.}
5223 @{mean@} @r{Arithmetic mean of numbers.}
5224 @{:min@} @r{Smallest time value in column.}
5225 @{:max@} @r{Largest time value.}
5226 @{:mean@} @r{Arithmetic mean of time values.}
5227 @{@@min@} @r{Minimum age (in days/hours/mins/seconds).}
5228 @{@@max@} @r{Maximum age (in days/hours/mins/seconds).}
5229 @{@@mean@} @r{Arithmetic mean of ages (in days/hours/mins/seconds).}
5230 @{est+@} @r{Add low-high estimates.}
5231 @end example
5232
5233 @noindent
5234 Be aware that you can only have one summary type for any property you
5235 include. Subsequent columns referencing the same property will all display the
5236 same summary information.
5237
5238 The @code{est+} summary type requires further explanation. It is used for
5239 combining estimates, expressed as low-high ranges. For example, instead
5240 of estimating a particular task will take 5 days, you might estimate it as
5241 5-6 days if you're fairly confident you know how much work is required, or
5242 1-10 days if you don't really know what needs to be done. Both ranges
5243 average at 5.5 days, but the first represents a more predictable delivery.
5244
5245 When combining a set of such estimates, simply adding the lows and highs
5246 produces an unrealistically wide result. Instead, @code{est+} adds the
5247 statistical mean and variance of the sub-tasks, generating a final estimate
5248 from the sum. For example, suppose you had ten tasks, each of which was
5249 estimated at 0.5 to 2 days of work. Straight addition produces an estimate
5250 of 5 to 20 days, representing what to expect if everything goes either
5251 extremely well or extremely poorly. In contrast, @code{est+} estimates the
5252 full job more realistically, at 10-15 days.
5253
5254 Here is an example for a complete columns definition, along with allowed
5255 values.
5256
5257 @example
5258 :COLUMNS: %25ITEM %9Approved(Approved?)@{X@} %Owner %11Status \@footnote{Please note that the COLUMNS definition must be on a single line---it is wrapped here only because of formatting constraints.}
5259 %10Time_Estimate@{:@} %CLOCKSUM %CLOCKSUM_T
5260 :Owner_ALL: Tammy Mark Karl Lisa Don
5261 :Status_ALL: "In progress" "Not started yet" "Finished" ""
5262 :Approved_ALL: "[ ]" "[X]"
5263 @end example
5264
5265 @noindent
5266 The first column, @samp{%25ITEM}, means the first 25 characters of the
5267 item itself, i.e., of the headline. You probably always should start the
5268 column definition with the @samp{ITEM} specifier. The other specifiers
5269 create columns @samp{Owner} with a list of names as allowed values, for
5270 @samp{Status} with four different possible values, and for a checkbox
5271 field @samp{Approved}. When no width is given after the @samp{%}
5272 character, the column will be exactly as wide as it needs to be in order
5273 to fully display all values. The @samp{Approved} column does have a
5274 modified title (@samp{Approved?}, with a question mark). Summaries will
5275 be created for the @samp{Time_Estimate} column by adding time duration
5276 expressions like HH:MM, and for the @samp{Approved} column, by providing
5277 an @samp{[X]} status if all children have been checked. The
5278 @samp{CLOCKSUM} and @samp{CLOCKSUM_T} columns are special, they lists the
5279 sums of CLOCK intervals in the subtree, either for all clocks or just for
5280 today.
5281
5282 @node Using column view, Capturing column view, Defining columns, Column view
5283 @subsection Using column view
5284
5285 @table @kbd
5286 @tsubheading{Turning column view on and off}
5287 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-c,org-columns}
5288 @vindex org-columns-default-format
5289 Turn on column view. If the cursor is before the first headline in the file,
5290 column view is turned on for the entire file, using the @code{#+COLUMNS}
5291 definition. If the cursor is somewhere inside the outline, this command
5292 searches the hierarchy, up from point, for a @code{:COLUMNS:} property that
5293 defines a format. When one is found, the column view table is established
5294 for the tree starting at the entry that contains the @code{:COLUMNS:}
5295 property. If no such property is found, the format is taken from the
5296 @code{#+COLUMNS} line or from the variable @code{org-columns-default-format},
5297 and column view is established for the current entry and its subtree.
5298 @orgcmd{r,org-columns-redo}
5299 Recreate the column view, to include recent changes made in the buffer.
5300 @orgcmd{g,org-columns-redo}
5301 Same as @kbd{r}.
5302 @orgcmd{q,org-columns-quit}
5303 Exit column view.
5304 @tsubheading{Editing values}
5305 @item @key{left} @key{right} @key{up} @key{down}
5306 Move through the column view from field to field.
5307 @kindex S-@key{left}
5308 @kindex S-@key{right}
5309 @item S-@key{left}/@key{right}
5310 Switch to the next/previous allowed value of the field. For this, you
5311 have to have specified allowed values for a property.
5312 @item 1..9,0
5313 Directly select the Nth allowed value, @kbd{0} selects the 10th value.
5314 @orgcmdkkcc{n,p,org-columns-next-allowed-value,org-columns-previous-allowed-value}
5315 Same as @kbd{S-@key{left}/@key{right}}
5316 @orgcmd{e,org-columns-edit-value}
5317 Edit the property at point. For the special properties, this will
5318 invoke the same interface that you normally use to change that
5319 property. For example, when editing a TAGS property, the tag completion
5320 or fast selection interface will pop up.
5321 @orgcmd{C-c C-c,org-columns-set-tags-or-toggle}
5322 When there is a checkbox at point, toggle it.
5323 @orgcmd{v,org-columns-show-value}
5324 View the full value of this property. This is useful if the width of
5325 the column is smaller than that of the value.
5326 @orgcmd{a,org-columns-edit-allowed}
5327 Edit the list of allowed values for this property. If the list is found
5328 in the hierarchy, the modified values is stored there. If no list is
5329 found, the new value is stored in the first entry that is part of the
5330 current column view.
5331 @tsubheading{Modifying the table structure}
5332 @orgcmdkkcc{<,>,org-columns-narrow,org-columns-widen}
5333 Make the column narrower/wider by one character.
5334 @orgcmd{S-M-@key{right},org-columns-new}
5335 Insert a new column, to the left of the current column.
5336 @orgcmd{S-M-@key{left},org-columns-delete}
5337 Delete the current column.
5338 @end table
5339
5340 @node Capturing column view, , Using column view, Column view
5341 @subsection Capturing column view
5342
5343 Since column view is just an overlay over a buffer, it cannot be
5344 exported or printed directly. If you want to capture a column view, use
5345 a @code{columnview} dynamic block (@pxref{Dynamic blocks}). The frame
5346 of this block looks like this:
5347
5348 @cindex #+BEGIN, columnview
5349 @example
5350 * The column view
5351 #+BEGIN: columnview :hlines 1 :id "label"
5352
5353 #+END:
5354 @end example
5355
5356 @noindent This dynamic block has the following parameters:
5357
5358 @table @code
5359 @item :id
5360 This is the most important parameter. Column view is a feature that is
5361 often localized to a certain (sub)tree, and the capture block might be
5362 at a different location in the file. To identify the tree whose view to
5363 capture, you can use 4 values:
5364 @cindex property, ID
5365 @example
5366 local @r{use the tree in which the capture block is located}
5367 global @r{make a global view, including all headings in the file}
5368 "file:@var{path-to-file}"
5369 @r{run column view at the top of this file}
5370 "@var{ID}" @r{call column view in the tree that has an @code{:ID:}}
5371 @r{property with the value @i{label}. You can use}
5372 @r{@kbd{M-x org-id-copy} to create a globally unique ID for}
5373 @r{the current entry and copy it to the kill-ring.}
5374 @end example
5375 @item :hlines
5376 When @code{t}, insert an hline after every line. When a number @var{N}, insert
5377 an hline before each headline with level @code{<= @var{N}}.
5378 @item :vlines
5379 When set to @code{t}, force column groups to get vertical lines.
5380 @item :maxlevel
5381 When set to a number, don't capture entries below this level.
5382 @item :skip-empty-rows
5383 When set to @code{t}, skip rows where the only non-empty specifier of the
5384 column view is @code{ITEM}.
5385
5386 @end table
5387
5388 @noindent
5389 The following commands insert or update the dynamic block:
5390
5391 @table @kbd
5392 @orgcmd{C-c C-x i,org-insert-columns-dblock}
5393 Insert a dynamic block capturing a column view. You will be prompted
5394 for the scope or ID of the view.
5395 @orgcmdkkc{C-c C-c,C-c C-x C-u,org-dblock-update}
5396 Update dynamic block at point. The cursor needs to be in the
5397 @code{#+BEGIN} line of the dynamic block.
5398 @orgcmd{C-u C-c C-x C-u,org-update-all-dblocks}
5399 Update all dynamic blocks (@pxref{Dynamic blocks}). This is useful if
5400 you have several clock table blocks, column-capturing blocks or other dynamic
5401 blocks in a buffer.
5402 @end table
5403
5404 You can add formulas to the column view table and you may add plotting
5405 instructions in front of the table---these will survive an update of the
5406 block. If there is a @code{#+TBLFM:} after the table, the table will
5407 actually be recalculated automatically after an update.
5408
5409 An alternative way to capture and process property values into a table is
5410 provided by Eric Schulte's @file{org-collector.el} which is a contributed
5411 package@footnote{Contributed packages are not part of Emacs, but are
5412 distributed with the main distribution of Org (visit
5413 @uref{http://orgmode.org}).}. It provides a general API to collect
5414 properties from entries in a certain scope, and arbitrary Lisp expressions to
5415 process these values before inserting them into a table or a dynamic block.
5416
5417 @node Property API, , Column view, Properties and Columns
5418 @section The Property API
5419 @cindex properties, API
5420 @cindex API, for properties
5421
5422 There is a full API for accessing and changing properties. This API can
5423 be used by Emacs Lisp programs to work with properties and to implement
5424 features based on them. For more information see @ref{Using the
5425 property API}.
5426
5427 @node Dates and Times, Capture - Refile - Archive, Properties and Columns, Top
5428 @chapter Dates and times
5429 @cindex dates
5430 @cindex times
5431 @cindex timestamp
5432 @cindex date stamp
5433
5434 To assist project planning, TODO items can be labeled with a date and/or
5435 a time. The specially formatted string carrying the date and time
5436 information is called a @emph{timestamp} in Org mode. This may be a
5437 little confusing because timestamp is often used as indicating when
5438 something was created or last changed. However, in Org mode this term
5439 is used in a much wider sense.
5440
5441 @menu
5442 * Timestamps:: Assigning a time to a tree entry
5443 * Creating timestamps:: Commands which insert timestamps
5444 * Deadlines and scheduling:: Planning your work
5445 * Clocking work time:: Tracking how long you spend on a task
5446 * Effort estimates:: Planning work effort in advance
5447 * Relative timer:: Notes with a running timer
5448 * Countdown timer:: Starting a countdown timer for a task
5449 @end menu
5450
5451
5452 @node Timestamps, Creating timestamps, Dates and Times, Dates and Times
5453 @section Timestamps, deadlines, and scheduling
5454 @cindex timestamps
5455 @cindex ranges, time
5456 @cindex date stamps
5457 @cindex deadlines
5458 @cindex scheduling
5459
5460 A timestamp is a specification of a date (possibly with a time or a range of
5461 times) in a special format, either @samp{<2003-09-16 Tue>}@footnote{In this
5462 simplest form, the day name is optional when you type the date yourself.
5463 However, any dates inserted or modified by Org will add that day name, for
5464 reading convenience.} or @samp{<2003-09-16 Tue 09:39>} or @samp{<2003-09-16
5465 Tue 12:00-12:30>}@footnote{This is inspired by the standard ISO 8601
5466 date/time format. To use an alternative format, see @ref{Custom time
5467 format}.}. A timestamp can appear anywhere in the headline or body of an Org
5468 tree entry. Its presence causes entries to be shown on specific dates in the
5469 agenda (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}). We distinguish:
5470
5471 @table @var
5472 @item Plain timestamp; Event; Appointment
5473 @cindex timestamp
5474 @cindex appointment
5475 A simple timestamp just assigns a date/time to an item. This is just
5476 like writing down an appointment or event in a paper agenda. In the
5477 timeline and agenda displays, the headline of an entry associated with a
5478 plain timestamp will be shown exactly on that date.
5479
5480 @example
5481 * Meet Peter at the movies
5482 <2006-11-01 Wed 19:15>
5483 * Discussion on climate change
5484 <2006-11-02 Thu 20:00-22:00>
5485 @end example
5486
5487 @item Timestamp with repeater interval
5488 @cindex timestamp, with repeater interval
5489 A timestamp may contain a @emph{repeater interval}, indicating that it
5490 applies not only on the given date, but again and again after a certain
5491 interval of N days (d), weeks (w), months (m), or years (y). The
5492 following will show up in the agenda every Wednesday:
5493
5494 @example
5495 * Pick up Sam at school
5496 <2007-05-16 Wed 12:30 +1w>
5497 @end example
5498
5499 @item Diary-style sexp entries
5500 For more complex date specifications, Org mode supports using the special
5501 sexp diary entries implemented in the Emacs calendar/diary
5502 package@footnote{When working with the standard diary sexp functions, you
5503 need to be very careful with the order of the arguments. That order depend
5504 evilly on the variable @code{calendar-date-style} (or, for older Emacs
5505 versions, @code{european-calendar-style}). For example, to specify a date
5506 December 12, 2005, the call might look like @code{(diary-date 12 1 2005)} or
5507 @code{(diary-date 1 12 2005)} or @code{(diary-date 2005 12 1)}, depending on
5508 the settings. This has been the source of much confusion. Org mode users
5509 can resort to special versions of these functions like @code{org-date} or
5510 @code{org-anniversary}. These work just like the corresponding @code{diary-}
5511 functions, but with stable ISO order of arguments (year, month, day) wherever
5512 applicable, independent of the value of @code{calendar-date-style}.}. For
5513 example with optional time
5514
5515 @example
5516 * 22:00-23:00 The nerd meeting on every 2nd Thursday of the month
5517 <%%(org-float t 4 2)>
5518 @end example
5519
5520 @item Time/Date range
5521 @cindex timerange
5522 @cindex date range
5523 Two timestamps connected by @samp{--} denote a range. The headline
5524 will be shown on the first and last day of the range, and on any dates
5525 that are displayed and fall in the range. Here is an example:
5526
5527 @example
5528 ** Meeting in Amsterdam
5529 <2004-08-23 Mon>--<2004-08-26 Thu>
5530 @end example
5531
5532 @item Inactive timestamp
5533 @cindex timestamp, inactive
5534 @cindex inactive timestamp
5535 Just like a plain timestamp, but with square brackets instead of
5536 angular ones. These timestamps are inactive in the sense that they do
5537 @emph{not} trigger an entry to show up in the agenda.
5538
5539 @example
5540 * Gillian comes late for the fifth time
5541 [2006-11-01 Wed]
5542 @end example
5543
5544 @end table
5545
5546 @node Creating timestamps, Deadlines and scheduling, Timestamps, Dates and Times
5547 @section Creating timestamps
5548 @cindex creating timestamps
5549 @cindex timestamps, creating
5550
5551 For Org mode to recognize timestamps, they need to be in the specific
5552 format. All commands listed below produce timestamps in the correct
5553 format.
5554
5555 @table @kbd
5556 @orgcmd{C-c .,org-time-stamp}
5557 Prompt for a date and insert a corresponding timestamp. When the cursor is
5558 at an existing timestamp in the buffer, the command is used to modify this
5559 timestamp instead of inserting a new one. When this command is used twice in
5560 succession, a time range is inserted.
5561 @c
5562 @orgcmd{C-c !,org-time-stamp-inactive}
5563 Like @kbd{C-c .}, but insert an inactive timestamp that will not cause
5564 an agenda entry.
5565 @c
5566 @kindex C-u C-c .
5567 @kindex C-u C-c !
5568 @item C-u C-c .
5569 @itemx C-u C-c !
5570 @vindex org-time-stamp-rounding-minutes
5571 Like @kbd{C-c .} and @kbd{C-c !}, but use the alternative format which
5572 contains date and time. The default time can be rounded to multiples of 5
5573 minutes, see the option @code{org-time-stamp-rounding-minutes}.
5574 @c
5575 @orgkey{C-c C-c}
5576 Normalize timestamp, insert/fix day name if missing or wrong.
5577 @c
5578 @orgcmd{C-c <,org-date-from-calendar}
5579 Insert a timestamp corresponding to the cursor date in the Calendar.
5580 @c
5581 @orgcmd{C-c >,org-goto-calendar}
5582 Access the Emacs calendar for the current date. If there is a
5583 timestamp in the current line, go to the corresponding date
5584 instead.
5585 @c
5586 @orgcmd{C-c C-o,org-open-at-point}
5587 Access the agenda for the date given by the timestamp or -range at
5588 point (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}).
5589 @c
5590 @orgcmdkkcc{S-@key{left},S-@key{right},org-timestamp-down-day,org-timestamp-up-day}
5591 Change date at cursor by one day. These key bindings conflict with
5592 shift-selection and related modes (@pxref{Conflicts}).
5593 @c
5594 @orgcmdkkcc{S-@key{up},S-@key{down},org-timestamp-up,org-timestamp-down-down}
5595 Change the item under the cursor in a timestamp. The cursor can be on a
5596 year, month, day, hour or minute. When the timestamp contains a time range
5597 like @samp{15:30-16:30}, modifying the first time will also shift the second,
5598 shifting the time block with constant length. To change the length, modify
5599 the second time. Note that if the cursor is in a headline and not at a
5600 timestamp, these same keys modify the priority of an item.
5601 (@pxref{Priorities}). The key bindings also conflict with shift-selection and
5602 related modes (@pxref{Conflicts}).
5603 @c
5604 @orgcmd{C-c C-y,org-evaluate-time-range}
5605 @cindex evaluate time range
5606 Evaluate a time range by computing the difference between start and end.
5607 With a prefix argument, insert result after the time range (in a table: into
5608 the following column).
5609 @end table
5610
5611
5612 @menu
5613 * The date/time prompt:: How Org mode helps you entering date and time
5614 * Custom time format:: Making dates look different
5615 @end menu
5616
5617 @node The date/time prompt, Custom time format, Creating timestamps, Creating timestamps
5618 @subsection The date/time prompt
5619 @cindex date, reading in minibuffer
5620 @cindex time, reading in minibuffer
5621
5622 @vindex org-read-date-prefer-future
5623 When Org mode prompts for a date/time, the default is shown in default
5624 date/time format, and the prompt therefore seems to ask for a specific
5625 format. But it will in fact accept any string containing some date and/or
5626 time information, and it is really smart about interpreting your input. You
5627 can, for example, use @kbd{C-y} to paste a (possibly multi-line) string
5628 copied from an email message. Org mode will find whatever information is in
5629 there and derive anything you have not specified from the @emph{default date
5630 and time}. The default is usually the current date and time, but when
5631 modifying an existing timestamp, or when entering the second stamp of a
5632 range, it is taken from the stamp in the buffer. When filling in
5633 information, Org mode assumes that most of the time you will want to enter a
5634 date in the future: if you omit the month/year and the given day/month is
5635 @i{before} today, it will assume that you mean a future date@footnote{See the
5636 variable @code{org-read-date-prefer-future}. You may set that variable to
5637 the symbol @code{time} to even make a time before now shift the date to
5638 tomorrow.}. If the date has been automatically shifted into the future, the
5639 time prompt will show this with @samp{(=>F).}
5640
5641 For example, let's assume that today is @b{June 13, 2006}. Here is how
5642 various inputs will be interpreted, the items filled in by Org mode are
5643 in @b{bold}.
5644
5645 @example
5646 3-2-5 @result{} 2003-02-05
5647 2/5/3 @result{} 2003-02-05
5648 14 @result{} @b{2006}-@b{06}-14
5649 12 @result{} @b{2006}-@b{07}-12
5650 2/5 @result{} @b{2007}-02-05
5651 Fri @result{} nearest Friday (default date or later)
5652 sep 15 @result{} @b{2006}-09-15
5653 feb 15 @result{} @b{2007}-02-15
5654 sep 12 9 @result{} 2009-09-12
5655 12:45 @result{} @b{2006}-@b{06}-@b{13} 12:45
5656 22 sept 0:34 @result{} @b{2006}-09-22 0:34
5657 w4 @result{} ISO week for of the current year @b{2006}
5658 2012 w4 fri @result{} Friday of ISO week 4 in 2012
5659 2012-w04-5 @result{} Same as above
5660 @end example
5661
5662 Furthermore you can specify a relative date by giving, as the
5663 @emph{first} thing in the input: a plus/minus sign, a number and a
5664 letter ([dwmy]) to indicate change in days, weeks, months, or years. With a
5665 single plus or minus, the date is always relative to today. With a
5666 double plus or minus, it is relative to the default date. If instead of
5667 a single letter, you use the abbreviation of day name, the date will be
5668 the Nth such day, e.g.:
5669
5670 @example
5671 +0 @result{} today
5672 . @result{} today
5673 +4d @result{} four days from today
5674 +4 @result{} same as above
5675 +2w @result{} two weeks from today
5676 ++5 @result{} five days from default date
5677 +2tue @result{} second Tuesday from now.
5678 @end example
5679
5680 @vindex parse-time-months
5681 @vindex parse-time-weekdays
5682 The function understands English month and weekday abbreviations. If
5683 you want to use unabbreviated names and/or other languages, configure
5684 the variables @code{parse-time-months} and @code{parse-time-weekdays}.
5685
5686 @vindex org-read-date-force-compatible-dates
5687 Not all dates can be represented in a given Emacs implementation. By default
5688 Org mode forces dates into the compatibility range 1970--2037 which works on
5689 all Emacs implementations. If you want to use dates outside of this range,
5690 read the docstring of the variable
5691 @code{org-read-date-force-compatible-dates}.
5692
5693 You can specify a time range by giving start and end times or by giving a
5694 start time and a duration (in HH:MM format). Use one or two dash(es) as the
5695 separator in the former case and use '+' as the separator in the latter
5696 case, e.g.:
5697
5698 @example
5699 11am-1:15pm @result{} 11:00-13:15
5700 11am--1:15pm @result{} same as above
5701 11am+2:15 @result{} same as above
5702 @end example
5703
5704 @cindex calendar, for selecting date
5705 @vindex org-popup-calendar-for-date-prompt
5706 Parallel to the minibuffer prompt, a calendar is popped up@footnote{If
5707 you don't need/want the calendar, configure the variable
5708 @code{org-popup-calendar-for-date-prompt}.}. When you exit the date
5709 prompt, either by clicking on a date in the calendar, or by pressing
5710 @key{RET}, the date selected in the calendar will be combined with the
5711 information entered at the prompt. You can control the calendar fully
5712 from the minibuffer:
5713
5714 @kindex <
5715 @kindex >
5716 @kindex M-v
5717 @kindex C-v
5718 @kindex mouse-1
5719 @kindex S-@key{right}
5720 @kindex S-@key{left}
5721 @kindex S-@key{down}
5722 @kindex S-@key{up}
5723 @kindex M-S-@key{right}
5724 @kindex M-S-@key{left}
5725 @kindex @key{RET}
5726 @example
5727 @key{RET} @r{Choose date at cursor in calendar.}
5728 mouse-1 @r{Select date by clicking on it.}
5729 S-@key{right}/@key{left} @r{One day forward/backward.}
5730 S-@key{down}/@key{up} @r{One week forward/backward.}
5731 M-S-@key{right}/@key{left} @r{One month forward/backward.}
5732 > / < @r{Scroll calendar forward/backward by one month.}
5733 M-v / C-v @r{Scroll calendar forward/backward by 3 months.}
5734 @end example
5735
5736 @vindex org-read-date-display-live
5737 The actions of the date/time prompt may seem complex, but I assure you they
5738 will grow on you, and you will start getting annoyed by pretty much any other
5739 way of entering a date/time out there. To help you understand what is going
5740 on, the current interpretation of your input will be displayed live in the
5741 minibuffer@footnote{If you find this distracting, turn the display of with
5742 @code{org-read-date-display-live}.}.
5743
5744 @node Custom time format, , The date/time prompt, Creating timestamps
5745 @subsection Custom time format
5746 @cindex custom date/time format
5747 @cindex time format, custom
5748 @cindex date format, custom
5749
5750 @vindex org-display-custom-times
5751 @vindex org-time-stamp-custom-formats
5752 Org mode uses the standard ISO notation for dates and times as it is
5753 defined in ISO 8601. If you cannot get used to this and require another
5754 representation of date and time to keep you happy, you can get it by
5755 customizing the variables @code{org-display-custom-times} and
5756 @code{org-time-stamp-custom-formats}.
5757
5758 @table @kbd
5759 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-t,org-toggle-time-stamp-overlays}
5760 Toggle the display of custom formats for dates and times.
5761 @end table
5762
5763 @noindent
5764 Org mode needs the default format for scanning, so the custom date/time
5765 format does not @emph{replace} the default format---instead it is put
5766 @emph{over} the default format using text properties. This has the
5767 following consequences:
5768 @itemize @bullet
5769 @item
5770 You cannot place the cursor onto a timestamp anymore, only before or
5771 after.
5772 @item
5773 The @kbd{S-@key{up}/@key{down}} keys can no longer be used to adjust
5774 each component of a timestamp. If the cursor is at the beginning of
5775 the stamp, @kbd{S-@key{up}/@key{down}} will change the stamp by one day,
5776 just like @kbd{S-@key{left}/@key{right}}. At the end of the stamp, the
5777 time will be changed by one minute.
5778 @item
5779 If the timestamp contains a range of clock times or a repeater, these
5780 will not be overlaid, but remain in the buffer as they were.
5781 @item
5782 When you delete a timestamp character-by-character, it will only
5783 disappear from the buffer after @emph{all} (invisible) characters
5784 belonging to the ISO timestamp have been removed.
5785 @item
5786 If the custom timestamp format is longer than the default and you are
5787 using dates in tables, table alignment will be messed up. If the custom
5788 format is shorter, things do work as expected.
5789 @end itemize
5790
5791
5792 @node Deadlines and scheduling, Clocking work time, Creating timestamps, Dates and Times
5793 @section Deadlines and scheduling
5794
5795 A timestamp may be preceded by special keywords to facilitate planning:
5796
5797 @table @var
5798 @item DEADLINE
5799 @cindex DEADLINE keyword
5800
5801 Meaning: the task (most likely a TODO item, though not necessarily) is supposed
5802 to be finished on that date.
5803
5804 @vindex org-deadline-warning-days
5805 On the deadline date, the task will be listed in the agenda. In
5806 addition, the agenda for @emph{today} will carry a warning about the
5807 approaching or missed deadline, starting
5808 @code{org-deadline-warning-days} before the due date, and continuing
5809 until the entry is marked DONE@. An example:
5810
5811 @example
5812 *** TODO write article about the Earth for the Guide
5813 DEADLINE: <2004-02-29 Sun>
5814 The editor in charge is [[bbdb:Ford Prefect]]
5815 @end example
5816
5817 You can specify a different lead time for warnings for a specific
5818 deadlines using the following syntax. Here is an example with a warning
5819 period of 5 days @code{DEADLINE: <2004-02-29 Sun -5d>}.
5820
5821 @item SCHEDULED
5822 @cindex SCHEDULED keyword
5823
5824 Meaning: you are planning to start working on that task on the given
5825 date.
5826
5827 @vindex org-agenda-skip-scheduled-if-done
5828 The headline will be listed under the given date@footnote{It will still
5829 be listed on that date after it has been marked DONE@. If you don't like
5830 this, set the variable @code{org-agenda-skip-scheduled-if-done}.}. In
5831 addition, a reminder that the scheduled date has passed will be present
5832 in the compilation for @emph{today}, until the entry is marked DONE, i.e.,
5833 the task will automatically be forwarded until completed.
5834
5835 @example
5836 *** TODO Call Trillian for a date on New Years Eve.
5837 SCHEDULED: <2004-12-25 Sat>
5838 @end example
5839
5840 @noindent
5841 @b{Important:} Scheduling an item in Org mode should @i{not} be
5842 understood in the same way that we understand @i{scheduling a meeting}.
5843 Setting a date for a meeting is just a simple appointment, you should
5844 mark this entry with a simple plain timestamp, to get this item shown
5845 on the date where it applies. This is a frequent misunderstanding by
5846 Org users. In Org mode, @i{scheduling} means setting a date when you
5847 want to start working on an action item.
5848 @end table
5849
5850 You may use timestamps with repeaters in scheduling and deadline
5851 entries. Org mode will issue early and late warnings based on the
5852 assumption that the timestamp represents the @i{nearest instance} of
5853 the repeater. However, the use of diary sexp entries like
5854 @c
5855 @code{<%%(org-float t 42)>}
5856 @c
5857 in scheduling and deadline timestamps is limited. Org mode does not
5858 know enough about the internals of each sexp function to issue early and
5859 late warnings. However, it will show the item on each day where the
5860 sexp entry matches.
5861
5862 @menu
5863 * Inserting deadline/schedule:: Planning items
5864 * Repeated tasks:: Items that show up again and again
5865 @end menu
5866
5867 @node Inserting deadline/schedule, Repeated tasks, Deadlines and scheduling, Deadlines and scheduling
5868 @subsection Inserting deadlines or schedules
5869
5870 The following commands allow you to quickly insert@footnote{The @samp{SCHEDULED} and
5871 @samp{DEADLINE} dates are inserted on the line right below the headline. Don't put
5872 any text between this line and the headline.} a deadline or to schedule
5873 an item:
5874
5875 @table @kbd
5876 @c
5877 @orgcmd{C-c C-d,org-deadline}
5878 Insert @samp{DEADLINE} keyword along with a stamp. The insertion will happen
5879 in the line directly following the headline. Any CLOSED timestamp will be
5880 removed. When called with a prefix arg, an existing deadline will be removed
5881 from the entry. Depending on the variable @code{org-log-redeadline}@footnote{with corresponding
5882 @code{#+STARTUP} keywords @code{logredeadline}, @code{lognoteredeadline},
5883 and @code{nologredeadline}}, a note will be taken when changing an existing
5884 deadline.
5885
5886 @orgcmd{C-c C-s,org-schedule}
5887 Insert @samp{SCHEDULED} keyword along with a stamp. The insertion will
5888 happen in the line directly following the headline. Any CLOSED timestamp
5889 will be removed. When called with a prefix argument, remove the scheduling
5890 date from the entry. Depending on the variable
5891 @code{org-log-reschedule}@footnote{with corresponding @code{#+STARTUP}
5892 keywords @code{logreschedule}, @code{lognotereschedule}, and
5893 @code{nologreschedule}}, a note will be taken when changing an existing
5894 scheduling time.
5895 @c
5896 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-k,org-mark-entry-for-agenda-action}
5897 @kindex k a
5898 @kindex k s
5899 Mark the current entry for agenda action. After you have marked the entry
5900 like this, you can open the agenda or the calendar to find an appropriate
5901 date. With the cursor on the selected date, press @kbd{k s} or @kbd{k d} to
5902 schedule the marked item.
5903 @c
5904 @orgcmd{C-c / d,org-check-deadlines}
5905 @cindex sparse tree, for deadlines
5906 @vindex org-deadline-warning-days
5907 Create a sparse tree with all deadlines that are either past-due, or
5908 which will become due within @code{org-deadline-warning-days}.
5909 With @kbd{C-u} prefix, show all deadlines in the file. With a numeric
5910 prefix, check that many days. For example, @kbd{C-1 C-c / d} shows
5911 all deadlines due tomorrow.
5912 @c
5913 @orgcmd{C-c / b,org-check-before-date}
5914 Sparse tree for deadlines and scheduled items before a given date.
5915 @c
5916 @orgcmd{C-c / a,org-check-after-date}
5917 Sparse tree for deadlines and scheduled items after a given date.
5918 @end table
5919
5920 Note that @code{org-schedule} and @code{org-deadline} supports
5921 setting the date by indicating a relative time: e.g., +1d will set
5922 the date to the next day after today, and --1w will set the date
5923 to the previous week before any current timestamp.
5924
5925 @node Repeated tasks, , Inserting deadline/schedule, Deadlines and scheduling
5926 @subsection Repeated tasks
5927 @cindex tasks, repeated
5928 @cindex repeated tasks
5929
5930 Some tasks need to be repeated again and again. Org mode helps to
5931 organize such tasks using a so-called repeater in a DEADLINE, SCHEDULED,
5932 or plain timestamp. In the following example
5933 @example
5934 ** TODO Pay the rent
5935 DEADLINE: <2005-10-01 Sat +1m>
5936 @end example
5937 @noindent
5938 the @code{+1m} is a repeater; the intended interpretation is that the task
5939 has a deadline on <2005-10-01> and repeats itself every (one) month starting
5940 from that time. You can use yearly, monthly, weekly, daily and hourly repeat
5941 cookies by using the @code{y/w/m/d/h} letters. If you need both a repeater
5942 and a special warning period in a deadline entry, the repeater should come
5943 first and the warning period last: @code{DEADLINE: <2005-10-01 Sat +1m -3d>}.
5944
5945 @vindex org-todo-repeat-to-state
5946 Deadlines and scheduled items produce entries in the agenda when they are
5947 over-due, so it is important to be able to mark such an entry as completed
5948 once you have done so. When you mark a DEADLINE or a SCHEDULE with the TODO
5949 keyword DONE, it will no longer produce entries in the agenda. The problem
5950 with this is, however, that then also the @emph{next} instance of the
5951 repeated entry will not be active. Org mode deals with this in the following
5952 way: When you try to mark such an entry DONE (using @kbd{C-c C-t}), it will
5953 shift the base date of the repeating timestamp by the repeater interval, and
5954 immediately set the entry state back to TODO@footnote{In fact, the target
5955 state is taken from, in this sequence, the @code{REPEAT_TO_STATE} property or
5956 the variable @code{org-todo-repeat-to-state}. If neither of these is
5957 specified, the target state defaults to the first state of the TODO state
5958 sequence.}. In the example above, setting the state to DONE would actually
5959 switch the date like this:
5960
5961 @example
5962 ** TODO Pay the rent
5963 DEADLINE: <2005-11-01 Tue +1m>
5964 @end example
5965
5966 @vindex org-log-repeat
5967 A timestamp@footnote{You can change this using the option
5968 @code{org-log-repeat}, or the @code{#+STARTUP} options @code{logrepeat},
5969 @code{lognoterepeat}, and @code{nologrepeat}. With @code{lognoterepeat}, you
5970 will also be prompted for a note.} will be added under the deadline, to keep
5971 a record that you actually acted on the previous instance of this deadline.
5972
5973 As a consequence of shifting the base date, this entry will no longer be
5974 visible in the agenda when checking past dates, but all future instances
5975 will be visible.
5976
5977 With the @samp{+1m} cookie, the date shift will always be exactly one
5978 month. So if you have not paid the rent for three months, marking this
5979 entry DONE will still keep it as an overdue deadline. Depending on the
5980 task, this may not be the best way to handle it. For example, if you
5981 forgot to call your father for 3 weeks, it does not make sense to call
5982 him 3 times in a single day to make up for it. Finally, there are tasks
5983 like changing batteries which should always repeat a certain time
5984 @i{after} the last time you did it. For these tasks, Org mode has
5985 special repeaters @samp{++} and @samp{.+}. For example:
5986
5987 @example
5988 ** TODO Call Father
5989 DEADLINE: <2008-02-10 Sun ++1w>
5990 Marking this DONE will shift the date by at least one week,
5991 but also by as many weeks as it takes to get this date into
5992 the future. However, it stays on a Sunday, even if you called
5993 and marked it done on Saturday.
5994 ** TODO Check the batteries in the smoke detectors
5995 DEADLINE: <2005-11-01 Tue .+1m>
5996 Marking this DONE will shift the date to one month after
5997 today.
5998 @end example
5999
6000 You may have both scheduling and deadline information for a specific
6001 task---just make sure that the repeater intervals on both are the same.
6002
6003 An alternative to using a repeater is to create a number of copies of a task
6004 subtree, with dates shifted in each copy. The command @kbd{C-c C-x c} was
6005 created for this purpose, it is described in @ref{Structure editing}.
6006
6007
6008 @node Clocking work time, Effort estimates, Deadlines and scheduling, Dates and Times
6009 @section Clocking work time
6010 @cindex clocking time
6011 @cindex time clocking
6012
6013 Org mode allows you to clock the time you spend on specific tasks in a
6014 project. When you start working on an item, you can start the clock. When
6015 you stop working on that task, or when you mark the task done, the clock is
6016 stopped and the corresponding time interval is recorded. It also computes
6017 the total time spent on each subtree@footnote{Clocking only works if all
6018 headings are indented with less than 30 stars. This is a hardcoded
6019 limitation of `lmax' in `org-clock-sum'.} of a project. And it remembers a
6020 history or tasks recently clocked, to that you can jump quickly between a
6021 number of tasks absorbing your time.
6022
6023 To save the clock history across Emacs sessions, use
6024 @lisp
6025 (setq org-clock-persist 'history)
6026 (org-clock-persistence-insinuate)
6027 @end lisp
6028 When you clock into a new task after resuming Emacs, the incomplete
6029 clock@footnote{To resume the clock under the assumption that you have worked
6030 on this task while outside Emacs, use @code{(setq org-clock-persist t)}.}
6031 will be found (@pxref{Resolving idle time}) and you will be prompted about
6032 what to do with it.
6033
6034 @menu
6035 * Clocking commands:: Starting and stopping a clock
6036 * The clock table:: Detailed reports
6037 * Resolving idle time:: Resolving time when you've been idle
6038 @end menu
6039
6040 @node Clocking commands, The clock table, Clocking work time, Clocking work time
6041 @subsection Clocking commands
6042
6043 @table @kbd
6044 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-i,org-clock-in}
6045 @vindex org-clock-into-drawer
6046 @vindex org-clock-continuously
6047 @cindex property, LOG_INTO_DRAWER
6048 Start the clock on the current item (clock-in). This inserts the CLOCK
6049 keyword together with a timestamp. If this is not the first clocking of
6050 this item, the multiple CLOCK lines will be wrapped into a
6051 @code{:LOGBOOK:} drawer (see also the variable
6052 @code{org-clock-into-drawer}). You can also overrule
6053 the setting of this variable for a subtree by setting a
6054 @code{CLOCK_INTO_DRAWER} or @code{LOG_INTO_DRAWER} property.
6055 When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix argument,
6056 select the task from a list of recently clocked tasks. With two @kbd{C-u
6057 C-u} prefixes, clock into the task at point and mark it as the default task;
6058 the default task will then always be available with letter @kbd{d} when
6059 selecting a clocking task. With three @kbd{C-u C-u C-u} prefixes, force
6060 continuous clocking by starting the clock when the last clock stopped.@*
6061 @cindex property: CLOCK_MODELINE_TOTAL
6062 @cindex property: LAST_REPEAT
6063 @vindex org-clock-modeline-total
6064 While the clock is running, the current clocking time is shown in the mode
6065 line, along with the title of the task. The clock time shown will be all
6066 time ever clocked for this task and its children. If the task has an effort
6067 estimate (@pxref{Effort estimates}), the mode line displays the current
6068 clocking time against it@footnote{To add an effort estimate ``on the fly'',
6069 hook a function doing this to @code{org-clock-in-prepare-hook}.} If the task
6070 is a repeating one (@pxref{Repeated tasks}), only the time since the last
6071 reset of the task @footnote{as recorded by the @code{LAST_REPEAT} property}
6072 will be shown. More control over what time is shown can be exercised with
6073 the @code{CLOCK_MODELINE_TOTAL} property. It may have the values
6074 @code{current} to show only the current clocking instance, @code{today} to
6075 show all time clocked on this tasks today (see also the variable
6076 @code{org-extend-today-until}), @code{all} to include all time, or
6077 @code{auto} which is the default@footnote{See also the variable
6078 @code{org-clock-modeline-total}.}.@* Clicking with @kbd{mouse-1} onto the
6079 mode line entry will pop up a menu with clocking options.
6080 @c
6081 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-o,org-clock-out}
6082 @vindex org-log-note-clock-out
6083 Stop the clock (clock-out). This inserts another timestamp at the same
6084 location where the clock was last started. It also directly computes
6085 the resulting time in inserts it after the time range as @samp{=>
6086 HH:MM}. See the variable @code{org-log-note-clock-out} for the
6087 possibility to record an additional note together with the clock-out
6088 timestamp@footnote{The corresponding in-buffer setting is:
6089 @code{#+STARTUP: lognoteclock-out}}.
6090 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-x,org-clock-in-last}
6091 @vindex org-clock-continuously
6092 Reclock the last clocked task. With one @kbd{C-u} prefix argument,
6093 select the task from the clock history. With two @kbd{C-u} prefixes,
6094 force continuous clocking by starting the clock when the last clock
6095 stopped.
6096 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-e,org-clock-modify-effort-estimate}
6097 Update the effort estimate for the current clock task.
6098 @kindex C-c C-y
6099 @kindex C-c C-c
6100 @orgcmdkkc{C-c C-c,C-c C-y,org-evaluate-time-range}
6101 Recompute the time interval after changing one of the timestamps. This
6102 is only necessary if you edit the timestamps directly. If you change
6103 them with @kbd{S-@key{cursor}} keys, the update is automatic.
6104 @orgcmd{C-S-@key{up/down},org-clock-timestamps-up/down}
6105 On @code{CLOCK} log lines, increase/decrease both timestamps so that the
6106 clock duration keeps the same.
6107 @orgcmd{S-M-@key{up/down},org-timestamp-up/down}
6108 On @code{CLOCK} log lines, increase/decrease the timestamp at point and
6109 the one of the previous (or the next clock) timestamp by the same duration.
6110 For example, if you hit @kbd{S-M-@key{up}} to increase a clocked-out timestamp
6111 by five minutes, then the clocked-in timestamp of the next clock will be
6112 increased by five minutes.
6113 @orgcmd{C-c C-t,org-todo}
6114 Changing the TODO state of an item to DONE automatically stops the clock
6115 if it is running in this same item.
6116 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-q,org-clock-cancel}
6117 Cancel the current clock. This is useful if a clock was started by
6118 mistake, or if you ended up working on something else.
6119 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-j,org-clock-goto}
6120 Jump to the headline of the currently clocked in task. With a @kbd{C-u}
6121 prefix arg, select the target task from a list of recently clocked tasks.
6122 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-d,org-clock-display}
6123 @vindex org-remove-highlights-with-change
6124 Display time summaries for each subtree in the current buffer. This puts
6125 overlays at the end of each headline, showing the total time recorded under
6126 that heading, including the time of any subheadings. You can use visibility
6127 cycling to study the tree, but the overlays disappear when you change the
6128 buffer (see variable @code{org-remove-highlights-with-change}) or press
6129 @kbd{C-c C-c}.
6130 @end table
6131
6132 The @kbd{l} key may be used in the timeline (@pxref{Timeline}) and in
6133 the agenda (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}) to show which tasks have been
6134 worked on or closed during a day.
6135
6136 @strong{Important:} note that both @code{org-clock-out} and
6137 @code{org-clock-in-last} can have a global keybinding and will not
6138 modify the window disposition.
6139
6140 @node The clock table, Resolving idle time, Clocking commands, Clocking work time
6141 @subsection The clock table
6142 @cindex clocktable, dynamic block
6143 @cindex report, of clocked time
6144
6145 Org mode can produce quite complex reports based on the time clocking
6146 information. Such a report is called a @emph{clock table}, because it is
6147 formatted as one or several Org tables.
6148
6149 @table @kbd
6150 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-r,org-clock-report}
6151 Insert a dynamic block (@pxref{Dynamic blocks}) containing a clock
6152 report as an Org mode table into the current file. When the cursor is
6153 at an existing clock table, just update it. When called with a prefix
6154 argument, jump to the first clock report in the current document and
6155 update it. The clock table always includes also trees with
6156 @code{:ARCHIVE:} tag.
6157 @orgcmdkkc{C-c C-c,C-c C-x C-u,org-dblock-update}
6158 Update dynamic block at point. The cursor needs to be in the
6159 @code{#+BEGIN} line of the dynamic block.
6160 @orgkey{C-u C-c C-x C-u}
6161 Update all dynamic blocks (@pxref{Dynamic blocks}). This is useful if
6162 you have several clock table blocks in a buffer.
6163 @orgcmdkxkc{S-@key{left},S-@key{right},org-clocktable-try-shift}
6164 Shift the current @code{:block} interval and update the table. The cursor
6165 needs to be in the @code{#+BEGIN: clocktable} line for this command. If
6166 @code{:block} is @code{today}, it will be shifted to @code{today-1} etc.
6167 @end table
6168
6169
6170 Here is an example of the frame for a clock table as it is inserted into the
6171 buffer with the @kbd{C-c C-x C-r} command:
6172
6173 @cindex #+BEGIN, clocktable
6174 @example
6175 #+BEGIN: clocktable :maxlevel 2 :emphasize nil :scope file
6176 #+END: clocktable
6177 @end example
6178 @noindent
6179 @vindex org-clocktable-defaults
6180 The @samp{BEGIN} line and specify a number of options to define the scope,
6181 structure, and formatting of the report. Defaults for all these options can
6182 be configured in the variable @code{org-clocktable-defaults}.
6183
6184 @noindent First there are options that determine which clock entries are to
6185 be selected:
6186 @example
6187 :maxlevel @r{Maximum level depth to which times are listed in the table.}
6188 @r{Clocks at deeper levels will be summed into the upper level.}
6189 :scope @r{The scope to consider. This can be any of the following:}
6190 nil @r{the current buffer or narrowed region}
6191 file @r{the full current buffer}
6192 subtree @r{the subtree where the clocktable is located}
6193 tree@var{N} @r{the surrounding level @var{N} tree, for example @code{tree3}}
6194 tree @r{the surrounding level 1 tree}
6195 agenda @r{all agenda files}
6196 ("file"..) @r{scan these files}
6197 file-with-archives @r{current file and its archives}
6198 agenda-with-archives @r{all agenda files, including archives}
6199 :block @r{The time block to consider. This block is specified either}
6200 @r{absolute, or relative to the current time and may be any of}
6201 @r{these formats:}
6202 2007-12-31 @r{New year eve 2007}
6203 2007-12 @r{December 2007}
6204 2007-W50 @r{ISO-week 50 in 2007}
6205 2007-Q2 @r{2nd quarter in 2007}
6206 2007 @r{the year 2007}
6207 today, yesterday, today-@var{N} @r{a relative day}
6208 thisweek, lastweek, thisweek-@var{N} @r{a relative week}
6209 thismonth, lastmonth, thismonth-@var{N} @r{a relative month}
6210 thisyear, lastyear, thisyear-@var{N} @r{a relative year}
6211 @r{Use @kbd{S-@key{left}/@key{right}} keys to shift the time interval.}
6212 :tstart @r{A time string specifying when to start considering times.}
6213 :tend @r{A time string specifying when to stop considering times.}
6214 :step @r{@code{week} or @code{day}, to split the table into chunks.}
6215 @r{To use this, @code{:block} or @code{:tstart}, @code{:tend} are needed.}
6216 :stepskip0 @r{Do not show steps that have zero time.}
6217 :fileskip0 @r{Do not show table sections from files which did not contribute.}
6218 :tags @r{A tags match to select entries that should contribute. See}
6219 @r{@ref{Matching tags and properties} for the match syntax.}
6220 @end example
6221
6222 Then there are options which determine the formatting of the table. There
6223 options are interpreted by the function @code{org-clocktable-write-default},
6224 but you can specify your own function using the @code{:formatter} parameter.
6225 @example
6226 :emphasize @r{When @code{t}, emphasize level one and level two items.}
6227 :lang @r{Language@footnote{Language terms can be set through the variable @code{org-clock-clocktable-language-setup}.} to use for descriptive cells like "Task".}
6228 :link @r{Link the item headlines in the table to their origins.}
6229 :narrow @r{An integer to limit the width of the headline column in}
6230 @r{the org table. If you write it like @samp{50!}, then the}
6231 @r{headline will also be shortened in export.}
6232 :indent @r{Indent each headline field according to its level.}
6233 :tcolumns @r{Number of columns to be used for times. If this is smaller}
6234 @r{than @code{:maxlevel}, lower levels will be lumped into one column.}
6235 :level @r{Should a level number column be included?}
6236 :compact @r{Abbreviation for @code{:level nil :indent t :narrow 40! :tcolumns 1}}
6237 @r{All are overwritten except if there is an explicit @code{:narrow}}
6238 :timestamp @r{A timestamp for the entry, when available. Look for SCHEDULED,}
6239 @r{DEADLINE, TIMESTAMP and TIMESTAMP_IA, in this order.}
6240 :properties @r{List of properties that should be shown in the table. Each}
6241 @r{property will get its own column.}
6242 :inherit-props @r{When this flag is @code{t}, the values for @code{:properties} will be inherited.}
6243 :formula @r{Content of a @code{#+TBLFM} line to be added and evaluated.}
6244 @r{As a special case, @samp{:formula %} adds a column with % time.}
6245 @r{If you do not specify a formula here, any existing formula}
6246 @r{below the clock table will survive updates and be evaluated.}
6247 :formatter @r{A function to format clock data and insert it into the buffer.}
6248 @end example
6249 To get a clock summary of the current level 1 tree, for the current
6250 day, you could write
6251 @example
6252 #+BEGIN: clocktable :maxlevel 2 :block today :scope tree1 :link t
6253 #+END: clocktable
6254 @end example
6255 @noindent
6256 and to use a specific time range you could write@footnote{Note that all
6257 parameters must be specified in a single line---the line is broken here
6258 only to fit it into the manual.}
6259 @example
6260 #+BEGIN: clocktable :tstart "<2006-08-10 Thu 10:00>"
6261 :tend "<2006-08-10 Thu 12:00>"
6262 #+END: clocktable
6263 @end example
6264 A summary of the current subtree with % times would be
6265 @example
6266 #+BEGIN: clocktable :scope subtree :link t :formula %
6267 #+END: clocktable
6268 @end example
6269 A horizontally compact representation of everything clocked during last week
6270 would be
6271 @example
6272 #+BEGIN: clocktable :scope agenda :block lastweek :compact t
6273 #+END: clocktable
6274 @end example
6275
6276 @node Resolving idle time, , The clock table, Clocking work time
6277 @subsection Resolving idle time and continuous clocking
6278
6279 @subsubheading Resolving idle time
6280 @cindex resolve idle time
6281
6282 @cindex idle, resolve, dangling
6283 If you clock in on a work item, and then walk away from your
6284 computer---perhaps to take a phone call---you often need to ``resolve'' the
6285 time you were away by either subtracting it from the current clock, or
6286 applying it to another one.
6287
6288 @vindex org-clock-idle-time
6289 By customizing the variable @code{org-clock-idle-time} to some integer, such
6290 as 10 or 15, Emacs can alert you when you get back to your computer after
6291 being idle for that many minutes@footnote{On computers using Mac OS X,
6292 idleness is based on actual user idleness, not just Emacs' idle time. For
6293 X11, you can install a utility program @file{x11idle.c}, available in the
6294 @code{contrib/scripts} directory of the Org git distribution, to get the same
6295 general treatment of idleness. On other systems, idle time refers to Emacs
6296 idle time only.}, and ask what you want to do with the idle time. There will
6297 be a question waiting for you when you get back, indicating how much idle
6298 time has passed (constantly updated with the current amount), as well as a
6299 set of choices to correct the discrepancy:
6300
6301 @table @kbd
6302 @item k
6303 To keep some or all of the minutes and stay clocked in, press @kbd{k}. Org
6304 will ask how many of the minutes to keep. Press @key{RET} to keep them all,
6305 effectively changing nothing, or enter a number to keep that many minutes.
6306 @item K
6307 If you use the shift key and press @kbd{K}, it will keep however many minutes
6308 you request and then immediately clock out of that task. If you keep all of
6309 the minutes, this is the same as just clocking out of the current task.
6310 @item s
6311 To keep none of the minutes, use @kbd{s} to subtract all the away time from
6312 the clock, and then check back in from the moment you returned.
6313 @item S
6314 To keep none of the minutes and just clock out at the start of the away time,
6315 use the shift key and press @kbd{S}. Remember that using shift will always
6316 leave you clocked out, no matter which option you choose.
6317 @item C
6318 To cancel the clock altogether, use @kbd{C}. Note that if instead of
6319 canceling you subtract the away time, and the resulting clock amount is less
6320 than a minute, the clock will still be canceled rather than clutter up the
6321 log with an empty entry.
6322 @end table
6323
6324 What if you subtracted those away minutes from the current clock, and now
6325 want to apply them to a new clock? Simply clock in to any task immediately
6326 after the subtraction. Org will notice that you have subtracted time ``on
6327 the books'', so to speak, and will ask if you want to apply those minutes to
6328 the next task you clock in on.
6329
6330 There is one other instance when this clock resolution magic occurs. Say you
6331 were clocked in and hacking away, and suddenly your cat chased a mouse who
6332 scared a hamster that crashed into your UPS's power button! You suddenly
6333 lose all your buffers, but thanks to auto-save you still have your recent Org
6334 mode changes, including your last clock in.
6335
6336 If you restart Emacs and clock into any task, Org will notice that you have a
6337 dangling clock which was never clocked out from your last session. Using
6338 that clock's starting time as the beginning of the unaccounted-for period,
6339 Org will ask how you want to resolve that time. The logic and behavior is
6340 identical to dealing with away time due to idleness; it is just happening due
6341 to a recovery event rather than a set amount of idle time.
6342
6343 You can also check all the files visited by your Org agenda for dangling
6344 clocks at any time using @kbd{M-x org-resolve-clocks RET} (or @kbd{C-c C-x C-z}).
6345
6346 @subsubheading Continuous clocking
6347 @cindex continuous clocking
6348 @vindex org-clock-continuously
6349
6350 You may want to start clocking from the time when you clocked out the
6351 previous task. To enable this systematically, set @code{org-clock-continuously}
6352 to @code{t}. Each time you clock in, Org retrieves the clock-out time of the
6353 last clocked entry for this session, and start the new clock from there.
6354
6355 If you only want this from time to time, use three universal prefix arguments
6356 with @code{org-clock-in} and two @kbd{C-u C-u} with @code{org-clock-in-last}.
6357
6358 @node Effort estimates, Relative timer, Clocking work time, Dates and Times
6359 @section Effort estimates
6360 @cindex effort estimates
6361
6362 @cindex property, Effort
6363 @vindex org-effort-property
6364 If you want to plan your work in a very detailed way, or if you need to
6365 produce offers with quotations of the estimated work effort, you may want to
6366 assign effort estimates to entries. If you are also clocking your work, you
6367 may later want to compare the planned effort with the actual working time, a
6368 great way to improve planning estimates. Effort estimates are stored in a
6369 special property @samp{Effort}@footnote{You may change the property being
6370 used with the variable @code{org-effort-property}.}. You can set the effort
6371 for an entry with the following commands:
6372
6373 @table @kbd
6374 @orgcmd{C-c C-x e,org-set-effort}
6375 Set the effort estimate for the current entry. With a numeric prefix
6376 argument, set it to the Nth allowed value (see below). This command is also
6377 accessible from the agenda with the @kbd{e} key.
6378 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-e,org-clock-modify-effort-estimate}
6379 Modify the effort estimate of the item currently being clocked.
6380 @end table
6381
6382 Clearly the best way to work with effort estimates is through column view
6383 (@pxref{Column view}). You should start by setting up discrete values for
6384 effort estimates, and a @code{COLUMNS} format that displays these values
6385 together with clock sums (if you want to clock your time). For a specific
6386 buffer you can use
6387
6388 @example
6389 #+PROPERTY: Effort_ALL 0 0:10 0:30 1:00 2:00 3:00 4:00 5:00 6:00 7:00
6390 #+COLUMNS: %40ITEM(Task) %17Effort(Estimated Effort)@{:@} %CLOCKSUM
6391 @end example
6392
6393 @noindent
6394 @vindex org-global-properties
6395 @vindex org-columns-default-format
6396 or, even better, you can set up these values globally by customizing the
6397 variables @code{org-global-properties} and @code{org-columns-default-format}.
6398 In particular if you want to use this setup also in the agenda, a global
6399 setup may be advised.
6400
6401 The way to assign estimates to individual items is then to switch to column
6402 mode, and to use @kbd{S-@key{right}} and @kbd{S-@key{left}} to change the
6403 value. The values you enter will immediately be summed up in the hierarchy.
6404 In the column next to it, any clocked time will be displayed.
6405
6406 @vindex org-agenda-columns-add-appointments-to-effort-sum
6407 If you switch to column view in the daily/weekly agenda, the effort column
6408 will summarize the estimated work effort for each day@footnote{Please note
6409 the pitfalls of summing hierarchical data in a flat list (@pxref{Agenda
6410 column view}).}, and you can use this to find space in your schedule. To get
6411 an overview of the entire part of the day that is committed, you can set the
6412 option @code{org-agenda-columns-add-appointments-to-effort-sum}. The
6413 appointments on a day that take place over a specified time interval will
6414 then also be added to the load estimate of the day.
6415
6416 Effort estimates can be used in secondary agenda filtering that is triggered
6417 with the @kbd{/} key in the agenda (@pxref{Agenda commands}). If you have
6418 these estimates defined consistently, two or three key presses will narrow
6419 down the list to stuff that fits into an available time slot.
6420
6421 @node Relative timer, Countdown timer, Effort estimates, Dates and Times
6422 @section Taking notes with a relative timer
6423 @cindex relative timer
6424
6425 When taking notes during, for example, a meeting or a video viewing, it can
6426 be useful to have access to times relative to a starting time. Org provides
6427 such a relative timer and make it easy to create timed notes.
6428
6429 @table @kbd
6430 @orgcmd{C-c C-x .,org-timer}
6431 Insert a relative time into the buffer. The first time you use this, the
6432 timer will be started. When called with a prefix argument, the timer is
6433 restarted.
6434 @orgcmd{C-c C-x -,org-timer-item}
6435 Insert a description list item with the current relative time. With a prefix
6436 argument, first reset the timer to 0.
6437 @orgcmd{M-@key{RET},org-insert-heading}
6438 Once the timer list is started, you can also use @kbd{M-@key{RET}} to insert
6439 new timer items.
6440 @c for key sequences with a comma, command name macros fail :(
6441 @kindex C-c C-x ,
6442 @item C-c C-x ,
6443 Pause the timer, or continue it if it is already paused
6444 (@command{org-timer-pause-or-continue}).
6445 @c removed the sentence because it is redundant to the following item
6446 @kindex C-u C-c C-x ,
6447 @item C-u C-c C-x ,
6448 Stop the timer. After this, you can only start a new timer, not continue the
6449 old one. This command also removes the timer from the mode line.
6450 @orgcmd{C-c C-x 0,org-timer-start}
6451 Reset the timer without inserting anything into the buffer. By default, the
6452 timer is reset to 0. When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix, reset the timer to
6453 specific starting offset. The user is prompted for the offset, with a
6454 default taken from a timer string at point, if any, So this can be used to
6455 restart taking notes after a break in the process. When called with a double
6456 prefix argument @kbd{C-u C-u}, change all timer strings in the active region
6457 by a certain amount. This can be used to fix timer strings if the timer was
6458 not started at exactly the right moment.
6459 @end table
6460
6461 @node Countdown timer, , Relative timer, Dates and Times
6462 @section Countdown timer
6463 @cindex Countdown timer
6464 @kindex C-c C-x ;
6465 @kindex ;
6466
6467 Calling @code{org-timer-set-timer} from an Org mode buffer runs a countdown
6468 timer. Use @kbd{;} from agenda buffers, @key{C-c C-x ;} everywhere else.
6469
6470 @code{org-timer-set-timer} prompts the user for a duration and displays a
6471 countdown timer in the modeline. @code{org-timer-default-timer} sets the
6472 default countdown value. Giving a prefix numeric argument overrides this
6473 default value.
6474
6475 @node Capture - Refile - Archive, Agenda Views, Dates and Times, Top
6476 @chapter Capture - Refile - Archive
6477 @cindex capture
6478
6479 An important part of any organization system is the ability to quickly
6480 capture new ideas and tasks, and to associate reference material with them.
6481 Org does this using a process called @i{capture}. It also can store files
6482 related to a task (@i{attachments}) in a special directory. Once in the
6483 system, tasks and projects need to be moved around. Moving completed project
6484 trees to an archive file keeps the system compact and fast.
6485
6486 @menu
6487 * Capture:: Capturing new stuff
6488 * Attachments:: Add files to tasks
6489 * RSS Feeds:: Getting input from RSS feeds
6490 * Protocols:: External (e.g., Browser) access to Emacs and Org
6491 * Refiling notes:: Moving a tree from one place to another
6492 * Archiving:: What to do with finished projects
6493 @end menu
6494
6495 @node Capture, Attachments, Capture - Refile - Archive, Capture - Refile - Archive
6496 @section Capture
6497 @cindex capture
6498
6499 Org's method for capturing new items is heavily inspired by John Wiegley
6500 excellent remember package. Up to version 6.36 Org used a special setup
6501 for @file{remember.el}. @file{org-remember.el} is still part of Org mode for
6502 backward compatibility with existing setups. You can find the documentation
6503 for org-remember at @url{http://orgmode.org/org-remember.pdf}.
6504
6505 The new capturing setup described here is preferred and should be used by new
6506 users. To convert your @code{org-remember-templates}, run the command
6507 @example
6508 @kbd{M-x org-capture-import-remember-templates @key{RET}}
6509 @end example
6510 @noindent and then customize the new variable with @kbd{M-x
6511 customize-variable org-capture-templates}, check the result, and save the
6512 customization. You can then use both remember and capture until
6513 you are familiar with the new mechanism.
6514
6515 Capture lets you quickly store notes with little interruption of your work
6516 flow. The basic process of capturing is very similar to remember, but Org
6517 does enhance it with templates and more.
6518
6519 @menu
6520 * Setting up capture:: Where notes will be stored
6521 * Using capture:: Commands to invoke and terminate capture
6522 * Capture templates:: Define the outline of different note types
6523 @end menu
6524
6525 @node Setting up capture, Using capture, Capture, Capture
6526 @subsection Setting up capture
6527
6528 The following customization sets a default target file for notes, and defines
6529 a global key@footnote{Please select your own key, @kbd{C-c c} is only a
6530 suggestion.} for capturing new material.
6531
6532 @vindex org-default-notes-file
6533 @example
6534 (setq org-default-notes-file (concat org-directory "/notes.org"))
6535 (define-key global-map "\C-cc" 'org-capture)
6536 @end example
6537
6538 @node Using capture, Capture templates, Setting up capture, Capture
6539 @subsection Using capture
6540
6541 @table @kbd
6542 @orgcmd{C-c c,org-capture}
6543 Call the command @code{org-capture}. Note that this keybinding is global and
6544 not active by default - you need to install it. If you have templates
6545 @cindex date tree
6546 defined @pxref{Capture templates}, it will offer these templates for
6547 selection or use a new Org outline node as the default template. It will
6548 insert the template into the target file and switch to an indirect buffer
6549 narrowed to this new node. You may then insert the information you want.
6550
6551 @orgcmd{C-c C-c,org-capture-finalize}
6552 Once you have finished entering information into the capture buffer, @kbd{C-c
6553 C-c} will return you to the window configuration before the capture process,
6554 so that you can resume your work without further distraction. When called
6555 with a prefix arg, finalize and then jump to the captured item.
6556
6557 @orgcmd{C-c C-w,org-capture-refile}
6558 Finalize the capture process by refiling (@pxref{Refiling notes}) the note to
6559 a different place. Please realize that this is a normal refiling command
6560 that will be executed---so the cursor position at the moment you run this
6561 command is important. If you have inserted a tree with a parent and
6562 children, first move the cursor back to the parent. Any prefix argument
6563 given to this command will be passed on to the @code{org-refile} command.
6564
6565 @orgcmd{C-c C-k,org-capture-kill}
6566 Abort the capture process and return to the previous state.
6567
6568 @end table
6569
6570 You can also call @code{org-capture} in a special way from the agenda, using
6571 the @kbd{k c} key combination. With this access, any timestamps inserted by
6572 the selected capture template will default to the cursor date in the agenda,
6573 rather than to the current date.
6574
6575 To find the locations of the last stored capture, use @code{org-capture} with
6576 prefix commands:
6577
6578 @table @kbd
6579 @orgkey{C-u C-c c}
6580 Visit the target location of a capture template. You get to select the
6581 template in the usual way.
6582 @orgkey{C-u C-u C-c c}
6583 Visit the last stored capture item in its buffer.
6584 @end table
6585
6586 @vindex org-capture-bookmark
6587 @cindex org-capture-last-stored
6588 You can also jump to the bookmark @code{org-capture-last-stored}, which will
6589 automatically be created unless you set @code{org-capture-bookmark} to
6590 @code{nil}.
6591
6592 To insert the capture at point in an Org buffer, call @code{org-capture} with
6593 a @code{C-0} prefix argument.
6594
6595 @node Capture templates, , Using capture, Capture
6596 @subsection Capture templates
6597 @cindex templates, for Capture
6598
6599 You can use templates for different types of capture items, and
6600 for different target locations. The easiest way to create such templates is
6601 through the customize interface.
6602
6603 @table @kbd
6604 @orgkey{C-c c C}
6605 Customize the variable @code{org-capture-templates}.
6606 @end table
6607
6608 Before we give the formal description of template definitions, let's look at
6609 an example. Say you would like to use one template to create general TODO
6610 entries, and you want to put these entries under the heading @samp{Tasks} in
6611 your file @file{~/org/gtd.org}. Also, a date tree in the file
6612 @file{journal.org} should capture journal entries. A possible configuration
6613 would look like:
6614
6615 @example
6616 (setq org-capture-templates
6617 '(("t" "Todo" entry (file+headline "~/org/gtd.org" "Tasks")
6618 "* TODO %?\n %i\n %a")
6619 ("j" "Journal" entry (file+datetree "~/org/journal.org")
6620 "* %?\nEntered on %U\n %i\n %a")))
6621 @end example
6622
6623 @noindent If you then press @kbd{C-c c t}, Org will prepare the template
6624 for you like this:
6625 @example
6626 * TODO
6627 [[file:@var{link to where you initiated capture}]]
6628 @end example
6629
6630 @noindent
6631 During expansion of the template, @code{%a} has been replaced by a link to
6632 the location from where you called the capture command. This can be
6633 extremely useful for deriving tasks from emails, for example. You fill in
6634 the task definition, press @code{C-c C-c} and Org returns you to the same
6635 place where you started the capture process.
6636
6637 To define special keys to capture to a particular template without going
6638 through the interactive template selection, you can create your key binding
6639 like this:
6640
6641 @lisp
6642 (define-key global-map "\C-cx"
6643 (lambda () (interactive) (org-capture nil "x")))
6644 @end lisp
6645
6646 @menu
6647 * Template elements:: What is needed for a complete template entry
6648 * Template expansion:: Filling in information about time and context
6649 * Templates in contexts:: Only show a template in a specific context
6650 @end menu
6651
6652 @node Template elements, Template expansion, Capture templates, Capture templates
6653 @subsubsection Template elements
6654
6655 Now lets look at the elements of a template definition. Each entry in
6656 @code{org-capture-templates} is a list with the following items:
6657
6658 @table @var
6659 @item keys
6660 The keys that will select the template, as a string, characters
6661 only, for example @code{"a"} for a template to be selected with a
6662 single key, or @code{"bt"} for selection with two keys. When using
6663 several keys, keys using the same prefix key must be sequential
6664 in the list and preceded by a 2-element entry explaining the
6665 prefix key, for example
6666 @example
6667 ("b" "Templates for marking stuff to buy")
6668 @end example
6669 @noindent If you do not define a template for the @kbd{C} key, this key will
6670 be used to open the customize buffer for this complex variable.
6671
6672 @item description
6673 A short string describing the template, which will be shown during
6674 selection.
6675
6676 @item type
6677 The type of entry, a symbol. Valid values are:
6678 @table @code
6679 @item entry
6680 An Org mode node, with a headline. Will be filed as the child of the target
6681 entry or as a top-level entry. The target file should be an Org mode file.
6682 @item item
6683 A plain list item, placed in the first plain list at the target
6684 location. Again the target file should be an Org file.
6685 @item checkitem
6686 A checkbox item. This only differs from the plain list item by the
6687 default template.
6688 @item table-line
6689 a new line in the first table at the target location. Where exactly the
6690 line will be inserted depends on the properties @code{:prepend} and
6691 @code{:table-line-pos} (see below).
6692 @item plain
6693 Text to be inserted as it is.
6694 @end table
6695
6696 @item target
6697 @vindex org-default-notes-file
6698 Specification of where the captured item should be placed. In Org mode
6699 files, targets usually define a node. Entries will become children of this
6700 node. Other types will be added to the table or list in the body of this
6701 node. Most target specifications contain a file name. If that file name is
6702 the empty string, it defaults to @code{org-default-notes-file}. A file can
6703 also be given as a variable, function, or Emacs Lisp form.
6704
6705 Valid values are:
6706 @table @code
6707 @item (file "path/to/file")
6708 Text will be placed at the beginning or end of that file.
6709
6710 @item (id "id of existing org entry")
6711 Filing as child of this entry, or in the body of the entry.
6712
6713 @item (file+headline "path/to/file" "node headline")
6714 Fast configuration if the target heading is unique in the file.
6715
6716 @item (file+olp "path/to/file" "Level 1 heading" "Level 2" ...)
6717 For non-unique headings, the full path is safer.
6718
6719 @item (file+regexp "path/to/file" "regexp to find location")
6720 Use a regular expression to position the cursor.
6721
6722 @item (file+datetree "path/to/file")
6723 Will create a heading in a date tree for today's date.
6724
6725 @item (file+datetree+prompt "path/to/file")
6726 Will create a heading in a date tree, but will prompt for the date.
6727
6728 @item (file+function "path/to/file" function-finding-location)
6729 A function to find the right location in the file.
6730
6731 @item (clock)
6732 File to the entry that is currently being clocked.
6733
6734 @item (function function-finding-location)
6735 Most general way, write your own function to find both
6736 file and location.
6737 @end table
6738
6739 @item template
6740 The template for creating the capture item. If you leave this empty, an
6741 appropriate default template will be used. Otherwise this is a string with
6742 escape codes, which will be replaced depending on time and context of the
6743 capture call. The string with escapes may be loaded from a template file,
6744 using the special syntax @code{(file "path/to/template")}. See below for
6745 more details.
6746
6747 @item properties
6748 The rest of the entry is a property list of additional options.
6749 Recognized properties are:
6750 @table @code
6751 @item :prepend
6752 Normally new captured information will be appended at
6753 the target location (last child, last table line, last list item...).
6754 Setting this property will change that.
6755
6756 @item :immediate-finish
6757 When set, do not offer to edit the information, just
6758 file it away immediately. This makes sense if the template only needs
6759 information that can be added automatically.
6760
6761 @item :empty-lines
6762 Set this to the number of lines to insert
6763 before and after the new item. Default 0, only common other value is 1.
6764
6765 @item :clock-in
6766 Start the clock in this item.
6767
6768 @item :clock-keep
6769 Keep the clock running when filing the captured entry.
6770
6771 @item :clock-resume
6772 If starting the capture interrupted a clock, restart that clock when finished
6773 with the capture. Note that @code{:clock-keep} has precedence over
6774 @code{:clock-resume}. When setting both to @code{t}, the current clock will
6775 run and the previous one will not be resumed.
6776
6777 @item :unnarrowed
6778 Do not narrow the target buffer, simply show the full buffer. Default is to
6779 narrow it so that you only see the new material.
6780
6781 @item :table-line-pos
6782 Specification of the location in the table where the new line should be
6783 inserted. It should be a string like @code{"II-3"} meaning that the new
6784 line should become the third line before the second horizontal separator
6785 line.
6786
6787 @item :kill-buffer
6788 If the target file was not yet visited when capture was invoked, kill the
6789 buffer again after capture is completed.
6790 @end table
6791 @end table
6792
6793 @node Template expansion, Templates in contexts, Template elements, Capture templates
6794 @subsubsection Template expansion
6795
6796 In the template itself, special @kbd{%}-escapes@footnote{If you need one of
6797 these sequences literally, escape the @kbd{%} with a backslash.} allow
6798 dynamic insertion of content. The templates are expanded in the order given here:
6799
6800 @smallexample
6801 %[@var{file}] @r{Insert the contents of the file given by @var{file}.}
6802 %(@var{sexp}) @r{Evaluate Elisp @var{sexp} and replace with the result.}
6803 @r{The sexp must return a string.}
6804 %<...> @r{The result of format-time-string on the ... format specification.}
6805 %t @r{Timestamp, date only.}
6806 %T @r{Timestamp, with date and time.}
6807 %u, %U @r{Like the above, but inactive timestamps.}
6808 %i @r{Initial content, the region when capture is called while the}
6809 @r{region is active.}
6810 @r{The entire text will be indented like @code{%i} itself.}
6811 %a @r{Annotation, normally the link created with @code{org-store-link}.}
6812 %A @r{Like @code{%a}, but prompt for the description part.}
6813 %l @r{Like %a, but only insert the literal link.}
6814 %c @r{Current kill ring head.}
6815 %x @r{Content of the X clipboard.}
6816 %k @r{Title of the currently clocked task.}
6817 %K @r{Link to the currently clocked task.}
6818 %n @r{User name (taken from @code{user-full-name}).}
6819 %f @r{File visited by current buffer when org-capture was called.}
6820 %F @r{Full path of the file or directory visited by current buffer.}
6821 %:keyword @r{Specific information for certain link types, see below.}
6822 %^g @r{Prompt for tags, with completion on tags in target file.}
6823 %^G @r{Prompt for tags, with completion all tags in all agenda files.}
6824 %^t @r{Like @code{%t}, but prompt for date. Similarly @code{%^T}, @code{%^u}, @code{%^U}.}
6825 @r{You may define a prompt like @code{%^@{Birthday@}t}.}
6826 %^C @r{Interactive selection of which kill or clip to use.}
6827 %^L @r{Like @code{%^C}, but insert as link.}
6828 %^@{@var{prop}@}p @r{Prompt the user for a value for property @var{prop}.}
6829 %^@{@var{prompt}@} @r{prompt the user for a string and replace this sequence with it.}
6830 @r{You may specify a default value and a completion table with}
6831 @r{%^@{prompt|default|completion2|completion3...@}.}
6832 @r{The arrow keys access a prompt-specific history.}
6833 %\n @r{Insert the text entered at the nth %^@{@var{prompt}@}, where @code{n} is}
6834 @r{a number, starting from 1.}
6835 %? @r{After completing the template, position cursor here.}
6836 @end smallexample
6837
6838 @noindent
6839 For specific link types, the following keywords will be
6840 defined@footnote{If you define your own link types (@pxref{Adding
6841 hyperlink types}), any property you store with
6842 @code{org-store-link-props} can be accessed in capture templates in a
6843 similar way.}:
6844
6845 @vindex org-from-is-user-regexp
6846 @smallexample
6847 Link type | Available keywords
6848 ---------------------------------+----------------------------------------------
6849 bbdb | %:name %:company
6850 irc | %:server %:port %:nick
6851 vm, vm-imap, wl, mh, mew, rmail | %:type %:subject %:message-id
6852 | %:from %:fromname %:fromaddress
6853 | %:to %:toname %:toaddress
6854 | %:date @r{(message date header field)}
6855 | %:date-timestamp @r{(date as active timestamp)}
6856 | %:date-timestamp-inactive @r{(date as inactive timestamp)}
6857 | %:fromto @r{(either "to NAME" or "from NAME")@footnote{This will always be the other, not the user. See the variable @code{org-from-is-user-regexp}.}}
6858 gnus | %:group, @r{for messages also all email fields}
6859 w3, w3m | %:url
6860 info | %:file %:node
6861 calendar | %:date
6862 @end smallexample
6863
6864 @noindent
6865 To place the cursor after template expansion use:
6866
6867 @smallexample
6868 %? @r{After completing the template, position cursor here.}
6869 @end smallexample
6870
6871 @node Templates in contexts, , Template expansion, Capture templates
6872 @subsubsection Templates in contexts
6873
6874 @vindex org-capture-templates-contexts
6875 To control whether a capture template should be accessible from a specific
6876 context, you can customize @var{org-capture-templates-contexts}. Let's say
6877 for example that you have a capture template @code{"p"} for storing Gnus
6878 emails containing patches. Then you would configure this option like this:
6879
6880 @example
6881 (setq org-capture-templates-contexts
6882 '(("p" (in-mode . "message-mode"))))
6883 @end example
6884
6885 You can also tell that the command key @code{"p"} should refer to another
6886 template. In that case, add this command key like this:
6887
6888 @example
6889 (setq org-capture-templates-contexts
6890 '(("p" "q" (in-mode . "message-mode"))))
6891 @end example
6892
6893 See the docstring of the variable for more information.
6894
6895 @node Attachments, RSS Feeds, Capture, Capture - Refile - Archive
6896 @section Attachments
6897 @cindex attachments
6898
6899 @vindex org-attach-directory
6900 It is often useful to associate reference material with an outline node/task.
6901 Small chunks of plain text can simply be stored in the subtree of a project.
6902 Hyperlinks (@pxref{Hyperlinks}) can establish associations with
6903 files that live elsewhere on your computer or in the cloud, like emails or
6904 source code files belonging to a project. Another method is @i{attachments},
6905 which are files located in a directory belonging to an outline node. Org
6906 uses directories named by the unique ID of each entry. These directories are
6907 located in the @file{data} directory which lives in the same directory where
6908 your Org file lives@footnote{If you move entries or Org files from one
6909 directory to another, you may want to configure @code{org-attach-directory}
6910 to contain an absolute path.}. If you initialize this directory with
6911 @code{git init}, Org will automatically commit changes when it sees them.
6912 The attachment system has been contributed to Org by John Wiegley.
6913
6914 In cases where it seems better to do so, you can also attach a directory of your
6915 choice to an entry. You can also make children inherit the attachment
6916 directory from a parent, so that an entire subtree uses the same attached
6917 directory.
6918
6919 @noindent The following commands deal with attachments:
6920
6921 @table @kbd
6922
6923 @orgcmd{C-c C-a,org-attach}
6924 The dispatcher for commands related to the attachment system. After these
6925 keys, a list of commands is displayed and you must press an additional key
6926 to select a command:
6927
6928 @table @kbd
6929 @orgcmdtkc{a,C-c C-a a,org-attach-attach}
6930 @vindex org-attach-method
6931 Select a file and move it into the task's attachment directory. The file
6932 will be copied, moved, or linked, depending on @code{org-attach-method}.
6933 Note that hard links are not supported on all systems.
6934
6935 @kindex C-c C-a c
6936 @kindex C-c C-a m
6937 @kindex C-c C-a l
6938 @item c/m/l
6939 Attach a file using the copy/move/link method.
6940 Note that hard links are not supported on all systems.
6941
6942 @orgcmdtkc{n,C-c C-a n,org-attach-new}
6943 Create a new attachment as an Emacs buffer.
6944
6945 @orgcmdtkc{z,C-c C-a z,org-attach-sync}
6946 Synchronize the current task with its attachment directory, in case you added
6947 attachments yourself.
6948
6949 @orgcmdtkc{o,C-c C-a o,org-attach-open}
6950 @vindex org-file-apps
6951 Open current task's attachment. If there is more than one, prompt for a
6952 file name first. Opening will follow the rules set by @code{org-file-apps}.
6953 For more details, see the information on following hyperlinks
6954 (@pxref{Handling links}).
6955
6956 @orgcmdtkc{O,C-c C-a O,org-attach-open-in-emacs}
6957 Also open the attachment, but force opening the file in Emacs.
6958
6959 @orgcmdtkc{f,C-c C-a f,org-attach-reveal}
6960 Open the current task's attachment directory.
6961
6962 @orgcmdtkc{F,C-c C-a F,org-attach-reveal-in-emacs}
6963 Also open the directory, but force using @command{dired} in Emacs.
6964
6965 @orgcmdtkc{d,C-c C-a d,org-attach-delete-one}
6966 Select and delete a single attachment.
6967
6968 @orgcmdtkc{D,C-c C-a D,org-attach-delete-all}
6969 Delete all of a task's attachments. A safer way is to open the directory in
6970 @command{dired} and delete from there.
6971
6972 @orgcmdtkc{s,C-c C-a s,org-attach-set-directory}
6973 @cindex property, ATTACH_DIR
6974 Set a specific directory as the entry's attachment directory. This works by
6975 putting the directory path into the @code{ATTACH_DIR} property.
6976
6977 @orgcmdtkc{i,C-c C-a i,org-attach-set-inherit}
6978 @cindex property, ATTACH_DIR_INHERIT
6979 Set the @code{ATTACH_DIR_INHERIT} property, so that children will use the
6980 same directory for attachments as the parent does.
6981 @end table
6982 @end table
6983
6984 @node RSS Feeds, Protocols, Attachments, Capture - Refile - Archive
6985 @section RSS feeds
6986 @cindex RSS feeds
6987 @cindex Atom feeds
6988
6989 Org can add and change entries based on information found in RSS feeds and
6990 Atom feeds. You could use this to make a task out of each new podcast in a
6991 podcast feed. Or you could use a phone-based note-creating service on the
6992 web to import tasks into Org. To access feeds, configure the variable
6993 @code{org-feed-alist}. The docstring of this variable has detailed
6994 information. Here is just an example:
6995
6996 @example
6997 (setq org-feed-alist
6998 '(("Slashdot"
6999 "http://rss.slashdot.org/Slashdot/slashdot"
7000 "~/txt/org/feeds.org" "Slashdot Entries")))
7001 @end example
7002
7003 @noindent
7004 will configure that new items from the feed provided by
7005 @code{rss.slashdot.org} will result in new entries in the file
7006 @file{~/org/feeds.org} under the heading @samp{Slashdot Entries}, whenever
7007 the following command is used:
7008
7009 @table @kbd
7010 @orgcmd{C-c C-x g,org-feed-update-all}
7011 @item C-c C-x g
7012 Collect items from the feeds configured in @code{org-feed-alist} and act upon
7013 them.
7014 @orgcmd{C-c C-x G,org-feed-goto-inbox}
7015 Prompt for a feed name and go to the inbox configured for this feed.
7016 @end table
7017
7018 Under the same headline, Org will create a drawer @samp{FEEDSTATUS} in which
7019 it will store information about the status of items in the feed, to avoid
7020 adding the same item several times. You should add @samp{FEEDSTATUS} to the
7021 list of drawers in that file:
7022
7023 @example
7024 #+DRAWERS: LOGBOOK PROPERTIES FEEDSTATUS
7025 @end example
7026
7027 For more information, including how to read atom feeds, see
7028 @file{org-feed.el} and the docstring of @code{org-feed-alist}.
7029
7030 @node Protocols, Refiling notes, RSS Feeds, Capture - Refile - Archive
7031 @section Protocols for external access
7032 @cindex protocols, for external access
7033 @cindex emacsserver
7034
7035 You can set up Org for handling protocol calls from outside applications that
7036 are passed to Emacs through the @file{emacsserver}. For example, you can
7037 configure bookmarks in your web browser to send a link to the current page to
7038 Org and create a note from it using capture (@pxref{Capture}). Or you
7039 could create a bookmark that will tell Emacs to open the local source file of
7040 a remote website you are looking at with the browser. See
7041 @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-contrib/org-protocol.php} for detailed
7042 documentation and setup instructions.
7043
7044 @node Refiling notes, Archiving, Protocols, Capture - Refile - Archive
7045 @section Refiling notes
7046 @cindex refiling notes
7047
7048 When reviewing the captured data, you may want to refile some of the entries
7049 into a different list, for example into a project. Cutting, finding the
7050 right location, and then pasting the note is cumbersome. To simplify this
7051 process, you can use the following special command:
7052
7053 @table @kbd
7054 @orgcmd{C-c C-w,org-refile}
7055 @vindex org-reverse-note-order
7056 @vindex org-refile-targets
7057 @vindex org-refile-use-outline-path
7058 @vindex org-outline-path-complete-in-steps
7059 @vindex org-refile-allow-creating-parent-nodes
7060 @vindex org-log-refile
7061 @vindex org-refile-use-cache
7062 Refile the entry or region at point. This command offers possible locations
7063 for refiling the entry and lets you select one with completion. The item (or
7064 all items in the region) is filed below the target heading as a subitem.
7065 Depending on @code{org-reverse-note-order}, it will be either the first or
7066 last subitem.@*
7067 By default, all level 1 headlines in the current buffer are considered to be
7068 targets, but you can have more complex definitions across a number of files.
7069 See the variable @code{org-refile-targets} for details. If you would like to
7070 select a location via a file-path-like completion along the outline path, see
7071 the variables @code{org-refile-use-outline-path} and
7072 @code{org-outline-path-complete-in-steps}. If you would like to be able to
7073 create new nodes as new parents for refiling on the fly, check the
7074 variable @code{org-refile-allow-creating-parent-nodes}.
7075 When the variable @code{org-log-refile}@footnote{with corresponding
7076 @code{#+STARTUP} keywords @code{logrefile}, @code{lognoterefile},
7077 and @code{nologrefile}} is set, a timestamp or a note will be
7078 recorded when an entry has been refiled.
7079 @orgkey{C-u C-c C-w}
7080 Use the refile interface to jump to a heading.
7081 @orgcmd{C-u C-u C-c C-w,org-refile-goto-last-stored}
7082 Jump to the location where @code{org-refile} last moved a tree to.
7083 @item C-2 C-c C-w
7084 Refile as the child of the item currently being clocked.
7085 @orgcmdtkc{C-0 C-c C-w @ @r{or} @ C-u C-u C-u C-c C-w,C-0 C-c C-w,org-refile-cache-clear}
7086 Clear the target cache. Caching of refile targets can be turned on by
7087 setting @code{org-refile-use-cache}. To make the command see new possible
7088 targets, you have to clear the cache with this command.
7089 @end table
7090
7091 @node Archiving, , Refiling notes, Capture - Refile - Archive
7092 @section Archiving
7093 @cindex archiving
7094
7095 When a project represented by a (sub)tree is finished, you may want
7096 to move the tree out of the way and to stop it from contributing to the
7097 agenda. Archiving is important to keep your working files compact and global
7098 searches like the construction of agenda views fast.
7099
7100 @table @kbd
7101 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-a,org-archive-subtree-default}
7102 @vindex org-archive-default-command
7103 Archive the current entry using the command specified in the variable
7104 @code{org-archive-default-command}.
7105 @end table
7106
7107 @menu
7108 * Moving subtrees:: Moving a tree to an archive file
7109 * Internal archiving:: Switch off a tree but keep it in the file
7110 @end menu
7111
7112 @node Moving subtrees, Internal archiving, Archiving, Archiving
7113 @subsection Moving a tree to the archive file
7114 @cindex external archiving
7115
7116 The most common archiving action is to move a project tree to another file,
7117 the archive file.
7118
7119 @table @kbd
7120 @orgcmdkskc{C-c C-x C-s,C-c $,org-archive-subtree}
7121 @vindex org-archive-location
7122 Archive the subtree starting at the cursor position to the location
7123 given by @code{org-archive-location}.
7124 @orgkey{C-u C-c C-x C-s}
7125 Check if any direct children of the current headline could be moved to
7126 the archive. To do this, each subtree is checked for open TODO entries.
7127 If none are found, the command offers to move it to the archive
7128 location. If the cursor is @emph{not} on a headline when this command
7129 is invoked, the level 1 trees will be checked.
7130 @end table
7131
7132 @cindex archive locations
7133 The default archive location is a file in the same directory as the
7134 current file, with the name derived by appending @file{_archive} to the
7135 current file name. You can also choose what heading to file archived
7136 items under, with the possibility to add them to a datetree in a file.
7137 For information and examples on how to specify the file and the heading,
7138 see the documentation string of the variable
7139 @code{org-archive-location}.
7140
7141 There is also an in-buffer option for setting this variable, for
7142 example@footnote{For backward compatibility, the following also works:
7143 If there are several such lines in a file, each specifies the archive
7144 location for the text below it. The first such line also applies to any
7145 text before its definition. However, using this method is
7146 @emph{strongly} deprecated as it is incompatible with the outline
7147 structure of the document. The correct method for setting multiple
7148 archive locations in a buffer is using properties.}:
7149
7150 @cindex #+ARCHIVE
7151 @example
7152 #+ARCHIVE: %s_done::
7153 @end example
7154
7155 @cindex property, ARCHIVE
7156 @noindent
7157 If you would like to have a special ARCHIVE location for a single entry
7158 or a (sub)tree, give the entry an @code{:ARCHIVE:} property with the
7159 location as the value (@pxref{Properties and Columns}).
7160
7161 @vindex org-archive-save-context-info
7162 When a subtree is moved, it receives a number of special properties that
7163 record context information like the file from where the entry came, its
7164 outline path the archiving time etc. Configure the variable
7165 @code{org-archive-save-context-info} to adjust the amount of information
7166 added.
7167
7168
7169 @node Internal archiving, , Moving subtrees, Archiving
7170 @subsection Internal archiving
7171
7172 If you want to just switch off (for agenda views) certain subtrees without
7173 moving them to a different file, you can use the @code{ARCHIVE tag}.
7174
7175 A headline that is marked with the ARCHIVE tag (@pxref{Tags}) stays at
7176 its location in the outline tree, but behaves in the following way:
7177 @itemize @minus
7178 @item
7179 @vindex org-cycle-open-archived-trees
7180 It does not open when you attempt to do so with a visibility cycling
7181 command (@pxref{Visibility cycling}). You can force cycling archived
7182 subtrees with @kbd{C-@key{TAB}}, or by setting the option
7183 @code{org-cycle-open-archived-trees}. Also normal outline commands like
7184 @code{show-all} will open archived subtrees.
7185 @item
7186 @vindex org-sparse-tree-open-archived-trees
7187 During sparse tree construction (@pxref{Sparse trees}), matches in
7188 archived subtrees are not exposed, unless you configure the option
7189 @code{org-sparse-tree-open-archived-trees}.
7190 @item
7191 @vindex org-agenda-skip-archived-trees
7192 During agenda view construction (@pxref{Agenda Views}), the content of
7193 archived trees is ignored unless you configure the option
7194 @code{org-agenda-skip-archived-trees}, in which case these trees will always
7195 be included. In the agenda you can press @kbd{v a} to get archives
7196 temporarily included.
7197 @item
7198 @vindex org-export-with-archived-trees
7199 Archived trees are not exported (@pxref{Exporting}), only the headline
7200 is. Configure the details using the variable
7201 @code{org-export-with-archived-trees}.
7202 @item
7203 @vindex org-columns-skip-archived-trees
7204 Archived trees are excluded from column view unless the variable
7205 @code{org-columns-skip-archived-trees} is configured to @code{nil}.
7206 @end itemize
7207
7208 The following commands help manage the ARCHIVE tag:
7209
7210 @table @kbd
7211 @orgcmd{C-c C-x a,org-toggle-archive-tag}
7212 Toggle the ARCHIVE tag for the current headline. When the tag is set,
7213 the headline changes to a shadowed face, and the subtree below it is
7214 hidden.
7215 @orgkey{C-u C-c C-x a}
7216 Check if any direct children of the current headline should be archived.
7217 To do this, each subtree is checked for open TODO entries. If none are
7218 found, the command offers to set the ARCHIVE tag for the child. If the
7219 cursor is @emph{not} on a headline when this command is invoked, the
7220 level 1 trees will be checked.
7221 @orgcmd{C-@kbd{TAB},org-force-cycle-archived}
7222 Cycle a tree even if it is tagged with ARCHIVE.
7223 @orgcmd{C-c C-x A,org-archive-to-archive-sibling}
7224 Move the current entry to the @emph{Archive Sibling}. This is a sibling of
7225 the entry with the heading @samp{Archive} and the tag @samp{ARCHIVE}. The
7226 entry becomes a child of that sibling and in this way retains a lot of its
7227 original context, including inherited tags and approximate position in the
7228 outline.
7229 @end table
7230
7231
7232 @node Agenda Views, Markup, Capture - Refile - Archive, Top
7233 @chapter Agenda views
7234 @cindex agenda views
7235
7236 Due to the way Org works, TODO items, time-stamped items, and
7237 tagged headlines can be scattered throughout a file or even a number of
7238 files. To get an overview of open action items, or of events that are
7239 important for a particular date, this information must be collected,
7240 sorted and displayed in an organized way.
7241
7242 Org can select items based on various criteria and display them
7243 in a separate buffer. Seven different view types are provided:
7244
7245 @itemize @bullet
7246 @item
7247 an @emph{agenda} that is like a calendar and shows information
7248 for specific dates,
7249 @item
7250 a @emph{TODO list} that covers all unfinished
7251 action items,
7252 @item
7253 a @emph{match view}, showings headlines based on the tags, properties, and
7254 TODO state associated with them,
7255 @item
7256 a @emph{timeline view} that shows all events in a single Org file,
7257 in time-sorted view,
7258 @item
7259 a @emph{text search view} that shows all entries from multiple files
7260 that contain specified keywords,
7261 @item
7262 a @emph{stuck projects view} showing projects that currently don't move
7263 along, and
7264 @item
7265 @emph{custom views} that are special searches and combinations of different
7266 views.
7267 @end itemize
7268
7269 @noindent
7270 The extracted information is displayed in a special @emph{agenda
7271 buffer}. This buffer is read-only, but provides commands to visit the
7272 corresponding locations in the original Org files, and even to
7273 edit these files remotely.
7274
7275 @vindex org-agenda-window-setup
7276 @vindex org-agenda-restore-windows-after-quit
7277 Two variables control how the agenda buffer is displayed and whether the
7278 window configuration is restored when the agenda exits:
7279 @code{org-agenda-window-setup} and
7280 @code{org-agenda-restore-windows-after-quit}.
7281
7282 @menu
7283 * Agenda files:: Files being searched for agenda information
7284 * Agenda dispatcher:: Keyboard access to agenda views
7285 * Built-in agenda views:: What is available out of the box?
7286 * Presentation and sorting:: How agenda items are prepared for display
7287 * Agenda commands:: Remote editing of Org trees
7288 * Custom agenda views:: Defining special searches and views
7289 * Exporting Agenda Views:: Writing a view to a file
7290 * Agenda column view:: Using column view for collected entries
7291 @end menu
7292
7293 @node Agenda files, Agenda dispatcher, Agenda Views, Agenda Views
7294 @section Agenda files
7295 @cindex agenda files
7296 @cindex files for agenda
7297
7298 @vindex org-agenda-files
7299 The information to be shown is normally collected from all @emph{agenda
7300 files}, the files listed in the variable
7301 @code{org-agenda-files}@footnote{If the value of that variable is not a
7302 list, but a single file name, then the list of agenda files will be
7303 maintained in that external file.}. If a directory is part of this list,
7304 all files with the extension @file{.org} in this directory will be part
7305 of the list.
7306
7307 Thus, even if you only work with a single Org file, that file should
7308 be put into the list@footnote{When using the dispatcher, pressing
7309 @kbd{<} before selecting a command will actually limit the command to
7310 the current file, and ignore @code{org-agenda-files} until the next
7311 dispatcher command.}. You can customize @code{org-agenda-files}, but
7312 the easiest way to maintain it is through the following commands
7313
7314 @cindex files, adding to agenda list
7315 @table @kbd
7316 @orgcmd{C-c [,org-agenda-file-to-front}
7317 Add current file to the list of agenda files. The file is added to
7318 the front of the list. If it was already in the list, it is moved to
7319 the front. With a prefix argument, file is added/moved to the end.
7320 @orgcmd{C-c ],org-remove-file}
7321 Remove current file from the list of agenda files.
7322 @kindex C-,
7323 @cindex cycling, of agenda files
7324 @orgcmd{C-',org-cycle-agenda-files}
7325 @itemx C-,
7326 Cycle through agenda file list, visiting one file after the other.
7327 @kindex M-x org-iswitchb
7328 @item M-x org-iswitchb
7329 Command to use an @code{iswitchb}-like interface to switch to and between Org
7330 buffers.
7331 @end table
7332
7333 @noindent
7334 The Org menu contains the current list of files and can be used
7335 to visit any of them.
7336
7337 If you would like to focus the agenda temporarily on a file not in
7338 this list, or on just one file in the list, or even on only a subtree in a
7339 file, then this can be done in different ways. For a single agenda command,
7340 you may press @kbd{<} once or several times in the dispatcher
7341 (@pxref{Agenda dispatcher}). To restrict the agenda scope for an
7342 extended period, use the following commands:
7343
7344 @table @kbd
7345 @orgcmd{C-c C-x <,org-agenda-set-restriction-lock}
7346 Permanently restrict the agenda to the current subtree. When with a
7347 prefix argument, or with the cursor before the first headline in a file,
7348 the agenda scope is set to the entire file. This restriction remains in
7349 effect until removed with @kbd{C-c C-x >}, or by typing either @kbd{<}
7350 or @kbd{>} in the agenda dispatcher. If there is a window displaying an
7351 agenda view, the new restriction takes effect immediately.
7352 @orgcmd{C-c C-x >,org-agenda-remove-restriction-lock}
7353 Remove the permanent restriction created by @kbd{C-c C-x <}.
7354 @end table
7355
7356 @noindent
7357 When working with @file{speedbar.el}, you can use the following commands in
7358 the Speedbar frame:
7359 @table @kbd
7360 @orgcmdtkc{< @r{in the speedbar frame},<,org-speedbar-set-agenda-restriction}
7361 Permanently restrict the agenda to the item---either an Org file or a subtree
7362 in such a file---at the cursor in the Speedbar frame.
7363 If there is a window displaying an agenda view, the new restriction takes
7364 effect immediately.
7365 @orgcmdtkc{> @r{in the speedbar frame},>,org-agenda-remove-restriction-lock}
7366 Lift the restriction.
7367 @end table
7368
7369 @node Agenda dispatcher, Built-in agenda views, Agenda files, Agenda Views
7370 @section The agenda dispatcher
7371 @cindex agenda dispatcher
7372 @cindex dispatching agenda commands
7373 The views are created through a dispatcher, which should be bound to a
7374 global key---for example @kbd{C-c a} (@pxref{Activation}). In the
7375 following we will assume that @kbd{C-c a} is indeed how the dispatcher
7376 is accessed and list keyboard access to commands accordingly. After
7377 pressing @kbd{C-c a}, an additional letter is required to execute a
7378 command. The dispatcher offers the following default commands:
7379 @table @kbd
7380 @item a
7381 Create the calendar-like agenda (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}).
7382 @item t @r{/} T
7383 Create a list of all TODO items (@pxref{Global TODO list}).
7384 @item m @r{/} M
7385 Create a list of headlines matching a TAGS expression (@pxref{Matching
7386 tags and properties}).
7387 @item L
7388 Create the timeline view for the current buffer (@pxref{Timeline}).
7389 @item s
7390 Create a list of entries selected by a boolean expression of keywords
7391 and/or regular expressions that must or must not occur in the entry.
7392 @item /
7393 @vindex org-agenda-text-search-extra-files
7394 Search for a regular expression in all agenda files and additionally in
7395 the files listed in @code{org-agenda-text-search-extra-files}. This
7396 uses the Emacs command @code{multi-occur}. A prefix argument can be
7397 used to specify the number of context lines for each match, default is
7398 1.
7399 @item # @r{/} !
7400 Create a list of stuck projects (@pxref{Stuck projects}).
7401 @item <
7402 Restrict an agenda command to the current buffer@footnote{For backward
7403 compatibility, you can also press @kbd{1} to restrict to the current
7404 buffer.}. After pressing @kbd{<}, you still need to press the character
7405 selecting the command.
7406 @item < <
7407 If there is an active region, restrict the following agenda command to
7408 the region. Otherwise, restrict it to the current subtree@footnote{For
7409 backward compatibility, you can also press @kbd{0} to restrict to the
7410 current region/subtree.}. After pressing @kbd{< <}, you still need to press the
7411 character selecting the command.
7412
7413 @item *
7414 @vindex org-agenda-sticky
7415 Toggle sticky agenda views. By default, Org maintains only a single agenda
7416 buffer and rebuilds it each time you change the view, to make sure everything
7417 is always up to date. If you switch between views often and the build time
7418 bothers you, you can turn on sticky agenda buffers (make this the default by
7419 customizing the variable @code{org-agenda-sticky}). With sticky agendas, the
7420 dispatcher only switches to the selected view, you need to update it by hand
7421 with @kbd{r} or @kbd{g}. You can toggle sticky agenda view any time with
7422 @code{org-toggle-sticky-agenda}.
7423 @end table
7424
7425 You can also define custom commands that will be accessible through the
7426 dispatcher, just like the default commands. This includes the
7427 possibility to create extended agenda buffers that contain several
7428 blocks together, for example the weekly agenda, the global TODO list and
7429 a number of special tags matches. @xref{Custom agenda views}.
7430
7431 @node Built-in agenda views, Presentation and sorting, Agenda dispatcher, Agenda Views
7432 @section The built-in agenda views
7433
7434 In this section we describe the built-in views.
7435
7436 @menu
7437 * Weekly/daily agenda:: The calendar page with current tasks
7438 * Global TODO list:: All unfinished action items
7439 * Matching tags and properties:: Structured information with fine-tuned search
7440 * Timeline:: Time-sorted view for single file
7441 * Search view:: Find entries by searching for text
7442 * Stuck projects:: Find projects you need to review
7443 @end menu
7444
7445 @node Weekly/daily agenda, Global TODO list, Built-in agenda views, Built-in agenda views
7446 @subsection The weekly/daily agenda
7447 @cindex agenda
7448 @cindex weekly agenda
7449 @cindex daily agenda
7450
7451 The purpose of the weekly/daily @emph{agenda} is to act like a page of a
7452 paper agenda, showing all the tasks for the current week or day.
7453
7454 @table @kbd
7455 @cindex org-agenda, command
7456 @orgcmd{C-c a a,org-agenda-list}
7457 Compile an agenda for the current week from a list of Org files. The agenda
7458 shows the entries for each day. With a numeric prefix@footnote{For backward
7459 compatibility, the universal prefix @kbd{C-u} causes all TODO entries to be
7460 listed before the agenda. This feature is deprecated, use the dedicated TODO
7461 list, or a block agenda instead (@pxref{Block agenda}).} (like @kbd{C-u 2 1
7462 C-c a a}) you may set the number of days to be displayed.
7463 @end table
7464
7465 @vindex org-agenda-span
7466 @vindex org-agenda-ndays
7467 The default number of days displayed in the agenda is set by the variable
7468 @code{org-agenda-span} (or the obsolete @code{org-agenda-ndays}). This
7469 variable can be set to any number of days you want to see by default in the
7470 agenda, or to a span name, such a @code{day}, @code{week}, @code{month} or
7471 @code{year}.
7472
7473 Remote editing from the agenda buffer means, for example, that you can
7474 change the dates of deadlines and appointments from the agenda buffer.
7475 The commands available in the Agenda buffer are listed in @ref{Agenda
7476 commands}.
7477
7478 @subsubheading Calendar/Diary integration
7479 @cindex calendar integration
7480 @cindex diary integration
7481
7482 Emacs contains the calendar and diary by Edward M. Reingold. The
7483 calendar displays a three-month calendar with holidays from different
7484 countries and cultures. The diary allows you to keep track of
7485 anniversaries, lunar phases, sunrise/set, recurrent appointments
7486 (weekly, monthly) and more. In this way, it is quite complementary to
7487 Org. It can be very useful to combine output from Org with
7488 the diary.
7489
7490 In order to include entries from the Emacs diary into Org mode's
7491 agenda, you only need to customize the variable
7492
7493 @lisp
7494 (setq org-agenda-include-diary t)
7495 @end lisp
7496
7497 @noindent After that, everything will happen automatically. All diary
7498 entries including holidays, anniversaries, etc., will be included in the
7499 agenda buffer created by Org mode. @key{SPC}, @key{TAB}, and
7500 @key{RET} can be used from the agenda buffer to jump to the diary
7501 file in order to edit existing diary entries. The @kbd{i} command to
7502 insert new entries for the current date works in the agenda buffer, as
7503 well as the commands @kbd{S}, @kbd{M}, and @kbd{C} to display
7504 Sunrise/Sunset times, show lunar phases and to convert to other
7505 calendars, respectively. @kbd{c} can be used to switch back and forth
7506 between calendar and agenda.
7507
7508 If you are using the diary only for sexp entries and holidays, it is
7509 faster to not use the above setting, but instead to copy or even move
7510 the entries into an Org file. Org mode evaluates diary-style sexp
7511 entries, and does it faster because there is no overhead for first
7512 creating the diary display. Note that the sexp entries must start at
7513 the left margin, no whitespace is allowed before them. For example,
7514 the following segment of an Org file will be processed and entries
7515 will be made in the agenda:
7516
7517 @example
7518 * Birthdays and similar stuff
7519 #+CATEGORY: Holiday
7520 %%(org-calendar-holiday) ; special function for holiday names
7521 #+CATEGORY: Ann
7522 %%(org-anniversary 1956 5 14)@footnote{@code{org-anniversary} is just like @code{diary-anniversary}, but the argument order is always according to ISO and therefore independent of the value of @code{calendar-date-style}.} Arthur Dent is %d years old
7523 %%(org-anniversary 1869 10 2) Mahatma Gandhi would be %d years old
7524 @end example
7525
7526 @subsubheading Anniversaries from BBDB
7527 @cindex BBDB, anniversaries
7528 @cindex anniversaries, from BBDB
7529
7530 If you are using the Big Brothers Database to store your contacts, you will
7531 very likely prefer to store anniversaries in BBDB rather than in a
7532 separate Org or diary file. Org supports this and will show BBDB
7533 anniversaries as part of the agenda. All you need to do is to add the
7534 following to one of your agenda files:
7535
7536 @example
7537 * Anniversaries
7538 :PROPERTIES:
7539 :CATEGORY: Anniv
7540 :END:
7541 %%(org-bbdb-anniversaries)
7542 @end example
7543
7544 You can then go ahead and define anniversaries for a BBDB record. Basically,
7545 you need to press @kbd{C-o anniversary @key{RET}} with the cursor in a BBDB
7546 record and then add the date in the format @code{YYYY-MM-DD} or @code{MM-DD},
7547 followed by a space and the class of the anniversary (@samp{birthday} or
7548 @samp{wedding}, or a format string). If you omit the class, it will default to
7549 @samp{birthday}. Here are a few examples, the header for the file
7550 @file{org-bbdb.el} contains more detailed information.
7551
7552 @example
7553 1973-06-22
7554 06-22
7555 1955-08-02 wedding
7556 2008-04-14 %s released version 6.01 of org mode, %d years ago
7557 @end example
7558
7559 After a change to BBDB, or for the first agenda display during an Emacs
7560 session, the agenda display will suffer a short delay as Org updates its
7561 hash with anniversaries. However, from then on things will be very fast---much
7562 faster in fact than a long list of @samp{%%(diary-anniversary)} entries
7563 in an Org or Diary file.
7564
7565 @subsubheading Appointment reminders
7566 @cindex @file{appt.el}
7567 @cindex appointment reminders
7568 @cindex appointment
7569 @cindex reminders
7570
7571 Org can interact with Emacs appointments notification facility. To add the
7572 appointments of your agenda files, use the command @code{org-agenda-to-appt}.
7573 This command lets you filter through the list of your appointments and add
7574 only those belonging to a specific category or matching a regular expression.
7575 It also reads a @code{APPT_WARNTIME} property which will then override the
7576 value of @code{appt-message-warning-time} for this appointment. See the
7577 docstring for details.
7578
7579 @node Global TODO list, Matching tags and properties, Weekly/daily agenda, Built-in agenda views
7580 @subsection The global TODO list
7581 @cindex global TODO list
7582 @cindex TODO list, global
7583
7584 The global TODO list contains all unfinished TODO items formatted and
7585 collected into a single place.
7586
7587 @table @kbd
7588 @orgcmd{C-c a t,org-todo-list}
7589 Show the global TODO list. This collects the TODO items from all agenda
7590 files (@pxref{Agenda Views}) into a single buffer. By default, this lists
7591 items with a state the is not a DONE state. The buffer is in
7592 @code{agenda-mode}, so there are commands to examine and manipulate the TODO
7593 entries directly from that buffer (@pxref{Agenda commands}).
7594 @orgcmd{C-c a T,org-todo-list}
7595 @cindex TODO keyword matching
7596 @vindex org-todo-keywords
7597 Like the above, but allows selection of a specific TODO keyword. You can
7598 also do this by specifying a prefix argument to @kbd{C-c a t}. You are
7599 prompted for a keyword, and you may also specify several keywords by
7600 separating them with @samp{|} as the boolean OR operator. With a numeric
7601 prefix, the Nth keyword in @code{org-todo-keywords} is selected.
7602 @kindex r
7603 The @kbd{r} key in the agenda buffer regenerates it, and you can give
7604 a prefix argument to this command to change the selected TODO keyword,
7605 for example @kbd{3 r}. If you often need a search for a specific
7606 keyword, define a custom command for it (@pxref{Agenda dispatcher}).@*
7607 Matching specific TODO keywords can also be done as part of a tags
7608 search (@pxref{Tag searches}).
7609 @end table
7610
7611 Remote editing of TODO items means that you can change the state of a
7612 TODO entry with a single key press. The commands available in the
7613 TODO list are described in @ref{Agenda commands}.
7614
7615 @cindex sublevels, inclusion into TODO list
7616 Normally the global TODO list simply shows all headlines with TODO
7617 keywords. This list can become very long. There are two ways to keep
7618 it more compact:
7619 @itemize @minus
7620 @item
7621 @vindex org-agenda-todo-ignore-scheduled
7622 @vindex org-agenda-todo-ignore-deadlines
7623 @vindex org-agenda-todo-ignore-timestamp
7624 @vindex org-agenda-todo-ignore-with-date
7625 Some people view a TODO item that has been @emph{scheduled} for execution or
7626 have a @emph{deadline} (@pxref{Timestamps}) as no longer @emph{open}.
7627 Configure the variables @code{org-agenda-todo-ignore-scheduled},
7628 @code{org-agenda-todo-ignore-deadlines},
7629 @code{org-agenda-todo-ignore-timestamp} and/or
7630 @code{org-agenda-todo-ignore-with-date} to exclude such items from the global
7631 TODO list.
7632 @item
7633 @vindex org-agenda-todo-list-sublevels
7634 TODO items may have sublevels to break up the task into subtasks. In
7635 such cases it may be enough to list only the highest level TODO headline
7636 and omit the sublevels from the global list. Configure the variable
7637 @code{org-agenda-todo-list-sublevels} to get this behavior.
7638 @end itemize
7639
7640 @node Matching tags and properties, Timeline, Global TODO list, Built-in agenda views
7641 @subsection Matching tags and properties
7642 @cindex matching, of tags
7643 @cindex matching, of properties
7644 @cindex tags view
7645 @cindex match view
7646
7647 If headlines in the agenda files are marked with @emph{tags} (@pxref{Tags}),
7648 or have properties (@pxref{Properties and Columns}), you can select headlines
7649 based on this metadata and collect them into an agenda buffer. The match
7650 syntax described here also applies when creating sparse trees with @kbd{C-c /
7651 m}.
7652
7653 @table @kbd
7654 @orgcmd{C-c a m,org-tags-view}
7655 Produce a list of all headlines that match a given set of tags. The
7656 command prompts for a selection criterion, which is a boolean logic
7657 expression with tags, like @samp{+work+urgent-withboss} or
7658 @samp{work|home} (@pxref{Tags}). If you often need a specific search,
7659 define a custom command for it (@pxref{Agenda dispatcher}).
7660 @orgcmd{C-c a M,org-tags-view}
7661 @vindex org-tags-match-list-sublevels
7662 @vindex org-agenda-tags-todo-honor-ignore-options
7663 Like @kbd{C-c a m}, but only select headlines that are also TODO items in a
7664 not-DONE state and force checking subitems (see variable
7665 @code{org-tags-match-list-sublevels}). To exclude scheduled/deadline items,
7666 see the variable @code{org-agenda-tags-todo-honor-ignore-options}. Matching
7667 specific TODO keywords together with a tags match is also possible, see
7668 @ref{Tag searches}.
7669 @end table
7670
7671 The commands available in the tags list are described in @ref{Agenda
7672 commands}.
7673
7674 @subsubheading Match syntax
7675
7676 @cindex Boolean logic, for tag/property searches
7677 A search string can use Boolean operators @samp{&} for AND and @samp{|} for
7678 OR@. @samp{&} binds more strongly than @samp{|}. Parentheses are currently
7679 not implemented. Each element in the search is either a tag, a regular
7680 expression matching tags, or an expression like @code{PROPERTY OPERATOR
7681 VALUE} with a comparison operator, accessing a property value. Each element
7682 may be preceded by @samp{-}, to select against it, and @samp{+} is syntactic
7683 sugar for positive selection. The AND operator @samp{&} is optional when
7684 @samp{+} or @samp{-} is present. Here are some examples, using only tags.
7685
7686 @table @samp
7687 @item +work-boss
7688 Select headlines tagged @samp{:work:}, but discard those also tagged
7689 @samp{:boss:}.
7690 @item work|laptop
7691 Selects lines tagged @samp{:work:} or @samp{:laptop:}.
7692 @item work|laptop+night
7693 Like before, but require the @samp{:laptop:} lines to be tagged also
7694 @samp{:night:}.
7695 @end table
7696
7697 @cindex regular expressions, with tags search
7698 Instead of a tag, you may also specify a regular expression enclosed in curly
7699 braces. For example,
7700 @samp{work+@{^boss.*@}} matches headlines that contain the tag
7701 @samp{:work:} and any tag @i{starting} with @samp{boss}.
7702
7703 @cindex TODO keyword matching, with tags search
7704 @cindex level, require for tags/property match
7705 @cindex category, require for tags/property match
7706 @vindex org-odd-levels-only
7707 You may also test for properties (@pxref{Properties and Columns}) at the same
7708 time as matching tags. The properties may be real properties, or special
7709 properties that represent other metadata (@pxref{Special properties}). For
7710 example, the ``property'' @code{TODO} represents the TODO keyword of the
7711 entry. Or, the ``property'' @code{LEVEL} represents the level of an entry.
7712 So a search @samp{+LEVEL=3+boss-TODO="DONE"} lists all level three headlines
7713 that have the tag @samp{boss} and are @emph{not} marked with the TODO keyword
7714 DONE@. In buffers with @code{org-odd-levels-only} set, @samp{LEVEL} does not
7715 count the number of stars, but @samp{LEVEL=2} will correspond to 3 stars etc.
7716 The ITEM special property cannot currently be used in tags/property
7717 searches@footnote{But @pxref{x-agenda-skip-entry-regexp,
7718 ,skipping entries based on regexp}.}.
7719
7720 Here are more examples:
7721 @table @samp
7722 @item work+TODO="WAITING"
7723 Select @samp{:work:}-tagged TODO lines with the specific TODO
7724 keyword @samp{WAITING}.
7725 @item work+TODO="WAITING"|home+TODO="WAITING"
7726 Waiting tasks both at work and at home.
7727 @end table
7728
7729 When matching properties, a number of different operators can be used to test
7730 the value of a property. Here is a complex example:
7731
7732 @example
7733 +work-boss+PRIORITY="A"+Coffee="unlimited"+Effort<2 \
7734 +With=@{Sarah\|Denny@}+SCHEDULED>="<2008-10-11>"
7735 @end example
7736
7737 @noindent
7738 The type of comparison will depend on how the comparison value is written:
7739 @itemize @minus
7740 @item
7741 If the comparison value is a plain number, a numerical comparison is done,
7742 and the allowed operators are @samp{<}, @samp{=}, @samp{>}, @samp{<=},
7743 @samp{>=}, and @samp{<>}.
7744 @item
7745 If the comparison value is enclosed in double-quotes,
7746 a string comparison is done, and the same operators are allowed.
7747 @item
7748 If the comparison value is enclosed in double-quotes @emph{and} angular
7749 brackets (like @samp{DEADLINE<="<2008-12-24 18:30>"}), both values are
7750 assumed to be date/time specifications in the standard Org way, and the
7751 comparison will be done accordingly. Special values that will be recognized
7752 are @code{"<now>"} for now (including time), and @code{"<today>"}, and
7753 @code{"<tomorrow>"} for these days at 0:00 hours, i.e., without a time
7754 specification. Also strings like @code{"<+5d>"} or @code{"<-2m>"} with units
7755 @code{d}, @code{w}, @code{m}, and @code{y} for day, week, month, and year,
7756 respectively, can be used.
7757 @item
7758 If the comparison value is enclosed
7759 in curly braces, a regexp match is performed, with @samp{=} meaning that the
7760 regexp matches the property value, and @samp{<>} meaning that it does not
7761 match.
7762 @end itemize
7763
7764 So the search string in the example finds entries tagged @samp{:work:} but
7765 not @samp{:boss:}, which also have a priority value @samp{A}, a
7766 @samp{:Coffee:} property with the value @samp{unlimited}, an @samp{Effort}
7767 property that is numerically smaller than 2, a @samp{:With:} property that is
7768 matched by the regular expression @samp{Sarah\|Denny}, and that are scheduled
7769 on or after October 11, 2008.
7770
7771 Accessing TODO, LEVEL, and CATEGORY during a search is fast. Accessing any
7772 other properties will slow down the search. However, once you have paid the
7773 price by accessing one property, testing additional properties is cheap
7774 again.
7775
7776 You can configure Org mode to use property inheritance during a search, but
7777 beware that this can slow down searches considerably. See @ref{Property
7778 inheritance}, for details.
7779
7780 For backward compatibility, and also for typing speed, there is also a
7781 different way to test TODO states in a search. For this, terminate the
7782 tags/property part of the search string (which may include several terms
7783 connected with @samp{|}) with a @samp{/} and then specify a Boolean
7784 expression just for TODO keywords. The syntax is then similar to that for
7785 tags, but should be applied with care: for example, a positive selection on
7786 several TODO keywords cannot meaningfully be combined with boolean AND@.
7787 However, @emph{negative selection} combined with AND can be meaningful. To
7788 make sure that only lines are checked that actually have any TODO keyword
7789 (resulting in a speed-up), use @kbd{C-c a M}, or equivalently start the TODO
7790 part after the slash with @samp{!}. Using @kbd{C-c a M} or @samp{/!} will
7791 not match TODO keywords in a DONE state. Examples:
7792
7793 @table @samp
7794 @item work/WAITING
7795 Same as @samp{work+TODO="WAITING"}
7796 @item work/!-WAITING-NEXT
7797 Select @samp{:work:}-tagged TODO lines that are neither @samp{WAITING}
7798 nor @samp{NEXT}
7799 @item work/!+WAITING|+NEXT
7800 Select @samp{:work:}-tagged TODO lines that are either @samp{WAITING} or
7801 @samp{NEXT}.
7802 @end table
7803
7804 @node Timeline, Search view, Matching tags and properties, Built-in agenda views
7805 @subsection Timeline for a single file
7806 @cindex timeline, single file
7807 @cindex time-sorted view
7808
7809 The timeline summarizes all time-stamped items from a single Org mode
7810 file in a @emph{time-sorted view}. The main purpose of this command is
7811 to give an overview over events in a project.
7812
7813 @table @kbd
7814 @orgcmd{C-c a L,org-timeline}
7815 Show a time-sorted view of the Org file, with all time-stamped items.
7816 When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix, all unfinished TODO entries
7817 (scheduled or not) are also listed under the current date.
7818 @end table
7819
7820 @noindent
7821 The commands available in the timeline buffer are listed in
7822 @ref{Agenda commands}.
7823
7824 @node Search view, Stuck projects, Timeline, Built-in agenda views
7825 @subsection Search view
7826 @cindex search view
7827 @cindex text search
7828 @cindex searching, for text
7829
7830 This agenda view is a general text search facility for Org mode entries.
7831 It is particularly useful to find notes.
7832
7833 @table @kbd
7834 @orgcmd{C-c a s,org-search-view}
7835 This is a special search that lets you select entries by matching a substring
7836 or specific words using a boolean logic.
7837 @end table
7838 For example, the search string @samp{computer equipment} will find entries
7839 that contain @samp{computer equipment} as a substring. If the two words are
7840 separated by more space or a line break, the search will still match.
7841 Search view can also search for specific keywords in the entry, using Boolean
7842 logic. The search string @samp{+computer +wifi -ethernet -@{8\.11[bg]@}}
7843 will search for note entries that contain the keywords @code{computer}
7844 and @code{wifi}, but not the keyword @code{ethernet}, and which are also
7845 not matched by the regular expression @code{8\.11[bg]}, meaning to
7846 exclude both 8.11b and 8.11g. The first @samp{+} is necessary to turn on
7847 word search, other @samp{+} characters are optional. For more details, see
7848 the docstring of the command @code{org-search-view}.
7849
7850 @vindex org-agenda-text-search-extra-files
7851 Note that in addition to the agenda files, this command will also search
7852 the files listed in @code{org-agenda-text-search-extra-files}.
7853
7854 @node Stuck projects, , Search view, Built-in agenda views
7855 @subsection Stuck projects
7856 @pindex GTD, Getting Things Done
7857
7858 If you are following a system like David Allen's GTD to organize your
7859 work, one of the ``duties'' you have is a regular review to make sure
7860 that all projects move along. A @emph{stuck} project is a project that
7861 has no defined next actions, so it will never show up in the TODO lists
7862 Org mode produces. During the review, you need to identify such
7863 projects and define next actions for them.
7864
7865 @table @kbd
7866 @orgcmd{C-c a #,org-agenda-list-stuck-projects}
7867 List projects that are stuck.
7868 @kindex C-c a !
7869 @item C-c a !
7870 @vindex org-stuck-projects
7871 Customize the variable @code{org-stuck-projects} to define what a stuck
7872 project is and how to find it.
7873 @end table
7874
7875 You almost certainly will have to configure this view before it will
7876 work for you. The built-in default assumes that all your projects are
7877 level-2 headlines, and that a project is not stuck if it has at least
7878 one entry marked with a TODO keyword TODO or NEXT or NEXTACTION.
7879
7880 Let's assume that you, in your own way of using Org mode, identify
7881 projects with a tag PROJECT, and that you use a TODO keyword MAYBE to
7882 indicate a project that should not be considered yet. Let's further
7883 assume that the TODO keyword DONE marks finished projects, and that NEXT
7884 and TODO indicate next actions. The tag @@SHOP indicates shopping and
7885 is a next action even without the NEXT tag. Finally, if the project
7886 contains the special word IGNORE anywhere, it should not be listed
7887 either. In this case you would start by identifying eligible projects
7888 with a tags/todo match@footnote{@xref{Tag searches}.}
7889 @samp{+PROJECT/-MAYBE-DONE}, and then check for TODO, NEXT, @@SHOP, and
7890 IGNORE in the subtree to identify projects that are not stuck. The
7891 correct customization for this is
7892
7893 @lisp
7894 (setq org-stuck-projects
7895 '("+PROJECT/-MAYBE-DONE" ("NEXT" "TODO") ("@@SHOP")
7896 "\\<IGNORE\\>"))
7897 @end lisp
7898
7899 Note that if a project is identified as non-stuck, the subtree of this entry
7900 will still be searched for stuck projects.
7901
7902 @node Presentation and sorting, Agenda commands, Built-in agenda views, Agenda Views
7903 @section Presentation and sorting
7904 @cindex presentation, of agenda items
7905
7906 @vindex org-agenda-prefix-format
7907 @vindex org-agenda-tags-column
7908 Before displaying items in an agenda view, Org mode visually prepares the
7909 items and sorts them. Each item occupies a single line. The line starts
7910 with a @emph{prefix} that contains the @emph{category} (@pxref{Categories})
7911 of the item and other important information. You can customize in which
7912 column tags will be displayed through @code{org-agenda-tags-column}. You can
7913 also customize the prefix using the option @code{org-agenda-prefix-format}.
7914 This prefix is followed by a cleaned-up version of the outline headline
7915 associated with the item.
7916
7917 @menu
7918 * Categories:: Not all tasks are equal
7919 * Time-of-day specifications:: How the agenda knows the time
7920 * Sorting of agenda items:: The order of things
7921 @end menu
7922
7923 @node Categories, Time-of-day specifications, Presentation and sorting, Presentation and sorting
7924 @subsection Categories
7925
7926 @cindex category
7927 @cindex #+CATEGORY
7928 The category is a broad label assigned to each agenda item. By default,
7929 the category is simply derived from the file name, but you can also
7930 specify it with a special line in the buffer, like this@footnote{For
7931 backward compatibility, the following also works: if there are several
7932 such lines in a file, each specifies the category for the text below it.
7933 The first category also applies to any text before the first CATEGORY
7934 line. However, using this method is @emph{strongly} deprecated as it is
7935 incompatible with the outline structure of the document. The correct
7936 method for setting multiple categories in a buffer is using a
7937 property.}:
7938
7939 @example
7940 #+CATEGORY: Thesis
7941 @end example
7942
7943 @noindent
7944 @cindex property, CATEGORY
7945 If you would like to have a special CATEGORY for a single entry or a
7946 (sub)tree, give the entry a @code{:CATEGORY:} property with the
7947 special category you want to apply as the value.
7948
7949 @noindent
7950 The display in the agenda buffer looks best if the category is not
7951 longer than 10 characters.
7952
7953 @noindent
7954 You can set up icons for category by customizing the
7955 @code{org-agenda-category-icon-alist} variable.
7956
7957 @node Time-of-day specifications, Sorting of agenda items, Categories, Presentation and sorting
7958 @subsection Time-of-day specifications
7959 @cindex time-of-day specification
7960
7961 Org mode checks each agenda item for a time-of-day specification. The
7962 time can be part of the timestamp that triggered inclusion into the
7963 agenda, for example as in @w{@samp{<2005-05-10 Tue 19:00>}}. Time
7964 ranges can be specified with two timestamps, like
7965 @c
7966 @w{@samp{<2005-05-10 Tue 20:30>--<2005-05-10 Tue 22:15>}}.
7967
7968 In the headline of the entry itself, a time(range) may also appear as
7969 plain text (like @samp{12:45} or a @samp{8:30-1pm}). If the agenda
7970 integrates the Emacs diary (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}), time
7971 specifications in diary entries are recognized as well.
7972
7973 For agenda display, Org mode extracts the time and displays it in a
7974 standard 24 hour format as part of the prefix. The example times in
7975 the previous paragraphs would end up in the agenda like this:
7976
7977 @example
7978 8:30-13:00 Arthur Dent lies in front of the bulldozer
7979 12:45...... Ford Prefect arrives and takes Arthur to the pub
7980 19:00...... The Vogon reads his poem
7981 20:30-22:15 Marvin escorts the Hitchhikers to the bridge
7982 @end example
7983
7984 @cindex time grid
7985 If the agenda is in single-day mode, or for the display of today, the
7986 timed entries are embedded in a time grid, like
7987
7988 @example
7989 8:00...... ------------------
7990 8:30-13:00 Arthur Dent lies in front of the bulldozer
7991 10:00...... ------------------
7992 12:00...... ------------------
7993 12:45...... Ford Prefect arrives and takes Arthur to the pub
7994 14:00...... ------------------
7995 16:00...... ------------------
7996 18:00...... ------------------
7997 19:00...... The Vogon reads his poem
7998 20:00...... ------------------
7999 20:30-22:15 Marvin escorts the Hitchhikers to the bridge
8000 @end example
8001
8002 @vindex org-agenda-use-time-grid
8003 @vindex org-agenda-time-grid
8004 The time grid can be turned on and off with the variable
8005 @code{org-agenda-use-time-grid}, and can be configured with
8006 @code{org-agenda-time-grid}.
8007
8008 @node Sorting of agenda items, , Time-of-day specifications, Presentation and sorting
8009 @subsection Sorting of agenda items
8010 @cindex sorting, of agenda items
8011 @cindex priorities, of agenda items
8012 Before being inserted into a view, the items are sorted. How this is
8013 done depends on the type of view.
8014 @itemize @bullet
8015 @item
8016 @vindex org-agenda-files
8017 For the daily/weekly agenda, the items for each day are sorted. The
8018 default order is to first collect all items containing an explicit
8019 time-of-day specification. These entries will be shown at the beginning
8020 of the list, as a @emph{schedule} for the day. After that, items remain
8021 grouped in categories, in the sequence given by @code{org-agenda-files}.
8022 Within each category, items are sorted by priority (@pxref{Priorities}),
8023 which is composed of the base priority (2000 for priority @samp{A}, 1000
8024 for @samp{B}, and 0 for @samp{C}), plus additional increments for
8025 overdue scheduled or deadline items.
8026 @item
8027 For the TODO list, items remain in the order of categories, but within
8028 each category, sorting takes place according to priority
8029 (@pxref{Priorities}). The priority used for sorting derives from the
8030 priority cookie, with additions depending on how close an item is to its due
8031 or scheduled date.
8032 @item
8033 For tags matches, items are not sorted at all, but just appear in the
8034 sequence in which they are found in the agenda files.
8035 @end itemize
8036
8037 @vindex org-agenda-sorting-strategy
8038 Sorting can be customized using the variable
8039 @code{org-agenda-sorting-strategy}, and may also include criteria based on
8040 the estimated effort of an entry (@pxref{Effort estimates}).
8041
8042 @node Agenda commands, Custom agenda views, Presentation and sorting, Agenda Views
8043 @section Commands in the agenda buffer
8044 @cindex commands, in agenda buffer
8045
8046 Entries in the agenda buffer are linked back to the Org file or diary
8047 file where they originate. You are not allowed to edit the agenda
8048 buffer itself, but commands are provided to show and jump to the
8049 original entry location, and to edit the Org files ``remotely'' from
8050 the agenda buffer. In this way, all information is stored only once,
8051 removing the risk that your agenda and note files may diverge.
8052
8053 Some commands can be executed with mouse clicks on agenda lines. For
8054 the other commands, the cursor needs to be in the desired line.
8055
8056 @table @kbd
8057 @tsubheading{Motion}
8058 @cindex motion commands in agenda
8059 @orgcmd{n,org-agenda-next-line}
8060 Next line (same as @key{down} and @kbd{C-n}).
8061 @orgcmd{p,org-agenda-previous-line}
8062 Previous line (same as @key{up} and @kbd{C-p}).
8063 @tsubheading{View/Go to Org file}
8064 @orgcmdkkc{@key{SPC},mouse-3,org-agenda-show-and-scroll-up}
8065 Display the original location of the item in another window.
8066 With prefix arg, make sure that the entire entry is made visible in the
8067 outline, not only the heading.
8068 @c
8069 @orgcmd{L,org-agenda-recenter}
8070 Display original location and recenter that window.
8071 @c
8072 @orgcmdkkc{@key{TAB},mouse-2,org-agenda-goto}
8073 Go to the original location of the item in another window.
8074 @c
8075 @orgcmd{@key{RET},org-agenda-switch-to}
8076 Go to the original location of the item and delete other windows.
8077 @c
8078 @orgcmd{F,org-agenda-follow-mode}
8079 @vindex org-agenda-start-with-follow-mode
8080 Toggle Follow mode. In Follow mode, as you move the cursor through
8081 the agenda buffer, the other window always shows the corresponding
8082 location in the Org file. The initial setting for this mode in new
8083 agenda buffers can be set with the variable
8084 @code{org-agenda-start-with-follow-mode}.
8085 @c
8086 @orgcmd{C-c C-x b,org-agenda-tree-to-indirect-buffer}
8087 Display the entire subtree of the current item in an indirect buffer. With a
8088 numeric prefix argument N, go up to level N and then take that tree. If N is
8089 negative, go up that many levels. With a @kbd{C-u} prefix, do not remove the
8090 previously used indirect buffer.
8091
8092 @orgcmd{C-c C-o,org-agenda-open-link}
8093 Follow a link in the entry. This will offer a selection of any links in the
8094 text belonging to the referenced Org node. If there is only one link, it
8095 will be followed without a selection prompt.
8096
8097 @tsubheading{Change display}
8098 @cindex display changing, in agenda
8099 @kindex A
8100 @item A
8101 Interactively select another agenda view and append it to the current view.
8102 @c
8103 @kindex o
8104 @item o
8105 Delete other windows.
8106 @c
8107 @orgcmdkskc{v d,d,org-agenda-day-view}
8108 @xorgcmdkskc{v w,w,org-agenda-week-view}
8109 @xorgcmd{v m,org-agenda-month-view}
8110 @xorgcmd{v y,org-agenda-year-view}
8111 @xorgcmd{v SPC,org-agenda-reset-view}
8112 @vindex org-agenda-span
8113 Switch to day/week/month/year view. When switching to day or week view, this
8114 setting becomes the default for subsequent agenda refreshes. Since month and
8115 year views are slow to create, they do not become the default. A numeric
8116 prefix argument may be used to jump directly to a specific day of the year,
8117 ISO week, month, or year, respectively. For example, @kbd{32 d} jumps to
8118 February 1st, @kbd{9 w} to ISO week number 9. When setting day, week, or
8119 month view, a year may be encoded in the prefix argument as well. For
8120 example, @kbd{200712 w} will jump to week 12 in 2007. If such a year
8121 specification has only one or two digits, it will be mapped to the interval
8122 1938-2037. @kbd{v @key{SPC}} will reset to what is set in
8123 @code{org-agenda-span}.
8124 @c
8125 @orgcmd{f,org-agenda-later}
8126 Go forward in time to display the following @code{org-agenda-current-span} days.
8127 For example, if the display covers a week, switch to the following week.
8128 With prefix arg, go forward that many times @code{org-agenda-current-span} days.
8129 @c
8130 @orgcmd{b,org-agenda-earlier}
8131 Go backward in time to display earlier dates.
8132 @c
8133 @orgcmd{.,org-agenda-goto-today}
8134 Go to today.
8135 @c
8136 @orgcmd{j,org-agenda-goto-date}
8137 Prompt for a date and go there.
8138 @c
8139 @orgcmd{J,org-agenda-clock-goto}
8140 Go to the currently clocked-in task @i{in the agenda buffer}.
8141 @c
8142 @orgcmd{D,org-agenda-toggle-diary}
8143 Toggle the inclusion of diary entries. See @ref{Weekly/daily agenda}.
8144 @c
8145 @orgcmdkskc{v l,l,org-agenda-log-mode}
8146 @kindex v L
8147 @vindex org-log-done
8148 @vindex org-agenda-log-mode-items
8149 Toggle Logbook mode. In Logbook mode, entries that were marked DONE while
8150 logging was on (variable @code{org-log-done}) are shown in the agenda, as are
8151 entries that have been clocked on that day. You can configure the entry
8152 types that should be included in log mode using the variable
8153 @code{org-agenda-log-mode-items}. When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix, show
8154 all possible logbook entries, including state changes. When called with two
8155 prefix args @kbd{C-u C-u}, show only logging information, nothing else.
8156 @kbd{v L} is equivalent to @kbd{C-u v l}.
8157 @c
8158 @orgcmdkskc{v [,[,org-agenda-manipulate-query-add}
8159 Include inactive timestamps into the current view. Only for weekly/daily
8160 agenda and timeline views.
8161 @c
8162 @orgcmd{v a,org-agenda-archives-mode}
8163 @xorgcmd{v A,org-agenda-archives-mode 'files}
8164 Toggle Archives mode. In Archives mode, trees that are marked
8165 @code{ARCHIVED} are also scanned when producing the agenda. When you use the
8166 capital @kbd{A}, even all archive files are included. To exit archives mode,
8167 press @kbd{v a} again.
8168 @c
8169 @orgcmdkskc{v R,R,org-agenda-clockreport-mode}
8170 @vindex org-agenda-start-with-clockreport-mode
8171 @vindex org-clock-report-include-clocking-task
8172 Toggle Clockreport mode. In Clockreport mode, the daily/weekly agenda will
8173 always show a table with the clocked times for the timespan and file scope
8174 covered by the current agenda view. The initial setting for this mode in new
8175 agenda buffers can be set with the variable
8176 @code{org-agenda-start-with-clockreport-mode}. By using a prefix argument
8177 when toggling this mode (i.e., @kbd{C-u R}), the clock table will not show
8178 contributions from entries that are hidden by agenda filtering@footnote{Only
8179 tags filtering will be respected here, effort filtering is ignored.}. See
8180 also the variable @code{org-clock-report-include-clocking-task}.
8181 @c
8182 @orgkey{v c}
8183 @vindex org-agenda-clock-consistency-checks
8184 Show overlapping clock entries, clocking gaps, and other clocking problems in
8185 the current agenda range. You can then visit clocking lines and fix them
8186 manually. See the variable @code{org-agenda-clock-consistency-checks} for
8187 information on how to customize the definition of what constituted a clocking
8188 problem. To return to normal agenda display, press @kbd{l} to exit Logbook
8189 mode.
8190 @c
8191 @orgcmdkskc{v E,E,org-agenda-entry-text-mode}
8192 @vindex org-agenda-start-with-entry-text-mode
8193 @vindex org-agenda-entry-text-maxlines
8194 Toggle entry text mode. In entry text mode, a number of lines from the Org
8195 outline node referenced by an agenda line will be displayed below the line.
8196 The maximum number of lines is given by the variable
8197 @code{org-agenda-entry-text-maxlines}. Calling this command with a numeric
8198 prefix argument will temporarily modify that number to the prefix value.
8199 @c
8200 @orgcmd{G,org-agenda-toggle-time-grid}
8201 @vindex org-agenda-use-time-grid
8202 @vindex org-agenda-time-grid
8203 Toggle the time grid on and off. See also the variables
8204 @code{org-agenda-use-time-grid} and @code{org-agenda-time-grid}.
8205 @c
8206 @orgcmd{r,org-agenda-redo}
8207 Recreate the agenda buffer, for example to reflect the changes after
8208 modification of the timestamps of items with @kbd{S-@key{left}} and
8209 @kbd{S-@key{right}}. When the buffer is the global TODO list, a prefix
8210 argument is interpreted to create a selective list for a specific TODO
8211 keyword.
8212 @orgcmd{g,org-agenda-redo}
8213 Same as @kbd{r}.
8214 @c
8215 @orgcmdkskc{C-x C-s,s,org-save-all-org-buffers}
8216 Save all Org buffers in the current Emacs session, and also the locations of
8217 IDs.
8218 @c
8219 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-c,org-agenda-columns}
8220 @vindex org-columns-default-format
8221 Invoke column view (@pxref{Column view}) in the agenda buffer. The column
8222 view format is taken from the entry at point, or (if there is no entry at
8223 point), from the first entry in the agenda view. So whatever the format for
8224 that entry would be in the original buffer (taken from a property, from a
8225 @code{#+COLUMNS} line, or from the default variable
8226 @code{org-columns-default-format}), will be used in the agenda.
8227
8228 @orgcmd{C-c C-x >,org-agenda-remove-restriction-lock}
8229 Remove the restriction lock on the agenda, if it is currently restricted to a
8230 file or subtree (@pxref{Agenda files}).
8231
8232 @tsubheading{Secondary filtering and query editing}
8233 @cindex filtering, by tag category and effort, in agenda
8234 @cindex tag filtering, in agenda
8235 @cindex category filtering, in agenda
8236 @cindex effort filtering, in agenda
8237 @cindex query editing, in agenda
8238
8239 @orgcmd{<,org-agenda-filter-by-category}
8240 @vindex org-agenda-category-filter-preset
8241
8242 Filter the current agenda view with respect to the category of the item at
8243 point. Pressing @code{<} another time will remove this filter. You can add
8244 a filter preset through the option @code{org-agenda-category-filter-preset}
8245 (see below.)
8246
8247 @orgcmd{/,org-agenda-filter-by-tag}
8248 @vindex org-agenda-tag-filter-preset
8249 Filter the current agenda view with respect to a tag and/or effort estimates.
8250 The difference between this and a custom agenda command is that filtering is
8251 very fast, so that you can switch quickly between different filters without
8252 having to recreate the agenda.@footnote{Custom commands can preset a filter by
8253 binding the variable @code{org-agenda-tag-filter-preset} as an option. This
8254 filter will then be applied to the view and persist as a basic filter through
8255 refreshes and more secondary filtering. The filter is a global property of
8256 the entire agenda view---in a block agenda, you should only set this in the
8257 global options section, not in the section of an individual block.}
8258
8259 You will be prompted for a tag selection letter; @key{SPC} will mean any tag at
8260 all. Pressing @key{TAB} at that prompt will offer use completion to select a
8261 tag (including any tags that do not have a selection character). The command
8262 then hides all entries that do not contain or inherit this tag. When called
8263 with prefix arg, remove the entries that @emph{do} have the tag. A second
8264 @kbd{/} at the prompt will turn off the filter and unhide any hidden entries.
8265 If the first key you press is either @kbd{+} or @kbd{-}, the previous filter
8266 will be narrowed by requiring or forbidding the selected additional tag.
8267 Instead of pressing @kbd{+} or @kbd{-} after @kbd{/}, you can also
8268 immediately use the @kbd{\} command.
8269
8270 @vindex org-sort-agenda-noeffort-is-high
8271 In order to filter for effort estimates, you should set up allowed
8272 efforts globally, for example
8273 @lisp
8274 (setq org-global-properties
8275 '(("Effort_ALL". "0 0:10 0:30 1:00 2:00 3:00 4:00")))
8276 @end lisp
8277 You can then filter for an effort by first typing an operator, one of
8278 @kbd{<}, @kbd{>}, and @kbd{=}, and then the one-digit index of an effort
8279 estimate in your array of allowed values, where @kbd{0} means the 10th value.
8280 The filter will then restrict to entries with effort smaller-or-equal, equal,
8281 or larger-or-equal than the selected value. If the digits 0-9 are not used
8282 as fast access keys to tags, you can also simply press the index digit
8283 directly without an operator. In this case, @kbd{<} will be assumed. For
8284 application of the operator, entries without a defined effort will be treated
8285 according to the value of @code{org-sort-agenda-noeffort-is-high}. To filter
8286 for tasks without effort definition, press @kbd{?} as the operator.
8287
8288 Org also supports automatic, context-aware tag filtering. If the variable
8289 @code{org-agenda-auto-exclude-function} is set to a user-defined function,
8290 that function can decide which tags should be excluded from the agenda
8291 automatically. Once this is set, the @kbd{/} command then accepts @kbd{RET}
8292 as a sub-option key and runs the auto exclusion logic. For example, let's
8293 say you use a @code{Net} tag to identify tasks which need network access, an
8294 @code{Errand} tag for errands in town, and a @code{Call} tag for making phone
8295 calls. You could auto-exclude these tags based on the availability of the
8296 Internet, and outside of business hours, with something like this:
8297
8298 @lisp
8299 @group
8300 (defun org-my-auto-exclude-function (tag)
8301 (and (cond
8302 ((string= tag "Net")
8303 (/= 0 (call-process "/sbin/ping" nil nil nil
8304 "-c1" "-q" "-t1" "mail.gnu.org")))
8305 ((or (string= tag "Errand") (string= tag "Call"))
8306 (let ((hour (nth 2 (decode-time))))
8307 (or (< hour 8) (> hour 21)))))
8308 (concat "-" tag)))
8309
8310 (setq org-agenda-auto-exclude-function 'org-my-auto-exclude-function)
8311 @end group
8312 @end lisp
8313
8314 @orgcmd{\\,org-agenda-filter-by-tag-refine}
8315 Narrow the current agenda filter by an additional condition. When called with
8316 prefix arg, remove the entries that @emph{do} have the tag, or that do match
8317 the effort criterion. You can achieve the same effect by pressing @kbd{+} or
8318 @kbd{-} as the first key after the @kbd{/} command.
8319
8320 @c
8321 @kindex [
8322 @kindex ]
8323 @kindex @{
8324 @kindex @}
8325 @item [ ] @{ @}
8326 @table @i
8327 @item @r{in} search view
8328 add new search words (@kbd{[} and @kbd{]}) or new regular expressions
8329 (@kbd{@{} and @kbd{@}}) to the query string. The opening bracket/brace will
8330 add a positive search term prefixed by @samp{+}, indicating that this search
8331 term @i{must} occur/match in the entry. The closing bracket/brace will add a
8332 negative search term which @i{must not} occur/match in the entry for it to be
8333 selected.
8334 @end table
8335
8336 @tsubheading{Remote editing}
8337 @cindex remote editing, from agenda
8338
8339 @item 0-9
8340 Digit argument.
8341 @c
8342 @cindex undoing remote-editing events
8343 @cindex remote editing, undo
8344 @orgcmd{C-_,org-agenda-undo}
8345 Undo a change due to a remote editing command. The change is undone
8346 both in the agenda buffer and in the remote buffer.
8347 @c
8348 @orgcmd{t,org-agenda-todo}
8349 Change the TODO state of the item, both in the agenda and in the
8350 original org file.
8351 @c
8352 @orgcmd{C-S-@key{right},org-agenda-todo-nextset}
8353 @orgcmd{C-S-@key{left},org-agenda-todo-previousset}
8354 Switch to the next/previous set of TODO keywords.
8355 @c
8356 @orgcmd{C-k,org-agenda-kill}
8357 @vindex org-agenda-confirm-kill
8358 Delete the current agenda item along with the entire subtree belonging
8359 to it in the original Org file. If the text to be deleted remotely
8360 is longer than one line, the kill needs to be confirmed by the user. See
8361 variable @code{org-agenda-confirm-kill}.
8362 @c
8363 @orgcmd{C-c C-w,org-agenda-refile}
8364 Refile the entry at point.
8365 @c
8366 @orgcmdkskc{C-c C-x C-a,a,org-agenda-archive-default-with-confirmation}
8367 @vindex org-archive-default-command
8368 Archive the subtree corresponding to the entry at point using the default
8369 archiving command set in @code{org-archive-default-command}. When using the
8370 @code{a} key, confirmation will be required.
8371 @c
8372 @orgcmd{C-c C-x a,org-agenda-toggle-archive-tag}
8373 Toggle the ARCHIVE tag for the current headline.
8374 @c
8375 @orgcmd{C-c C-x A,org-agenda-archive-to-archive-sibling}
8376 Move the subtree corresponding to the current entry to its @emph{archive
8377 sibling}.
8378 @c
8379 @orgcmdkskc{C-c C-x C-s,$,org-agenda-archive}
8380 Archive the subtree corresponding to the current headline. This means the
8381 entry will be moved to the configured archive location, most likely a
8382 different file.
8383 @c
8384 @orgcmd{T,org-agenda-show-tags}
8385 @vindex org-agenda-show-inherited-tags
8386 Show all tags associated with the current item. This is useful if you have
8387 turned off @code{org-agenda-show-inherited-tags}, but still want to see all
8388 tags of a headline occasionally.
8389 @c
8390 @orgcmd{:,org-agenda-set-tags}
8391 Set tags for the current headline. If there is an active region in the
8392 agenda, change a tag for all headings in the region.
8393 @c
8394 @kindex ,
8395 @item ,
8396 Set the priority for the current item (@command{org-agenda-priority}).
8397 Org mode prompts for the priority character. If you reply with @key{SPC},
8398 the priority cookie is removed from the entry.
8399 @c
8400 @orgcmd{P,org-agenda-show-priority}
8401 Display weighted priority of current item.
8402 @c
8403 @orgcmdkkc{+,S-@key{up},org-agenda-priority-up}
8404 Increase the priority of the current item. The priority is changed in
8405 the original buffer, but the agenda is not resorted. Use the @kbd{r}
8406 key for this.
8407 @c
8408 @orgcmdkkc{-,S-@key{down},org-agenda-priority-down}
8409 Decrease the priority of the current item.
8410 @c
8411 @orgcmdkkc{z,C-c C-z,org-agenda-add-note}
8412 @vindex org-log-into-drawer
8413 Add a note to the entry. This note will be recorded, and then filed to the
8414 same location where state change notes are put. Depending on
8415 @code{org-log-into-drawer}, this may be inside a drawer.
8416 @c
8417 @orgcmd{C-c C-a,org-attach}
8418 Dispatcher for all command related to attachments.
8419 @c
8420 @orgcmd{C-c C-s,org-agenda-schedule}
8421 Schedule this item. With prefix arg remove the scheduling timestamp
8422 @c
8423 @orgcmd{C-c C-d,org-agenda-deadline}
8424 Set a deadline for this item. With prefix arg remove the deadline.
8425 @c
8426 @orgcmd{S-@key{right},org-agenda-do-date-later}
8427 Change the timestamp associated with the current line by one day into the
8428 future. If the date is in the past, the first call to this command will move
8429 it to today.@*
8430 With a numeric prefix argument, change it by that many days. For example,
8431 @kbd{3 6 5 S-@key{right}} will change it by a year. With a @kbd{C-u} prefix,
8432 change the time by one hour. If you immediately repeat the command, it will
8433 continue to change hours even without the prefix arg. With a double @kbd{C-u
8434 C-u} prefix, do the same for changing minutes.@*
8435 The stamp is changed in the original Org file, but the change is not directly
8436 reflected in the agenda buffer. Use @kbd{r} or @kbd{g} to update the buffer.
8437 @c
8438 @orgcmd{S-@key{left},org-agenda-do-date-earlier}
8439 Change the timestamp associated with the current line by one day
8440 into the past.
8441 @c
8442 @orgcmd{>,org-agenda-date-prompt}
8443 Change the timestamp associated with the current line. The key @kbd{>} has
8444 been chosen, because it is the same as @kbd{S-.} on my keyboard.
8445 @c
8446 @orgcmd{I,org-agenda-clock-in}
8447 Start the clock on the current item. If a clock is running already, it
8448 is stopped first.
8449 @c
8450 @orgcmd{O,org-agenda-clock-out}
8451 Stop the previously started clock.
8452 @c
8453 @orgcmd{X,org-agenda-clock-cancel}
8454 Cancel the currently running clock.
8455 @c
8456 @orgcmd{J,org-agenda-clock-goto}
8457 Jump to the running clock in another window.
8458 @c
8459 @orgcmd{k,org-agenda-capture}
8460 Like @code{org-capture}, but use the date at point as the default date for
8461 the capture template. See @var{org-capture-use-agenda-date} to make this
8462 the default behavior of @code{org-capture}.
8463 @cindex capturing, from agenda
8464 @vindex org-capture-use-agenda-date
8465
8466 @tsubheading{Bulk remote editing selected entries}
8467 @cindex remote editing, bulk, from agenda
8468 @vindex org-agenda-bulk-persistent-marks
8469 @vindex org-agenda-bulk-custom-functions
8470
8471 @orgcmd{m,org-agenda-bulk-mark}
8472 Mark the entry at point for bulk action. With prefix arg, mark that many
8473 successive entries.
8474 @c
8475 @orgcmd{%,org-agenda-bulk-mark-regexp}
8476 Mark entries matching a regular expression for bulk action.
8477 @c
8478 @orgcmd{u,org-agenda-bulk-unmark}
8479 Unmark entry for bulk action.
8480 @c
8481 @orgcmd{U,org-agenda-bulk-remove-all-marks}
8482 Unmark all marked entries for bulk action.
8483 @c
8484 @orgcmd{B,org-agenda-bulk-action}
8485 Bulk action: act on all marked entries in the agenda. This will prompt for
8486 another key to select the action to be applied. The prefix arg to @kbd{B}
8487 will be passed through to the @kbd{s} and @kbd{d} commands, to bulk-remove
8488 these special timestamps. By default, marks are removed after the bulk. If
8489 you want them to persist, set @code{org-agenda-bulk-persistent-marks} to
8490 @code{t} or hit @kbd{p} at the prompt.
8491
8492 @example
8493 * @r{Toggle persistent marks.}
8494 $ @r{Archive all selected entries.}
8495 A @r{Archive entries by moving them to their respective archive siblings.}
8496 t @r{Change TODO state. This prompts for a single TODO keyword and}
8497 @r{changes the state of all selected entries, bypassing blocking and}
8498 @r{suppressing logging notes (but not timestamps).}
8499 + @r{Add a tag to all selected entries.}
8500 - @r{Remove a tag from all selected entries.}
8501 s @r{Schedule all items to a new date. To shift existing schedule dates}
8502 @r{by a fixed number of days, use something starting with double plus}
8503 @r{at the prompt, for example @samp{++8d} or @samp{++2w}.}
8504 d @r{Set deadline to a specific date.}
8505 r @r{Prompt for a single refile target and move all entries. The entries}
8506 @r{will no longer be in the agenda; refresh (@kbd{g}) to bring them back.}
8507 S @r{Reschedule randomly into the coming N days. N will be prompted for.}
8508 @r{With prefix arg (@kbd{C-u B S}), scatter only across weekdays.}
8509 f @r{Apply a function@footnote{You can also create persistent custom functions through@code{org-agenda-bulk-custom-functions}.} to marked entries.}
8510 @r{For example, the function below sets the CATEGORY property of the}
8511 @r{entries to web.}
8512 @r{(defun set-category ()}
8513 @r{ (interactive "P")}
8514 @r{ (let* ((marker (or (org-get-at-bol 'org-hd-marker)}
8515 @r{ (org-agenda-error)))}
8516 @r{ (buffer (marker-buffer marker)))}
8517 @r{ (with-current-buffer buffer}
8518 @r{ (save-excursion}
8519 @r{ (save-restriction}
8520 @r{ (widen)}
8521 @r{ (goto-char marker)}
8522 @r{ (org-back-to-heading t)}
8523 @r{ (org-set-property "CATEGORY" "web"))))))}
8524 @end example
8525
8526
8527 @tsubheading{Calendar commands}
8528 @cindex calendar commands, from agenda
8529
8530 @orgcmd{c,org-agenda-goto-calendar}
8531 Open the Emacs calendar and move to the date at the agenda cursor.
8532 @c
8533 @orgcmd{c,org-calendar-goto-agenda}
8534 When in the calendar, compute and show the Org mode agenda for the
8535 date at the cursor.
8536 @c
8537 @cindex diary entries, creating from agenda
8538 @orgcmd{i,org-agenda-diary-entry}
8539 @vindex org-agenda-diary-file
8540 Insert a new entry into the diary, using the date at the cursor and (for
8541 block entries) the date at the mark. This will add to the Emacs diary
8542 file@footnote{This file is parsed for the agenda when
8543 @code{org-agenda-include-diary} is set.}, in a way similar to the @kbd{i}
8544 command in the calendar. The diary file will pop up in another window, where
8545 you can add the entry.
8546
8547 If you configure @code{org-agenda-diary-file} to point to an Org mode file,
8548 Org will create entries (in Org mode syntax) in that file instead. Most
8549 entries will be stored in a date-based outline tree that will later make it
8550 easy to archive appointments from previous months/years. The tree will be
8551 built under an entry with a @code{DATE_TREE} property, or else with years as
8552 top-level entries. Emacs will prompt you for the entry text---if you specify
8553 it, the entry will be created in @code{org-agenda-diary-file} without further
8554 interaction. If you directly press @key{RET} at the prompt without typing
8555 text, the target file will be shown in another window for you to finish the
8556 entry there. See also the @kbd{k r} command.
8557 @c
8558 @orgcmd{M,org-agenda-phases-of-moon}
8559 Show the phases of the moon for the three months around current date.
8560 @c
8561 @orgcmd{S,org-agenda-sunrise-sunset}
8562 Show sunrise and sunset times. The geographical location must be set
8563 with calendar variables, see the documentation for the Emacs calendar.
8564 @c
8565 @orgcmd{C,org-agenda-convert-date}
8566 Convert the date at cursor into many other cultural and historic
8567 calendars.
8568 @c
8569 @orgcmd{H,org-agenda-holidays}
8570 Show holidays for three months around the cursor date.
8571
8572 @item M-x org-export-icalendar-combine-agenda-files
8573 Export a single iCalendar file containing entries from all agenda files.
8574 This is a globally available command, and also available in the agenda menu.
8575
8576 @tsubheading{Exporting to a file}
8577 @orgcmd{C-x C-w,org-agenda-write}
8578 @cindex exporting agenda views
8579 @cindex agenda views, exporting
8580 @vindex org-agenda-exporter-settings
8581 Write the agenda view to a file. Depending on the extension of the selected
8582 file name, the view will be exported as HTML (extension @file{.html} or
8583 @file{.htm}), Postscript (extension @file{.ps}), PDF (extension @file{.pdf}),
8584 and plain text (any other extension). When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix
8585 argument, immediately open the newly created file. Use the variable
8586 @code{org-agenda-exporter-settings} to set options for @file{ps-print} and
8587 for @file{htmlize} to be used during export.
8588
8589 @tsubheading{Quit and Exit}
8590 @orgcmd{q,org-agenda-quit}
8591 Quit agenda, remove the agenda buffer.
8592 @c
8593 @cindex agenda files, removing buffers
8594 @orgcmd{x,org-agenda-exit}
8595 Exit agenda, remove the agenda buffer and all buffers loaded by Emacs
8596 for the compilation of the agenda. Buffers created by the user to
8597 visit Org files will not be removed.
8598 @end table
8599
8600
8601 @node Custom agenda views, Exporting Agenda Views, Agenda commands, Agenda Views
8602 @section Custom agenda views
8603 @cindex custom agenda views
8604 @cindex agenda views, custom
8605
8606 Custom agenda commands serve two purposes: to store and quickly access
8607 frequently used TODO and tags searches, and to create special composite
8608 agenda buffers. Custom agenda commands will be accessible through the
8609 dispatcher (@pxref{Agenda dispatcher}), just like the default commands.
8610
8611 @menu
8612 * Storing searches:: Type once, use often
8613 * Block agenda:: All the stuff you need in a single buffer
8614 * Setting Options:: Changing the rules
8615 @end menu
8616
8617 @node Storing searches, Block agenda, Custom agenda views, Custom agenda views
8618 @subsection Storing searches
8619
8620 The first application of custom searches is the definition of keyboard
8621 shortcuts for frequently used searches, either creating an agenda
8622 buffer, or a sparse tree (the latter covering of course only the current
8623 buffer).
8624 @kindex C-c a C
8625 @vindex org-agenda-custom-commands
8626
8627 Custom commands are configured in the variable
8628 @code{org-agenda-custom-commands}. You can customize this variable, for
8629 example by pressing @kbd{C-c a C}. You can also directly set it with Emacs
8630 Lisp in @file{.emacs}. The following example contains all valid search
8631 types:
8632
8633 @lisp
8634 @group
8635 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands
8636 '(("w" todo "WAITING")
8637 ("W" todo-tree "WAITING")
8638 ("u" tags "+boss-urgent")
8639 ("v" tags-todo "+boss-urgent")
8640 ("U" tags-tree "+boss-urgent")
8641 ("f" occur-tree "\\<FIXME\\>")
8642 ("h" . "HOME+Name tags searches") ; description for "h" prefix
8643 ("hl" tags "+home+Lisa")
8644 ("hp" tags "+home+Peter")
8645 ("hk" tags "+home+Kim")))
8646 @end group
8647 @end lisp
8648
8649 @noindent
8650 The initial string in each entry defines the keys you have to press
8651 after the dispatcher command @kbd{C-c a} in order to access the command.
8652 Usually this will be just a single character, but if you have many
8653 similar commands, you can also define two-letter combinations where the
8654 first character is the same in several combinations and serves as a
8655 prefix key@footnote{You can provide a description for a prefix key by
8656 inserting a cons cell with the prefix and the description.}. The second
8657 parameter is the search type, followed by the string or regular
8658 expression to be used for the matching. The example above will
8659 therefore define:
8660
8661 @table @kbd
8662 @item C-c a w
8663 as a global search for TODO entries with @samp{WAITING} as the TODO
8664 keyword
8665 @item C-c a W
8666 as the same search, but only in the current buffer and displaying the
8667 results as a sparse tree
8668 @item C-c a u
8669 as a global tags search for headlines marked @samp{:boss:} but not
8670 @samp{:urgent:}
8671 @item C-c a v
8672 as the same search as @kbd{C-c a u}, but limiting the search to
8673 headlines that are also TODO items
8674 @item C-c a U
8675 as the same search as @kbd{C-c a u}, but only in the current buffer and
8676 displaying the result as a sparse tree
8677 @item C-c a f
8678 to create a sparse tree (again: current buffer only) with all entries
8679 containing the word @samp{FIXME}
8680 @item C-c a h
8681 as a prefix command for a HOME tags search where you have to press an
8682 additional key (@kbd{l}, @kbd{p} or @kbd{k}) to select a name (Lisa,
8683 Peter, or Kim) as additional tag to match.
8684 @end table
8685
8686 @node Block agenda, Setting Options, Storing searches, Custom agenda views
8687 @subsection Block agenda
8688 @cindex block agenda
8689 @cindex agenda, with block views
8690
8691 Another possibility is the construction of agenda views that comprise
8692 the results of @emph{several} commands, each of which creates a block in
8693 the agenda buffer. The available commands include @code{agenda} for the
8694 daily or weekly agenda (as created with @kbd{C-c a a}), @code{alltodo}
8695 for the global TODO list (as constructed with @kbd{C-c a t}), and the
8696 matching commands discussed above: @code{todo}, @code{tags}, and
8697 @code{tags-todo}. Here are two examples:
8698
8699 @lisp
8700 @group
8701 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands
8702 '(("h" "Agenda and Home-related tasks"
8703 ((agenda "")
8704 (tags-todo "home")
8705 (tags "garden")))
8706 ("o" "Agenda and Office-related tasks"
8707 ((agenda "")
8708 (tags-todo "work")
8709 (tags "office")))))
8710 @end group
8711 @end lisp
8712
8713 @noindent
8714 This will define @kbd{C-c a h} to create a multi-block view for stuff
8715 you need to attend to at home. The resulting agenda buffer will contain
8716 your agenda for the current week, all TODO items that carry the tag
8717 @samp{home}, and also all lines tagged with @samp{garden}. Finally the
8718 command @kbd{C-c a o} provides a similar view for office tasks.
8719
8720 @node Setting Options, , Block agenda, Custom agenda views
8721 @subsection Setting options for custom commands
8722 @cindex options, for custom agenda views
8723
8724 @vindex org-agenda-custom-commands
8725 Org mode contains a number of variables regulating agenda construction
8726 and display. The global variables define the behavior for all agenda
8727 commands, including the custom commands. However, if you want to change
8728 some settings just for a single custom view, you can do so. Setting
8729 options requires inserting a list of variable names and values at the
8730 right spot in @code{org-agenda-custom-commands}. For example:
8731
8732 @lisp
8733 @group
8734 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands
8735 '(("w" todo "WAITING"
8736 ((org-agenda-sorting-strategy '(priority-down))
8737 (org-agenda-prefix-format " Mixed: ")))
8738 ("U" tags-tree "+boss-urgent"
8739 ((org-show-following-heading nil)
8740 (org-show-hierarchy-above nil)))
8741 ("N" search ""
8742 ((org-agenda-files '("~org/notes.org"))
8743 (org-agenda-text-search-extra-files nil)))))
8744 @end group
8745 @end lisp
8746
8747 @noindent
8748 Now the @kbd{C-c a w} command will sort the collected entries only by
8749 priority, and the prefix format is modified to just say @samp{ Mixed: }
8750 instead of giving the category of the entry. The sparse tags tree of
8751 @kbd{C-c a U} will now turn out ultra-compact, because neither the
8752 headline hierarchy above the match, nor the headline following the match
8753 will be shown. The command @kbd{C-c a N} will do a text search limited
8754 to only a single file.
8755
8756 @vindex org-agenda-custom-commands
8757 For command sets creating a block agenda,
8758 @code{org-agenda-custom-commands} has two separate spots for setting
8759 options. You can add options that should be valid for just a single
8760 command in the set, and options that should be valid for all commands in
8761 the set. The former are just added to the command entry; the latter
8762 must come after the list of command entries. Going back to the block
8763 agenda example (@pxref{Block agenda}), let's change the sorting strategy
8764 for the @kbd{C-c a h} commands to @code{priority-down}, but let's sort
8765 the results for GARDEN tags query in the opposite order,
8766 @code{priority-up}. This would look like this:
8767
8768 @lisp
8769 @group
8770 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands
8771 '(("h" "Agenda and Home-related tasks"
8772 ((agenda)
8773 (tags-todo "home")
8774 (tags "garden"
8775 ((org-agenda-sorting-strategy '(priority-up)))))
8776 ((org-agenda-sorting-strategy '(priority-down))))
8777 ("o" "Agenda and Office-related tasks"
8778 ((agenda)
8779 (tags-todo "work")
8780 (tags "office")))))
8781 @end group
8782 @end lisp
8783
8784 As you see, the values and parentheses setting is a little complex.
8785 When in doubt, use the customize interface to set this variable---it
8786 fully supports its structure. Just one caveat: when setting options in
8787 this interface, the @emph{values} are just Lisp expressions. So if the
8788 value is a string, you need to add the double-quotes around the value
8789 yourself.
8790
8791 @vindex org-agenda-custom-commands-contexts
8792 To control whether an agenda command should be accessible from a specific
8793 context, you can customize @var{org-agenda-custom-commands-contexts}. Let's
8794 say for example that you have an agenda commands @code{"o"} displaying a view
8795 that you only need when reading emails. Then you would configure this option
8796 like this:
8797
8798 @example
8799 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands-contexts
8800 '(("o" (in-mode . "message-mode"))))
8801 @end example
8802
8803 You can also tell that the command key @code{"o"} should refer to another
8804 command key @code{"r"}. In that case, add this command key like this:
8805
8806 @example
8807 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands-contexts
8808 '(("o" "r" (in-mode . "message-mode"))))
8809 @end example
8810
8811 See the docstring of the variable for more information.
8812
8813 @node Exporting Agenda Views, Agenda column view, Custom agenda views, Agenda Views
8814 @section Exporting Agenda Views
8815 @cindex agenda views, exporting
8816
8817 If you are away from your computer, it can be very useful to have a printed
8818 version of some agenda views to carry around. Org mode can export custom
8819 agenda views as plain text, HTML@footnote{You need to install Hrvoje Niksic's
8820 @file{htmlize.el}.}, Postscript, PDF@footnote{To create PDF output, the
8821 ghostscript @file{ps2pdf} utility must be installed on the system. Selecting
8822 a PDF file will also create the postscript file.}, and iCalendar files. If
8823 you want to do this only occasionally, use the command
8824
8825 @table @kbd
8826 @orgcmd{C-x C-w,org-agenda-write}
8827 @cindex exporting agenda views
8828 @cindex agenda views, exporting
8829 @vindex org-agenda-exporter-settings
8830 Write the agenda view to a file. Depending on the extension of the selected
8831 file name, the view will be exported as HTML (extension @file{.html} or
8832 @file{.htm}), Postscript (extension @file{.ps}), iCalendar (extension
8833 @file{.ics}), or plain text (any other extension). Use the variable
8834 @code{org-agenda-exporter-settings} to set options for @file{ps-print} and
8835 for @file{htmlize} to be used during export, for example
8836
8837 @vindex org-agenda-add-entry-text-maxlines
8838 @vindex htmlize-output-type
8839 @vindex ps-number-of-columns
8840 @vindex ps-landscape-mode
8841 @lisp
8842 (setq org-agenda-exporter-settings
8843 '((ps-number-of-columns 2)
8844 (ps-landscape-mode t)
8845 (org-agenda-add-entry-text-maxlines 5)
8846 (htmlize-output-type 'css)))
8847 @end lisp
8848 @end table
8849
8850 If you need to export certain agenda views frequently, you can associate
8851 any custom agenda command with a list of output file names
8852 @footnote{If you want to store standard views like the weekly agenda
8853 or the global TODO list as well, you need to define custom commands for
8854 them in order to be able to specify file names.}. Here is an example
8855 that first defines custom commands for the agenda and the global
8856 TODO list, together with a number of files to which to export them.
8857 Then we define two block agenda commands and specify file names for them
8858 as well. File names can be relative to the current working directory,
8859 or absolute.
8860
8861 @lisp
8862 @group
8863 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands
8864 '(("X" agenda "" nil ("agenda.html" "agenda.ps"))
8865 ("Y" alltodo "" nil ("todo.html" "todo.txt" "todo.ps"))
8866 ("h" "Agenda and Home-related tasks"
8867 ((agenda "")
8868 (tags-todo "home")
8869 (tags "garden"))
8870 nil
8871 ("~/views/home.html"))
8872 ("o" "Agenda and Office-related tasks"
8873 ((agenda)
8874 (tags-todo "work")
8875 (tags "office"))
8876 nil
8877 ("~/views/office.ps" "~/calendars/office.ics"))))
8878 @end group
8879 @end lisp
8880
8881 The extension of the file name determines the type of export. If it is
8882 @file{.html}, Org mode will use the @file{htmlize.el} package to convert
8883 the buffer to HTML and save it to this file name. If the extension is
8884 @file{.ps}, @code{ps-print-buffer-with-faces} is used to produce
8885 Postscript output. If the extension is @file{.ics}, iCalendar export is
8886 run export over all files that were used to construct the agenda, and
8887 limit the export to entries listed in the agenda. Any other
8888 extension produces a plain ASCII file.
8889
8890 The export files are @emph{not} created when you use one of those
8891 commands interactively because this might use too much overhead.
8892 Instead, there is a special command to produce @emph{all} specified
8893 files in one step:
8894
8895 @table @kbd
8896 @orgcmd{C-c a e,org-store-agenda-views}
8897 Export all agenda views that have export file names associated with
8898 them.
8899 @end table
8900
8901 You can use the options section of the custom agenda commands to also
8902 set options for the export commands. For example:
8903
8904 @lisp
8905 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands
8906 '(("X" agenda ""
8907 ((ps-number-of-columns 2)
8908 (ps-landscape-mode t)
8909 (org-agenda-prefix-format " [ ] ")
8910 (org-agenda-with-colors nil)
8911 (org-agenda-remove-tags t))
8912 ("theagenda.ps"))))
8913 @end lisp
8914
8915 @noindent
8916 This command sets two options for the Postscript exporter, to make it
8917 print in two columns in landscape format---the resulting page can be cut
8918 in two and then used in a paper agenda. The remaining settings modify
8919 the agenda prefix to omit category and scheduling information, and
8920 instead include a checkbox to check off items. We also remove the tags
8921 to make the lines compact, and we don't want to use colors for the
8922 black-and-white printer. Settings specified in
8923 @code{org-agenda-exporter-settings} will also apply, but the settings
8924 in @code{org-agenda-custom-commands} take precedence.
8925
8926 @noindent
8927 From the command line you may also use
8928 @example
8929 emacs -eval (org-batch-store-agenda-views) -kill
8930 @end example
8931 @noindent
8932 or, if you need to modify some parameters@footnote{Quoting depends on the
8933 system you use, please check the FAQ for examples.}
8934 @example
8935 emacs -eval '(org-batch-store-agenda-views \
8936 org-agenda-span (quote month) \
8937 org-agenda-start-day "2007-11-01" \
8938 org-agenda-include-diary nil \
8939 org-agenda-files (quote ("~/org/project.org")))' \
8940 -kill
8941 @end example
8942 @noindent
8943 which will create the agenda views restricted to the file
8944 @file{~/org/project.org}, without diary entries and with a 30-day
8945 extent.
8946
8947 You can also extract agenda information in a way that allows further
8948 processing by other programs. See @ref{Extracting agenda information}, for
8949 more information.
8950
8951
8952 @node Agenda column view, , Exporting Agenda Views, Agenda Views
8953 @section Using column view in the agenda
8954 @cindex column view, in agenda
8955 @cindex agenda, column view
8956
8957 Column view (@pxref{Column view}) is normally used to view and edit
8958 properties embedded in the hierarchical structure of an Org file. It can be
8959 quite useful to use column view also from the agenda, where entries are
8960 collected by certain criteria.
8961
8962 @table @kbd
8963 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-c,org-agenda-columns}
8964 Turn on column view in the agenda.
8965 @end table
8966
8967 To understand how to use this properly, it is important to realize that the
8968 entries in the agenda are no longer in their proper outline environment.
8969 This causes the following issues:
8970
8971 @enumerate
8972 @item
8973 @vindex org-columns-default-format
8974 @vindex org-overriding-columns-format
8975 Org needs to make a decision which @code{COLUMNS} format to use. Since the
8976 entries in the agenda are collected from different files, and different files
8977 may have different @code{COLUMNS} formats, this is a non-trivial problem.
8978 Org first checks if the variable @code{org-agenda-overriding-columns-format} is
8979 currently set, and if so, takes the format from there. Otherwise it takes
8980 the format associated with the first item in the agenda, or, if that item
8981 does not have a specific format (defined in a property, or in its file), it
8982 uses @code{org-columns-default-format}.
8983 @item
8984 @cindex property, special, CLOCKSUM
8985 If any of the columns has a summary type defined (@pxref{Column attributes}),
8986 turning on column view in the agenda will visit all relevant agenda files and
8987 make sure that the computations of this property are up to date. This is
8988 also true for the special @code{CLOCKSUM} property. Org will then sum the
8989 values displayed in the agenda. In the daily/weekly agenda, the sums will
8990 cover a single day; in all other views they cover the entire block. It is
8991 vital to realize that the agenda may show the same entry @emph{twice} (for
8992 example as scheduled and as a deadline), and it may show two entries from the
8993 same hierarchy (for example a @emph{parent} and its @emph{child}). In these
8994 cases, the summation in the agenda will lead to incorrect results because
8995 some values will count double.
8996 @item
8997 When the column view in the agenda shows the @code{CLOCKSUM}, that is always
8998 the entire clocked time for this item. So even in the daily/weekly agenda,
8999 the clocksum listed in column view may originate from times outside the
9000 current view. This has the advantage that you can compare these values with
9001 a column listing the planned total effort for a task---one of the major
9002 applications for column view in the agenda. If you want information about
9003 clocked time in the displayed period use clock table mode (press @kbd{R} in
9004 the agenda).
9005
9006 @item
9007 @cindex property, special, CLOCKSUM_T
9008 When the column view in the agenda shows the @code{CLOCKSUM_T}, that is
9009 always today's clocked time for this item. So even in the weekly agenda,
9010 the clocksum listed in column view only originates from today. This lets
9011 you compare the time you spent on a task for today, with the time already
9012 spent (via @code{CLOCKSUM}) and with the planned total effort for it.
9013 @end enumerate
9014
9015
9016 @node Markup, Exporting, Agenda Views, Top
9017 @chapter Markup for rich export
9018
9019 When exporting Org mode documents, the exporter tries to reflect the
9020 structure of the document as accurately as possible in the backend. Since
9021 export targets like HTML, @LaTeX{}, or DocBook allow much richer formatting,
9022 Org mode has rules on how to prepare text for rich export. This section
9023 summarizes the markup rules used in an Org mode buffer.
9024
9025 @menu
9026 * Structural markup elements:: The basic structure as seen by the exporter
9027 * Images and tables:: Tables and Images will be included
9028 * Literal examples:: Source code examples with special formatting
9029 * Include files:: Include additional files into a document
9030 * Index entries:: Making an index
9031 * Macro replacement:: Use macros to create complex output
9032 * Embedded @LaTeX{}:: LaTeX can be freely used inside Org documents
9033 @end menu
9034
9035 @node Structural markup elements, Images and tables, Markup, Markup
9036 @section Structural markup elements
9037
9038 @menu
9039 * Document title:: Where the title is taken from
9040 * Headings and sections:: The document structure as seen by the exporter
9041 * Table of contents:: The if and where of the table of contents
9042 * Initial text:: Text before the first heading?
9043 * Lists:: Lists
9044 * Paragraphs:: Paragraphs
9045 * Footnote markup:: Footnotes
9046 * Emphasis and monospace:: Bold, italic, etc.
9047 * Horizontal rules:: Make a line
9048 * Comment lines:: What will *not* be exported
9049 @end menu
9050
9051 @node Document title, Headings and sections, Structural markup elements, Structural markup elements
9052 @subheading Document title
9053 @cindex document title, markup rules
9054
9055 @noindent
9056 The title of the exported document is taken from the special line
9057
9058 @cindex #+TITLE
9059 @example
9060 #+TITLE: This is the title of the document
9061 @end example
9062
9063 @noindent
9064 If this line does not exist, the title is derived from the first non-empty,
9065 non-comment line in the buffer. If no such line exists, or if you have
9066 turned off exporting of the text before the first headline (see below), the
9067 title will be the file name without extension.
9068
9069 @cindex property, EXPORT_TITLE
9070 If you are exporting only a subtree by marking is as the region, the heading
9071 of the subtree will become the title of the document. If the subtree has a
9072 property @code{EXPORT_TITLE}, that will take precedence.
9073
9074 @node Headings and sections, Table of contents, Document title, Structural markup elements
9075 @subheading Headings and sections
9076 @cindex headings and sections, markup rules
9077
9078 @vindex org-export-headline-levels
9079 The outline structure of the document as described in @ref{Document
9080 Structure}, forms the basis for defining sections of the exported document.
9081 However, since the outline structure is also used for (for example) lists of
9082 tasks, only the first three outline levels will be used as headings. Deeper
9083 levels will become itemized lists. You can change the location of this
9084 switch globally by setting the variable @code{org-export-headline-levels}, or on a
9085 per-file basis with a line
9086
9087 @cindex #+OPTIONS
9088 @example
9089 #+OPTIONS: H:4
9090 @end example
9091
9092 @node Table of contents, Initial text, Headings and sections, Structural markup elements
9093 @subheading Table of contents
9094 @cindex table of contents, markup rules
9095
9096 @vindex org-export-with-toc
9097 The table of contents is normally inserted directly before the first headline
9098 of the file. If you would like to get it to a different location, insert the
9099 string @code{[TABLE-OF-CONTENTS]} on a line by itself at the desired
9100 location. The depth of the table of contents is by default the same as the
9101 number of headline levels, but you can choose a smaller number, or turn off
9102 the table of contents entirely, by configuring the variable
9103 @code{org-export-with-toc}, or on a per-file basis with a line like
9104
9105 @example
9106 #+OPTIONS: toc:2 (only to two levels in TOC)
9107 #+OPTIONS: toc:nil (no TOC at all)
9108 @end example
9109
9110 @node Initial text, Lists, Table of contents, Structural markup elements
9111 @subheading Text before the first headline
9112 @cindex text before first headline, markup rules
9113 @cindex #+TEXT
9114
9115 Org mode normally exports the text before the first headline, and even uses
9116 the first line as the document title. The text will be fully marked up. If
9117 you need to include literal HTML, @LaTeX{}, or DocBook code, use the special
9118 constructs described below in the sections for the individual exporters.
9119
9120 @vindex org-export-skip-text-before-1st-heading
9121 Some people like to use the space before the first headline for setup and
9122 internal links and therefore would like to control the exported text before
9123 the first headline in a different way. You can do so by setting the variable
9124 @code{org-export-skip-text-before-1st-heading} to @code{t}. On a per-file
9125 basis, you can get the same effect with @samp{#+OPTIONS: skip:t}.
9126
9127 @noindent
9128 If you still want to have some text before the first headline, use the
9129 @code{#+TEXT} construct:
9130
9131 @example
9132 #+OPTIONS: skip:t
9133 #+TEXT: This text will go before the *first* headline.
9134 #+TEXT: [TABLE-OF-CONTENTS]
9135 #+TEXT: This goes between the table of contents and the *first* headline
9136 @end example
9137
9138 @node Lists, Paragraphs, Initial text, Structural markup elements
9139 @subheading Lists
9140 @cindex lists, markup rules
9141
9142 Plain lists as described in @ref{Plain lists}, are translated to the backend's
9143 syntax for such lists. Most backends support unordered, ordered, and
9144 description lists.
9145
9146 @node Paragraphs, Footnote markup, Lists, Structural markup elements
9147 @subheading Paragraphs, line breaks, and quoting
9148 @cindex paragraphs, markup rules
9149
9150 Paragraphs are separated by at least one empty line. If you need to enforce
9151 a line break within a paragraph, use @samp{\\} at the end of a line.
9152
9153 To keep the line breaks in a region, but otherwise use normal formatting, you
9154 can use this construct, which can also be used to format poetry.
9155
9156 @cindex #+BEGIN_VERSE
9157 @example
9158 #+BEGIN_VERSE
9159 Great clouds overhead
9160 Tiny black birds rise and fall
9161 Snow covers Emacs
9162
9163 -- AlexSchroeder
9164 #+END_VERSE
9165 @end example
9166
9167 When quoting a passage from another document, it is customary to format this
9168 as a paragraph that is indented on both the left and the right margin. You
9169 can include quotations in Org mode documents like this:
9170
9171 @cindex #+BEGIN_QUOTE
9172 @example
9173 #+BEGIN_QUOTE
9174 Everything should be made as simple as possible,
9175 but not any simpler -- Albert Einstein
9176 #+END_QUOTE
9177 @end example
9178
9179 If you would like to center some text, do it like this:
9180 @cindex #+BEGIN_CENTER
9181 @example
9182 #+BEGIN_CENTER
9183 Everything should be made as simple as possible, \\
9184 but not any simpler
9185 #+END_CENTER
9186 @end example
9187
9188
9189 @node Footnote markup, Emphasis and monospace, Paragraphs, Structural markup elements
9190 @subheading Footnote markup
9191 @cindex footnotes, markup rules
9192 @cindex @file{footnote.el}
9193
9194 Footnotes defined in the way described in @ref{Footnotes}, will be exported
9195 by all backends. Org allows multiple references to the same note, and
9196 multiple footnotes side by side.
9197
9198 @node Emphasis and monospace, Horizontal rules, Footnote markup, Structural markup elements
9199 @subheading Emphasis and monospace
9200
9201 @cindex underlined text, markup rules
9202 @cindex bold text, markup rules
9203 @cindex italic text, markup rules
9204 @cindex verbatim text, markup rules
9205 @cindex code text, markup rules
9206 @cindex strike-through text, markup rules
9207 You can make words @b{*bold*}, @i{/italic/}, _underlined_, @code{=code=}
9208 and @code{~verbatim~}, and, if you must, @samp{+strike-through+}. Text
9209 in the code and verbatim string is not processed for Org mode specific
9210 syntax; it is exported verbatim.
9211
9212 @node Horizontal rules, Comment lines, Emphasis and monospace, Structural markup elements
9213 @subheading Horizontal rules
9214 @cindex horizontal rules, markup rules
9215 A line consisting of only dashes, and at least 5 of them, will be exported as
9216 a horizontal line (@samp{<hr/>} in HTML and @code{\hrule} in @LaTeX{}).
9217
9218 @node Comment lines, , Horizontal rules, Structural markup elements
9219 @subheading Comment lines
9220 @cindex comment lines
9221 @cindex exporting, not
9222 @cindex #+BEGIN_COMMENT
9223
9224 Lines starting with zero or more whitespace characters followed by one
9225 @samp{#} and a whitespace are treated as comments and will never be exported.
9226 Also entire subtrees starting with the word @samp{COMMENT} will never be
9227 exported. Finally, regions surrounded by @samp{#+BEGIN_COMMENT}
9228 ... @samp{#+END_COMMENT} will not be exported.
9229
9230 @table @kbd
9231 @kindex C-c ;
9232 @item C-c ;
9233 Toggle the COMMENT keyword at the beginning of an entry.
9234 @end table
9235
9236
9237 @node Images and tables, Literal examples, Structural markup elements, Markup
9238 @section Images and Tables
9239
9240 @cindex tables, markup rules
9241 @cindex #+CAPTION
9242 @cindex #+LABEL
9243 Both the native Org mode tables (@pxref{Tables}) and tables formatted with
9244 the @file{table.el} package will be exported properly. For Org mode tables,
9245 the lines before the first horizontal separator line will become table header
9246 lines. You can use the following lines somewhere before the table to assign
9247 a caption and a label for cross references, and in the text you can refer to
9248 the object with @code{\ref@{tab:basic-data@}}:
9249
9250 @example
9251 #+CAPTION: This is the caption for the next table (or link)
9252 #+LABEL: tab:basic-data
9253 | ... | ...|
9254 |-----|----|
9255 @end example
9256
9257 Optionally, the caption can take the form:
9258 @example
9259 #+CAPTION: [Caption for list of figures]@{Caption for table (or link).@}
9260 @end example
9261
9262 @cindex inlined images, markup rules
9263 Some backends (HTML, @LaTeX{}, and DocBook) allow you to directly include
9264 images into the exported document. Org does this, if a link to an image
9265 files does not have a description part, for example @code{[[./img/a.jpg]]}.
9266 If you wish to define a caption for the image and maybe a label for internal
9267 cross references, make sure that the link is on a line by itself and precede
9268 it with @code{#+CAPTION} and @code{#+LABEL} as follows:
9269
9270 @example
9271 #+CAPTION: This is the caption for the next figure link (or table)
9272 #+LABEL: fig:SED-HR4049
9273 [[./img/a.jpg]]
9274 @end example
9275
9276 You may also define additional attributes for the figure. As this is
9277 backend-specific, see the sections about the individual backends for more
9278 information.
9279
9280 @xref{Handling links,the discussion of image links}.
9281
9282 @node Literal examples, Include files, Images and tables, Markup
9283 @section Literal examples
9284 @cindex literal examples, markup rules
9285 @cindex code line references, markup rules
9286
9287 You can include literal examples that should not be subjected to
9288 markup. Such examples will be typeset in monospace, so this is well suited
9289 for source code and similar examples.
9290 @cindex #+BEGIN_EXAMPLE
9291
9292 @example
9293 #+BEGIN_EXAMPLE
9294 Some example from a text file.
9295 #+END_EXAMPLE
9296 @end example
9297
9298 Note that such blocks may be @i{indented} in order to align nicely with
9299 indented text and in particular with plain list structure (@pxref{Plain
9300 lists}). For simplicity when using small examples, you can also start the
9301 example lines with a colon followed by a space. There may also be additional
9302 whitespace before the colon:
9303
9304 @example
9305 Here is an example
9306 : Some example from a text file.
9307 @end example
9308
9309 @cindex formatting source code, markup rules
9310 If the example is source code from a programming language, or any other text
9311 that can be marked up by font-lock in Emacs, you can ask for the example to
9312 look like the fontified Emacs buffer@footnote{This works automatically for
9313 the HTML backend (it requires version 1.34 of the @file{htmlize.el} package,
9314 which is distributed with Org). Fontified code chunks in @LaTeX{} can be
9315 achieved using either the listings or the
9316 @url{http://code.google.com/p/minted, minted,} package. Refer to
9317 @code{org-export-latex-listings} documentation for details.}. This is done
9318 with the @samp{src} block, where you also need to specify the name of the
9319 major mode that should be used to fontify the example@footnote{Code in
9320 @samp{src} blocks may also be evaluated either interactively or on export.
9321 See @pxref{Working With Source Code} for more information on evaluating code
9322 blocks.}, see @ref{Easy Templates} for shortcuts to easily insert code
9323 blocks.
9324 @cindex #+BEGIN_SRC
9325
9326 @example
9327 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp
9328 (defun org-xor (a b)
9329 "Exclusive or."
9330 (if a (not b) b))
9331 #+END_SRC
9332 @end example
9333
9334 Both in @code{example} and in @code{src} snippets, you can add a @code{-n}
9335 switch to the end of the @code{BEGIN} line, to get the lines of the example
9336 numbered. If you use a @code{+n} switch, the numbering from the previous
9337 numbered snippet will be continued in the current one. In literal examples,
9338 Org will interpret strings like @samp{(ref:name)} as labels, and use them as
9339 targets for special hyperlinks like @code{[[(name)]]} (i.e., the reference name
9340 enclosed in single parenthesis). In HTML, hovering the mouse over such a
9341 link will remote-highlight the corresponding code line, which is kind of
9342 cool.
9343
9344 You can also add a @code{-r} switch which @i{removes} the labels from the
9345 source code@footnote{Adding @code{-k} to @code{-n -r} will @i{keep} the
9346 labels in the source code while using line numbers for the links, which might
9347 be useful to explain those in an Org mode example code.}. With the @code{-n}
9348 switch, links to these references will be labeled by the line numbers from
9349 the code listing, otherwise links will use the labels with no parentheses.
9350 Here is an example:
9351
9352 @example
9353 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp -n -r
9354 (save-excursion (ref:sc)
9355 (goto-char (point-min)) (ref:jump)
9356 #+END_SRC
9357 In line [[(sc)]] we remember the current position. [[(jump)][Line (jump)]]
9358 jumps to point-min.
9359 @end example
9360
9361 @vindex org-coderef-label-format
9362 If the syntax for the label format conflicts with the language syntax, use a
9363 @code{-l} switch to change the format, for example @samp{#+BEGIN_SRC pascal
9364 -n -r -l "((%s))"}. See also the variable @code{org-coderef-label-format}.
9365
9366 HTML export also allows examples to be published as text areas (@pxref{Text
9367 areas in HTML export}).
9368
9369 Because the @code{#+BEGIN_...} and @code{#+END_...} patterns need to be added
9370 so often, shortcuts are provided using the Easy Templates facility
9371 (@pxref{Easy Templates}).
9372
9373 @table @kbd
9374 @kindex C-c '
9375 @item C-c '
9376 Edit the source code example at point in its native mode. This works by
9377 switching to a temporary buffer with the source code. You need to exit by
9378 pressing @kbd{C-c '} again@footnote{Upon exit, lines starting with @samp{*},
9379 @samp{,*}, @samp{#+} and @samp{,#+} will get a comma prepended, to keep them
9380 from being interpreted by Org as outline nodes or special syntax. These
9381 commas will be stripped for editing with @kbd{C-c '}, and also for export.}.
9382 The edited version will then replace the old version in the Org buffer.
9383 Fixed-width regions (where each line starts with a colon followed by a space)
9384 will be edited using @code{artist-mode}@footnote{You may select
9385 a different-mode with the variable @code{org-edit-fixed-width-region-mode}.}
9386 to allow creating ASCII drawings easily. Using this command in an empty line
9387 will create a new fixed-width region.
9388 @kindex C-c l
9389 @item C-c l
9390 Calling @code{org-store-link} while editing a source code example in a
9391 temporary buffer created with @kbd{C-c '} will prompt for a label. Make sure
9392 that it is unique in the current buffer, and insert it with the proper
9393 formatting like @samp{(ref:label)} at the end of the current line. Then the
9394 label is stored as a link @samp{(label)}, for retrieval with @kbd{C-c C-l}.
9395 @end table
9396
9397
9398 @node Include files, Index entries, Literal examples, Markup
9399 @section Include files
9400 @cindex include files, markup rules
9401
9402 During export, you can include the content of another file. For example, to
9403 include your @file{.emacs} file, you could use:
9404 @cindex #+INCLUDE
9405
9406 @example
9407 #+INCLUDE: "~/.emacs" src emacs-lisp
9408 @end example
9409 @noindent
9410 The optional second and third parameter are the markup (e.g., @samp{quote},
9411 @samp{example}, or @samp{src}), and, if the markup is @samp{src}, the
9412 language for formatting the contents. The markup is optional; if it is not
9413 given, the text will be assumed to be in Org mode format and will be
9414 processed normally. The include line will also allow additional keyword
9415 parameters @code{:prefix1} and @code{:prefix} to specify prefixes for the
9416 first line and for each following line, @code{:minlevel} in order to get
9417 Org mode content demoted to a specified level, as well as any options
9418 accepted by the selected markup. For example, to include a file as an item,
9419 use
9420
9421 @example
9422 #+INCLUDE: "~/snippets/xx" :prefix1 " + " :prefix " "
9423 @end example
9424
9425 You can also include a portion of a file by specifying a lines range using
9426 the @code{:lines} parameter. The line at the upper end of the range will not
9427 be included. The start and/or the end of the range may be omitted to use the
9428 obvious defaults.
9429
9430 @example
9431 #+INCLUDE: "~/.emacs" :lines "5-10" @r{Include lines 5 to 10, 10 excluded}
9432 #+INCLUDE: "~/.emacs" :lines "-10" @r{Include lines 1 to 10, 10 excluded}
9433 #+INCLUDE: "~/.emacs" :lines "10-" @r{Include lines from 10 to EOF}
9434 @end example
9435
9436 @table @kbd
9437 @kindex C-c '
9438 @item C-c '
9439 Visit the include file at point.
9440 @end table
9441
9442 @node Index entries, Macro replacement, Include files, Markup
9443 @section Index entries
9444 @cindex index entries, for publishing
9445
9446 You can specify entries that will be used for generating an index during
9447 publishing. This is done by lines starting with @code{#+INDEX}. An entry
9448 the contains an exclamation mark will create a sub item. See @ref{Generating
9449 an index} for more information.
9450
9451 @example
9452 * Curriculum Vitae
9453 #+INDEX: CV
9454 #+INDEX: Application!CV
9455 @end example
9456
9457
9458
9459
9460 @node Macro replacement, Embedded @LaTeX{}, Index entries, Markup
9461 @section Macro replacement
9462 @cindex macro replacement, during export
9463 @cindex #+MACRO
9464
9465 You can define text snippets with
9466
9467 @example
9468 #+MACRO: name replacement text $1, $2 are arguments
9469 @end example
9470
9471 @noindent which can be referenced anywhere in the document (even in
9472 code examples) with @code{@{@{@{name(arg1,arg2)@}@}@}}. In addition to
9473 defined macros, @code{@{@{@{title@}@}@}}, @code{@{@{@{author@}@}@}}, etc.,
9474 will reference information set by the @code{#+TITLE:}, @code{#+AUTHOR:}, and
9475 similar lines. Also, @code{@{@{@{date(@var{FORMAT})@}@}@}} and
9476 @code{@{@{@{modification-time(@var{FORMAT})@}@}@}} refer to current date time
9477 and to the modification time of the file being exported, respectively.
9478 @var{FORMAT} should be a format string understood by
9479 @code{format-time-string}.
9480
9481 Macro expansion takes place during export, and some people use it to
9482 construct complex HTML code.
9483
9484
9485 @node Embedded @LaTeX{}, , Macro replacement, Markup
9486 @section Embedded @LaTeX{}
9487 @cindex @TeX{} interpretation
9488 @cindex @LaTeX{} interpretation
9489
9490 Plain ASCII is normally sufficient for almost all note taking. Exceptions
9491 include scientific notes, which often require mathematical symbols and the
9492 occasional formula. @LaTeX{}@footnote{@LaTeX{} is a macro system based on
9493 Donald E. Knuth's @TeX{} system. Many of the features described here as
9494 ``@LaTeX{}'' are really from @TeX{}, but for simplicity I am blurring this
9495 distinction.} is widely used to typeset scientific documents. Org mode
9496 supports embedding @LaTeX{} code into its files, because many academics are
9497 used to writing and reading @LaTeX{} source code, and because it can be
9498 readily processed to produce pretty output for a number of export backends.
9499
9500 @menu
9501 * Special symbols:: Greek letters and other symbols
9502 * Subscripts and superscripts:: Simple syntax for raising/lowering text
9503 * @LaTeX{} fragments:: Complex formulas made easy
9504 * Previewing @LaTeX{} fragments:: What will this snippet look like?
9505 * CDLaTeX mode:: Speed up entering of formulas
9506 @end menu
9507
9508 @node Special symbols, Subscripts and superscripts, Embedded @LaTeX{}, Embedded @LaTeX{}
9509 @subsection Special symbols
9510 @cindex math symbols
9511 @cindex special symbols
9512 @cindex @TeX{} macros
9513 @cindex @LaTeX{} fragments, markup rules
9514 @cindex HTML entities
9515 @cindex @LaTeX{} entities
9516
9517 You can use @LaTeX{} macros to insert special symbols like @samp{\alpha} to
9518 indicate the Greek letter, or @samp{\to} to indicate an arrow. Completion
9519 for these macros is available, just type @samp{\} and maybe a few letters,
9520 and press @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} to see possible completions. Unlike @LaTeX{}
9521 code, Org mode allows these macros to be present without surrounding math
9522 delimiters, for example:
9523
9524 @example
9525 Angles are written as Greek letters \alpha, \beta and \gamma.
9526 @end example
9527
9528 @vindex org-entities
9529 During export, these symbols will be transformed into the native format of
9530 the exporter backend. Strings like @code{\alpha} will be exported as
9531 @code{&alpha;} in the HTML output, and as @code{$\alpha$} in the @LaTeX{}
9532 output. Similarly, @code{\nbsp} will become @code{&nbsp;} in HTML and
9533 @code{~} in @LaTeX{}. If you need such a symbol inside a word, terminate it
9534 like this: @samp{\Aacute@{@}stor}.
9535
9536 A large number of entities is provided, with names taken from both HTML and
9537 @LaTeX{}; see the variable @code{org-entities} for the complete list.
9538 @samp{\-} is treated as a shy hyphen, and @samp{--}, @samp{---}, and
9539 @samp{...} are all converted into special commands creating hyphens of
9540 different lengths or a compact set of dots.
9541
9542 If you would like to see entities displayed as UTF8 characters, use the
9543 following command@footnote{You can turn this on by default by setting the
9544 variable @code{org-pretty-entities}, or on a per-file base with the
9545 @code{#+STARTUP} option @code{entitiespretty}.}:
9546
9547 @table @kbd
9548 @kindex C-c C-x \
9549 @item C-c C-x \
9550 Toggle display of entities as UTF-8 characters. This does not change the
9551 buffer content which remains plain ASCII, but it overlays the UTF-8 character
9552 for display purposes only.
9553 @end table
9554
9555 @node Subscripts and superscripts, @LaTeX{} fragments, Special symbols, Embedded @LaTeX{}
9556 @subsection Subscripts and superscripts
9557 @cindex subscript
9558 @cindex superscript
9559
9560 Just like in @LaTeX{}, @samp{^} and @samp{_} are used to indicate super-
9561 and subscripts. Again, these can be used without embedding them in
9562 math-mode delimiters. To increase the readability of ASCII text, it is
9563 not necessary (but OK) to surround multi-character sub- and superscripts
9564 with curly braces. For example
9565
9566 @example
9567 The mass of the sun is M_sun = 1.989 x 10^30 kg. The radius of
9568 the sun is R_@{sun@} = 6.96 x 10^8 m.
9569 @end example
9570
9571 @vindex org-export-with-sub-superscripts
9572 To avoid interpretation as raised or lowered text, you can quote @samp{^} and
9573 @samp{_} with a backslash: @samp{\^} and @samp{\_}. If you write a text
9574 where the underscore is often used in a different context, Org's convention
9575 to always interpret these as subscripts can get in your way. Configure the
9576 variable @code{org-export-with-sub-superscripts} to globally change this
9577 convention, or use, on a per-file basis:
9578
9579 @example
9580 #+OPTIONS: ^:@{@}
9581 @end example
9582
9583 @noindent With this setting, @samp{a_b} will not be interpreted as a
9584 subscript, but @samp{a_@{b@}} will.
9585
9586 @table @kbd
9587 @kindex C-c C-x \
9588 @item C-c C-x \
9589 In addition to showing entities as UTF-8 characters, this command will also
9590 format sub- and superscripts in a WYSIWYM way.
9591 @end table
9592
9593 @node @LaTeX{} fragments, Previewing @LaTeX{} fragments, Subscripts and superscripts, Embedded @LaTeX{}
9594 @subsection @LaTeX{} fragments
9595 @cindex @LaTeX{} fragments
9596
9597 @vindex org-format-latex-header
9598 Going beyond symbols and sub- and superscripts, a full formula language is
9599 needed. Org mode can contain @LaTeX{} math fragments, and it supports ways
9600 to process these for several export backends. When exporting to @LaTeX{},
9601 the code is obviously left as it is. When exporting to HTML, Org invokes the
9602 @uref{http://www.mathjax.org, MathJax library} (@pxref{Math formatting in
9603 HTML export}) to process and display the math@footnote{If you plan to use
9604 this regularly or on pages with significant page views, you should install
9605 @file{MathJax} on your own
9606 server in order to limit the load of our server.}. Finally, it can also
9607 process the mathematical expressions into images@footnote{For this to work
9608 you need to be on a system with a working @LaTeX{} installation. You also
9609 need the @file{dvipng} program or the @file{convert}, respectively available
9610 at @url{http://sourceforge.net/projects/dvipng/} and from the
9611 @file{imagemagick} suite. The @LaTeX{} header that will be used when
9612 processing a fragment can be configured with the variable
9613 @code{org-format-latex-header}.} that can be displayed in a browser or in
9614 DocBook documents.
9615
9616 @LaTeX{} fragments don't need any special marking at all. The following
9617 snippets will be identified as @LaTeX{} source code:
9618 @itemize @bullet
9619 @item
9620 Environments of any kind@footnote{When @file{MathJax} is used, only the
9621 environment recognized by @file{MathJax} will be processed. When
9622 @file{dvipng} is used to create images, any @LaTeX{} environments will be
9623 handled.}. The only requirement is that the @code{\begin} statement appears
9624 on a new line, preceded by only whitespace.
9625 @item
9626 Text within the usual @LaTeX{} math delimiters. To avoid conflicts with
9627 currency specifications, single @samp{$} characters are only recognized as
9628 math delimiters if the enclosed text contains at most two line breaks, is
9629 directly attached to the @samp{$} characters with no whitespace in between,
9630 and if the closing @samp{$} is followed by whitespace, punctuation or a dash.
9631 For the other delimiters, there is no such restriction, so when in doubt, use
9632 @samp{\(...\)} as inline math delimiters.
9633 @end itemize
9634
9635 @noindent For example:
9636
9637 @example
9638 \begin@{equation@} % arbitrary environments,
9639 x=\sqrt@{b@} % even tables, figures
9640 \end@{equation@} % etc
9641
9642 If $a^2=b$ and \( b=2 \), then the solution must be
9643 either $$ a=+\sqrt@{2@} $$ or \[ a=-\sqrt@{2@} \].
9644 @end example
9645
9646 @noindent
9647 @vindex org-format-latex-options
9648 If you need any of the delimiter ASCII sequences for other purposes, you
9649 can configure the option @code{org-format-latex-options} to deselect the
9650 ones you do not wish to have interpreted by the @LaTeX{} converter.
9651
9652 @vindex org-export-with-LaTeX-fragments
9653 @LaTeX{} processing can be configured with the variable
9654 @code{org-export-with-LaTeX-fragments}. The default setting is @code{t}
9655 which means @file{MathJax} for HTML, and no processing for DocBook, ASCII and
9656 @LaTeX{} backends. You can also set this variable on a per-file basis using one
9657 of these lines:
9658
9659 @example
9660 #+OPTIONS: LaTeX:t @r{Do the right thing automatically (MathJax)}
9661 #+OPTIONS: LaTeX:dvipng @r{Force using dvipng images}
9662 #+OPTIONS: LaTeX:nil @r{Do not process @LaTeX{} fragments at all}
9663 #+OPTIONS: LaTeX:verbatim @r{Verbatim export, for jsMath or so}
9664 @end example
9665
9666 @node Previewing @LaTeX{} fragments, CDLaTeX mode, @LaTeX{} fragments, Embedded @LaTeX{}
9667 @subsection Previewing @LaTeX{} fragments
9668 @cindex @LaTeX{} fragments, preview
9669
9670 If you have @file{dvipng} installed, @LaTeX{} fragments can be processed to
9671 produce preview images of the typeset expressions:
9672
9673 @table @kbd
9674 @kindex C-c C-x C-l
9675 @item C-c C-x C-l
9676 Produce a preview image of the @LaTeX{} fragment at point and overlay it
9677 over the source code. If there is no fragment at point, process all
9678 fragments in the current entry (between two headlines). When called
9679 with a prefix argument, process the entire subtree. When called with
9680 two prefix arguments, or when the cursor is before the first headline,
9681 process the entire buffer.
9682 @kindex C-c C-c
9683 @item C-c C-c
9684 Remove the overlay preview images.
9685 @end table
9686
9687 @vindex org-format-latex-options
9688 You can customize the variable @code{org-format-latex-options} to influence
9689 some aspects of the preview. In particular, the @code{:scale} (and for HTML
9690 export, @code{:html-scale}) property can be used to adjust the size of the
9691 preview images.
9692
9693 @node CDLaTeX mode, , Previewing @LaTeX{} fragments, Embedded @LaTeX{}
9694 @subsection Using CD@LaTeX{} to enter math
9695 @cindex CD@LaTeX{}
9696
9697 CD@LaTeX{} mode is a minor mode that is normally used in combination with a
9698 major @LaTeX{} mode like AUC@TeX{} in order to speed-up insertion of
9699 environments and math templates. Inside Org mode, you can make use of
9700 some of the features of CD@LaTeX{} mode. You need to install
9701 @file{cdlatex.el} and @file{texmathp.el} (the latter comes also with
9702 AUC@TeX{}) from @url{http://www.astro.uva.nl/~dominik/Tools/cdlatex}.
9703 Don't use CD@LaTeX{} mode itself under Org mode, but use the light
9704 version @code{org-cdlatex-mode} that comes as part of Org mode. Turn it
9705 on for the current buffer with @code{M-x org-cdlatex-mode}, or for all
9706 Org files with
9707
9708 @lisp
9709 (add-hook 'org-mode-hook 'turn-on-org-cdlatex)
9710 @end lisp
9711
9712 When this mode is enabled, the following features are present (for more
9713 details see the documentation of CD@LaTeX{} mode):
9714 @itemize @bullet
9715 @kindex C-c @{
9716 @item
9717 Environment templates can be inserted with @kbd{C-c @{}.
9718 @item
9719 @kindex @key{TAB}
9720 The @key{TAB} key will do template expansion if the cursor is inside a
9721 @LaTeX{} fragment@footnote{Org mode has a method to test if the cursor is
9722 inside such a fragment, see the documentation of the function
9723 @code{org-inside-LaTeX-fragment-p}.}. For example, @key{TAB} will
9724 expand @code{fr} to @code{\frac@{@}@{@}} and position the cursor
9725 correctly inside the first brace. Another @key{TAB} will get you into
9726 the second brace. Even outside fragments, @key{TAB} will expand
9727 environment abbreviations at the beginning of a line. For example, if
9728 you write @samp{equ} at the beginning of a line and press @key{TAB},
9729 this abbreviation will be expanded to an @code{equation} environment.
9730 To get a list of all abbreviations, type @kbd{M-x cdlatex-command-help}.
9731 @item
9732 @kindex _
9733 @kindex ^
9734 @vindex cdlatex-simplify-sub-super-scripts
9735 Pressing @kbd{_} and @kbd{^} inside a @LaTeX{} fragment will insert these
9736 characters together with a pair of braces. If you use @key{TAB} to move
9737 out of the braces, and if the braces surround only a single character or
9738 macro, they are removed again (depending on the variable
9739 @code{cdlatex-simplify-sub-super-scripts}).
9740 @item
9741 @kindex `
9742 Pressing the backquote @kbd{`} followed by a character inserts math
9743 macros, also outside @LaTeX{} fragments. If you wait more than 1.5 seconds
9744 after the backquote, a help window will pop up.
9745 @item
9746 @kindex '
9747 Pressing the single-quote @kbd{'} followed by another character modifies
9748 the symbol before point with an accent or a font. If you wait more than
9749 1.5 seconds after the single-quote, a help window will pop up. Character
9750 modification will work only inside @LaTeX{} fragments; outside the quote
9751 is normal.
9752 @end itemize
9753
9754 @node Exporting, Publishing, Markup, Top
9755 @chapter Exporting
9756 @cindex exporting
9757
9758 Org mode documents can be exported into a variety of other formats. For
9759 printing and sharing of notes, ASCII export produces a readable and simple
9760 version of an Org file. HTML export allows you to publish a notes file on
9761 the web, while the XOXO format provides a solid base for exchange with a
9762 broad range of other applications. @LaTeX{} export lets you use Org mode and
9763 its structured editing functions to easily create @LaTeX{} files. DocBook
9764 export makes it possible to convert Org files to many other formats using
9765 DocBook tools. OpenDocument Text (ODT) export allows seamless
9766 collaboration across organizational boundaries. For project management you
9767 can create gantt and resource charts by using TaskJuggler export. To
9768 incorporate entries with associated times like deadlines or appointments into
9769 a desktop calendar program like iCal, Org mode can also produce extracts in
9770 the iCalendar format. Currently, Org mode only supports export, not import of
9771 these different formats.
9772
9773 Org supports export of selected regions when @code{transient-mark-mode} is
9774 enabled (default in Emacs 23).
9775
9776 @menu
9777 * Selective export:: Using tags to select and exclude trees
9778 * Export options:: Per-file export settings
9779 * The export dispatcher:: How to access exporter commands
9780 * ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export:: Exporting to flat files with encoding
9781 * HTML export:: Exporting to HTML
9782 * @LaTeX{} and PDF export:: Exporting to @LaTeX{}, and processing to PDF
9783 * DocBook export:: Exporting to DocBook
9784 * OpenDocument Text export:: Exporting to OpenDocument Text
9785 * TaskJuggler export:: Exporting to TaskJuggler
9786 * Freemind export:: Exporting to Freemind mind maps
9787 * XOXO export:: Exporting to XOXO
9788 * iCalendar export:: Exporting in iCalendar format
9789 @end menu
9790
9791 @node Selective export, Export options, Exporting, Exporting
9792 @section Selective export
9793 @cindex export, selective by tags or TODO keyword
9794
9795 @vindex org-export-select-tags
9796 @vindex org-export-exclude-tags
9797 @cindex org-export-with-tasks
9798 You may use tags to select the parts of a document that should be exported,
9799 or to exclude parts from export. This behavior is governed by two variables:
9800 @code{org-export-select-tags} and @code{org-export-exclude-tags},
9801 respectively defaulting to @code{'(:export:)} and @code{'(:noexport:)}.
9802
9803 @enumerate
9804 @item
9805 Org first checks if any of the @emph{select} tags is present in the
9806 buffer. If yes, all trees that do not carry one of these tags will be
9807 excluded. If a selected tree is a subtree, the heading hierarchy above it
9808 will also be selected for export, but not the text below those headings.
9809
9810 @item
9811 If none of the select tags is found, the whole buffer will be selected for
9812 export.
9813
9814 @item
9815 Finally, all subtrees that are marked by any of the @emph{exclude} tags will
9816 be removed from the export buffer.
9817 @end enumerate
9818
9819 The variable @code{org-export-with-tasks} can be configured to select which
9820 kind of tasks should be included for export. See the docstring of the
9821 variable for more information.
9822
9823 @node Export options, The export dispatcher, Selective export, Exporting
9824 @section Export options
9825 @cindex options, for export
9826
9827 @cindex completion, of option keywords
9828 The exporter recognizes special lines in the buffer which provide
9829 additional information. These lines may be put anywhere in the file.
9830 The whole set of lines can be inserted into the buffer with @kbd{C-c
9831 C-e t}. For individual lines, a good way to make sure the keyword is
9832 correct is to type @samp{#+} and then use @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} completion
9833 (@pxref{Completion}). For a summary of other in-buffer settings not
9834 specifically related to export, see @ref{In-buffer settings}.
9835 In particular, note that you can place commonly-used (export) options in
9836 a separate file which can be included using @code{#+SETUPFILE}.
9837
9838 @table @kbd
9839 @orgcmd{C-c C-e t,org-insert-export-options-template}
9840 Insert template with export options, see example below.
9841 @end table
9842
9843 @cindex #+TITLE
9844 @cindex #+AUTHOR
9845 @cindex #+DATE
9846 @cindex #+EMAIL
9847 @cindex #+DESCRIPTION
9848 @cindex #+KEYWORDS
9849 @cindex #+LANGUAGE
9850 @cindex #+TEXT
9851 @cindex #+OPTIONS
9852 @cindex #+BIND
9853 @cindex #+LINK_UP
9854 @cindex #+LINK_HOME
9855 @cindex #+EXPORT_SELECT_TAGS
9856 @cindex #+EXPORT_EXCLUDE_TAGS
9857 @cindex #+XSLT
9858 @cindex #+LaTeX_HEADER
9859 @vindex user-full-name
9860 @vindex user-mail-address
9861 @vindex org-export-default-language
9862 @vindex org-export-date-timestamp-format
9863 @example
9864 #+TITLE: the title to be shown (default is the buffer name)
9865 #+AUTHOR: the author (default taken from @code{user-full-name})
9866 #+DATE: a date, an Org timestamp@footnote{@code{org-export-date-timestamp-format} defines how this timestamp will be exported.}, or a format string for @code{format-time-string}
9867 #+EMAIL: his/her email address (default from @code{user-mail-address})
9868 #+DESCRIPTION: the page description, e.g., for the XHTML meta tag
9869 #+KEYWORDS: the page keywords, e.g., for the XHTML meta tag
9870 #+LANGUAGE: language for HTML, e.g., @samp{en} (@code{org-export-default-language})
9871 #+TEXT: Some descriptive text to be inserted at the beginning.
9872 #+TEXT: Several lines may be given.
9873 #+OPTIONS: H:2 num:t toc:t \n:nil @@:t ::t |:t ^:t f:t TeX:t ...
9874 #+BIND: lisp-var lisp-val, e.g., @code{org-export-latex-low-levels itemize}
9875 @r{You need to confirm using these, or configure @code{org-export-allow-BIND}}
9876 #+LINK_UP: the ``up'' link of an exported page
9877 #+LINK_HOME: the ``home'' link of an exported page
9878 #+LaTeX_HEADER: extra line(s) for the @LaTeX{} header, like \usepackage@{xyz@}
9879 #+EXPORT_SELECT_TAGS: Tags that select a tree for export
9880 #+EXPORT_EXCLUDE_TAGS: Tags that exclude a tree from export
9881 #+XSLT: the XSLT stylesheet used by DocBook exporter to generate FO file
9882 @end example
9883
9884 @noindent
9885 The @code{#+OPTIONS} line is a compact@footnote{If you want to configure many options
9886 this way, you can use several @code{#+OPTIONS} lines.} form to specify export
9887 settings. Here you can:
9888 @cindex headline levels
9889 @cindex section-numbers
9890 @cindex table of contents
9891 @cindex line-break preservation
9892 @cindex quoted HTML tags
9893 @cindex fixed-width sections
9894 @cindex tables
9895 @cindex @TeX{}-like syntax for sub- and superscripts
9896 @cindex footnotes
9897 @cindex special strings
9898 @cindex emphasized text
9899 @cindex @TeX{} macros
9900 @cindex @LaTeX{} fragments
9901 @cindex author info, in export
9902 @cindex time info, in export
9903 @vindex org-export-plist-vars
9904 @vindex org-export-author-info
9905 @vindex org-export-creator-info
9906 @vindex org-export-email-info
9907 @vindex org-export-time-stamp-file
9908 @example
9909 H: @r{set the number of headline levels for export}
9910 num: @r{turn on/off section-numbers}
9911 toc: @r{turn on/off table of contents, or set level limit (integer)}
9912 \n: @r{turn on/off line-break-preservation (DOES NOT WORK)}
9913 @@: @r{turn on/off quoted HTML tags}
9914 :: @r{turn on/off fixed-width sections}
9915 |: @r{turn on/off tables}
9916 ^: @r{turn on/off @TeX{}-like syntax for sub- and superscripts. If}
9917 @r{you write "^:@{@}", @code{a_@{b@}} will be interpreted, but}
9918 @r{the simple @code{a_b} will be left as it is.}
9919 -: @r{turn on/off conversion of special strings.}
9920 f: @r{turn on/off footnotes like this[1].}
9921 todo: @r{turn on/off inclusion of TODO keywords into exported text}
9922 tasks: @r{turn on/off inclusion of tasks (TODO items), can be nil to remove}
9923 @r{all tasks, @code{todo} to remove DONE tasks, or list of kwds to keep}
9924 pri: @r{turn on/off priority cookies}
9925 tags: @r{turn on/off inclusion of tags, may also be @code{not-in-toc}}
9926 <: @r{turn on/off inclusion of any time/date stamps like DEADLINES}
9927 *: @r{turn on/off emphasized text (bold, italic, underlined)}
9928 TeX: @r{turn on/off simple @TeX{} macros in plain text}
9929 LaTeX: @r{configure export of @LaTeX{} fragments. Default @code{auto}}
9930 skip: @r{turn on/off skipping the text before the first heading}
9931 author: @r{turn on/off inclusion of author name/email into exported file}
9932 email: @r{turn on/off inclusion of author email into exported file}
9933 creator: @r{turn on/off inclusion of creator info into exported file}
9934 timestamp: @r{turn on/off inclusion creation time into exported file}
9935 d: @r{turn on/off inclusion of drawers, or list drawers to include}
9936 @end example
9937 @noindent
9938 These options take effect in both the HTML and @LaTeX{} export, except for
9939 @code{TeX} and @code{LaTeX} options, which are respectively @code{t} and
9940 @code{nil} for the @LaTeX{} export.
9941
9942 The default values for these and many other options are given by a set of
9943 variables. For a list of such variables, the corresponding OPTIONS keys and
9944 also the publishing keys (@pxref{Project alist}), see the constant
9945 @code{org-export-plist-vars}.
9946
9947 When exporting only a single subtree by selecting it with @kbd{C-c @@} before
9948 calling an export command, the subtree can overrule some of the file's export
9949 settings with properties @code{EXPORT_FILE_NAME}, @code{EXPORT_TITLE},
9950 @code{EXPORT_TEXT}, @code{EXPORT_AUTHOR}, @code{EXPORT_DATE}, and
9951 @code{EXPORT_OPTIONS}.
9952
9953 @node The export dispatcher, ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export, Export options, Exporting
9954 @section The export dispatcher
9955 @cindex dispatcher, for export commands
9956
9957 All export commands can be reached using the export dispatcher, which is a
9958 prefix key that prompts for an additional key specifying the command.
9959 Normally the entire file is exported, but if there is an active region that
9960 contains one outline tree, the first heading is used as document title and
9961 the subtrees are exported.
9962
9963 @table @kbd
9964 @orgcmd{C-c C-e,org-export}
9965 @vindex org-export-run-in-background
9966 Dispatcher for export and publishing commands. Displays a help-window
9967 listing the additional key(s) needed to launch an export or publishing
9968 command. The prefix arg is passed through to the exporter. A double prefix
9969 @kbd{C-u C-u} causes most commands to be executed in the background, in a
9970 separate Emacs process@footnote{To make this behavior the default, customize
9971 the variable @code{org-export-run-in-background}.}.
9972 @orgcmd{C-c C-e v,org-export-visible}
9973 Like @kbd{C-c C-e}, but only export the text that is currently visible
9974 (i.e., not hidden by outline visibility).
9975 @orgcmd{C-u C-u C-c C-e,org-export}
9976 @vindex org-export-run-in-background
9977 Call the exporter, but reverse the setting of
9978 @code{org-export-run-in-background}, i.e., request background processing if
9979 not set, or force processing in the current Emacs process if set.
9980 @end table
9981
9982 @node ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export, HTML export, The export dispatcher, Exporting
9983 @section ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export
9984 @cindex ASCII export
9985 @cindex Latin-1 export
9986 @cindex UTF-8 export
9987
9988 ASCII export produces a simple and very readable version of an Org mode
9989 file, containing only plain ASCII@. Latin-1 and UTF-8 export augment the file
9990 with special characters and symbols available in these encodings.
9991
9992 @cindex region, active
9993 @cindex active region
9994 @cindex transient-mark-mode
9995 @table @kbd
9996 @orgcmd{C-c C-e a,org-export-as-ascii}
9997 @cindex property, EXPORT_FILE_NAME
9998 Export as an ASCII file. For an Org file, @file{myfile.org}, the ASCII file
9999 will be @file{myfile.txt}. The file will be overwritten without
10000 warning. If there is an active region@footnote{This requires
10001 @code{transient-mark-mode} be turned on.}, only the region will be
10002 exported. If the selected region is a single tree@footnote{To select the
10003 current subtree, use @kbd{C-c @@}.}, the tree head will
10004 become the document title. If the tree head entry has or inherits an
10005 @code{EXPORT_FILE_NAME} property, that name will be used for the
10006 export.
10007 @orgcmd{C-c C-e A,org-export-as-ascii-to-buffer}
10008 Export to a temporary buffer. Do not create a file.
10009 @orgcmd{C-c C-e n,org-export-as-latin1}
10010 @xorgcmd{C-c C-e N,org-export-as-latin1-to-buffer}
10011 Like the above commands, but use Latin-1 encoding.
10012 @orgcmd{C-c C-e u,org-export-as-utf8}
10013 @xorgcmd{C-c C-e U,org-export-as-utf8-to-buffer}
10014 Like the above commands, but use UTF-8 encoding.
10015 @item C-c C-e v a/n/u
10016 Export only the visible part of the document.
10017 @end table
10018
10019 @cindex headline levels, for exporting
10020 In the exported version, the first 3 outline levels will become
10021 headlines, defining a general document structure. Additional levels
10022 will be exported as itemized lists. If you want that transition to occur
10023 at a different level, specify it with a prefix argument. For example,
10024
10025 @example
10026 @kbd{C-1 C-c C-e a}
10027 @end example
10028
10029 @noindent
10030 creates only top level headlines and exports the rest as items. When
10031 headlines are converted to items, the indentation of the text following
10032 the headline is changed to fit nicely under the item. This is done with
10033 the assumption that the first body line indicates the base indentation of
10034 the body text. Any indentation larger than this is adjusted to preserve
10035 the layout relative to the first line. Should there be lines with less
10036 indentation than the first one, these are left alone.
10037
10038 @vindex org-export-ascii-links-to-notes
10039 Links will be exported in a footnote-like style, with the descriptive part in
10040 the text and the link in a note before the next heading. See the variable
10041 @code{org-export-ascii-links-to-notes} for details and other options.
10042
10043 @node HTML export, @LaTeX{} and PDF export, ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export, Exporting
10044 @section HTML export
10045 @cindex HTML export
10046
10047 Org mode contains a HTML (XHTML 1.0 strict) exporter with extensive
10048 HTML formatting, in ways similar to John Gruber's @emph{markdown}
10049 language, but with additional support for tables.
10050
10051 @menu
10052 * HTML Export commands:: How to invoke HTML export
10053 * HTML preamble and postamble:: How to insert a preamble and a postamble
10054 * Quoting HTML tags:: Using direct HTML in Org mode
10055 * Links in HTML export:: How links will be interpreted and formatted
10056 * Tables in HTML export:: How to modify the formatting of tables
10057 * Images in HTML export:: How to insert figures into HTML output
10058 * Math formatting in HTML export:: Beautiful math also on the web
10059 * Text areas in HTML export:: An alternative way to show an example
10060 * CSS support:: Changing the appearance of the output
10061 * JavaScript support:: Info and Folding in a web browser
10062 @end menu
10063
10064 @node HTML Export commands, HTML preamble and postamble, HTML export, HTML export
10065 @subsection HTML export commands
10066
10067 @cindex region, active
10068 @cindex active region
10069 @cindex transient-mark-mode
10070 @table @kbd
10071 @orgcmd{C-c C-e h,org-export-as-html}
10072 @cindex property, EXPORT_FILE_NAME
10073 Export as a HTML file. For an Org file @file{myfile.org},
10074 the HTML file will be @file{myfile.html}. The file will be overwritten
10075 without warning. If there is an active region@footnote{This requires
10076 @code{transient-mark-mode} be turned on.}, only the region will be
10077 exported. If the selected region is a single tree@footnote{To select the
10078 current subtree, use @kbd{C-c @@}.}, the tree head will become the document
10079 title. If the tree head entry has, or inherits, an @code{EXPORT_FILE_NAME}
10080 property, that name will be used for the export.
10081 @orgcmd{C-c C-e b,org-export-as-html-and-open}
10082 Export as a HTML file and immediately open it with a browser.
10083 @orgcmd{C-c C-e H,org-export-as-html-to-buffer}
10084 Export to a temporary buffer. Do not create a file.
10085 @orgcmd{C-c C-e R,org-export-region-as-html}
10086 Export the active region to a temporary buffer. With a prefix argument, do
10087 not produce the file header and footer, but just the plain HTML section for
10088 the region. This is good for cut-and-paste operations.
10089 @item C-c C-e v h/b/H/R
10090 Export only the visible part of the document.
10091 @item M-x org-export-region-as-html
10092 Convert the region to HTML under the assumption that it was in Org mode
10093 syntax before. This is a global command that can be invoked in any
10094 buffer.
10095 @item M-x org-replace-region-by-HTML
10096 Replace the active region (assumed to be in Org mode syntax) by HTML
10097 code.
10098 @end table
10099
10100 @cindex headline levels, for exporting
10101 In the exported version, the first 3 outline levels will become headlines,
10102 defining a general document structure. Additional levels will be exported as
10103 itemized lists. If you want that transition to occur at a different level,
10104 specify it with a numeric prefix argument. For example,
10105
10106 @example
10107 @kbd{C-2 C-c C-e b}
10108 @end example
10109
10110 @noindent
10111 creates two levels of headings and does the rest as items.
10112
10113
10114 @node HTML preamble and postamble, Quoting HTML tags, HTML Export commands, HTML export
10115 @subsection HTML preamble and postamble
10116 @vindex org-export-html-preamble
10117 @vindex org-export-html-postamble
10118 @vindex org-export-html-preamble-format
10119 @vindex org-export-html-postamble-format
10120 @vindex org-export-html-validation-link
10121 @vindex org-export-author-info
10122 @vindex org-export-email-info
10123 @vindex org-export-creator-info
10124 @vindex org-export-time-stamp-file
10125
10126 The HTML exporter lets you define a preamble and a postamble.
10127
10128 The default value for @code{org-export-html-preamble} is @code{t}, which
10129 means that the preamble is inserted depending on the relevant format string
10130 in @code{org-export-html-preamble-format}.
10131
10132 Setting @code{org-export-html-preamble} to a string will override the default
10133 format string. Setting it to a function, will insert the output of the
10134 function, which must be a string; such a function takes no argument but you
10135 can check against the value of @code{opt-plist}, which contains the list of
10136 publishing properties for the current file. Setting to @code{nil} will not
10137 insert any preamble.
10138
10139 The default value for @code{org-export-html-postamble} is @code{'auto}, which
10140 means that the HTML exporter will look for the value of
10141 @code{org-export-author-info}, @code{org-export-email-info},
10142 @code{org-export-creator-info} and @code{org-export-time-stamp-file},
10143 @code{org-export-html-validation-link} and build the postamble from these
10144 values. Setting @code{org-export-html-postamble} to @code{t} will insert the
10145 postamble from the relevant format string found in
10146 @code{org-export-html-postamble-format}. Setting it to @code{nil} will not
10147 insert any postamble.
10148
10149 @node Quoting HTML tags, Links in HTML export, HTML preamble and postamble, HTML export
10150 @subsection Quoting HTML tags
10151
10152 Plain @samp{<} and @samp{>} are always transformed to @samp{&lt;} and
10153 @samp{&gt;} in HTML export. If you want to include simple HTML tags
10154 which should be interpreted as such, mark them with @samp{@@} as in
10155 @samp{@@<b>bold text@@</b>}. Note that this really works only for
10156 simple tags. For more extensive HTML that should be copied verbatim to
10157 the exported file use either
10158
10159 @cindex #+HTML
10160 @cindex #+BEGIN_HTML
10161 @example
10162 #+HTML: Literal HTML code for export
10163 @end example
10164
10165 @noindent or
10166 @cindex #+BEGIN_HTML
10167
10168 @example
10169 #+BEGIN_HTML
10170 All lines between these markers are exported literally
10171 #+END_HTML
10172 @end example
10173
10174
10175 @node Links in HTML export, Tables in HTML export, Quoting HTML tags, HTML export
10176 @subsection Links in HTML export
10177
10178 @cindex links, in HTML export
10179 @cindex internal links, in HTML export
10180 @cindex external links, in HTML export
10181 Internal links (@pxref{Internal links}) will continue to work in HTML@. This
10182 includes automatic links created by radio targets (@pxref{Radio
10183 targets}). Links to external files will still work if the target file is on
10184 the same @i{relative} path as the published Org file. Links to other
10185 @file{.org} files will be translated into HTML links under the assumption
10186 that a HTML version also exists of the linked file, at the same relative
10187 path. @samp{id:} links can then be used to jump to specific entries across
10188 files. For information related to linking files while publishing them to a
10189 publishing directory see @ref{Publishing links}.
10190
10191 If you want to specify attributes for links, you can do so using a special
10192 @code{#+ATTR_HTML} line to define attributes that will be added to the
10193 @code{<a>} or @code{<img>} tags. Here is an example that sets @code{title}
10194 and @code{style} attributes for a link:
10195
10196 @cindex #+ATTR_HTML
10197 @example
10198 #+ATTR_HTML: title="The Org mode homepage" style="color:red;"
10199 [[http://orgmode.org]]
10200 @end example
10201
10202 @node Tables in HTML export, Images in HTML export, Links in HTML export, HTML export
10203 @subsection Tables
10204 @cindex tables, in HTML
10205 @vindex org-export-html-table-tag
10206
10207 Org mode tables are exported to HTML using the table tag defined in
10208 @code{org-export-html-table-tag}. The default setting makes tables without
10209 cell borders and frame. If you would like to change this for individual
10210 tables, place something like the following before the table:
10211
10212 @cindex #+CAPTION
10213 @cindex #+ATTR_HTML
10214 @example
10215 #+CAPTION: This is a table with lines around and between cells
10216 #+ATTR_HTML: border="2" rules="all" frame="border"
10217 @end example
10218
10219 @node Images in HTML export, Math formatting in HTML export, Tables in HTML export, HTML export
10220 @subsection Images in HTML export
10221
10222 @cindex images, inline in HTML
10223 @cindex inlining images in HTML
10224 @vindex org-export-html-inline-images
10225 HTML export can inline images given as links in the Org file, and
10226 it can make an image the clickable part of a link. By
10227 default@footnote{But see the variable
10228 @code{org-export-html-inline-images}.}, images are inlined if a link does
10229 not have a description. So @samp{[[file:myimg.jpg]]} will be inlined,
10230 while @samp{[[file:myimg.jpg][the image]]} will just produce a link
10231 @samp{the image} that points to the image. If the description part
10232 itself is a @code{file:} link or a @code{http:} URL pointing to an
10233 image, this image will be inlined and activated so that clicking on the
10234 image will activate the link. For example, to include a thumbnail that
10235 will link to a high resolution version of the image, you could use:
10236
10237 @example
10238 [[file:highres.jpg][file:thumb.jpg]]
10239 @end example
10240
10241 If you need to add attributes to an inlined image, use a @code{#+ATTR_HTML}.
10242 In the example below we specify the @code{alt} and @code{title} attributes to
10243 support text viewers and accessibility, and align it to the right.
10244
10245 @cindex #+CAPTION
10246 @cindex #+ATTR_HTML
10247 @example
10248 #+CAPTION: A black cat stalking a spider
10249 #+ATTR_HTML: alt="cat/spider image" title="Action!" align="right"
10250 [[./img/a.jpg]]
10251 @end example
10252
10253 @noindent
10254 You could use @code{http} addresses just as well.
10255
10256 @node Math formatting in HTML export, Text areas in HTML export, Images in HTML export, HTML export
10257 @subsection Math formatting in HTML export
10258 @cindex MathJax
10259 @cindex dvipng
10260
10261 @LaTeX{} math snippets (@pxref{@LaTeX{} fragments}) can be displayed in two
10262 different ways on HTML pages. The default is to use the
10263 @uref{http://www.mathjax.org, MathJax system} which should work out of the
10264 box with Org mode installation because @code{http://orgmode.org} serves
10265 @file{MathJax} for Org mode users for small applications and for testing
10266 purposes. @b{If you plan to use this regularly or on pages with significant
10267 page views, you should install@footnote{Installation instructions can be
10268 found on the MathJax website, see
10269 @uref{http://www.mathjax.org/resources/docs/?installation.html}.} MathJax on
10270 your own server in order to limit the load of our server.} To configure
10271 @file{MathJax}, use the variable @code{org-export-html-mathjax-options} or
10272 insert something like the following into the buffer:
10273
10274 @example
10275 #+MATHJAX: align:"left" mathml:t path:"/MathJax/MathJax.js"
10276 @end example
10277
10278 @noindent See the docstring of the variable
10279 @code{org-export-html-mathjax-options} for the meaning of the parameters in
10280 this line.
10281
10282 If you prefer, you can also request that @LaTeX{} fragments are processed
10283 into small images that will be inserted into the browser page. Before the
10284 availability of MathJax, this was the default method for Org files. This
10285 method requires that the @file{dvipng} program is available on your system.
10286 You can still get this processing with
10287
10288 @example
10289 #+OPTIONS: LaTeX:dvipng
10290 @end example
10291
10292 @node Text areas in HTML export, CSS support, Math formatting in HTML export, HTML export
10293 @subsection Text areas in HTML export
10294
10295 @cindex text areas, in HTML
10296 An alternative way to publish literal code examples in HTML is to use text
10297 areas, where the example can even be edited before pasting it into an
10298 application. It is triggered by a @code{-t} switch at an @code{example} or
10299 @code{src} block. Using this switch disables any options for syntax and
10300 label highlighting, and line numbering, which may be present. You may also
10301 use @code{-h} and @code{-w} switches to specify the height and width of the
10302 text area, which default to the number of lines in the example, and 80,
10303 respectively. For example
10304
10305 @example
10306 #+BEGIN_EXAMPLE -t -w 40
10307 (defun org-xor (a b)
10308 "Exclusive or."
10309 (if a (not b) b))
10310 #+END_EXAMPLE
10311 @end example
10312
10313
10314 @node CSS support, JavaScript support, Text areas in HTML export, HTML export
10315 @subsection CSS support
10316 @cindex CSS, for HTML export
10317 @cindex HTML export, CSS
10318
10319 @vindex org-export-html-todo-kwd-class-prefix
10320 @vindex org-export-html-tag-class-prefix
10321 You can also give style information for the exported file. The HTML exporter
10322 assigns the following special CSS classes@footnote{If the classes on TODO
10323 keywords and tags lead to conflicts, use the variables
10324 @code{org-export-html-todo-kwd-class-prefix} and
10325 @code{org-export-html-tag-class-prefix} to make them unique.} to appropriate
10326 parts of the document---your style specifications may change these, in
10327 addition to any of the standard classes like for headlines, tables, etc.
10328 @example
10329 p.author @r{author information, including email}
10330 p.date @r{publishing date}
10331 p.creator @r{creator info, about org mode version}
10332 .title @r{document title}
10333 .todo @r{TODO keywords, all not-done states}
10334 .done @r{the DONE keywords, all states that count as done}
10335 .WAITING @r{each TODO keyword also uses a class named after itself}
10336 .timestamp @r{timestamp}
10337 .timestamp-kwd @r{keyword associated with a timestamp, like SCHEDULED}
10338 .timestamp-wrapper @r{span around keyword plus timestamp}
10339 .tag @r{tag in a headline}
10340 ._HOME @r{each tag uses itself as a class, "@@" replaced by "_"}
10341 .target @r{target for links}
10342 .linenr @r{the line number in a code example}
10343 .code-highlighted @r{for highlighting referenced code lines}
10344 div.outline-N @r{div for outline level N (headline plus text))}
10345 div.outline-text-N @r{extra div for text at outline level N}
10346 .section-number-N @r{section number in headlines, different for each level}
10347 div.figure @r{how to format an inlined image}
10348 pre.src @r{formatted source code}
10349 pre.example @r{normal example}
10350 p.verse @r{verse paragraph}
10351 div.footnotes @r{footnote section headline}
10352 p.footnote @r{footnote definition paragraph, containing a footnote}
10353 .footref @r{a footnote reference number (always a <sup>)}
10354 .footnum @r{footnote number in footnote definition (always <sup>)}
10355 @end example
10356
10357 @vindex org-export-html-style-default
10358 @vindex org-export-html-style-include-default
10359 @vindex org-export-html-style
10360 @vindex org-export-html-extra
10361 @vindex org-export-html-style-default
10362 Each exported file contains a compact default style that defines these
10363 classes in a basic way@footnote{This style is defined in the constant
10364 @code{org-export-html-style-default}, which you should not modify. To turn
10365 inclusion of these defaults off, customize
10366 @code{org-export-html-style-include-default}}. You may overwrite these
10367 settings, or add to them by using the variables @code{org-export-html-style}
10368 (for Org-wide settings) and @code{org-export-html-style-extra} (for more
10369 fine-grained settings, like file-local settings). To set the latter variable
10370 individually for each file, you can use
10371
10372 @cindex #+STYLE
10373 @example
10374 #+STYLE: <link rel="stylesheet" type="text/css" href="stylesheet.css" />
10375 @end example
10376
10377 @noindent
10378 For longer style definitions, you can use several such lines. You could also
10379 directly write a @code{<style>} @code{</style>} section in this way, without
10380 referring to an external file.
10381
10382 In order to add styles to a subtree, use the @code{:HTML_CONTAINER_CLASS:}
10383 property to assign a class to the tree. In order to specify CSS styles for a
10384 particular headline, you can use the id specified in a @code{:CUSTOM_ID:}
10385 property.
10386
10387 @c FIXME: More about header and footer styles
10388 @c FIXME: Talk about links and targets.
10389
10390 @node JavaScript support, , CSS support, HTML export
10391 @subsection JavaScript supported display of web pages
10392
10393 @cindex Rose, Sebastian
10394 Sebastian Rose has written a JavaScript program especially designed to
10395 enhance the web viewing experience of HTML files created with Org. This
10396 program allows you to view large files in two different ways. The first one
10397 is an @emph{Info}-like mode where each section is displayed separately and
10398 navigation can be done with the @kbd{n} and @kbd{p} keys (and some other keys
10399 as well, press @kbd{?} for an overview of the available keys). The second
10400 view type is a @emph{folding} view much like Org provides inside Emacs. The
10401 script is available at @url{http://orgmode.org/org-info.js} and you can find
10402 the documentation for it at @url{http://orgmode.org/worg/code/org-info-js/}.
10403 We host the script at our site, but if you use it a lot, you might
10404 not want to be dependent on @url{orgmode.org} and prefer to install a local
10405 copy on your own web server.
10406
10407 To use the script, you need to make sure that the @file{org-jsinfo.el} module
10408 gets loaded. It should be loaded by default, but you can try @kbd{M-x
10409 customize-variable @key{RET} org-modules @key{RET}} to convince yourself that
10410 this is indeed the case. All it then takes to make use of the program is
10411 adding a single line to the Org file:
10412
10413 @cindex #+INFOJS_OPT
10414 @example
10415 #+INFOJS_OPT: view:info toc:nil
10416 @end example
10417
10418 @noindent
10419 If this line is found, the HTML header will automatically contain the code
10420 needed to invoke the script. Using the line above, you can set the following
10421 viewing options:
10422
10423 @example
10424 path: @r{The path to the script. The default is to grab the script from}
10425 @r{@url{http://orgmode.org/org-info.js}, but you might want to have}
10426 @r{a local copy and use a path like @samp{../scripts/org-info.js}.}
10427 view: @r{Initial view when the website is first shown. Possible values are:}
10428 info @r{Info-like interface with one section per page.}
10429 overview @r{Folding interface, initially showing only top-level.}
10430 content @r{Folding interface, starting with all headlines visible.}
10431 showall @r{Folding interface, all headlines and text visible.}
10432 sdepth: @r{Maximum headline level that will still become an independent}
10433 @r{section for info and folding modes. The default is taken from}
10434 @r{@code{org-export-headline-levels} (= the @code{H} switch in @code{#+OPTIONS}).}
10435 @r{If this is smaller than in @code{org-export-headline-levels}, each}
10436 @r{info/folding section can still contain child headlines.}
10437 toc: @r{Should the table of contents @emph{initially} be visible?}
10438 @r{Even when @code{nil}, you can always get to the "toc" with @kbd{i}.}
10439 tdepth: @r{The depth of the table of contents. The defaults are taken from}
10440 @r{the variables @code{org-export-headline-levels} and @code{org-export-with-toc}.}
10441 ftoc: @r{Does the CSS of the page specify a fixed position for the "toc"?}
10442 @r{If yes, the toc will never be displayed as a section.}
10443 ltoc: @r{Should there be short contents (children) in each section?}
10444 @r{Make this @code{above} if the section should be above initial text.}
10445 mouse: @r{Headings are highlighted when the mouse is over them. Should be}
10446 @r{@samp{underline} (default) or a background color like @samp{#cccccc}.}
10447 buttons: @r{Should view-toggle buttons be everywhere? When @code{nil} (the}
10448 @r{default), only one such button will be present.}
10449 @end example
10450 @noindent
10451 @vindex org-infojs-options
10452 @vindex org-export-html-use-infojs
10453 You can choose default values for these options by customizing the variable
10454 @code{org-infojs-options}. If you always want to apply the script to your
10455 pages, configure the variable @code{org-export-html-use-infojs}.
10456
10457 @node @LaTeX{} and PDF export, DocBook export, HTML export, Exporting
10458 @section @LaTeX{} and PDF export
10459 @cindex @LaTeX{} export
10460 @cindex PDF export
10461 @cindex Guerry, Bastien
10462
10463 Org mode contains a @LaTeX{} exporter written by Bastien Guerry. With
10464 further processing@footnote{The default @LaTeX{} output is designed for
10465 processing with @code{pdftex} or @LaTeX{}. It includes packages that are not
10466 compatible with @code{xetex} and possibly @code{luatex}. See the variables
10467 @code{org-export-latex-default-packages-alist} and
10468 @code{org-export-latex-packages-alist}.}, this backend is also used to
10469 produce PDF output. Since the @LaTeX{} output uses @file{hyperref} to
10470 implement links and cross references, the PDF output file will be fully
10471 linked. Beware of the fact that your @code{org} file has to be properly
10472 structured in order to be correctly exported: respect the hierarchy of
10473 sections.
10474
10475 @menu
10476 * @LaTeX{}/PDF export commands::
10477 * Header and sectioning:: Setting up the export file structure
10478 * Quoting @LaTeX{} code:: Incorporating literal @LaTeX{} code
10479 * Tables in @LaTeX{} export:: Options for exporting tables to @LaTeX{}
10480 * Images in @LaTeX{} export:: How to insert figures into @LaTeX{} output
10481 * Beamer class export:: Turning the file into a presentation
10482 @end menu
10483
10484 @node @LaTeX{}/PDF export commands, Header and sectioning, @LaTeX{} and PDF export, @LaTeX{} and PDF export
10485 @subsection @LaTeX{} export commands
10486
10487 @cindex region, active
10488 @cindex active region
10489 @cindex transient-mark-mode
10490 @table @kbd
10491 @orgcmd{C-c C-e l,org-export-as-latex}
10492 @cindex property EXPORT_FILE_NAME
10493 Export as a @LaTeX{} file. For an Org file
10494 @file{myfile.org}, the @LaTeX{} file will be @file{myfile.tex}. The file will
10495 be overwritten without warning. If there is an active region@footnote{This
10496 requires @code{transient-mark-mode} be turned on.}, only the region will be
10497 exported. If the selected region is a single tree@footnote{To select the
10498 current subtree, use @kbd{C-c @@}.}, the tree head will become the document
10499 title. If the tree head entry has or inherits an @code{EXPORT_FILE_NAME}
10500 property, that name will be used for the export.
10501 @orgcmd{C-c C-e L,org-export-as-latex-to-buffer}
10502 Export to a temporary buffer. Do not create a file.
10503 @item C-c C-e v l/L
10504 Export only the visible part of the document.
10505 @item M-x org-export-region-as-latex
10506 Convert the region to @LaTeX{} under the assumption that it was in Org mode
10507 syntax before. This is a global command that can be invoked in any
10508 buffer.
10509 @item M-x org-replace-region-by-latex
10510 Replace the active region (assumed to be in Org mode syntax) by @LaTeX{}
10511 code.
10512 @orgcmd{C-c C-e p,org-export-as-pdf}
10513 Export as @LaTeX{} and then process to PDF.
10514 @orgcmd{C-c C-e d,org-export-as-pdf-and-open}
10515 Export as @LaTeX{} and then process to PDF, then open the resulting PDF file.
10516 @end table
10517
10518 @cindex headline levels, for exporting
10519 @vindex org-latex-low-levels
10520 In the exported version, the first 3 outline levels will become
10521 headlines, defining a general document structure. Additional levels
10522 will be exported as description lists. The exporter can ignore them or
10523 convert them to a custom string depending on
10524 @code{org-latex-low-levels}.
10525
10526 If you want that transition to occur at a different level, specify it
10527 with a numeric prefix argument. For example,
10528
10529 @example
10530 @kbd{C-2 C-c C-e l}
10531 @end example
10532
10533 @noindent
10534 creates two levels of headings and does the rest as items.
10535
10536 @node Header and sectioning, Quoting @LaTeX{} code, @LaTeX{}/PDF export commands, @LaTeX{} and PDF export
10537 @subsection Header and sectioning structure
10538 @cindex @LaTeX{} class
10539 @cindex @LaTeX{} sectioning structure
10540 @cindex @LaTeX{} header
10541 @cindex header, for @LaTeX{} files
10542 @cindex sectioning structure, for @LaTeX{} export
10543
10544 By default, the @LaTeX{} output uses the class @code{article}.
10545
10546 @vindex org-export-latex-default-class
10547 @vindex org-export-latex-classes
10548 @vindex org-export-latex-default-packages-alist
10549 @vindex org-export-latex-packages-alist
10550 @cindex #+LaTeX_HEADER
10551 @cindex #+LaTeX_CLASS
10552 @cindex #+LaTeX_CLASS_OPTIONS
10553 @cindex property, LaTeX_CLASS
10554 @cindex property, LaTeX_CLASS_OPTIONS
10555 You can change this globally by setting a different value for
10556 @code{org-export-latex-default-class} or locally by adding an option like
10557 @code{#+LaTeX_CLASS: myclass} in your file, or with a @code{:LaTeX_CLASS:}
10558 property that applies when exporting a region containing only this (sub)tree.
10559 The class must be listed in @code{org-export-latex-classes}. This variable
10560 defines a header template for each class@footnote{Into which the values of
10561 @code{org-export-latex-default-packages-alist} and
10562 @code{org-export-latex-packages-alist} are spliced.}, and allows you to
10563 define the sectioning structure for each class. You can also define your own
10564 classes there. @code{#+LaTeX_CLASS_OPTIONS} or a @code{:LaTeX_CLASS_OPTIONS:}
10565 property can specify the options for the @code{\documentclass} macro. The
10566 options to documentclass have to be provided, as expected by @LaTeX{}, within
10567 square brackets. You can also use @code{#+LaTeX_HEADER: \usepackage@{xyz@}}
10568 to add lines to the header. See the docstring of
10569 @code{org-export-latex-classes} for more information. An example is shown
10570 below.
10571
10572 @example
10573 #+LaTeX_CLASS: article
10574 #+LaTeX_CLASS_OPTIONS: [a4paper]
10575 #+LaTeX_HEADER: \usepackage@{xyz@}
10576
10577 * Headline 1
10578 some text
10579 @end example
10580
10581 @node Quoting @LaTeX{} code, Tables in @LaTeX{} export, Header and sectioning, @LaTeX{} and PDF export
10582 @subsection Quoting @LaTeX{} code
10583
10584 Embedded @LaTeX{} as described in @ref{Embedded @LaTeX{}}, will be correctly
10585 inserted into the @LaTeX{} file. This includes simple macros like
10586 @samp{\ref@{LABEL@}} to create a cross reference to a figure. Furthermore,
10587 you can add special code that should only be present in @LaTeX{} export with
10588 the following constructs:
10589
10590 @cindex #+LaTeX
10591 @cindex #+BEGIN_LaTeX
10592 @example
10593 #+LaTeX: Literal @LaTeX{} code for export
10594 @end example
10595
10596 @noindent or
10597 @cindex #+BEGIN_LaTeX
10598
10599 @example
10600 #+BEGIN_LaTeX
10601 All lines between these markers are exported literally
10602 #+END_LaTeX
10603 @end example
10604
10605
10606 @node Tables in @LaTeX{} export, Images in @LaTeX{} export, Quoting @LaTeX{} code, @LaTeX{} and PDF export
10607 @subsection Tables in @LaTeX{} export
10608 @cindex tables, in @LaTeX{} export
10609
10610 For @LaTeX{} export of a table, you can specify a label, a caption and
10611 placement options (@pxref{Images and tables}). You can also use the
10612 @code{ATTR_LaTeX} line to request a @code{longtable} environment for the
10613 table, so that it may span several pages, or to change the default table
10614 environment from @code{table} to @code{table*} or to change the default inner
10615 tabular environment to @code{tabularx} or @code{tabulary}. Finally, you can
10616 set the alignment string, and (with @code{tabularx} or @code{tabulary}) the
10617 width:
10618
10619 @cindex #+CAPTION
10620 @cindex #+LABEL
10621 @cindex #+ATTR_LaTeX
10622 @example
10623 #+CAPTION: A long table
10624 #+LABEL: tbl:long
10625 #+ATTR_LaTeX: longtable align=l|lp@{3cm@}r|l
10626 | ..... | ..... |
10627 | ..... | ..... |
10628 @end example
10629
10630 or to specify a multicolumn table with @code{tabulary}
10631
10632 @cindex #+CAPTION
10633 @cindex #+LABEL
10634 @cindex #+ATTR_LaTeX
10635 @example
10636 #+CAPTION: A wide table with tabulary
10637 #+LABEL: tbl:wide
10638 #+ATTR_LaTeX: table* tabulary width=\textwidth
10639 | ..... | ..... |
10640 | ..... | ..... |
10641 @end example
10642
10643 @node Images in @LaTeX{} export, Beamer class export, Tables in @LaTeX{} export, @LaTeX{} and PDF export
10644 @subsection Images in @LaTeX{} export
10645 @cindex images, inline in @LaTeX{}
10646 @cindex inlining images in @LaTeX{}
10647
10648 Images that are linked to without a description part in the link, like
10649 @samp{[[file:img.jpg]]} or @samp{[[./img.jpg]]} will be inserted into the PDF
10650 output file resulting from @LaTeX{} processing. Org will use an
10651 @code{\includegraphics} macro to insert the image. If you have specified a
10652 caption and/or a label as described in @ref{Images and tables}, the figure
10653 will be wrapped into a @code{figure} environment and thus become a floating
10654 element. You can use an @code{#+ATTR_LaTeX:} line to specify various other
10655 options. You can ask org to export an image as a float without specifying
10656 a label or a caption by using the keyword @code{float} in this line. Various
10657 optional arguments to the @code{\includegraphics} macro can also be specified
10658 in this fashion. To modify the placement option of the floating environment,
10659 add something like @samp{placement=[h!]} to the attributes. It is to be noted
10660 this option can be used with tables as well@footnote{One can also take
10661 advantage of this option to pass other, unrelated options into the figure or
10662 table environment. For an example see the section ``Exporting org files'' in
10663 @url{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-hacks.html}}.
10664
10665 If you would like to let text flow around the image, add the word @samp{wrap}
10666 to the @code{#+ATTR_LaTeX:} line, which will make the figure occupy the left
10667 half of the page. To fine-tune, the @code{placement} field will be the set
10668 of additional arguments needed by the @code{wrapfigure} environment. Note
10669 that if you change the size of the image, you need to use compatible settings
10670 for @code{\includegraphics} and @code{wrapfigure}.
10671
10672 @cindex #+CAPTION
10673 @cindex #+LABEL
10674 @cindex #+ATTR_LaTeX
10675 @example
10676 #+CAPTION: The black-body emission of the disk around HR 4049
10677 #+LABEL: fig:SED-HR4049
10678 #+ATTR_LaTeX: width=5cm,angle=90
10679 [[./img/sed-hr4049.pdf]]
10680
10681 #+ATTR_LaTeX: width=0.38\textwidth wrap placement=@{r@}@{0.4\textwidth@}
10682 [[./img/hst.png]]
10683 @end example
10684
10685 If you wish to include an image which spans multiple columns in a page, you
10686 can use the keyword @code{multicolumn} in the @code{#+ATTR_LaTeX} line. This
10687 will export the image wrapped in a @code{figure*} environment.
10688
10689 If you need references to a label created in this way, write
10690 @samp{\ref@{fig:SED-HR4049@}} just like in @LaTeX{}.
10691
10692 @node Beamer class export, , Images in @LaTeX{} export, @LaTeX{} and PDF export
10693 @subsection Beamer class export
10694
10695 The @LaTeX{} class @file{beamer} allows production of high quality presentations
10696 using @LaTeX{} and pdf processing. Org mode has special support for turning an
10697 Org mode file or tree into a @file{beamer} presentation.
10698
10699 When the @LaTeX{} class for the current buffer (as set with @code{#+LaTeX_CLASS:
10700 beamer}) or subtree (set with a @code{LaTeX_CLASS} property) is
10701 @code{beamer}, a special export mode will turn the file or tree into a beamer
10702 presentation. Any tree with not-too-deep level nesting should in principle be
10703 exportable as a beamer presentation. By default, the top-level entries (or
10704 the first level below the selected subtree heading) will be turned into
10705 frames, and the outline structure below this level will become itemize lists.
10706 You can also configure the variable @code{org-beamer-frame-level} to a
10707 different level---then the hierarchy above frames will produce the sectioning
10708 structure of the presentation.
10709
10710 A template for useful in-buffer settings or properties can be inserted into
10711 the buffer with @kbd{M-x org-insert-beamer-options-template}. Among other
10712 things, this will install a column view format which is very handy for
10713 editing special properties used by beamer.
10714
10715 You can influence the structure of the presentation using the following
10716 properties:
10717
10718 @table @code
10719 @item BEAMER_env
10720 The environment that should be used to format this entry. Valid environments
10721 are defined in the constant @code{org-beamer-environments-default}, and you
10722 can define more in @code{org-beamer-environments-extra}. If this property is
10723 set, the entry will also get a @code{:B_environment:} tag to make this
10724 visible. This tag has no semantic meaning, it is only a visual aid.
10725 @item BEAMER_envargs
10726 The beamer-special arguments that should be used for the environment, like
10727 @code{[t]} or @code{[<+->]} of @code{<2-3>}. If the @code{BEAMER_col}
10728 property is also set, something like @code{C[t]} can be added here as well to
10729 set an options argument for the implied @code{columns} environment.
10730 @code{c[t]} or @code{c<2->} will set an options for the implied @code{column}
10731 environment.
10732 @item BEAMER_col
10733 The width of a column that should start with this entry. If this property is
10734 set, the entry will also get a @code{:BMCOL:} property to make this visible.
10735 Also this tag is only a visual aid. When this is a plain number, it will be
10736 interpreted as a fraction of @code{\textwidth}. Otherwise it will be assumed
10737 that you have specified the units, like @samp{3cm}. The first such property
10738 in a frame will start a @code{columns} environment to surround the columns.
10739 This environment is closed when an entry has a @code{BEAMER_col} property
10740 with value 0 or 1, or automatically at the end of the frame.
10741 @item BEAMER_extra
10742 Additional commands that should be inserted after the environment has been
10743 opened. For example, when creating a frame, this can be used to specify
10744 transitions.
10745 @end table
10746
10747 Frames will automatically receive a @code{fragile} option if they contain
10748 source code that uses the verbatim environment. Special @file{beamer}
10749 specific code can be inserted using @code{#+BEAMER:} and
10750 @code{#+BEGIN_BEAMER...#+END_BEAMER} constructs, similar to other export
10751 backends, but with the difference that @code{#+LaTeX:} stuff will be included
10752 in the presentation as well.
10753
10754 Outline nodes with @code{BEAMER_env} property value @samp{note} or
10755 @samp{noteNH} will be formatted as beamer notes, i,e, they will be wrapped
10756 into @code{\note@{...@}}. The former will include the heading as part of the
10757 note text, the latter will ignore the heading of that node. To simplify note
10758 generation, it is actually enough to mark the note with a @emph{tag} (either
10759 @code{:B_note:} or @code{:B_noteNH:}) instead of creating the
10760 @code{BEAMER_env} property.
10761
10762 You can turn on a special minor mode @code{org-beamer-mode} for editing
10763 support with
10764
10765 @example
10766 #+STARTUP: beamer
10767 @end example
10768
10769 @table @kbd
10770 @orgcmd{C-c C-b,org-beamer-select-environment}
10771 In @code{org-beamer-mode}, this key offers fast selection of a beamer
10772 environment or the @code{BEAMER_col} property.
10773 @end table
10774
10775 Column view provides a great way to set the environment of a node and other
10776 important parameters. Make sure you are using a COLUMN format that is geared
10777 toward this special purpose. The command @kbd{M-x
10778 org-insert-beamer-options-template} defines such a format.
10779
10780 Here is a simple example Org document that is intended for beamer export.
10781
10782 @smallexample
10783 #+LaTeX_CLASS: beamer
10784 #+TITLE: Example Presentation
10785 #+AUTHOR: Carsten Dominik
10786 #+LaTeX_CLASS_OPTIONS: [presentation]
10787 #+BEAMER_FRAME_LEVEL: 2
10788 #+BEAMER_HEADER_EXTRA: \usetheme@{Madrid@}\usecolortheme@{default@}
10789 #+COLUMNS: %35ITEM %10BEAMER_env(Env) %10BEAMER_envargs(Args) %4BEAMER_col(Col) %8BEAMER_extra(Ex)
10790
10791 * This is the first structural section
10792
10793 ** Frame 1 \\ with a subtitle
10794 *** Thanks to Eric Fraga :BMCOL:B_block:
10795 :PROPERTIES:
10796 :BEAMER_env: block
10797 :BEAMER_envargs: C[t]
10798 :BEAMER_col: 0.5
10799 :END:
10800 for the first viable beamer setup in Org
10801 *** Thanks to everyone else :BMCOL:B_block:
10802 :PROPERTIES:
10803 :BEAMER_col: 0.5
10804 :BEAMER_env: block
10805 :BEAMER_envargs: <2->
10806 :END:
10807 for contributing to the discussion
10808 **** This will be formatted as a beamer note :B_note:
10809 ** Frame 2 \\ where we will not use columns
10810 *** Request :B_block:
10811 Please test this stuff!
10812 :PROPERTIES:
10813 :BEAMER_env: block
10814 :END:
10815 @end smallexample
10816
10817 For more information, see the documentation on Worg.
10818
10819 @node DocBook export, OpenDocument Text export, @LaTeX{} and PDF export, Exporting
10820 @section DocBook export
10821 @cindex DocBook export
10822 @cindex PDF export
10823 @cindex Cui, Baoqiu
10824
10825 Org contains a DocBook exporter written by Baoqiu Cui. Once an Org file is
10826 exported to DocBook format, it can be further processed to produce other
10827 formats, including PDF, HTML, man pages, etc., using many available DocBook
10828 tools and stylesheets.
10829
10830 Currently DocBook exporter only supports DocBook V5.0.
10831
10832 @menu
10833 * DocBook export commands:: How to invoke DocBook export
10834 * Quoting DocBook code:: Incorporating DocBook code in Org files
10835 * Recursive sections:: Recursive sections in DocBook
10836 * Tables in DocBook export:: Tables are exported as HTML tables
10837 * Images in DocBook export:: How to insert figures into DocBook output
10838 * Special characters:: How to handle special characters
10839 @end menu
10840
10841 @node DocBook export commands, Quoting DocBook code, DocBook export, DocBook export
10842 @subsection DocBook export commands
10843
10844 @cindex region, active
10845 @cindex active region
10846 @cindex transient-mark-mode
10847 @table @kbd
10848 @orgcmd{C-c C-e D,org-export-as-docbook}
10849 @cindex property EXPORT_FILE_NAME
10850 Export as a DocBook file. For an Org file, @file{myfile.org}, the DocBook XML
10851 file will be @file{myfile.xml}. The file will be overwritten without
10852 warning. If there is an active region@footnote{This requires
10853 @code{transient-mark-mode} to be turned on}, only the region will be
10854 exported. If the selected region is a single tree@footnote{To select the
10855 current subtree, use @kbd{C-c @@}.}, the tree head will become the document
10856 title. If the tree head entry has, or inherits, an @code{EXPORT_FILE_NAME}
10857 property, that name will be used for the export.
10858 @orgcmd{C-c C-e V,org-export-as-docbook-pdf-and-open}
10859 Export as a DocBook file, process to PDF, then open the resulting PDF file.
10860
10861 @vindex org-export-docbook-xslt-proc-command
10862 @vindex org-export-docbook-xsl-fo-proc-command
10863 Note that, in order to produce PDF output based on an exported DocBook file,
10864 you need to have XSLT processor and XSL-FO processor software installed on your
10865 system. Check variables @code{org-export-docbook-xslt-proc-command} and
10866 @code{org-export-docbook-xsl-fo-proc-command}.
10867
10868 @vindex org-export-docbook-xslt-stylesheet
10869 The stylesheet argument @code{%s} in variable
10870 @code{org-export-docbook-xslt-proc-command} is replaced by the value of
10871 variable @code{org-export-docbook-xslt-stylesheet}, which needs to be set by
10872 the user. You can also overrule this global setting on a per-file basis by
10873 adding an in-buffer setting @code{#+XSLT:} to the Org file.
10874
10875 @orgkey{C-c C-e v D}
10876 Export only the visible part of the document.
10877 @end table
10878
10879 @node Quoting DocBook code, Recursive sections, DocBook export commands, DocBook export
10880 @subsection Quoting DocBook code
10881
10882 You can quote DocBook code in Org files and copy it verbatim into exported
10883 DocBook file with the following constructs:
10884
10885 @cindex #+DOCBOOK
10886 @cindex #+BEGIN_DOCBOOK
10887 @example
10888 #+DOCBOOK: Literal DocBook code for export
10889 @end example
10890
10891 @noindent or
10892 @cindex #+BEGIN_DOCBOOK
10893
10894 @example
10895 #+BEGIN_DOCBOOK
10896 All lines between these markers are exported by DocBook exporter
10897 literally.
10898 #+END_DOCBOOK
10899 @end example
10900
10901 For example, you can use the following lines to include a DocBook warning
10902 admonition. As to what this warning says, you should pay attention to the
10903 document context when quoting DocBook code in Org files. You may make
10904 exported DocBook XML files invalid by not quoting DocBook code correctly.
10905
10906 @example
10907 #+BEGIN_DOCBOOK
10908 <warning>
10909 <para>You should know what you are doing when quoting DocBook XML code
10910 in your Org file. Invalid DocBook XML may be generated by
10911 DocBook exporter if you are not careful!</para>
10912 </warning>
10913 #+END_DOCBOOK
10914 @end example
10915
10916 @node Recursive sections, Tables in DocBook export, Quoting DocBook code, DocBook export
10917 @subsection Recursive sections
10918 @cindex DocBook recursive sections
10919
10920 DocBook exporter exports Org files as articles using the @code{article}
10921 element in DocBook. Recursive sections, i.e., @code{section} elements, are
10922 used in exported articles. Top level headlines in Org files are exported as
10923 top level sections, and lower level headlines are exported as nested
10924 sections. The entire structure of Org files will be exported completely, no
10925 matter how many nested levels of headlines there are.
10926
10927 Using recursive sections makes it easy to port and reuse exported DocBook
10928 code in other DocBook document types like @code{book} or @code{set}.
10929
10930 @node Tables in DocBook export, Images in DocBook export, Recursive sections, DocBook export
10931 @subsection Tables in DocBook export
10932 @cindex tables, in DocBook export
10933
10934 Tables in Org files are exported as HTML tables, which have been supported since
10935 DocBook V4.3.
10936
10937 If a table does not have a caption, an informal table is generated using the
10938 @code{informaltable} element; otherwise, a formal table will be generated
10939 using the @code{table} element.
10940
10941 @node Images in DocBook export, Special characters, Tables in DocBook export, DocBook export
10942 @subsection Images in DocBook export
10943 @cindex images, inline in DocBook
10944 @cindex inlining images in DocBook
10945
10946 Images that are linked to without a description part in the link, like
10947 @samp{[[file:img.jpg]]} or @samp{[[./img.jpg]]}, will be exported to DocBook
10948 using @code{mediaobject} elements. Each @code{mediaobject} element contains
10949 an @code{imageobject} that wraps an @code{imagedata} element. If you have
10950 specified a caption for an image as described in @ref{Images and tables}, a
10951 @code{caption} element will be added in @code{mediaobject}. If a label is
10952 also specified, it will be exported as an @code{xml:id} attribute of the
10953 @code{mediaobject} element.
10954
10955 @vindex org-export-docbook-default-image-attributes
10956 Image attributes supported by the @code{imagedata} element, like @code{align}
10957 or @code{width}, can be specified in two ways: you can either customize
10958 variable @code{org-export-docbook-default-image-attributes} or use the
10959 @code{#+ATTR_DOCBOOK:} line. Attributes specified in variable
10960 @code{org-export-docbook-default-image-attributes} are applied to all inline
10961 images in the Org file to be exported (unless they are overridden by image
10962 attributes specified in @code{#+ATTR_DOCBOOK:} lines).
10963
10964 The @code{#+ATTR_DOCBOOK:} line can be used to specify additional image
10965 attributes or override default image attributes for individual images. If
10966 the same attribute appears in both the @code{#+ATTR_DOCBOOK:} line and
10967 variable @code{org-export-docbook-default-image-attributes}, the former
10968 takes precedence. Here is an example about how image attributes can be
10969 set:
10970
10971 @cindex #+CAPTION
10972 @cindex #+LABEL
10973 @cindex #+ATTR_DOCBOOK
10974 @example
10975 #+CAPTION: The logo of Org mode
10976 #+LABEL: unicorn-svg
10977 #+ATTR_DOCBOOK: scalefit="1" width="100%" depth="100%"
10978 [[./img/org-mode-unicorn.svg]]
10979 @end example
10980
10981 @vindex org-export-docbook-inline-image-extensions
10982 By default, DocBook exporter recognizes the following image file types:
10983 @file{jpeg}, @file{jpg}, @file{png}, @file{gif}, and @file{svg}. You can
10984 customize variable @code{org-export-docbook-inline-image-extensions} to add
10985 more types to this list as long as DocBook supports them.
10986
10987 @node Special characters, , Images in DocBook export, DocBook export
10988 @subsection Special characters in DocBook export
10989 @cindex Special characters in DocBook export
10990
10991 @vindex org-export-docbook-doctype
10992 @vindex org-entities
10993 Special characters that are written in @TeX{}-like syntax, such as @code{\alpha},
10994 @code{\Gamma}, and @code{\Zeta}, are supported by DocBook exporter. These
10995 characters are rewritten to XML entities, like @code{&alpha;},
10996 @code{&Gamma;}, and @code{&Zeta;}, based on the list saved in variable
10997 @code{org-entities}. As long as the generated DocBook file includes the
10998 corresponding entities, these special characters are recognized.
10999
11000 You can customize variable @code{org-export-docbook-doctype} to include the
11001 entities you need. For example, you can set variable
11002 @code{org-export-docbook-doctype} to the following value to recognize all
11003 special characters included in XHTML entities:
11004
11005 @example
11006 "<!DOCTYPE article [
11007 <!ENTITY % xhtml1-symbol PUBLIC
11008 \"-//W3C//ENTITIES Symbol for HTML//EN//XML\"
11009 \"http://www.w3.org/2003/entities/2007/xhtml1-symbol.ent\"
11010 >
11011 %xhtml1-symbol;
11012 ]>
11013 "
11014 @end example
11015
11016 @c begin opendocument
11017
11018 @node OpenDocument Text export, TaskJuggler export, DocBook export, Exporting
11019 @section OpenDocument Text export
11020 @cindex K, Jambunathan
11021 @cindex ODT
11022 @cindex OpenDocument
11023 @cindex export, OpenDocument
11024 @cindex LibreOffice
11025 @cindex org-odt.el
11026 @cindex org-modules
11027
11028 Org Mode@footnote{Versions 7.8 or later} supports export to OpenDocument Text
11029 (ODT) format using the @file{org-odt.el} module. Documents created
11030 by this exporter use the @cite{OpenDocument-v1.2
11031 specification}@footnote{@url{http://docs.oasis-open.org/office/v1.2/OpenDocument-v1.2.html,
11032 Open Document Format for Office Applications (OpenDocument) Version 1.2}} and
11033 are compatible with LibreOffice 3.4.
11034
11035 @menu
11036 * Pre-requisites for ODT export:: What packages ODT exporter relies on
11037 * ODT export commands:: How to invoke ODT export
11038 * Extending ODT export:: How to produce @samp{doc}, @samp{pdf} files
11039 * Applying custom styles:: How to apply custom styles to the output
11040 * Links in ODT export:: How links will be interpreted and formatted
11041 * Tables in ODT export:: How Tables are exported
11042 * Images in ODT export:: How to insert images
11043 * Math formatting in ODT export:: How @LaTeX{} fragments are formatted
11044 * Labels and captions in ODT export:: How captions are rendered
11045 * Literal examples in ODT export:: How source and example blocks are formatted
11046 * Advanced topics in ODT export:: Read this if you are a power user
11047 @end menu
11048
11049 @node Pre-requisites for ODT export, ODT export commands, OpenDocument Text export, OpenDocument Text export
11050 @subsection Pre-requisites for ODT export
11051 @cindex zip
11052 The ODT exporter relies on the @file{zip} program to create the final
11053 output. Check the availability of this program before proceeding further.
11054
11055 @node ODT export commands, Extending ODT export, Pre-requisites for ODT export, OpenDocument Text export
11056 @subsection ODT export commands
11057
11058 @subsubheading Exporting to ODT
11059 @anchor{x-export-to-odt}
11060
11061 @cindex region, active
11062 @cindex active region
11063 @cindex transient-mark-mode
11064 @table @kbd
11065 @orgcmd{C-c C-e o,org-export-as-odt}
11066 @cindex property EXPORT_FILE_NAME
11067
11068 Export as OpenDocument Text file.
11069
11070 @vindex org-export-odt-preferred-output-format
11071 If @code{org-export-odt-preferred-output-format} is specified, automatically
11072 convert the exported file to that format. @xref{x-export-to-other-formats, ,
11073 Automatically exporting to other formats}.
11074
11075 For an Org file @file{myfile.org}, the ODT file will be
11076 @file{myfile.odt}. The file will be overwritten without warning. If there
11077 is an active region,@footnote{This requires @code{transient-mark-mode} to be
11078 turned on} only the region will be exported. If the selected region is a
11079 single tree,@footnote{To select the current subtree, use @kbd{C-c @@}} the
11080 tree head will become the document title. If the tree head entry has, or
11081 inherits, an @code{EXPORT_FILE_NAME} property, that name will be used for the
11082 export.
11083
11084 @orgcmd{C-c C-e O,org-export-as-odt-and-open}
11085 Export as an OpenDocument Text file and open the resulting file.
11086
11087 @vindex org-export-odt-preferred-output-format
11088 If @code{org-export-odt-preferred-output-format} is specified, open the
11089 converted file instead. @xref{x-export-to-other-formats, , Automatically
11090 exporting to other formats}.
11091 @end table
11092
11093 @node Extending ODT export, Applying custom styles, ODT export commands, OpenDocument Text export
11094 @subsection Extending ODT export
11095
11096 The ODT exporter can interface with a variety of document
11097 converters and supports popular converters out of the box. As a result, you
11098 can use it to export to formats like @samp{doc} or convert a document from
11099 one format (say @samp{csv}) to another format (say @samp{ods} or @samp{xls}).
11100
11101 @cindex @file{unoconv}
11102 @cindex LibreOffice
11103 If you have a working installation of LibreOffice, a document converter is
11104 pre-configured for you and you can use it right away. If you would like to
11105 use @file{unoconv} as your preferred converter, customize the variable
11106 @code{org-export-odt-convert-process} to point to @code{unoconv}. You can
11107 also use your own favorite converter or tweak the default settings of the
11108 @file{LibreOffice} and @samp{unoconv} converters. @xref{Configuring a
11109 document converter}.
11110
11111 @subsubsection Automatically exporting to other formats
11112 @anchor{x-export-to-other-formats}
11113
11114 @vindex org-export-odt-preferred-output-format
11115 Very often, you will find yourself exporting to ODT format, only to
11116 immediately save the exported document to other formats like @samp{doc},
11117 @samp{docx}, @samp{rtf}, @samp{pdf} etc. In such cases, you can specify your
11118 preferred output format by customizing the variable
11119 @code{org-export-odt-preferred-output-format}. This way, the export commands
11120 (@pxref{x-export-to-odt,,Exporting to ODT}) can be extended to export to a
11121 format that is of immediate interest to you.
11122
11123 @subsubsection Converting between document formats
11124 @anchor{x-convert-to-other-formats}
11125
11126 There are many document converters in the wild which support conversion to
11127 and from various file formats, including, but not limited to the
11128 ODT format. LibreOffice converter, mentioned above, is one such
11129 converter. Once a converter is configured, you can interact with it using
11130 the following command.
11131
11132 @vindex org-export-odt-convert
11133 @table @kbd
11134
11135 @item M-x org-export-odt-convert
11136 Convert an existing document from one format to another. With a prefix
11137 argument, also open the newly produced file.
11138 @end table
11139
11140 @node Applying custom styles, Links in ODT export, Extending ODT export, OpenDocument Text export
11141 @subsection Applying custom styles
11142 @cindex styles, custom
11143 @cindex template, custom
11144
11145 The ODT exporter ships with a set of OpenDocument styles
11146 (@pxref{Working with OpenDocument style files}) that ensure a well-formatted
11147 output. These factory styles, however, may not cater to your specific
11148 tastes. To customize the output, you can either modify the above styles
11149 files directly, or generate the required styles using an application like
11150 LibreOffice. The latter method is suitable for expert and non-expert
11151 users alike, and is described here.
11152
11153 @subsubsection Applying custom styles - the easy way
11154
11155 @enumerate
11156 @item
11157 Create a sample @file{example.org} file with the below settings and export it
11158 to ODT format.
11159
11160 @example
11161 #+OPTIONS: H:10 num:t
11162 @end example
11163
11164 @item
11165 Open the above @file{example.odt} using LibreOffice. Use the @file{Stylist}
11166 to locate the target styles - these typically have the @samp{Org} prefix -
11167 and modify those to your taste. Save the modified file either as an
11168 OpenDocument Text (@file{.odt}) or OpenDocument Template (@file{.ott}) file.
11169
11170 @item
11171 @cindex #+ODT_STYLES_FILE
11172 @vindex org-export-odt-styles-file
11173 Customize the variable @code{org-export-odt-styles-file} and point it to the
11174 newly created file. For additional configuration options
11175 @pxref{x-overriding-factory-styles,,Overriding factory styles}.
11176
11177 If you would like to choose a style on a per-file basis, you can use the
11178 @code{#+ODT_STYLES_FILE} option. A typical setting will look like
11179
11180 @example
11181 #+ODT_STYLES_FILE: "/path/to/example.ott"
11182 @end example
11183
11184 or
11185
11186 @example
11187 #+ODT_STYLES_FILE: ("/path/to/file.ott" ("styles.xml" "image/hdr.png"))
11188 @end example
11189
11190 @end enumerate
11191
11192 @subsubsection Using third-party styles and templates
11193
11194 You can use third-party styles and templates for customizing your output.
11195 This will produce the desired output only if the template provides all
11196 style names that the @samp{ODT} exporter relies on. Unless this condition is
11197 met, the output is going to be less than satisfactory. So it is highly
11198 recommended that you only work with templates that are directly derived from
11199 the factory settings.
11200
11201 @node Links in ODT export, Tables in ODT export, Applying custom styles, OpenDocument Text export
11202 @subsection Links in ODT export
11203 @cindex tables, in DocBook export
11204
11205 ODT exporter creates native cross-references for internal links. It creates
11206 Internet-style links for all other links.
11207
11208 A link with no description and destined to a regular (un-itemized) outline
11209 heading is replaced with a cross-reference and section number of the heading.
11210
11211 A @samp{\ref@{label@}}-style reference to an image, table etc. is replaced
11212 with a cross-reference and sequence number of the labeled entity.
11213 @xref{Labels and captions in ODT export}.
11214
11215 @node Tables in ODT export, Images in ODT export, Links in ODT export, OpenDocument Text export
11216 @subsection Tables in ODT export
11217 @cindex tables, in DocBook export
11218
11219 Export of native Org mode tables (@pxref{Tables}) and simple @file{table.el}
11220 tables is supported. However, export of complex @file{table.el} tables -
11221 tables that have column or row spans - is not supported. Such tables are
11222 stripped from the exported document.
11223
11224 By default, a table is exported with top and bottom frames and with rules
11225 separating row and column groups (@pxref{Column groups}). Furthermore, all
11226 tables are typeset to occupy the same width. If the table specifies
11227 alignment and relative width for its columns (@pxref{Column width and
11228 alignment}) then these are honored on export.@footnote{The column widths are
11229 interpreted as weighted ratios with the default weight being 1}
11230
11231 @cindex #+ATTR_ODT
11232 You can control the width of the table by specifying @code{:rel-width}
11233 property using an @code{#+ATTR_ODT} line.
11234
11235 For example, consider the following table which makes use of all the rules
11236 mentioned above.
11237
11238 @example
11239 #+ATTR_ODT: :rel-width 50
11240 | Area/Month | Jan | Feb | Mar | Sum |
11241 |---------------+-------+-------+-------+-------|
11242 | / | < | | | < |
11243 | <l13> | <r5> | <r5> | <r5> | <r6> |
11244 | North America | 1 | 21 | 926 | 948 |
11245 | Middle East | 6 | 75 | 844 | 925 |
11246 | Asia Pacific | 9 | 27 | 790 | 826 |
11247 |---------------+-------+-------+-------+-------|
11248 | Sum | 16 | 123 | 2560 | 2699 |
11249 @end example
11250
11251 On export, the table will occupy 50% of text area. The columns will be sized
11252 (roughly) in the ratio of 13:5:5:5:6. The first column will be left-aligned
11253 and rest of the columns will be right-aligned. There will be vertical rules
11254 after separating the header and last columns from other columns. There will
11255 be horizontal rules separating the header and last rows from other rows.
11256
11257 If you are not satisfied with the above formatting options, you can create
11258 custom table styles and associate them with a table using the
11259 @code{#+ATTR_ODT} line. @xref{Customizing tables in ODT export}.
11260
11261 @node Images in ODT export, Math formatting in ODT export, Tables in ODT export, OpenDocument Text export
11262 @subsection Images in ODT export
11263 @cindex images, embedding in ODT
11264 @cindex embedding images in ODT
11265
11266 @subsubheading Embedding images
11267 You can embed images within the exported document by providing a link to the
11268 desired image file with no link description. For example, to embed
11269 @samp{img.png} do either of the following:
11270
11271 @example
11272 [[file:img.png]]
11273 @end example
11274
11275 @example
11276 [[./img.png]]
11277 @end example
11278
11279 @subsubheading Embedding clickable images
11280 You can create clickable images by providing a link whose description is a
11281 link to an image file. For example, to embed a image
11282 @file{org-mode-unicorn.png} which when clicked jumps to
11283 @uref{http://Orgmode.org} website, do the following
11284
11285 @example
11286 [[http://orgmode.org][./org-mode-unicorn.png]]
11287 @end example
11288
11289 @subsubheading Sizing and scaling of embedded images
11290
11291 @cindex #+ATTR_ODT
11292 You can control the size and scale of the embedded images using the
11293 @code{#+ATTR_ODT} attribute.
11294
11295 @cindex identify, ImageMagick
11296 @vindex org-export-odt-pixels-per-inch
11297 The exporter specifies the desired size of the image in the final document in
11298 units of centimeters. In order to scale the embedded images, the exporter
11299 queries for pixel dimensions of the images using one of a) ImageMagick's
11300 @file{identify} program or b) Emacs `create-image' and `image-size'
11301 APIs.@footnote{Use of @file{ImageMagick} is only desirable. However, if you
11302 routinely produce documents that have large images or you export your Org
11303 files that has images using a Emacs batch script, then the use of
11304 @file{ImageMagick} is mandatory.} The pixel dimensions are subsequently
11305 converted in to units of centimeters using
11306 @code{org-export-odt-pixels-per-inch}. The default value of this variable is
11307 set to @code{display-pixels-per-inch}. You can tweak this variable to
11308 achieve the best results.
11309
11310 The examples below illustrate the various possibilities.
11311
11312 @table @asis
11313 @item Explicitly size the image
11314 To embed @file{img.png} as a 10 cm x 10 cm image, do the following:
11315
11316 @example
11317 #+ATTR_ODT: :width 10 :height 10
11318 [[./img.png]]
11319 @end example
11320
11321 @item Scale the image
11322 To embed @file{img.png} at half its size, do the following:
11323
11324 @example
11325 #+ATTR_ODT: :scale 0.5
11326 [[./img.png]]
11327 @end example
11328
11329 @item Scale the image to a specific width
11330 To embed @file{img.png} with a width of 10 cm while retaining the original
11331 height:width ratio, do the following:
11332
11333 @example
11334 #+ATTR_ODT: :width 10
11335 [[./img.png]]
11336 @end example
11337
11338 @item Scale the image to a specific height
11339 To embed @file{img.png} with a height of 10 cm while retaining the original
11340 height:width ratio, do the following
11341
11342 @example
11343 #+ATTR_ODT: :height 10
11344 [[./img.png]]
11345 @end example
11346 @end table
11347
11348 @subsubheading Anchoring of images
11349
11350 @cindex #+ATTR_ODT
11351 You can control the manner in which an image is anchored by setting the
11352 @code{:anchor} property of it's @code{#+ATTR_ODT} line. You can specify one
11353 of the the following three values for the @code{:anchor} property -
11354 @samp{"as-char"}, @samp{"paragraph"} and @samp{"page"}.
11355
11356 To create an image that is anchored to a page, do the following:
11357 @example
11358 #+ATTR_ODT: :anchor "page"
11359 [[./img.png]]
11360 @end example
11361
11362 @node Math formatting in ODT export, Labels and captions in ODT export, Images in ODT export, OpenDocument Text export
11363 @subsection Math formatting in ODT export
11364
11365 The ODT exporter has special support for handling math.
11366
11367 @menu
11368 * Working with @LaTeX{} math snippets:: How to embed @LaTeX{} math fragments
11369 * Working with MathML or OpenDocument formula files:: How to embed equations in native format
11370 @end menu
11371
11372 @node Working with @LaTeX{} math snippets, Working with MathML or OpenDocument formula files, Math formatting in ODT export, Math formatting in ODT export
11373 @subsubsection Working with @LaTeX{} math snippets
11374
11375 @LaTeX{} math snippets (@pxref{@LaTeX{} fragments}) can be embedded in the ODT
11376 document in one of the following ways:
11377
11378 @cindex MathML
11379 @enumerate
11380 @item MathML
11381
11382 This option is activated on a per-file basis with
11383
11384 @example
11385 #+OPTIONS: LaTeX:t
11386 @end example
11387
11388 With this option, @LaTeX{} fragments are first converted into MathML
11389 fragments using an external @LaTeX{}-to-MathML converter program. The
11390 resulting MathML fragments are then embedded as an OpenDocument Formula in
11391 the exported document.
11392
11393 @vindex org-latex-to-mathml-convert-command
11394 @vindex org-latex-to-mathml-jar-file
11395
11396 You can specify the @LaTeX{}-to-MathML converter by customizing the variables
11397 @code{org-latex-to-mathml-convert-command} and
11398 @code{org-latex-to-mathml-jar-file}.
11399
11400 If you prefer to use @file{MathToWeb}@footnote{See
11401 @uref{http://www.mathtoweb.com/cgi-bin/mathtoweb_home.pl, MathToWeb}} as your
11402 converter, you can configure the above variables as shown below.
11403
11404 @lisp
11405 (setq org-latex-to-mathml-convert-command
11406 "java -jar %j -unicode -force -df %o %I"
11407 org-latex-to-mathml-jar-file
11408 "/path/to/mathtoweb.jar")
11409 @end lisp
11410
11411 You can use the following commands to quickly verify the reliability of
11412 the @LaTeX{}-to-MathML converter.
11413
11414 @table @kbd
11415
11416 @item M-x org-export-as-odf
11417 Convert a @LaTeX{} math snippet to an OpenDocument formula (@file{.odf}) file.
11418
11419 @item M-x org-export-as-odf-and-open
11420 Convert a @LaTeX{} math snippet to an OpenDocument formula (@file{.odf}) file
11421 and open the formula file with the system-registered application.
11422 @end table
11423
11424 @cindex dvipng
11425 @item PNG images
11426
11427 This option is activated on a per-file basis with
11428
11429 @example
11430 #+OPTIONS: LaTeX:dvipng
11431 @end example
11432
11433 With this option, @LaTeX{} fragments are processed into PNG images and the
11434 resulting images are embedded in the exported document. This method requires
11435 that the @file{dvipng} program be available on your system.
11436 @end enumerate
11437
11438 @node Working with MathML or OpenDocument formula files, , Working with @LaTeX{} math snippets, Math formatting in ODT export
11439 @subsubsection Working with MathML or OpenDocument formula files
11440
11441 For various reasons, you may find embedding @LaTeX{} math snippets in an
11442 ODT document less than reliable. In that case, you can embed a
11443 math equation by linking to its MathML (@file{.mml}) source or its
11444 OpenDocument formula (@file{.odf}) file as shown below:
11445
11446 @example
11447 [[./equation.mml]]
11448 @end example
11449
11450 or
11451
11452 @example
11453 [[./equation.odf]]
11454 @end example
11455
11456 @node Labels and captions in ODT export, Literal examples in ODT export, Math formatting in ODT export, OpenDocument Text export
11457 @subsection Labels and captions in ODT export
11458
11459 You can label and caption various category of objects - an inline image, a
11460 table, a @LaTeX{} fragment or a Math formula - using @code{#+LABEL} and
11461 @code{#+CAPTION} lines. @xref{Images and tables}. ODT exporter enumerates
11462 each labeled or captioned object of a given category separately. As a
11463 result, each such object is assigned a sequence number based on order of it's
11464 appearance in the Org file.
11465
11466 In the exported document, a user-provided caption is augmented with the
11467 category and sequence number. Consider the following inline image in an Org
11468 file.
11469
11470 @example
11471 #+CAPTION: Bell curve
11472 #+LABEL: fig:SED-HR4049
11473 [[./img/a.png]]
11474 @end example
11475
11476 It could be rendered as shown below in the exported document.
11477
11478 @example
11479 Figure 2: Bell curve
11480 @end example
11481
11482 @vindex org-export-odt-category-strings
11483 You can modify the category component of the caption by customizing the
11484 variable @code{org-export-odt-category-strings}. For example, to tag all
11485 embedded images with the string @samp{Illustration} (instead of the default
11486 @samp{Figure}) use the following setting.
11487
11488 @lisp
11489 (setq org-export-odt-category-strings
11490 '(("en" "Table" "Illustration" "Equation" "Equation")))
11491 @end lisp
11492
11493 With this, previous image will be captioned as below in the exported
11494 document.
11495
11496 @example
11497 Illustration 2: Bell curve
11498 @end example
11499
11500 @node Literal examples in ODT export, Advanced topics in ODT export, Labels and captions in ODT export, OpenDocument Text export
11501 @subsection Literal examples in ODT export
11502
11503 Export of literal examples (@pxref{Literal examples}) with full fontification
11504 is supported. Internally, the exporter relies on @file{htmlfontify.el} to
11505 generate all style definitions needed for a fancy listing.@footnote{Your
11506 @file{htmlfontify.el} library must at least be at Emacs 24.1 levels for
11507 fontification to be turned on.} The auto-generated styles have @samp{OrgSrc}
11508 as prefix and inherit their color from the faces used by Emacs
11509 @code{font-lock} library for the source language.
11510
11511 @vindex org-export-odt-fontify-srcblocks
11512 If you prefer to use your own custom styles for fontification, you can do so
11513 by customizing the variable
11514 @code{org-export-odt-create-custom-styles-for-srcblocks}.
11515
11516 @vindex org-export-odt-create-custom-styles-for-srcblocks
11517 You can turn off fontification of literal examples by customizing the
11518 variable @code{org-export-odt-fontify-srcblocks}.
11519
11520 @node Advanced topics in ODT export, , Literal examples in ODT export, OpenDocument Text export
11521 @subsection Advanced topics in ODT export
11522
11523 If you rely heavily on ODT export, you may want to exploit the full
11524 set of features that the exporter offers. This section describes features
11525 that would be of interest to power users.
11526
11527 @menu
11528 * Configuring a document converter:: How to register a document converter
11529 * Working with OpenDocument style files:: Explore the internals
11530 * Creating one-off styles:: How to produce custom highlighting etc
11531 * Customizing tables in ODT export:: How to define and use Table templates
11532 * Validating OpenDocument XML:: How to debug corrupt OpenDocument files
11533 @end menu
11534
11535 @node Configuring a document converter, Working with OpenDocument style files, Advanced topics in ODT export, Advanced topics in ODT export
11536 @subsubsection Configuring a document converter
11537 @cindex convert
11538 @cindex doc, docx, rtf
11539 @cindex converter
11540
11541 The ODT exporter can work with popular converters with little or no
11542 extra configuration from your side. @xref{Extending ODT export}.
11543 If you are using a converter that is not supported by default or if you would
11544 like to tweak the default converter settings, proceed as below.
11545
11546 @enumerate
11547 @item Register the converter
11548
11549 @vindex org-export-odt-convert-processes
11550 Name your converter and add it to the list of known converters by customizing
11551 the variable @code{org-export-odt-convert-processes}. Also specify how the
11552 converter can be invoked via command-line to effect the conversion.
11553
11554 @item Configure its capabilities
11555
11556 @vindex org-export-odt-convert-capabilities
11557 @anchor{x-odt-converter-capabilities}
11558 Specify the set of formats the converter can handle by customizing the
11559 variable @code{org-export-odt-convert-capabilities}. Use the default value
11560 for this variable as a guide for configuring your converter. As suggested by
11561 the default setting, you can specify the full set of formats supported by the
11562 converter and not limit yourself to specifying formats that are related to
11563 just the OpenDocument Text format.
11564
11565 @item Choose the converter
11566
11567 @vindex org-export-odt-convert-process
11568 Select the newly added converter as the preferred one by customizing the
11569 variable @code{org-export-odt-convert-process}.
11570 @end enumerate
11571
11572 @node Working with OpenDocument style files, Creating one-off styles, Configuring a document converter, Advanced topics in ODT export
11573 @subsubsection Working with OpenDocument style files
11574 @cindex styles, custom
11575 @cindex template, custom
11576
11577 This section explores the internals of the ODT exporter and the
11578 means by which it produces styled documents. Read this section if you are
11579 interested in exploring the automatic and custom OpenDocument styles used by
11580 the exporter.
11581
11582 @anchor{x-factory-styles}
11583 @subsubheading Factory styles
11584
11585 The ODT exporter relies on two files for generating its output.
11586 These files are bundled with the distribution under the directory pointed to
11587 by the variable @code{org-odt-styles-dir}. The two files are:
11588
11589 @itemize
11590 @anchor{x-orgodtstyles-xml}
11591 @item
11592 @file{OrgOdtStyles.xml}
11593
11594 This file contributes to the @file{styles.xml} file of the final @samp{ODT}
11595 document. This file gets modified for the following purposes:
11596 @enumerate
11597
11598 @item
11599 To control outline numbering based on user settings.
11600
11601 @item
11602 To add styles generated by @file{htmlfontify.el} for fontification of code
11603 blocks.
11604 @end enumerate
11605
11606 @anchor{x-orgodtcontenttemplate-xml}
11607 @item
11608 @file{OrgOdtContentTemplate.xml}
11609
11610 This file contributes to the @file{content.xml} file of the final @samp{ODT}
11611 document. The contents of the Org outline are inserted between the
11612 @samp{<office:text>}@dots{}@samp{</office:text>} elements of this file.
11613
11614 Apart from serving as a template file for the final @file{content.xml}, the
11615 file serves the following purposes:
11616 @enumerate
11617
11618 @item
11619 It contains automatic styles for formatting of tables which are referenced by
11620 the exporter.
11621
11622 @item
11623 It contains @samp{<text:sequence-decl>}@dots{}@samp{</text:sequence-decl>}
11624 elements that control how various entities - tables, images, equations etc -
11625 are numbered.
11626 @end enumerate
11627 @end itemize
11628
11629 @anchor{x-overriding-factory-styles}
11630 @subsubheading Overriding factory styles
11631 The following two variables control the location from which the ODT
11632 exporter picks up the custom styles and content template files. You can
11633 customize these variables to override the factory styles used by the
11634 exporter.
11635
11636 @itemize
11637 @anchor{x-org-export-odt-styles-file}
11638 @item
11639 @code{org-export-odt-styles-file}
11640
11641 Use this variable to specify the @file{styles.xml} that will be used in the
11642 final output. You can specify one of the following values:
11643
11644 @enumerate
11645 @item A @file{styles.xml} file
11646
11647 Use this file instead of the default @file{styles.xml}
11648
11649 @item A @file{.odt} or @file{.ott} file
11650
11651 Use the @file{styles.xml} contained in the specified OpenDocument Text or
11652 Template file
11653
11654 @item A @file{.odt} or @file{.ott} file and a subset of files contained within them
11655
11656 Use the @file{styles.xml} contained in the specified OpenDocument Text or
11657 Template file. Additionally extract the specified member files and embed
11658 those within the final @samp{ODT} document.
11659
11660 Use this option if the @file{styles.xml} file references additional files
11661 like header and footer images.
11662
11663 @item @code{nil}
11664
11665 Use the default @file{styles.xml}
11666 @end enumerate
11667
11668 @anchor{x-org-export-odt-content-template-file}
11669 @item
11670 @code{org-export-odt-content-template-file}
11671
11672 Use this variable to specify the blank @file{content.xml} that will be used
11673 in the final output.
11674 @end itemize
11675
11676 @node Creating one-off styles, Customizing tables in ODT export, Working with OpenDocument style files, Advanced topics in ODT export
11677 @subsubsection Creating one-off styles
11678
11679 There are times when you would want one-off formatting in the exported
11680 document. You can achieve this by embedding raw OpenDocument XML in the Org
11681 file. The use of this feature is better illustrated with couple of examples.
11682
11683 @enumerate
11684 @item Embedding ODT tags as part of regular text
11685
11686 You can include simple OpenDocument tags by prefixing them with
11687 @samp{@@}. For example, to highlight a region of text do the following:
11688
11689 @example
11690 @@<text:span text:style-name="Highlight">This is a
11691 highlighted text@@</text:span>. But this is a
11692 regular text.
11693 @end example
11694
11695 @strong{Hint:} To see the above example in action, edit your
11696 @file{styles.xml} (@pxref{x-orgodtstyles-xml,,Factory styles}) and add a
11697 custom @samp{Highlight} style as shown below.
11698
11699 @example
11700 <style:style style:name="Highlight" style:family="text">
11701 <style:text-properties fo:background-color="#ff0000"/>
11702 </style:style>
11703 @end example
11704
11705 @item Embedding a one-line OpenDocument XML
11706
11707 You can add a simple OpenDocument one-liner using the @code{#+ODT:}
11708 directive. For example, to force a page break do the following:
11709
11710 @example
11711 #+ODT: <text:p text:style-name="PageBreak"/>
11712 @end example
11713
11714 @strong{Hint:} To see the above example in action, edit your
11715 @file{styles.xml} (@pxref{x-orgodtstyles-xml,,Factory styles}) and add a
11716 custom @samp{PageBreak} style as shown below.
11717
11718 @example
11719 <style:style style:name="PageBreak" style:family="paragraph"
11720 style:parent-style-name="Text_20_body">
11721 <style:paragraph-properties fo:break-before="page"/>
11722 </style:style>
11723 @end example
11724
11725 @item Embedding a block of OpenDocument XML
11726
11727 You can add a large block of OpenDocument XML using the
11728 @code{#+BEGIN_ODT}@dots{}@code{#+END_ODT} construct.
11729
11730 For example, to create a one-off paragraph that uses bold text, do the
11731 following:
11732
11733 @example
11734 #+BEGIN_ODT
11735 <text:p text:style-name="Text_20_body_20_bold">
11736 This paragraph is specially formatted and uses bold text.
11737 </text:p>
11738 #+END_ODT
11739 @end example
11740
11741 @end enumerate
11742
11743 @node Customizing tables in ODT export, Validating OpenDocument XML, Creating one-off styles, Advanced topics in ODT export
11744 @subsubsection Customizing tables in ODT export
11745 @cindex tables, in ODT export
11746
11747 @cindex #+ATTR_ODT
11748 You can override the default formatting of the table by specifying a custom
11749 table style with the @code{#+ATTR_ODT} line. For a discussion on default
11750 formatting of tables @pxref{Tables in ODT export}.
11751
11752 This feature closely mimics the way table templates are defined in the
11753 OpenDocument-v1.2
11754 specification.@footnote{@url{http://docs.oasis-open.org/office/v1.2/OpenDocument-v1.2.html,
11755 OpenDocument-v1.2 Specification}}
11756
11757
11758
11759 @subsubheading Custom table styles - an illustration
11760
11761 To have a quick preview of this feature, install the below setting and export
11762 the table that follows.
11763
11764 @lisp
11765 (setq org-export-odt-table-styles
11766 (append org-export-odt-table-styles
11767 '(("TableWithHeaderRowAndColumn" "Custom"
11768 ((use-first-row-styles . t)
11769 (use-first-column-styles . t)))
11770 ("TableWithFirstRowandLastRow" "Custom"
11771 ((use-first-row-styles . t)
11772 (use-last-row-styles . t))))))
11773 @end lisp
11774
11775 @example
11776 #+ATTR_ODT: :style "TableWithHeaderRowAndColumn"
11777 | Name | Phone | Age |
11778 | Peter | 1234 | 17 |
11779 | Anna | 4321 | 25 |
11780 @end example
11781
11782 In the above example, you used a template named @samp{Custom} and installed
11783 two table styles with the names @samp{TableWithHeaderRowAndColumn} and
11784 @samp{TableWithFirstRowandLastRow}. (@strong{Important:} The OpenDocument
11785 styles needed for producing the above template have been pre-defined for you.
11786 These styles are available under the section marked @samp{Custom Table
11787 Template} in @file{OrgOdtContentTemplate.xml}
11788 (@pxref{x-orgodtcontenttemplate-xml,,Factory styles}). If you need
11789 additional templates you have to define these styles yourselves.
11790
11791 @subsubheading Custom table styles - the nitty-gritty
11792 To use this feature proceed as follows:
11793
11794 @enumerate
11795 @item
11796 Create a table template@footnote{See the @code{<table:table-template>}
11797 element of the OpenDocument-v1.2 specification}
11798
11799 A table template is nothing but a set of @samp{table-cell} and
11800 @samp{paragraph} styles for each of the following table cell categories:
11801
11802 @itemize @minus
11803 @item Body
11804 @item First column
11805 @item Last column
11806 @item First row
11807 @item Last row
11808 @item Even row
11809 @item Odd row
11810 @item Even column
11811 @item Odd Column
11812 @end itemize
11813
11814 The names for the above styles must be chosen based on the name of the table
11815 template using a well-defined convention.
11816
11817 The naming convention is better illustrated with an example. For a table
11818 template with the name @samp{Custom}, the needed style names are listed in
11819 the following table.
11820
11821 @multitable {Table cell type} {CustomEvenColumnTableCell} {CustomEvenColumnTableParagraph}
11822 @headitem Table cell type
11823 @tab @code{table-cell} style
11824 @tab @code{paragraph} style
11825 @item
11826 @tab
11827 @tab
11828 @item Body
11829 @tab @samp{CustomTableCell}
11830 @tab @samp{CustomTableParagraph}
11831 @item First column
11832 @tab @samp{CustomFirstColumnTableCell}
11833 @tab @samp{CustomFirstColumnTableParagraph}
11834 @item Last column
11835 @tab @samp{CustomLastColumnTableCell}
11836 @tab @samp{CustomLastColumnTableParagraph}
11837 @item First row
11838 @tab @samp{CustomFirstRowTableCell}
11839 @tab @samp{CustomFirstRowTableParagraph}
11840 @item Last row
11841 @tab @samp{CustomLastRowTableCell}
11842 @tab @samp{CustomLastRowTableParagraph}
11843 @item Even row
11844 @tab @samp{CustomEvenRowTableCell}
11845 @tab @samp{CustomEvenRowTableParagraph}
11846 @item Odd row
11847 @tab @samp{CustomOddRowTableCell}
11848 @tab @samp{CustomOddRowTableParagraph}
11849 @item Even column
11850 @tab @samp{CustomEvenColumnTableCell}
11851 @tab @samp{CustomEvenColumnTableParagraph}
11852 @item Odd column
11853 @tab @samp{CustomOddColumnTableCell}
11854 @tab @samp{CustomOddColumnTableParagraph}
11855 @end multitable
11856
11857 To create a table template with the name @samp{Custom}, define the above
11858 styles in the
11859 @code{<office:automatic-styles>}...@code{</office:automatic-styles>} element
11860 of the content template file (@pxref{x-orgodtcontenttemplate-xml,,Factory
11861 styles}).
11862
11863 @item
11864 Define a table style@footnote{See the attributes @code{table:template-name},
11865 @code{table:use-first-row-styles}, @code{table:use-last-row-styles},
11866 @code{table:use-first-column-styles}, @code{table:use-last-column-styles},
11867 @code{table:use-banding-rows-styles}, and
11868 @code{table:use-banding-column-styles} of the @code{<table:table>} element in
11869 the OpenDocument-v1.2 specification}
11870
11871 @vindex org-export-odt-table-styles
11872 To define a table style, create an entry for the style in the variable
11873 @code{org-export-odt-table-styles} and specify the following:
11874
11875 @itemize @minus
11876 @item the name of the table template created in step (1)
11877 @item the set of cell styles in that template that are to be activated
11878 @end itemize
11879
11880 For example, the entry below defines two different table styles
11881 @samp{TableWithHeaderRowAndColumn} and @samp{TableWithFirstRowandLastRow}
11882 based on the same template @samp{Custom}. The styles achieve their intended
11883 effect by selectively activating the individual cell styles in that template.
11884
11885 @lisp
11886 (setq org-export-odt-table-styles
11887 (append org-export-odt-table-styles
11888 '(("TableWithHeaderRowAndColumn" "Custom"
11889 ((use-first-row-styles . t)
11890 (use-first-column-styles . t)))
11891 ("TableWithFirstRowandLastRow" "Custom"
11892 ((use-first-row-styles . t)
11893 (use-last-row-styles . t))))))
11894 @end lisp
11895
11896 @item
11897 Associate a table with the table style
11898
11899 To do this, specify the table style created in step (2) as part of
11900 the @code{ATTR_ODT} line as shown below.
11901
11902 @example
11903 #+ATTR_ODT: :style "TableWithHeaderRowAndColumn"
11904 | Name | Phone | Age |
11905 | Peter | 1234 | 17 |
11906 | Anna | 4321 | 25 |
11907 @end example
11908 @end enumerate
11909
11910 @node Validating OpenDocument XML, , Customizing tables in ODT export, Advanced topics in ODT export
11911 @subsubsection Validating OpenDocument XML
11912
11913 Occasionally, you will discover that the document created by the
11914 ODT exporter cannot be opened by your favorite application. One of
11915 the common reasons for this is that the @file{.odt} file is corrupt. In such
11916 cases, you may want to validate the document against the OpenDocument RELAX
11917 NG Compact Syntax (RNC) schema.
11918
11919 For de-compressing the @file{.odt} file@footnote{@file{.odt} files are
11920 nothing but @samp{zip} archives}: @inforef{File Archives,,emacs}. For
11921 general help with validation (and schema-sensitive editing) of XML files:
11922 @inforef{Introduction,,nxml-mode}.
11923
11924 @vindex org-export-odt-schema-dir
11925 If you have ready access to OpenDocument @file{.rnc} files and the needed
11926 schema-locating rules in a single folder, you can customize the variable
11927 @code{org-export-odt-schema-dir} to point to that directory. The
11928 ODT exporter will take care of updating the
11929 @code{rng-schema-locating-files} for you.
11930
11931 @c end opendocument
11932
11933 @node TaskJuggler export, Freemind export, OpenDocument Text export, Exporting
11934 @section TaskJuggler export
11935 @cindex TaskJuggler export
11936 @cindex Project management
11937
11938 @uref{http://www.taskjuggler.org/, TaskJuggler} is a project management tool.
11939 It provides an optimizing scheduler that computes your project time lines and
11940 resource assignments based on the project outline and the constraints that
11941 you have provided.
11942
11943 The TaskJuggler exporter is a bit different from other exporters, such as the
11944 @code{HTML} and @LaTeX{} exporters for example, in that it does not export all the
11945 nodes of a document or strictly follow the order of the nodes in the
11946 document.
11947
11948 Instead the TaskJuggler exporter looks for a tree that defines the tasks and
11949 a optionally tree that defines the resources for this project. It then
11950 creates a TaskJuggler file based on these trees and the attributes defined in
11951 all the nodes.
11952
11953 @subsection TaskJuggler export commands
11954
11955 @table @kbd
11956 @orgcmd{C-c C-e j,org-export-as-taskjuggler}
11957 Export as a TaskJuggler file.
11958
11959 @orgcmd{C-c C-e J,org-export-as-taskjuggler-and-open}
11960 Export as a TaskJuggler file and then open the file with TaskJugglerUI.
11961 @end table
11962
11963 @subsection Tasks
11964
11965 @vindex org-export-taskjuggler-project-tag
11966 Create your tasks as you usually do with Org mode. Assign efforts to each
11967 task using properties (it is easiest to do this in the column view). You
11968 should end up with something similar to the example by Peter Jones in
11969 @url{http://www.contextualdevelopment.com/static/artifacts/articles/2008/project-planning/project-planning.org}.
11970 Now mark the top node of your tasks with a tag named
11971 @code{:taskjuggler_project:} (or whatever you customized
11972 @code{org-export-taskjuggler-project-tag} to). You are now ready to export
11973 the project plan with @kbd{C-c C-e J} which will export the project plan and
11974 open a gantt chart in TaskJugglerUI.
11975
11976 @subsection Resources
11977
11978 @vindex org-export-taskjuggler-resource-tag
11979 Next you can define resources and assign those to work on specific tasks. You
11980 can group your resources hierarchically. Tag the top node of the resources
11981 with @code{:taskjuggler_resource:} (or whatever you customized
11982 @code{org-export-taskjuggler-resource-tag} to). You can optionally assign an
11983 identifier (named @samp{resource_id}) to the resources (using the standard
11984 Org properties commands, @pxref{Property syntax}) or you can let the exporter
11985 generate identifiers automatically (the exporter picks the first word of the
11986 headline as the identifier as long as it is unique---see the documentation of
11987 @code{org-taskjuggler-get-unique-id}). Using that identifier you can then
11988 allocate resources to tasks. This is again done with the @samp{allocate}
11989 property on the tasks. Do this in column view or when on the task type
11990 @kbd{C-c C-x p allocate @key{RET} <resource_id> @key{RET}}.
11991
11992 Once the allocations are done you can again export to TaskJuggler and check
11993 in the Resource Allocation Graph which person is working on what task at what
11994 time.
11995
11996 @subsection Export of properties
11997
11998 The exporter also takes TODO state information into consideration, i.e., if a
11999 task is marked as done it will have the corresponding attribute in
12000 TaskJuggler (@samp{complete 100}). Also it will export any property on a task
12001 resource or resource node which is known to TaskJuggler, such as
12002 @samp{limits}, @samp{vacation}, @samp{shift}, @samp{booking},
12003 @samp{efficiency}, @samp{journalentry}, @samp{rate} for resources or
12004 @samp{account}, @samp{start}, @samp{note}, @samp{duration}, @samp{end},
12005 @samp{journalentry}, @samp{milestone}, @samp{reference}, @samp{responsible},
12006 @samp{scheduling}, etc for tasks.
12007
12008 @subsection Dependencies
12009
12010 The exporter will handle dependencies that are defined in the tasks either
12011 with the @samp{ORDERED} attribute (@pxref{TODO dependencies}), with the
12012 @samp{BLOCKER} attribute (see @file{org-depend.el}) or alternatively with a
12013 @samp{depends} attribute. Both the @samp{BLOCKER} and the @samp{depends}
12014 attribute can be either @samp{previous-sibling} or a reference to an
12015 identifier (named @samp{task_id}) which is defined for another task in the
12016 project. @samp{BLOCKER} and the @samp{depends} attribute can define multiple
12017 dependencies separated by either space or comma. You can also specify
12018 optional attributes on the dependency by simply appending it. The following
12019 examples should illustrate this:
12020
12021 @example
12022 * Preparation
12023 :PROPERTIES:
12024 :task_id: preparation
12025 :ORDERED: t
12026 :END:
12027 * Training material
12028 :PROPERTIES:
12029 :task_id: training_material
12030 :ORDERED: t
12031 :END:
12032 ** Markup Guidelines
12033 :PROPERTIES:
12034 :Effort: 2d
12035 :END:
12036 ** Workflow Guidelines
12037 :PROPERTIES:
12038 :Effort: 2d
12039 :END:
12040 * Presentation
12041 :PROPERTIES:
12042 :Effort: 2d
12043 :BLOCKER: training_material @{ gapduration 1d @} preparation
12044 :END:
12045 @end example
12046
12047 @subsection Reports
12048
12049 @vindex org-export-taskjuggler-default-reports
12050 TaskJuggler can produce many kinds of reports (e.g., gantt chart, resource
12051 allocation, etc). The user defines what kind of reports should be generated
12052 for a project in the TaskJuggler file. The exporter will automatically insert
12053 some default reports in the file. These defaults are defined in
12054 @code{org-export-taskjuggler-default-reports}. They can be modified using
12055 customize along with a number of other options. For a more complete list, see
12056 @kbd{M-x customize-group @key{RET} org-export-taskjuggler @key{RET}}.
12057
12058 For more information and examples see the Org-taskjuggler tutorial at
12059 @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-tutorials/org-taskjuggler.html}.
12060
12061 @node Freemind export, XOXO export, TaskJuggler export, Exporting
12062 @section Freemind export
12063 @cindex Freemind export
12064 @cindex mind map
12065
12066 The Freemind exporter was written by Lennart Borgman.
12067
12068 @table @kbd
12069 @orgcmd{C-c C-e m,org-export-as-freemind}
12070 Export as a Freemind mind map. For an Org file @file{myfile.org}, the Freemind
12071 file will be @file{myfile.mm}.
12072 @end table
12073
12074 @node XOXO export, iCalendar export, Freemind export, Exporting
12075 @section XOXO export
12076 @cindex XOXO export
12077
12078 Org mode contains an exporter that produces XOXO-style output.
12079 Currently, this exporter only handles the general outline structure and
12080 does not interpret any additional Org mode features.
12081
12082 @table @kbd
12083 @orgcmd{C-c C-e x,org-export-as-xoxo}
12084 Export as an XOXO file. For an Org file @file{myfile.org}, the XOXO file will be
12085 @file{myfile.html}.
12086 @orgkey{C-c C-e v x}
12087 Export only the visible part of the document.
12088 @end table
12089
12090 @node iCalendar export, , XOXO export, Exporting
12091 @section iCalendar export
12092 @cindex iCalendar export
12093
12094 @vindex org-icalendar-include-todo
12095 @vindex org-icalendar-use-deadline
12096 @vindex org-icalendar-use-scheduled
12097 @vindex org-icalendar-categories
12098 @vindex org-icalendar-alarm-time
12099 Some people use Org mode for keeping track of projects, but still prefer a
12100 standard calendar application for anniversaries and appointments. In this
12101 case it can be useful to show deadlines and other time-stamped items in Org
12102 files in the calendar application. Org mode can export calendar information
12103 in the standard iCalendar format. If you also want to have TODO entries
12104 included in the export, configure the variable
12105 @code{org-icalendar-include-todo}. Plain timestamps are exported as VEVENT,
12106 and TODO items as VTODO@. It will also create events from deadlines that are
12107 in non-TODO items. Deadlines and scheduling dates in TODO items will be used
12108 to set the start and due dates for the TODO entry@footnote{See the variables
12109 @code{org-icalendar-use-deadline} and @code{org-icalendar-use-scheduled}.}.
12110 As categories, it will use the tags locally defined in the heading, and the
12111 file/tree category@footnote{To add inherited tags or the TODO state,
12112 configure the variable @code{org-icalendar-categories}.}. See the variable
12113 @code{org-icalendar-alarm-time} for a way to assign alarms to entries with a
12114 time.
12115
12116 @vindex org-icalendar-store-UID
12117 @cindex property, ID
12118 The iCalendar standard requires each entry to have a globally unique
12119 identifier (UID). Org creates these identifiers during export. If you set
12120 the variable @code{org-icalendar-store-UID}, the UID will be stored in the
12121 @code{:ID:} property of the entry and re-used next time you report this
12122 entry. Since a single entry can give rise to multiple iCalendar entries (as
12123 a timestamp, a deadline, a scheduled item, and as a TODO item), Org adds
12124 prefixes to the UID, depending on what triggered the inclusion of the entry.
12125 In this way the UID remains unique, but a synchronization program can still
12126 figure out from which entry all the different instances originate.
12127
12128 @table @kbd
12129 @orgcmd{C-c C-e i,org-export-icalendar-this-file}
12130 Create iCalendar entries for the current file and store them in the same
12131 directory, using a file extension @file{.ics}.
12132 @orgcmd{C-c C-e I, org-export-icalendar-all-agenda-files}
12133 @vindex org-agenda-files
12134 Like @kbd{C-c C-e i}, but do this for all files in
12135 @code{org-agenda-files}. For each of these files, a separate iCalendar
12136 file will be written.
12137 @orgcmd{C-c C-e c,org-export-icalendar-combine-agenda-files}
12138 @vindex org-combined-agenda-icalendar-file
12139 Create a single large iCalendar file from all files in
12140 @code{org-agenda-files} and write it to the file given by
12141 @code{org-combined-agenda-icalendar-file}.
12142 @end table
12143
12144 @vindex org-use-property-inheritance
12145 @vindex org-icalendar-include-body
12146 @cindex property, SUMMARY
12147 @cindex property, DESCRIPTION
12148 @cindex property, LOCATION
12149 The export will honor SUMMARY, DESCRIPTION and LOCATION@footnote{The LOCATION
12150 property can be inherited from higher in the hierarchy if you configure
12151 @code{org-use-property-inheritance} accordingly.} properties if the selected
12152 entries have them. If not, the summary will be derived from the headline,
12153 and the description from the body (limited to
12154 @code{org-icalendar-include-body} characters).
12155
12156 How this calendar is best read and updated, depends on the application
12157 you are using. The FAQ covers this issue.
12158
12159 @node Publishing, Working With Source Code, Exporting, Top
12160 @chapter Publishing
12161 @cindex publishing
12162
12163 Org includes a publishing management system that allows you to configure
12164 automatic HTML conversion of @emph{projects} composed of interlinked org
12165 files. You can also configure Org to automatically upload your exported HTML
12166 pages and related attachments, such as images and source code files, to a web
12167 server.
12168
12169 You can also use Org to convert files into PDF, or even combine HTML and PDF
12170 conversion so that files are available in both formats on the server.
12171
12172 Publishing has been contributed to Org by David O'Toole.
12173
12174 @menu
12175 * Configuration:: Defining projects
12176 * Uploading files:: How to get files up on the server
12177 * Sample configuration:: Example projects
12178 * Triggering publication:: Publication commands
12179 @end menu
12180
12181 @node Configuration, Uploading files, Publishing, Publishing
12182 @section Configuration
12183
12184 Publishing needs significant configuration to specify files, destination
12185 and many other properties of a project.
12186
12187 @menu
12188 * Project alist:: The central configuration variable
12189 * Sources and destinations:: From here to there
12190 * Selecting files:: What files are part of the project?
12191 * Publishing action:: Setting the function doing the publishing
12192 * Publishing options:: Tweaking HTML/@LaTeX{} export
12193 * Publishing links:: Which links keep working after publishing?
12194 * Sitemap:: Generating a list of all pages
12195 * Generating an index:: An index that reaches across pages
12196 @end menu
12197
12198 @node Project alist, Sources and destinations, Configuration, Configuration
12199 @subsection The variable @code{org-publish-project-alist}
12200 @cindex org-publish-project-alist
12201 @cindex projects, for publishing
12202
12203 @vindex org-publish-project-alist
12204 Publishing is configured almost entirely through setting the value of one
12205 variable, called @code{org-publish-project-alist}. Each element of the list
12206 configures one project, and may be in one of the two following forms:
12207
12208 @lisp
12209 ("project-name" :property value :property value ...)
12210 @r{i.e., a well-formed property list with alternating keys and values}
12211 @r{or}
12212 ("project-name" :components ("project-name" "project-name" ...))
12213
12214 @end lisp
12215
12216 In both cases, projects are configured by specifying property values. A
12217 project defines the set of files that will be published, as well as the
12218 publishing configuration to use when publishing those files. When a project
12219 takes the second form listed above, the individual members of the
12220 @code{:components} property are taken to be sub-projects, which group
12221 together files requiring different publishing options. When you publish such
12222 a ``meta-project'', all the components will also be published, in the
12223 sequence given.
12224
12225 @node Sources and destinations, Selecting files, Project alist, Configuration
12226 @subsection Sources and destinations for files
12227 @cindex directories, for publishing
12228
12229 Most properties are optional, but some should always be set. In
12230 particular, Org needs to know where to look for source files,
12231 and where to put published files.
12232
12233 @multitable @columnfractions 0.3 0.7
12234 @item @code{:base-directory}
12235 @tab Directory containing publishing source files
12236 @item @code{:publishing-directory}
12237 @tab Directory where output files will be published. You can directly
12238 publish to a webserver using a file name syntax appropriate for
12239 the Emacs @file{tramp} package. Or you can publish to a local directory and
12240 use external tools to upload your website (@pxref{Uploading files}).
12241 @item @code{:preparation-function}
12242 @tab Function or list of functions to be called before starting the
12243 publishing process, for example, to run @code{make} for updating files to be
12244 published. The project property list is scoped into this call as the
12245 variable @code{project-plist}.
12246 @item @code{:completion-function}
12247 @tab Function or list of functions called after finishing the publishing
12248 process, for example, to change permissions of the resulting files. The
12249 project property list is scoped into this call as the variable
12250 @code{project-plist}.
12251 @end multitable
12252 @noindent
12253
12254 @node Selecting files, Publishing action, Sources and destinations, Configuration
12255 @subsection Selecting files
12256 @cindex files, selecting for publishing
12257
12258 By default, all files with extension @file{.org} in the base directory
12259 are considered part of the project. This can be modified by setting the
12260 properties
12261 @multitable @columnfractions 0.25 0.75
12262 @item @code{:base-extension}
12263 @tab Extension (without the dot!) of source files. This actually is a
12264 regular expression. Set this to the symbol @code{any} if you want to get all
12265 files in @code{:base-directory}, even without extension.
12266
12267 @item @code{:exclude}
12268 @tab Regular expression to match file names that should not be
12269 published, even though they have been selected on the basis of their
12270 extension.
12271
12272 @item @code{:include}
12273 @tab List of files to be included regardless of @code{:base-extension}
12274 and @code{:exclude}.
12275
12276 @item @code{:recursive}
12277 @tab Non-nil means, check base-directory recursively for files to publish.
12278 @end multitable
12279
12280 @node Publishing action, Publishing options, Selecting files, Configuration
12281 @subsection Publishing action
12282 @cindex action, for publishing
12283
12284 Publishing means that a file is copied to the destination directory and
12285 possibly transformed in the process. The default transformation is to export
12286 Org files as HTML files, and this is done by the function
12287 @code{org-publish-org-to-html} which calls the HTML exporter (@pxref{HTML
12288 export}). But you also can publish your content as PDF files using
12289 @code{org-publish-org-to-pdf}, or as @code{ascii}, @code{latin1} or
12290 @code{utf8} encoded files using the corresponding functions. If you want to
12291 publish the Org file itself, but with @i{archived}, @i{commented}, and
12292 @i{tag-excluded} trees removed, use @code{org-publish-org-to-org} and set the
12293 parameters @code{:plain-source} and/or @code{:htmlized-source}. This will
12294 produce @file{file.org} and @file{file.org.html} in the publishing
12295 directory@footnote{@file{file-source.org} and @file{file-source.org.html} if
12296 source and publishing directories are equal. Note that with this kind of
12297 setup, you need to add @code{:exclude "-source\\.org"} to the project
12298 definition in @code{org-publish-project-alist} to prevent the published
12299 source files from being considered as new org files the next time the project
12300 is published.}. Other files like images only need to be copied to the
12301 publishing destination; for this you may use @code{org-publish-attachment}.
12302 For non-Org files, you always need to specify the publishing function:
12303
12304 @multitable @columnfractions 0.3 0.7
12305 @item @code{:publishing-function}
12306 @tab Function executing the publication of a file. This may also be a
12307 list of functions, which will all be called in turn.
12308 @item @code{:plain-source}
12309 @tab Non-nil means, publish plain source.
12310 @item @code{:htmlized-source}
12311 @tab Non-nil means, publish htmlized source.
12312 @end multitable
12313
12314 The function must accept three arguments: a property list containing at least
12315 a @code{:publishing-directory} property, the name of the file to be
12316 published, and the path to the publishing directory of the output file. It
12317 should take the specified file, make the necessary transformation (if any)
12318 and place the result into the destination folder.
12319
12320 @node Publishing options, Publishing links, Publishing action, Configuration
12321 @subsection Options for the HTML/@LaTeX{} exporters
12322 @cindex options, for publishing
12323
12324 The property list can be used to set many export options for the HTML
12325 and @LaTeX{} exporters. In most cases, these properties correspond to user
12326 variables in Org. The table below lists these properties along
12327 with the variable they belong to. See the documentation string for the
12328 respective variable for details.
12329
12330 @vindex org-export-html-link-up
12331 @vindex org-export-html-link-home
12332 @vindex org-export-default-language
12333 @vindex org-display-custom-times
12334 @vindex org-export-headline-levels
12335 @vindex org-export-with-section-numbers
12336 @vindex org-export-section-number-format
12337 @vindex org-export-with-toc
12338 @vindex org-export-preserve-breaks
12339 @vindex org-export-with-archived-trees
12340 @vindex org-export-with-emphasize
12341 @vindex org-export-with-sub-superscripts
12342 @vindex org-export-with-special-strings
12343 @vindex org-export-with-footnotes
12344 @vindex org-export-with-drawers
12345 @vindex org-export-with-tags
12346 @vindex org-export-with-todo-keywords
12347 @vindex org-export-with-tasks
12348 @vindex org-export-with-done-tasks
12349 @vindex org-export-with-priority
12350 @vindex org-export-with-TeX-macros
12351 @vindex org-export-with-LaTeX-fragments
12352 @vindex org-export-skip-text-before-1st-heading
12353 @vindex org-export-with-fixed-width
12354 @vindex org-export-with-timestamps
12355 @vindex org-export-author-info
12356 @vindex org-export-email-info
12357 @vindex org-export-creator-info
12358 @vindex org-export-time-stamp-file
12359 @vindex org-export-with-tables
12360 @vindex org-export-highlight-first-table-line
12361 @vindex org-export-html-style-include-default
12362 @vindex org-export-html-style-include-scripts
12363 @vindex org-export-html-style
12364 @vindex org-export-html-style-extra
12365 @vindex org-export-html-link-org-files-as-html
12366 @vindex org-export-html-inline-images
12367 @vindex org-export-html-extension
12368 @vindex org-export-html-table-tag
12369 @vindex org-export-html-expand
12370 @vindex org-export-html-with-timestamp
12371 @vindex org-export-publishing-directory
12372 @vindex org-export-html-preamble
12373 @vindex org-export-html-postamble
12374 @vindex user-full-name
12375 @vindex user-mail-address
12376 @vindex org-export-select-tags
12377 @vindex org-export-exclude-tags
12378
12379 @multitable @columnfractions 0.32 0.68
12380 @item @code{:link-up} @tab @code{org-export-html-link-up}
12381 @item @code{:link-home} @tab @code{org-export-html-link-home}
12382 @item @code{:language} @tab @code{org-export-default-language}
12383 @item @code{:customtime} @tab @code{org-display-custom-times}
12384 @item @code{:headline-levels} @tab @code{org-export-headline-levels}
12385 @item @code{:section-numbers} @tab @code{org-export-with-section-numbers}
12386 @item @code{:section-number-format} @tab @code{org-export-section-number-format}
12387 @item @code{:table-of-contents} @tab @code{org-export-with-toc}
12388 @item @code{:preserve-breaks} @tab @code{org-export-preserve-breaks}
12389 @item @code{:archived-trees} @tab @code{org-export-with-archived-trees}
12390 @item @code{:emphasize} @tab @code{org-export-with-emphasize}
12391 @item @code{:sub-superscript} @tab @code{org-export-with-sub-superscripts}
12392 @item @code{:special-strings} @tab @code{org-export-with-special-strings}
12393 @item @code{:footnotes} @tab @code{org-export-with-footnotes}
12394 @item @code{:drawers} @tab @code{org-export-with-drawers}
12395 @item @code{:tags} @tab @code{org-export-with-tags}
12396 @item @code{:todo-keywords} @tab @code{org-export-with-todo-keywords}
12397 @item @code{:tasks} @tab @code{org-export-with-tasks}
12398 @item @code{:priority} @tab @code{org-export-with-priority}
12399 @item @code{:TeX-macros} @tab @code{org-export-with-TeX-macros}
12400 @item @code{:LaTeX-fragments} @tab @code{org-export-with-LaTeX-fragments}
12401 @item @code{:latex-listings} @tab @code{org-export-latex-listings}
12402 @item @code{:skip-before-1st-heading} @tab @code{org-export-skip-text-before-1st-heading}
12403 @item @code{:fixed-width} @tab @code{org-export-with-fixed-width}
12404 @item @code{:timestamps} @tab @code{org-export-with-timestamps}
12405 @item @code{:author} @tab @code{user-full-name}
12406 @item @code{:email} @tab @code{user-mail-address} : @code{addr;addr;..}
12407 @item @code{:author-info} @tab @code{org-export-author-info}
12408 @item @code{:email-info} @tab @code{org-export-email-info}
12409 @item @code{:creator-info} @tab @code{org-export-creator-info}
12410 @item @code{:tables} @tab @code{org-export-with-tables}
12411 @item @code{:table-auto-headline} @tab @code{org-export-highlight-first-table-line}
12412 @item @code{:style-include-default} @tab @code{org-export-html-style-include-default}
12413 @item @code{:style-include-scripts} @tab @code{org-export-html-style-include-scripts}
12414 @item @code{:style} @tab @code{org-export-html-style}
12415 @item @code{:style-extra} @tab @code{org-export-html-style-extra}
12416 @item @code{:convert-org-links} @tab @code{org-export-html-link-org-files-as-html}
12417 @item @code{:inline-images} @tab @code{org-export-html-inline-images}
12418 @item @code{:html-extension} @tab @code{org-export-html-extension}
12419 @item @code{:html-preamble} @tab @code{org-export-html-preamble}
12420 @item @code{:html-postamble} @tab @code{org-export-html-postamble}
12421 @item @code{:xml-declaration} @tab @code{org-export-html-xml-declaration}
12422 @item @code{:html-table-tag} @tab @code{org-export-html-table-tag}
12423 @item @code{:expand-quoted-html} @tab @code{org-export-html-expand}
12424 @item @code{:timestamp} @tab @code{org-export-html-with-timestamp}
12425 @item @code{:publishing-directory} @tab @code{org-export-publishing-directory}
12426 @item @code{:select-tags} @tab @code{org-export-select-tags}
12427 @item @code{:exclude-tags} @tab @code{org-export-exclude-tags}
12428 @item @code{:latex-image-options} @tab @code{org-export-latex-image-default-option}
12429 @end multitable
12430
12431 Most of the @code{org-export-with-*} variables have the same effect in
12432 both HTML and @LaTeX{} exporters, except for @code{:TeX-macros} and
12433 @code{:LaTeX-fragments} options, respectively @code{nil} and @code{t} in the
12434 @LaTeX{} export. See @code{org-export-plist-vars} to check this list of
12435 options.
12436
12437
12438
12439 @vindex org-publish-project-alist
12440 When a property is given a value in @code{org-publish-project-alist},
12441 its setting overrides the value of the corresponding user variable (if
12442 any) during publishing. Options set within a file (@pxref{Export
12443 options}), however, override everything.
12444
12445 @node Publishing links, Sitemap, Publishing options, Configuration
12446 @subsection Links between published files
12447 @cindex links, publishing
12448
12449 To create a link from one Org file to another, you would use
12450 something like @samp{[[file:foo.org][The foo]]} or simply
12451 @samp{file:foo.org.} (@pxref{Hyperlinks}). When published, this link
12452 becomes a link to @file{foo.html}. In this way, you can interlink the
12453 pages of your "org web" project and the links will work as expected when
12454 you publish them to HTML@. If you also publish the Org source file and want
12455 to link to that, use an @code{http:} link instead of a @code{file:} link,
12456 because @code{file:} links are converted to link to the corresponding
12457 @file{html} file.
12458
12459 You may also link to related files, such as images. Provided you are careful
12460 with relative file names, and provided you have also configured Org to upload
12461 the related files, these links will work too. See @ref{Complex example}, for
12462 an example of this usage.
12463
12464 Sometimes an Org file to be published may contain links that are
12465 only valid in your production environment, but not in the publishing
12466 location. In this case, use the property
12467
12468 @multitable @columnfractions 0.4 0.6
12469 @item @code{:link-validation-function}
12470 @tab Function to validate links
12471 @end multitable
12472
12473 @noindent
12474 to define a function for checking link validity. This function must
12475 accept two arguments, the file name and a directory relative to which
12476 the file name is interpreted in the production environment. If this
12477 function returns @code{nil}, then the HTML generator will only insert a
12478 description into the HTML file, but no link. One option for this
12479 function is @code{org-publish-validate-link} which checks if the given
12480 file is part of any project in @code{org-publish-project-alist}.
12481
12482 @node Sitemap, Generating an index, Publishing links, Configuration
12483 @subsection Generating a sitemap
12484 @cindex sitemap, of published pages
12485
12486 The following properties may be used to control publishing of
12487 a map of files for a given project.
12488
12489 @multitable @columnfractions 0.35 0.65
12490 @item @code{:auto-sitemap}
12491 @tab When non-nil, publish a sitemap during @code{org-publish-current-project}
12492 or @code{org-publish-all}.
12493
12494 @item @code{:sitemap-filename}
12495 @tab Filename for output of sitemap. Defaults to @file{sitemap.org} (which
12496 becomes @file{sitemap.html}).
12497
12498 @item @code{:sitemap-title}
12499 @tab Title of sitemap page. Defaults to name of file.
12500
12501 @item @code{:sitemap-function}
12502 @tab Plug-in function to use for generation of the sitemap.
12503 Defaults to @code{org-publish-org-sitemap}, which generates a plain list
12504 of links to all files in the project.
12505
12506 @item @code{:sitemap-sort-folders}
12507 @tab Where folders should appear in the sitemap. Set this to @code{first}
12508 (default) or @code{last} to display folders first or last,
12509 respectively. Any other value will mix files and folders.
12510
12511 @item @code{:sitemap-sort-files}
12512 @tab How the files are sorted in the site map. Set this to
12513 @code{alphabetically} (default), @code{chronologically} or
12514 @code{anti-chronologically}. @code{chronologically} sorts the files with
12515 older date first while @code{anti-chronologically} sorts the files with newer
12516 date first. @code{alphabetically} sorts the files alphabetically. The date of
12517 a file is retrieved with @code{org-publish-find-date}.
12518
12519 @item @code{:sitemap-ignore-case}
12520 @tab Should sorting be case-sensitive? Default @code{nil}.
12521
12522 @item @code{:sitemap-file-entry-format}
12523 @tab With this option one can tell how a sitemap's entry is formatted in the
12524 sitemap. This is a format string with some escape sequences: @code{%t} stands
12525 for the title of the file, @code{%a} stands for the author of the file and
12526 @code{%d} stands for the date of the file. The date is retrieved with the
12527 @code{org-publish-find-date} function and formatted with
12528 @code{org-publish-sitemap-date-format}. Default @code{%t}.
12529
12530 @item @code{:sitemap-date-format}
12531 @tab Format string for the @code{format-time-string} function that tells how
12532 a sitemap entry's date is to be formatted. This property bypasses
12533 @code{org-publish-sitemap-date-format} which defaults to @code{%Y-%m-%d}.
12534
12535 @item @code{:sitemap-sans-extension}
12536 @tab When non-nil, remove filenames' extensions from the generated sitemap.
12537 Useful to have cool URIs (see @uref{http://www.w3.org/Provider/Style/URI}).
12538 Defaults to @code{nil}.
12539
12540 @end multitable
12541
12542 @node Generating an index, , Sitemap, Configuration
12543 @subsection Generating an index
12544 @cindex index, in a publishing project
12545
12546 Org mode can generate an index across the files of a publishing project.
12547
12548 @multitable @columnfractions 0.25 0.75
12549 @item @code{:makeindex}
12550 @tab When non-nil, generate in index in the file @file{theindex.org} and
12551 publish it as @file{theindex.html}.
12552 @end multitable
12553
12554 The file will be created when first publishing a project with the
12555 @code{:makeindex} set. The file only contains a statement @code{#+INCLUDE:
12556 "theindex.inc"}. You can then build around this include statement by adding
12557 a title, style information, etc.
12558
12559 @node Uploading files, Sample configuration, Configuration, Publishing
12560 @section Uploading files
12561 @cindex rsync
12562 @cindex unison
12563
12564 For those people already utilizing third party sync tools such as
12565 @command{rsync} or @command{unison}, it might be preferable not to use the built in
12566 @i{remote} publishing facilities of Org mode which rely heavily on
12567 Tramp. Tramp, while very useful and powerful, tends not to be
12568 so efficient for multiple file transfer and has been known to cause problems
12569 under heavy usage.
12570
12571 Specialized synchronization utilities offer several advantages. In addition
12572 to timestamp comparison, they also do content and permissions/attribute
12573 checks. For this reason you might prefer to publish your web to a local
12574 directory (possibly even @i{in place} with your Org files) and then use
12575 @file{unison} or @file{rsync} to do the synchronization with the remote host.
12576
12577 Since Unison (for example) can be configured as to which files to transfer to
12578 a certain remote destination, it can greatly simplify the project publishing
12579 definition. Simply keep all files in the correct location, process your Org
12580 files with @code{org-publish} and let the synchronization tool do the rest.
12581 You do not need, in this scenario, to include attachments such as @file{jpg},
12582 @file{css} or @file{gif} files in the project definition since the 3rd party
12583 tool syncs them.
12584
12585 Publishing to a local directory is also much faster than to a remote one, so
12586 that you can afford more easily to republish entire projects. If you set
12587 @code{org-publish-use-timestamps-flag} to @code{nil}, you gain the main
12588 benefit of re-including any changed external files such as source example
12589 files you might include with @code{#+INCLUDE:}. The timestamp mechanism in
12590 Org is not smart enough to detect if included files have been modified.
12591
12592 @node Sample configuration, Triggering publication, Uploading files, Publishing
12593 @section Sample configuration
12594
12595 Below we provide two example configurations. The first one is a simple
12596 project publishing only a set of Org files. The second example is
12597 more complex, with a multi-component project.
12598
12599 @menu
12600 * Simple example:: One-component publishing
12601 * Complex example:: A multi-component publishing example
12602 @end menu
12603
12604 @node Simple example, Complex example, Sample configuration, Sample configuration
12605 @subsection Example: simple publishing configuration
12606
12607 This example publishes a set of Org files to the @file{public_html}
12608 directory on the local machine.
12609
12610 @lisp
12611 (setq org-publish-project-alist
12612 '(("org"
12613 :base-directory "~/org/"
12614 :publishing-directory "~/public_html"
12615 :section-numbers nil
12616 :table-of-contents nil
12617 :style "<link rel=\"stylesheet\"
12618 href=\"../other/mystyle.css\"
12619 type=\"text/css\"/>")))
12620 @end lisp
12621
12622 @node Complex example, , Simple example, Sample configuration
12623 @subsection Example: complex publishing configuration
12624
12625 This more complicated example publishes an entire website, including
12626 Org files converted to HTML, image files, Emacs Lisp source code, and
12627 style sheets. The publishing directory is remote and private files are
12628 excluded.
12629
12630 To ensure that links are preserved, care should be taken to replicate
12631 your directory structure on the web server, and to use relative file
12632 paths. For example, if your Org files are kept in @file{~/org} and your
12633 publishable images in @file{~/images}, you would link to an image with
12634 @c
12635 @example
12636 file:../images/myimage.png
12637 @end example
12638 @c
12639 On the web server, the relative path to the image should be the
12640 same. You can accomplish this by setting up an "images" folder in the
12641 right place on the web server, and publishing images to it.
12642
12643 @lisp
12644 (setq org-publish-project-alist
12645 '(("orgfiles"
12646 :base-directory "~/org/"
12647 :base-extension "org"
12648 :publishing-directory "/ssh:user@@host:~/html/notebook/"
12649 :publishing-function org-publish-org-to-html
12650 :exclude "PrivatePage.org" ;; regexp
12651 :headline-levels 3
12652 :section-numbers nil
12653 :table-of-contents nil
12654 :style "<link rel=\"stylesheet\"
12655 href=\"../other/mystyle.css\" type=\"text/css\"/>"
12656 :html-preamble t)
12657
12658 ("images"
12659 :base-directory "~/images/"
12660 :base-extension "jpg\\|gif\\|png"
12661 :publishing-directory "/ssh:user@@host:~/html/images/"
12662 :publishing-function org-publish-attachment)
12663
12664 ("other"
12665 :base-directory "~/other/"
12666 :base-extension "css\\|el"
12667 :publishing-directory "/ssh:user@@host:~/html/other/"
12668 :publishing-function org-publish-attachment)
12669 ("website" :components ("orgfiles" "images" "other"))))
12670 @end lisp
12671
12672 @node Triggering publication, , Sample configuration, Publishing
12673 @section Triggering publication
12674
12675 Once properly configured, Org can publish with the following commands:
12676
12677 @table @kbd
12678 @orgcmd{C-c C-e X,org-publish}
12679 Prompt for a specific project and publish all files that belong to it.
12680 @orgcmd{C-c C-e P,org-publish-current-project}
12681 Publish the project containing the current file.
12682 @orgcmd{C-c C-e F,org-publish-current-file}
12683 Publish only the current file.
12684 @orgcmd{C-c C-e E,org-publish-all}
12685 Publish every project.
12686 @end table
12687
12688 @vindex org-publish-use-timestamps-flag
12689 Org uses timestamps to track when a file has changed. The above functions
12690 normally only publish changed files. You can override this and force
12691 publishing of all files by giving a prefix argument to any of the commands
12692 above, or by customizing the variable @code{org-publish-use-timestamps-flag}.
12693 This may be necessary in particular if files include other files via
12694 @code{#+SETUPFILE:} or @code{#+INCLUDE:}.
12695
12696 @comment node-name, next, previous, up
12697 @comment Working With Source Code, Miscellaneous, Publishing, Top
12698
12699 @node Working With Source Code, Miscellaneous, Publishing, Top
12700 @chapter Working with source code
12701 @cindex Schulte, Eric
12702 @cindex Davison, Dan
12703 @cindex source code, working with
12704
12705 Source code can be included in Org mode documents using a @samp{src} block,
12706 e.g.:
12707
12708 @example
12709 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp
12710 (defun org-xor (a b)
12711 "Exclusive or."
12712 (if a (not b) b))
12713 #+END_SRC
12714 @end example
12715
12716 Org mode provides a number of features for working with live source code,
12717 including editing of code blocks in their native major-mode, evaluation of
12718 code blocks, converting code blocks into source files (known as @dfn{tangling}
12719 in literate programming), and exporting code blocks and their
12720 results in several formats. This functionality was contributed by Eric
12721 Schulte and Dan Davison, and was originally named Org-babel.
12722
12723 The following sections describe Org mode's code block handling facilities.
12724
12725 @menu
12726 * Structure of code blocks:: Code block syntax described
12727 * Editing source code:: Language major-mode editing
12728 * Exporting code blocks:: Export contents and/or results
12729 * Extracting source code:: Create pure source code files
12730 * Evaluating code blocks:: Place results of evaluation in the Org mode buffer
12731 * Library of Babel:: Use and contribute to a library of useful code blocks
12732 * Languages:: List of supported code block languages
12733 * Header arguments:: Configure code block functionality
12734 * Results of evaluation:: How evaluation results are handled
12735 * Noweb reference syntax:: Literate programming in Org mode
12736 * Key bindings and useful functions:: Work quickly with code blocks
12737 * Batch execution:: Call functions from the command line
12738 @end menu
12739
12740 @comment node-name, next, previous, up
12741 @comment Structure of code blocks, Editing source code, Working With Source Code, Working With Source Code
12742
12743 @node Structure of code blocks, Editing source code, Working With Source Code, Working With Source Code
12744 @section Structure of code blocks
12745 @cindex code block, structure
12746 @cindex source code, block structure
12747 @cindex #+NAME
12748 @cindex #+BEGIN_SRC
12749
12750 Live code blocks can be specified with a @samp{src} block or
12751 inline.@footnote{Note that @samp{src} blocks may be inserted using Org mode's
12752 @ref{Easy Templates} system} The structure of a @samp{src} block is
12753
12754 @example
12755 #+NAME: <name>
12756 #+BEGIN_SRC <language> <switches> <header arguments>
12757 <body>
12758 #+END_SRC
12759 @end example
12760
12761 The @code{#+NAME:} line is optional, and can be used to name the code
12762 block. Live code blocks require that a language be specified on the
12763 @code{#+BEGIN_SRC} line. Switches and header arguments are optional.
12764 @cindex source code, inline
12765
12766 Live code blocks can also be specified inline using
12767
12768 @example
12769 src_<language>@{<body>@}
12770 @end example
12771
12772 or
12773
12774 @example
12775 src_<language>[<header arguments>]@{<body>@}
12776 @end example
12777
12778 @table @code
12779 @item <#+NAME: name>
12780 This line associates a name with the code block. This is similar to the
12781 @code{#+TBLNAME: NAME} lines that can be used to name tables in Org mode
12782 files. Referencing the name of a code block makes it possible to evaluate
12783 the block from other places in the file, from other files, or from Org mode
12784 table formulas (see @ref{The spreadsheet}). Names are assumed to be unique
12785 and the behavior of Org mode when two or more blocks share the same name is
12786 undefined.
12787 @cindex #+NAME
12788 @item <language>
12789 The language of the code in the block (see @ref{Languages}).
12790 @cindex source code, language
12791 @item <switches>
12792 Optional switches control code block export (see the discussion of switches in
12793 @ref{Literal examples})
12794 @cindex source code, switches
12795 @item <header arguments>
12796 Optional header arguments control many aspects of evaluation, export and
12797 tangling of code blocks (see @ref{Header arguments}).
12798 Header arguments can also be set on a per-buffer or per-subtree
12799 basis using properties.
12800 @item source code, header arguments
12801 @item <body>
12802 Source code in the specified language.
12803 @end table
12804
12805 @comment node-name, next, previous, up
12806 @comment Editing source code, Exporting code blocks, Structure of code blocks, Working With Source Code
12807
12808 @node Editing source code, Exporting code blocks, Structure of code blocks, Working With Source Code
12809 @section Editing source code
12810 @cindex code block, editing
12811 @cindex source code, editing
12812
12813 @kindex C-c '
12814 Use @kbd{C-c '} to edit the current code block. This brings up
12815 a language major-mode edit buffer containing the body of the code
12816 block. Saving this buffer will write the new contents back to the Org
12817 buffer. Use @kbd{C-c '} again to exit.
12818
12819 The @code{org-src-mode} minor mode will be active in the edit buffer. The
12820 following variables can be used to configure the behavior of the edit
12821 buffer. See also the customization group @code{org-edit-structure} for
12822 further configuration options.
12823
12824 @table @code
12825 @item org-src-lang-modes
12826 If an Emacs major-mode named @code{<lang>-mode} exists, where
12827 @code{<lang>} is the language named in the header line of the code block,
12828 then the edit buffer will be placed in that major-mode. This variable
12829 can be used to map arbitrary language names to existing major modes.
12830 @item org-src-window-setup
12831 Controls the way Emacs windows are rearranged when the edit buffer is created.
12832 @item org-src-preserve-indentation
12833 This variable is especially useful for tangling languages such as
12834 Python, in which whitespace indentation in the output is critical.
12835 @item org-src-ask-before-returning-to-edit-buffer
12836 By default, Org will ask before returning to an open edit buffer. Set this
12837 variable to nil to switch without asking.
12838 @end table
12839
12840 To turn on native code fontification in the @emph{Org} buffer, configure the
12841 variable @code{org-src-fontify-natively}.
12842
12843 @comment node-name, next, previous, up
12844 @comment Exporting code blocks, Extracting source code, Editing source code, Working With Source Code
12845
12846 @node Exporting code blocks, Extracting source code, Editing source code, Working With Source Code
12847 @section Exporting code blocks
12848 @cindex code block, exporting
12849 @cindex source code, exporting
12850
12851 It is possible to export the @emph{code} of code blocks, the @emph{results}
12852 of code block evaluation, @emph{both} the code and the results of code block
12853 evaluation, or @emph{none}. For most languages, the default exports code.
12854 However, for some languages (e.g., @code{ditaa}) the default exports the
12855 results of code block evaluation. For information on exporting code block
12856 bodies, see @ref{Literal examples}.
12857
12858 The @code{:exports} header argument can be used to specify export
12859 behavior:
12860
12861 @subsubheading Header arguments:
12862 @table @code
12863 @item :exports code
12864 The default in most languages. The body of the code block is exported, as
12865 described in @ref{Literal examples}.
12866 @item :exports results
12867 The code block will be evaluated and the results will be placed in the
12868 Org mode buffer for export, either updating previous results of the code
12869 block located anywhere in the buffer or, if no previous results exist,
12870 placing the results immediately after the code block. The body of the code
12871 block will not be exported.
12872 @item :exports both
12873 Both the code block and its results will be exported.
12874 @item :exports none
12875 Neither the code block nor its results will be exported.
12876 @end table
12877
12878 It is possible to inhibit the evaluation of code blocks during export.
12879 Setting the @code{org-export-babel-evaluate} variable to @code{nil} will
12880 ensure that no code blocks are evaluated as part of the export process. This
12881 can be useful in situations where potentially untrusted Org mode files are
12882 exported in an automated fashion, for example when Org mode is used as the
12883 markup language for a wiki.
12884
12885 @comment node-name, next, previous, up
12886 @comment Extracting source code, Evaluating code blocks, Exporting code blocks, Working With Source Code
12887 @node Extracting source code, Evaluating code blocks, Exporting code blocks, Working With Source Code
12888 @section Extracting source code
12889 @cindex tangling
12890 @cindex source code, extracting
12891 @cindex code block, extracting source code
12892
12893 Creating pure source code files by extracting code from source blocks is
12894 referred to as ``tangling''---a term adopted from the literate programming
12895 community. During ``tangling'' of code blocks their bodies are expanded
12896 using @code{org-babel-expand-src-block} which can expand both variable and
12897 ``noweb'' style references (see @ref{Noweb reference syntax}).
12898
12899 @subsubheading Header arguments
12900 @table @code
12901 @item :tangle no
12902 The default. The code block is not included in the tangled output.
12903 @item :tangle yes
12904 Include the code block in the tangled output. The output file name is the
12905 name of the org file with the extension @samp{.org} replaced by the extension
12906 for the block language.
12907 @item :tangle filename
12908 Include the code block in the tangled output to file @samp{filename}.
12909 @end table
12910
12911 @kindex C-c C-v t
12912 @subsubheading Functions
12913 @table @code
12914 @item org-babel-tangle
12915 Tangle the current file. Bound to @kbd{C-c C-v t}.
12916 @item org-babel-tangle-file
12917 Choose a file to tangle. Bound to @kbd{C-c C-v f}.
12918 @end table
12919
12920 @subsubheading Hooks
12921 @table @code
12922 @item org-babel-post-tangle-hook
12923 This hook is run from within code files tangled by @code{org-babel-tangle}.
12924 Example applications could include post-processing, compilation or evaluation
12925 of tangled code files.
12926 @end table
12927
12928 @node Evaluating code blocks, Library of Babel, Extracting source code, Working With Source Code
12929 @section Evaluating code blocks
12930 @cindex code block, evaluating
12931 @cindex source code, evaluating
12932 @cindex #+RESULTS
12933
12934 Code blocks can be evaluated@footnote{Whenever code is evaluated there is a
12935 potential for that code to do harm. Org mode provides safeguards to ensure
12936 that code is only evaluated after explicit confirmation from the user. For
12937 information on these safeguards (and on how to disable them) see @ref{Code
12938 evaluation security}.} and the results of evaluation optionally placed in the
12939 Org mode buffer. The results of evaluation are placed following a line that
12940 begins by default with @code{#+RESULTS} and optionally a cache identifier
12941 and/or the name of the evaluated code block. The default value of
12942 @code{#+RESULTS} can be changed with the customizable variable
12943 @code{org-babel-results-keyword}.
12944
12945 By default, the evaluation facility is only enabled for Lisp code blocks
12946 specified as @code{emacs-lisp}. However, source code blocks in many languages
12947 can be evaluated within Org mode (see @ref{Languages} for a list of supported
12948 languages and @ref{Structure of code blocks} for information on the syntax
12949 used to define a code block).
12950
12951 @kindex C-c C-c
12952 There are a number of ways to evaluate code blocks. The simplest is to press
12953 @kbd{C-c C-c} or @kbd{C-c C-v e} with the point on a code block@footnote{The
12954 @code{org-babel-no-eval-on-ctrl-c-ctrl-c} variable can be used to remove code
12955 evaluation from the @kbd{C-c C-c} key binding.}. This will call the
12956 @code{org-babel-execute-src-block} function to evaluate the block and insert
12957 its results into the Org mode buffer.
12958 @cindex #+CALL
12959
12960 It is also possible to evaluate named code blocks from anywhere in an Org
12961 mode buffer or an Org mode table. Live code blocks located in the current
12962 Org mode buffer or in the ``Library of Babel'' (see @ref{Library of Babel})
12963 can be executed. Named code blocks can be executed with a separate
12964 @code{#+CALL:} line or inline within a block of text.
12965
12966 The syntax of the @code{#+CALL:} line is
12967
12968 @example
12969 #+CALL: <name>(<arguments>)
12970 #+CALL: <name>[<inside header arguments>](<arguments>) <end header arguments>
12971 @end example
12972
12973 The syntax for inline evaluation of named code blocks is
12974
12975 @example
12976 ... call_<name>(<arguments>) ...
12977 ... call_<name>[<inside header arguments>](<arguments>)[<end header arguments>] ...
12978 @end example
12979
12980 @table @code
12981 @item <name>
12982 The name of the code block to be evaluated (see @ref{Structure of code blocks}).
12983 @item <arguments>
12984 Arguments specified in this section will be passed to the code block. These
12985 arguments use standard function call syntax, rather than
12986 header argument syntax. For example, a @code{#+CALL:} line that passes the
12987 number four to a code block named @code{double}, which declares the header
12988 argument @code{:var n=2}, would be written as @code{#+CALL: double(n=4)}.
12989 @item <inside header arguments>
12990 Inside header arguments are passed through and applied to the named code
12991 block. These arguments use header argument syntax rather than standard
12992 function call syntax. Inside header arguments affect how the code block is
12993 evaluated. For example, @code{[:results output]} will collect the results of
12994 everything printed to @code{STDOUT} during execution of the code block.
12995 @item <end header arguments>
12996 End header arguments are applied to the calling instance and do not affect
12997 evaluation of the named code block. They affect how the results are
12998 incorporated into the Org mode buffer and how the call line is exported. For
12999 example, @code{:results html} will insert the results of the call line
13000 evaluation in the Org buffer, wrapped in a @code{BEGIN_HTML:} block.
13001
13002 For more examples of passing header arguments to @code{#+CALL:} lines see
13003 @ref{Header arguments in function calls}.
13004 @end table
13005
13006 @node Library of Babel, Languages, Evaluating code blocks, Working With Source Code
13007 @section Library of Babel
13008 @cindex babel, library of
13009 @cindex source code, library
13010 @cindex code block, library
13011
13012 The ``Library of Babel'' consists of code blocks that can be called from any
13013 Org mode file. Code blocks defined in the ``Library of Babel'' can be called
13014 remotely as if they were in the current Org mode buffer (see @ref{Evaluating
13015 code blocks} for information on the syntax of remote code block evaluation).
13016
13017
13018 The central repository of code blocks in the ``Library of Babel'' is housed
13019 in an Org mode file located in the @samp{contrib} directory of Org mode.
13020
13021 Users can add code blocks they believe to be generally useful to their
13022 ``Library of Babel.'' The code blocks can be stored in any Org mode file and
13023 then loaded into the library with @code{org-babel-lob-ingest}.
13024
13025
13026 @kindex C-c C-v i
13027 Code blocks located in any Org mode file can be loaded into the ``Library of
13028 Babel'' with the @code{org-babel-lob-ingest} function, bound to @kbd{C-c C-v
13029 i}.
13030
13031 @node Languages, Header arguments, Library of Babel, Working With Source Code
13032 @section Languages
13033 @cindex babel, languages
13034 @cindex source code, languages
13035 @cindex code block, languages
13036
13037 Code blocks in the following languages are supported.
13038
13039 @multitable @columnfractions 0.28 0.3 0.22 0.2
13040 @item @b{Language} @tab @b{Identifier} @tab @b{Language} @tab @b{Identifier}
13041 @item Asymptote @tab asymptote @tab Awk @tab awk
13042 @item Emacs Calc @tab calc @tab C @tab C
13043 @item C++ @tab C++ @tab Clojure @tab clojure
13044 @item CSS @tab css @tab ditaa @tab ditaa
13045 @item Graphviz @tab dot @tab Emacs Lisp @tab emacs-lisp
13046 @item gnuplot @tab gnuplot @tab Haskell @tab haskell
13047 @item Java @tab java @tab @tab
13048 @item Javascript @tab js @tab LaTeX @tab latex
13049 @item Ledger @tab ledger @tab Lisp @tab lisp
13050 @item Lilypond @tab lilypond @tab MATLAB @tab matlab
13051 @item Mscgen @tab mscgen @tab Objective Caml @tab ocaml
13052 @item Octave @tab octave @tab Org mode @tab org
13053 @item Oz @tab oz @tab Perl @tab perl
13054 @item Plantuml @tab plantuml @tab Python @tab python
13055 @item R @tab R @tab Ruby @tab ruby
13056 @item Sass @tab sass @tab Scheme @tab scheme
13057 @item GNU Screen @tab screen @tab shell @tab sh
13058 @item SQL @tab sql @tab SQLite @tab sqlite
13059 @end multitable
13060
13061 Language-specific documentation is available for some languages. If
13062 available, it can be found at
13063 @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-contrib/babel/languages.html}.
13064
13065 The @code{org-babel-load-languages} controls which languages are enabled for
13066 evaluation (by default only @code{emacs-lisp} is enabled). This variable can
13067 be set using the customization interface or by adding code like the following
13068 to your emacs configuration.
13069
13070 @quotation
13071 The following disables @code{emacs-lisp} evaluation and enables evaluation of
13072 @code{R} code blocks.
13073 @end quotation
13074
13075 @lisp
13076 (org-babel-do-load-languages
13077 'org-babel-load-languages
13078 '((emacs-lisp . nil)
13079 (R . t)))
13080 @end lisp
13081
13082 It is also possible to enable support for a language by loading the related
13083 elisp file with @code{require}.
13084
13085 @quotation
13086 The following adds support for evaluating @code{clojure} code blocks.
13087 @end quotation
13088
13089 @lisp
13090 (require 'ob-clojure)
13091 @end lisp
13092
13093 @node Header arguments, Results of evaluation, Languages, Working With Source Code
13094 @section Header arguments
13095 @cindex code block, header arguments
13096 @cindex source code, block header arguments
13097
13098 Code block functionality can be configured with header arguments. This
13099 section provides an overview of the use of header arguments, and then
13100 describes each header argument in detail.
13101
13102 @menu
13103 * Using header arguments:: Different ways to set header arguments
13104 * Specific header arguments:: List of header arguments
13105 @end menu
13106
13107 @node Using header arguments, Specific header arguments, Header arguments, Header arguments
13108 @subsection Using header arguments
13109
13110 The values of header arguments can be set in six different ways, each more
13111 specific (and having higher priority) than the last.
13112 @menu
13113 * System-wide header arguments:: Set global default values
13114 * Language-specific header arguments:: Set default values by language
13115 * Buffer-wide header arguments:: Set default values for a specific buffer
13116 * Header arguments in Org mode properties:: Set default values for a buffer or heading
13117 * Code block specific header arguments:: The most common way to set values
13118 * Header arguments in function calls:: The most specific level
13119 @end menu
13120
13121
13122 @node System-wide header arguments, Language-specific header arguments, Using header arguments, Using header arguments
13123 @subsubheading System-wide header arguments
13124 @vindex org-babel-default-header-args
13125 System-wide values of header arguments can be specified by customizing the
13126 @code{org-babel-default-header-args} variable:
13127
13128 @example
13129 :session => "none"
13130 :results => "replace"
13131 :exports => "code"
13132 :cache => "no"
13133 :noweb => "no"
13134 @end example
13135
13136 @c @example
13137 @c org-babel-default-header-args is a variable defined in `org-babel.el'.
13138 @c Its value is
13139 @c ((:session . "none")
13140 @c (:results . "replace")
13141 @c (:exports . "code")
13142 @c (:cache . "no")
13143 @c (:noweb . "no"))
13144
13145
13146 @c Documentation:
13147 @c Default arguments to use when evaluating a code block.
13148 @c @end example
13149
13150 For example, the following example could be used to set the default value of
13151 @code{:noweb} header arguments to @code{yes}. This would have the effect of
13152 expanding @code{:noweb} references by default when evaluating source code
13153 blocks.
13154
13155 @lisp
13156 (setq org-babel-default-header-args
13157 (cons '(:noweb . "yes")
13158 (assq-delete-all :noweb org-babel-default-header-args)))
13159 @end lisp
13160
13161 @node Language-specific header arguments, Buffer-wide header arguments, System-wide header arguments, Using header arguments
13162 @subsubheading Language-specific header arguments
13163 Each language can define its own set of default header arguments. See the
13164 language-specific documentation available online at
13165 @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-contrib/babel}.
13166
13167 @node Buffer-wide header arguments, Header arguments in Org mode properties, Language-specific header arguments, Using header arguments
13168 @subsubheading Buffer-wide header arguments
13169 Buffer-wide header arguments may be specified as properties through the use
13170 of @code{#+PROPERTY:} lines placed anywhere in an Org mode file (see
13171 @ref{Property syntax}).
13172
13173 For example the following would set @code{session} to @code{*R*}, and
13174 @code{results} to @code{silent} for every code block in the buffer, ensuring
13175 that all execution took place in the same session, and no results would be
13176 inserted into the buffer.
13177
13178 @example
13179 #+PROPERTY: session *R*
13180 #+PROPERTY: results silent
13181 @end example
13182
13183 @node Header arguments in Org mode properties, Code block specific header arguments, Buffer-wide header arguments, Using header arguments
13184 @subsubheading Header arguments in Org mode properties
13185
13186 Header arguments are also read from Org mode properties (see @ref{Property
13187 syntax}), which can be set on a buffer-wide or per-heading basis. An example
13188 of setting a header argument for all code blocks in a buffer is
13189
13190 @example
13191 #+PROPERTY: tangle yes
13192 @end example
13193
13194 @vindex org-use-property-inheritance
13195 When properties are used to set default header arguments, they are looked up
13196 with inheritance, regardless of the value of
13197 @code{org-use-property-inheritance}. In the following example the value of
13198 the @code{:cache} header argument will default to @code{yes} in all code
13199 blocks in the subtree rooted at the following heading:
13200
13201 @example
13202 * outline header
13203 :PROPERTIES:
13204 :cache: yes
13205 :END:
13206 @end example
13207
13208 @kindex C-c C-x p
13209 @vindex org-babel-default-header-args
13210 Properties defined in this way override the properties set in
13211 @code{org-babel-default-header-args}. It is convenient to use the
13212 @code{org-set-property} function bound to @kbd{C-c C-x p} to set properties
13213 in Org mode documents.
13214
13215 @node Code block specific header arguments, Header arguments in function calls, Header arguments in Org mode properties, Using header arguments
13216 @subsubheading Code block specific header arguments
13217
13218 The most common way to assign values to header arguments is at the
13219 code block level. This can be done by listing a sequence of header
13220 arguments and their values as part of the @code{#+BEGIN_SRC} line.
13221 Properties set in this way override both the values of
13222 @code{org-babel-default-header-args} and header arguments specified as
13223 properties. In the following example, the @code{:results} header argument
13224 is set to @code{silent}, meaning the results of execution will not be
13225 inserted in the buffer, and the @code{:exports} header argument is set to
13226 @code{code}, meaning only the body of the code block will be
13227 preserved on export to HTML or @LaTeX{}.
13228
13229 @example
13230 #+NAME: factorial
13231 #+BEGIN_SRC haskell :results silent :exports code :var n=0
13232 fac 0 = 1
13233 fac n = n * fac (n-1)
13234 #+END_SRC
13235 @end example
13236 Similarly, it is possible to set header arguments for inline code blocks
13237
13238 @example
13239 src_haskell[:exports both]@{fac 5@}
13240 @end example
13241
13242 Code block header arguments can span multiple lines using @code{#+HEADER:} or
13243 @code{#+HEADERS:} lines preceding a code block or nested between the
13244 @code{#+NAME:} line and the @code{#+BEGIN_SRC} line of a named code block.
13245 @cindex #+HEADER:
13246 @cindex #+HEADERS:
13247
13248 Multi-line header arguments on an un-named code block:
13249
13250 @example
13251 #+HEADERS: :var data1=1
13252 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var data2=2
13253 (message "data1:%S, data2:%S" data1 data2)
13254 #+END_SRC
13255
13256 #+RESULTS:
13257 : data1:1, data2:2
13258 @end example
13259
13260 Multi-line header arguments on a named code block:
13261
13262 @example
13263 #+NAME: named-block
13264 #+HEADER: :var data=2
13265 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp
13266 (message "data:%S" data)
13267 #+END_SRC
13268
13269 #+RESULTS: named-block
13270 : data:2
13271 @end example
13272
13273 @node Header arguments in function calls, , Code block specific header arguments, Using header arguments
13274 @comment node-name, next, previous, up
13275 @subsubheading Header arguments in function calls
13276
13277 At the most specific level, header arguments for ``Library of Babel'' or
13278 @code{#+CALL:} lines can be set as shown in the two examples below. For more
13279 information on the structure of @code{#+CALL:} lines see @ref{Evaluating code
13280 blocks}.
13281
13282 The following will apply the @code{:exports results} header argument to the
13283 evaluation of the @code{#+CALL:} line.
13284
13285 @example
13286 #+CALL: factorial(n=5) :exports results
13287 @end example
13288
13289 The following will apply the @code{:session special} header argument to the
13290 evaluation of the @code{factorial} code block.
13291
13292 @example
13293 #+CALL: factorial[:session special](n=5)
13294 @end example
13295
13296 @node Specific header arguments, , Using header arguments, Header arguments
13297 @subsection Specific header arguments
13298 Header arguments consist of an initial colon followed by the name of the
13299 argument in lowercase letters. The following header arguments are defined:
13300
13301 @menu
13302 * var:: Pass arguments to code blocks
13303 * results:: Specify the type of results and how they will
13304 be collected and handled
13305 * file:: Specify a path for file output
13306 * file-desc:: Specify a description for file results
13307 * dir:: Specify the default (possibly remote)
13308 directory for code block execution
13309 * exports:: Export code and/or results
13310 * tangle:: Toggle tangling and specify file name
13311 * mkdirp:: Toggle creation of parent directories of target
13312 files during tangling
13313 * comments:: Toggle insertion of comments in tangled
13314 code files
13315 * padline:: Control insertion of padding lines in tangled
13316 code files
13317 * no-expand:: Turn off variable assignment and noweb
13318 expansion during tangling
13319 * session:: Preserve the state of code evaluation
13320 * noweb:: Toggle expansion of noweb references
13321 * noweb-ref:: Specify block's noweb reference resolution target
13322 * noweb-sep:: String used to separate noweb references
13323 * cache:: Avoid re-evaluating unchanged code blocks
13324 * sep:: Delimiter for writing tabular results outside Org
13325 * hlines:: Handle horizontal lines in tables
13326 * colnames:: Handle column names in tables
13327 * rownames:: Handle row names in tables
13328 * shebang:: Make tangled files executable
13329 * eval:: Limit evaluation of specific code blocks
13330 * wrap:: Mark source block evaluation results
13331 @end menu
13332
13333 Additional header arguments are defined on a language-specific basis, see
13334 @ref{Languages}.
13335
13336 @node var, results, Specific header arguments, Specific header arguments
13337 @subsubsection @code{:var}
13338 The @code{:var} header argument is used to pass arguments to code blocks.
13339 The specifics of how arguments are included in a code block vary by language;
13340 these are addressed in the language-specific documentation. However, the
13341 syntax used to specify arguments is the same across all languages. In every
13342 case, variables require a default value when they are declared.
13343
13344 The values passed to arguments can either be literal values, references, or
13345 Emacs Lisp code (see @ref{var, Emacs Lisp evaluation of variables}). References
13346 include anything in the Org mode file that takes a @code{#+NAME:},
13347 @code{#+TBLNAME:}, or @code{#+RESULTS:} line. This includes tables, lists,
13348 @code{#+BEGIN_EXAMPLE} blocks, other code blocks, and the results of other
13349 code blocks.
13350
13351 Argument values can be indexed in a manner similar to arrays (see @ref{var,
13352 Indexable variable values}).
13353
13354 The following syntax is used to pass arguments to code blocks using the
13355 @code{:var} header argument.
13356
13357 @example
13358 :var name=assign
13359 @end example
13360
13361 The argument, @code{assign}, can either be a literal value, such as a string
13362 @samp{"string"} or a number @samp{9}, or a reference to a table, a list, a
13363 literal example, another code block (with or without arguments), or the
13364 results of evaluating another code block.
13365
13366 Here are examples of passing values by reference:
13367
13368 @table @dfn
13369
13370 @item table
13371 an Org mode table named with either a @code{#+NAME:} or @code{#+TBLNAME:} line
13372
13373 @example
13374 #+TBLNAME: example-table
13375 | 1 |
13376 | 2 |
13377 | 3 |
13378 | 4 |
13379
13380 #+NAME: table-length
13381 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var table=example-table
13382 (length table)
13383 #+END_SRC
13384
13385 #+RESULTS: table-length
13386 : 4
13387 @end example
13388
13389 @item list
13390 a simple list named with a @code{#+NAME:} line (note that nesting is not
13391 carried through to the source code block)
13392
13393 @example
13394 #+NAME: example-list
13395 - simple
13396 - not
13397 - nested
13398 - list
13399
13400 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var x=example-list
13401 (print x)
13402 #+END_SRC
13403
13404 #+RESULTS:
13405 | simple | list |
13406 @end example
13407
13408 @item code block without arguments
13409 a code block name (from the example above), as assigned by @code{#+NAME:},
13410 optionally followed by parentheses
13411
13412 @example
13413 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var length=table-length()
13414 (* 2 length)
13415 #+END_SRC
13416
13417 #+RESULTS:
13418 : 8
13419 @end example
13420
13421 @item code block with arguments
13422 a code block name, as assigned by @code{#+NAME:}, followed by parentheses and
13423 optional arguments passed within the parentheses following the
13424 code block name using standard function call syntax
13425
13426 @example
13427 #+NAME: double
13428 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var input=8
13429 (* 2 input)
13430 #+END_SRC
13431
13432 #+RESULTS: double
13433 : 16
13434
13435 #+NAME: squared
13436 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var input=double(input=1)
13437 (* input input)
13438 #+END_SRC
13439
13440 #+RESULTS: squared
13441 : 4
13442 @end example
13443
13444 @item literal example
13445 a literal example block named with a @code{#+NAME:} line
13446
13447 @example
13448 #+NAME: literal-example
13449 #+BEGIN_EXAMPLE
13450 A literal example
13451 on two lines
13452 #+END_EXAMPLE
13453
13454 #+NAME: read-literal-example
13455 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var x=literal-example
13456 (concatenate 'string x " for you.")
13457 #+END_SRC
13458
13459 #+RESULTS: read-literal-example
13460 : A literal example
13461 : on two lines for you.
13462
13463 @end example
13464
13465 @end table
13466
13467 @subsubheading Alternate argument syntax
13468 It is also possible to specify arguments in a potentially more natural way
13469 using the @code{#+NAME:} line of a code block. As in the following
13470 example, arguments can be packed inside of parentheses, separated by commas,
13471 following the source name.
13472
13473 @example
13474 #+NAME: double(input=0, x=2)
13475 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp
13476 (* 2 (+ input x))
13477 #+END_SRC
13478 @end example
13479
13480 @subsubheading Indexable variable values
13481 It is possible to reference portions of variable values by ``indexing'' into
13482 the variables. Indexes are 0 based with negative values counting back from
13483 the end. If an index is separated by @code{,}s then each subsequent section
13484 will index into the next deepest nesting or dimension of the value. Note
13485 that this indexing occurs @emph{before} other table related header arguments
13486 like @code{:hlines}, @code{:colnames} and @code{:rownames} are applied. The
13487 following example assigns the last cell of the first row the table
13488 @code{example-table} to the variable @code{data}:
13489
13490 @example
13491 #+NAME: example-table
13492 | 1 | a |
13493 | 2 | b |
13494 | 3 | c |
13495 | 4 | d |
13496
13497 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var data=example-table[0,-1]
13498 data
13499 #+END_SRC
13500
13501 #+RESULTS:
13502 : a
13503 @end example
13504
13505 Ranges of variable values can be referenced using two integers separated by a
13506 @code{:}, in which case the entire inclusive range is referenced. For
13507 example the following assigns the middle three rows of @code{example-table}
13508 to @code{data}.
13509
13510 @example
13511 #+NAME: example-table
13512 | 1 | a |
13513 | 2 | b |
13514 | 3 | c |
13515 | 4 | d |
13516 | 5 | 3 |
13517
13518 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var data=example-table[1:3]
13519 data
13520 #+END_SRC
13521
13522 #+RESULTS:
13523 | 2 | b |
13524 | 3 | c |
13525 | 4 | d |
13526 @end example
13527
13528 Additionally, an empty index, or the single character @code{*}, are both
13529 interpreted to mean the entire range and as such are equivalent to
13530 @code{0:-1}, as shown in the following example in which the entire first
13531 column is referenced.
13532
13533 @example
13534 #+NAME: example-table
13535 | 1 | a |
13536 | 2 | b |
13537 | 3 | c |
13538 | 4 | d |
13539
13540 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var data=example-table[,0]
13541 data
13542 #+END_SRC
13543
13544 #+RESULTS:
13545 | 1 | 2 | 3 | 4 |
13546 @end example
13547
13548 It is possible to index into the results of code blocks as well as tables.
13549 Any number of dimensions can be indexed. Dimensions are separated from one
13550 another by commas, as shown in the following example.
13551
13552 @example
13553 #+NAME: 3D
13554 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp
13555 '(((1 2 3) (4 5 6) (7 8 9))
13556 ((10 11 12) (13 14 15) (16 17 18))
13557 ((19 20 21) (22 23 24) (25 26 27)))
13558 #+END_SRC
13559
13560 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var data=3D[1,,1]
13561 data
13562 #+END_SRC
13563
13564 #+RESULTS:
13565 | 11 | 14 | 17 |
13566 @end example
13567
13568 @subsubheading Emacs Lisp evaluation of variables
13569
13570 Emacs lisp code can be used to initialize variable values. When a variable
13571 value starts with @code{(}, @code{[}, @code{'} or @code{`} it will be
13572 evaluated as Emacs Lisp and the result of the evaluation will be assigned as
13573 the variable value. The following example demonstrates use of this
13574 evaluation to reliably pass the file-name of the Org mode buffer to a code
13575 block---note that evaluation of header arguments is guaranteed to take place
13576 in the original Org mode file, while there is no such guarantee for
13577 evaluation of the code block body.
13578
13579 @example
13580 #+BEGIN_SRC sh :var filename=(buffer-file-name) :exports both
13581 wc -w $filename
13582 #+END_SRC
13583 @end example
13584
13585 Note that values read from tables and lists will not be evaluated as
13586 Emacs Lisp, as shown in the following example.
13587
13588 @example
13589 #+NAME: table
13590 | (a b c) |
13591
13592 #+HEADERS: :var data=table[0,0]
13593 #+BEGIN_SRC perl
13594 $data
13595 #+END_SRC
13596
13597 #+RESULTS:
13598 : (a b c)
13599 @end example
13600
13601 @node results, file, var, Specific header arguments
13602 @subsubsection @code{:results}
13603
13604 There are three classes of @code{:results} header argument. Only one option
13605 per class may be supplied per code block.
13606
13607 @itemize @bullet
13608 @item
13609 @b{collection} header arguments specify how the results should be collected
13610 from the code block
13611 @item
13612 @b{type} header arguments specify what type of result the code block will
13613 return---which has implications for how they will be inserted into the
13614 Org mode buffer
13615 @item
13616 @b{handling} header arguments specify how the results of evaluating the code
13617 block should be handled.
13618 @end itemize
13619
13620 @subsubheading Collection
13621 The following options are mutually exclusive, and specify how the results
13622 should be collected from the code block.
13623
13624 @itemize @bullet
13625 @item @code{value}
13626 This is the default. The result is the value of the last statement in the
13627 code block. This header argument places the evaluation in functional
13628 mode. Note that in some languages, e.g., Python, use of this result type
13629 requires that a @code{return} statement be included in the body of the source
13630 code block. E.g., @code{:results value}.
13631 @item @code{output}
13632 The result is the collection of everything printed to STDOUT during the
13633 execution of the code block. This header argument places the
13634 evaluation in scripting mode. E.g., @code{:results output}.
13635 @end itemize
13636
13637 @subsubheading Type
13638
13639 The following options are mutually exclusive and specify what type of results
13640 the code block will return. By default, results are inserted as either a
13641 table or scalar depending on their value.
13642
13643 @itemize @bullet
13644 @item @code{table}, @code{vector}
13645 The results should be interpreted as an Org mode table. If a single value is
13646 returned, it will be converted into a table with one row and one column.
13647 E.g., @code{:results value table}.
13648 @item @code{list}
13649 The results should be interpreted as an Org mode list. If a single scalar
13650 value is returned it will be converted into a list with only one element.
13651 @item @code{scalar}, @code{verbatim}
13652 The results should be interpreted literally---they will not be
13653 converted into a table. The results will be inserted into the Org mode
13654 buffer as quoted text. E.g., @code{:results value verbatim}.
13655 @item @code{file}
13656 The results will be interpreted as the path to a file, and will be inserted
13657 into the Org mode buffer as a file link. E.g., @code{:results value file}.
13658 @item @code{raw}
13659 The results are interpreted as raw Org mode code and are inserted directly
13660 into the buffer. If the results look like a table they will be aligned as
13661 such by Org mode. E.g., @code{:results value raw}.
13662 @item @code{org}
13663 The results are will be enclosed in a @code{BEGIN_SRC org} block.
13664 They are not comma-escaped by default but they will be if you hit @kbd{TAB}
13665 in the block and/or if you export the file. E.g., @code{:results value org}.
13666 @item @code{html}
13667 Results are assumed to be HTML and will be enclosed in a @code{BEGIN_HTML}
13668 block. E.g., @code{:results value html}.
13669 @item @code{latex}
13670 Results assumed to be @LaTeX{} and are enclosed in a @code{BEGIN_LaTeX} block.
13671 E.g., @code{:results value latex}.
13672 @item @code{code}
13673 Result are assumed to be parsable code and are enclosed in a code block.
13674 E.g., @code{:results value code}.
13675 @item @code{pp}
13676 The result is converted to pretty-printed code and is enclosed in a code
13677 block. This option currently supports Emacs Lisp, Python, and Ruby. E.g.,
13678 @code{:results value pp}.
13679 @item @code{drawer}
13680 The result is wrapped in a RESULTS drawer. This can be useful for
13681 inserting @code{raw} or @code{org} syntax results in such a way that their
13682 extent is known and they can be automatically removed or replaced.
13683 @end itemize
13684
13685 @subsubheading Handling
13686 The following results options indicate what happens with the
13687 results once they are collected.
13688
13689 @itemize @bullet
13690 @item @code{silent}
13691 The results will be echoed in the minibuffer but will not be inserted into
13692 the Org mode buffer. E.g., @code{:results output silent}.
13693 @item @code{replace}
13694 The default value. Any existing results will be removed, and the new results
13695 will be inserted into the Org mode buffer in their place. E.g.,
13696 @code{:results output replace}.
13697 @item @code{append}
13698 If there are pre-existing results of the code block then the new results will
13699 be appended to the existing results. Otherwise the new results will be
13700 inserted as with @code{replace}.
13701 @item @code{prepend}
13702 If there are pre-existing results of the code block then the new results will
13703 be prepended to the existing results. Otherwise the new results will be
13704 inserted as with @code{replace}.
13705 @end itemize
13706
13707 @node file, file-desc, results, Specific header arguments
13708 @subsubsection @code{:file}
13709
13710 The header argument @code{:file} is used to specify an external file in which
13711 to save code block results. After code block evaluation an Org mode style
13712 @code{[[file:]]} link (see @ref{Link format}) to the file will be inserted
13713 into the Org mode buffer. Some languages including R, gnuplot, dot, and
13714 ditaa provide special handling of the @code{:file} header argument
13715 automatically wrapping the code block body in the boilerplate code required
13716 to save output to the specified file. This is often useful for saving
13717 graphical output of a code block to the specified file.
13718
13719 The argument to @code{:file} should be either a string specifying the path to
13720 a file, or a list of two strings in which case the first element of the list
13721 should be the path to a file and the second a description for the link.
13722
13723 @node file-desc, dir, file, Specific header arguments
13724 @subsubsection @code{:file-desc}
13725
13726 The value of the @code{:file-desc} header argument is used to provide a
13727 description for file code block results which are inserted as Org mode links
13728 (see @ref{Link format}). If the @code{:file-desc} header argument is given
13729 with no value the link path will be placed in both the ``link'' and the
13730 ``description'' portion of the Org mode link.
13731
13732 @node dir, exports, file-desc, Specific header arguments
13733 @subsubsection @code{:dir} and remote execution
13734
13735 While the @code{:file} header argument can be used to specify the path to the
13736 output file, @code{:dir} specifies the default directory during code block
13737 execution. If it is absent, then the directory associated with the current
13738 buffer is used. In other words, supplying @code{:dir path} temporarily has
13739 the same effect as changing the current directory with @kbd{M-x cd path}, and
13740 then not supplying @code{:dir}. Under the surface, @code{:dir} simply sets
13741 the value of the Emacs variable @code{default-directory}.
13742
13743 When using @code{:dir}, you should supply a relative path for file output
13744 (e.g., @code{:file myfile.jpg} or @code{:file results/myfile.jpg}) in which
13745 case that path will be interpreted relative to the default directory.
13746
13747 In other words, if you want your plot to go into a folder called @file{Work}
13748 in your home directory, you could use
13749
13750 @example
13751 #+BEGIN_SRC R :file myplot.png :dir ~/Work
13752 matplot(matrix(rnorm(100), 10), type="l")
13753 #+END_SRC
13754 @end example
13755
13756 @subsubheading Remote execution
13757 A directory on a remote machine can be specified using tramp file syntax, in
13758 which case the code will be evaluated on the remote machine. An example is
13759
13760 @example
13761 #+BEGIN_SRC R :file plot.png :dir /dand@@yakuba.princeton.edu:
13762 plot(1:10, main=system("hostname", intern=TRUE))
13763 #+END_SRC
13764 @end example
13765
13766 Text results will be returned to the local Org mode buffer as usual, and file
13767 output will be created on the remote machine with relative paths interpreted
13768 relative to the remote directory. An Org mode link to the remote file will be
13769 created.
13770
13771 So, in the above example a plot will be created on the remote machine,
13772 and a link of the following form will be inserted in the org buffer:
13773
13774 @example
13775 [[file:/scp:dand@@yakuba.princeton.edu:/home/dand/plot.png][plot.png]]
13776 @end example
13777
13778 Most of this functionality follows immediately from the fact that @code{:dir}
13779 sets the value of the Emacs variable @code{default-directory}, thanks to
13780 tramp. Those using XEmacs, or GNU Emacs prior to version 23 may need to
13781 install tramp separately in order for these features to work correctly.
13782
13783 @subsubheading Further points
13784
13785 @itemize @bullet
13786 @item
13787 If @code{:dir} is used in conjunction with @code{:session}, although it will
13788 determine the starting directory for a new session as expected, no attempt is
13789 currently made to alter the directory associated with an existing session.
13790 @item
13791 @code{:dir} should typically not be used to create files during export with
13792 @code{:exports results} or @code{:exports both}. The reason is that, in order
13793 to retain portability of exported material between machines, during export
13794 links inserted into the buffer will @emph{not} be expanded against @code{default
13795 directory}. Therefore, if @code{default-directory} is altered using
13796 @code{:dir}, it is probable that the file will be created in a location to
13797 which the link does not point.
13798 @end itemize
13799
13800 @node exports, tangle, dir, Specific header arguments
13801 @subsubsection @code{:exports}
13802
13803 The @code{:exports} header argument specifies what should be included in HTML
13804 or @LaTeX{} exports of the Org mode file.
13805
13806 @itemize @bullet
13807 @item @code{code}
13808 The default. The body of code is included into the exported file. E.g.,
13809 @code{:exports code}.
13810 @item @code{results}
13811 The result of evaluating the code is included in the exported file. E.g.,
13812 @code{:exports results}.
13813 @item @code{both}
13814 Both the code and results are included in the exported file. E.g.,
13815 @code{:exports both}.
13816 @item @code{none}
13817 Nothing is included in the exported file. E.g., @code{:exports none}.
13818 @end itemize
13819
13820 @node tangle, mkdirp, exports, Specific header arguments
13821 @subsubsection @code{:tangle}
13822
13823 The @code{:tangle} header argument specifies whether or not the code
13824 block should be included in tangled extraction of source code files.
13825
13826 @itemize @bullet
13827 @item @code{tangle}
13828 The code block is exported to a source code file named after the full path
13829 (including the directory) and file name (w/o extension) of the Org mode file.
13830 E.g., @code{:tangle yes}.
13831 @item @code{no}
13832 The default. The code block is not exported to a source code file.
13833 E.g., @code{:tangle no}.
13834 @item other
13835 Any other string passed to the @code{:tangle} header argument is interpreted
13836 as a path (directory and file name relative to the directory of the Org mode
13837 file) to which the block will be exported. E.g., @code{:tangle path}.
13838 @end itemize
13839
13840 @node mkdirp, comments, tangle, Specific header arguments
13841 @subsubsection @code{:mkdirp}
13842
13843 The @code{:mkdirp} header argument can be used to create parent directories
13844 of tangled files when missing. This can be set to @code{yes} to enable
13845 directory creation or to @code{no} to inhibit directory creation.
13846
13847 @node comments, padline, mkdirp, Specific header arguments
13848 @subsubsection @code{:comments}
13849 By default code blocks are tangled to source-code files without any insertion
13850 of comments beyond those which may already exist in the body of the code
13851 block. The @code{:comments} header argument can be set as follows to control
13852 the insertion of extra comments into the tangled code file.
13853
13854 @itemize @bullet
13855 @item @code{no}
13856 The default. No extra comments are inserted during tangling.
13857 @item @code{link}
13858 The code block is wrapped in comments which contain pointers back to the
13859 original Org file from which the code was tangled.
13860 @item @code{yes}
13861 A synonym for ``link'' to maintain backwards compatibility.
13862 @item @code{org}
13863 Include text from the Org mode file as a comment.
13864
13865 The text is picked from the leading context of the tangled code and is
13866 limited by the nearest headline or source block as the case may be.
13867 @item @code{both}
13868 Turns on both the ``link'' and ``org'' comment options.
13869 @item @code{noweb}
13870 Turns on the ``link'' comment option, and additionally wraps expanded noweb
13871 references in the code block body in link comments.
13872 @end itemize
13873
13874 @node padline, no-expand, comments, Specific header arguments
13875 @subsubsection @code{:padline}
13876 Control in insertion of padding lines around code block bodies in tangled
13877 code files. The default value is @code{yes} which results in insertion of
13878 newlines before and after each tangled code block. The following arguments
13879 are accepted.
13880
13881 @itemize @bullet
13882 @item @code{yes}
13883 Insert newlines before and after each code block body in tangled code files.
13884 @item @code{no}
13885 Do not insert any newline padding in tangled output.
13886 @end itemize
13887
13888 @node no-expand, session, padline, Specific header arguments
13889 @subsubsection @code{:no-expand}
13890
13891 By default, code blocks are expanded with @code{org-babel-expand-src-block}
13892 during tangling. This has the effect of assigning values to variables
13893 specified with @code{:var} (see @ref{var}), and of replacing ``noweb''
13894 references (see @ref{Noweb reference syntax}) with their targets. The
13895 @code{:no-expand} header argument can be used to turn off this behavior.
13896
13897 @node session, noweb, no-expand, Specific header arguments
13898 @subsubsection @code{:session}
13899
13900 The @code{:session} header argument starts a session for an interpreted
13901 language where state is preserved.
13902
13903 By default, a session is not started.
13904
13905 A string passed to the @code{:session} header argument will give the session
13906 a name. This makes it possible to run concurrent sessions for each
13907 interpreted language.
13908
13909 @node noweb, noweb-ref, session, Specific header arguments
13910 @subsubsection @code{:noweb}
13911
13912 The @code{:noweb} header argument controls expansion of ``noweb'' syntax
13913 references (see @ref{Noweb reference syntax}) when the code block is
13914 evaluated, tangled, or exported. The @code{:noweb} header argument can have
13915 one of the five values: @code{no}, @code{yes}, @code{tangle}, or
13916 @code{no-export} @code{strip-export}.
13917
13918 @itemize @bullet
13919 @item @code{no}
13920 The default. ``Noweb'' syntax references in the body of the code block will
13921 not be expanded before the code block is evaluated, tangled or exported.
13922 @item @code{yes}
13923 ``Noweb'' syntax references in the body of the code block will be
13924 expanded before the code block is evaluated, tangled or exported.
13925 @item @code{tangle}
13926 ``Noweb'' syntax references in the body of the code block will be expanded
13927 before the code block is tangled. However, ``noweb'' syntax references will
13928 not be expanded when the code block is evaluated or exported.
13929 @item @code{no-export}
13930 ``Noweb'' syntax references in the body of the code block will be expanded
13931 before the block is evaluated or tangled. However, ``noweb'' syntax
13932 references will not be expanded when the code block is exported.
13933 @item @code{strip-export}
13934 ``Noweb'' syntax references in the body of the code block will be expanded
13935 before the block is evaluated or tangled. However, ``noweb'' syntax
13936 references will not be removed when the code block is exported.
13937 @item @code{eval}
13938 ``Noweb'' syntax references in the body of the code block will only be
13939 expanded before the block is evaluated.
13940 @end itemize
13941
13942 @subsubheading Noweb prefix lines
13943 Noweb insertions are now placed behind the line prefix of the
13944 @code{<<reference>>}.
13945 This behavior is illustrated in the following example. Because the
13946 @code{<<example>>} noweb reference appears behind the SQL comment syntax,
13947 each line of the expanded noweb reference will be commented.
13948
13949 This code block:
13950
13951 @example
13952 -- <<example>>
13953 @end example
13954
13955 expands to:
13956
13957 @example
13958 -- this is the
13959 -- multi-line body of example
13960 @end example
13961
13962 Note that noweb replacement text that does not contain any newlines will not
13963 be affected by this change, so it is still possible to use inline noweb
13964 references.
13965
13966 @node noweb-ref, noweb-sep, noweb, Specific header arguments
13967 @subsubsection @code{:noweb-ref}
13968 When expanding ``noweb'' style references the bodies of all code block with
13969 @emph{either} a block name matching the reference name @emph{or} a
13970 @code{:noweb-ref} header argument matching the reference name will be
13971 concatenated together to form the replacement text.
13972
13973 By setting this header argument at the sub-tree or file level, simple code
13974 block concatenation may be achieved. For example, when tangling the
13975 following Org mode file, the bodies of code blocks will be concatenated into
13976 the resulting pure code file@footnote{(The example needs property inheritance
13977 to be turned on for the @code{noweb-ref} property, see @ref{Property
13978 inheritance}).}.
13979
13980 @example
13981 #+BEGIN_SRC sh :tangle yes :noweb yes :shebang #!/bin/sh
13982 <<fullest-disk>>
13983 #+END_SRC
13984 * the mount point of the fullest disk
13985 :PROPERTIES:
13986 :noweb-ref: fullest-disk
13987 :END:
13988
13989 ** query all mounted disks
13990 #+BEGIN_SRC sh
13991 df \
13992 #+END_SRC
13993
13994 ** strip the header row
13995 #+BEGIN_SRC sh
13996 |sed '1d' \
13997 #+END_SRC
13998
13999 ** sort by the percent full
14000 #+BEGIN_SRC sh
14001 |awk '@{print $5 " " $6@}'|sort -n |tail -1 \
14002 #+END_SRC
14003
14004 ** extract the mount point
14005 #+BEGIN_SRC sh
14006 |awk '@{print $2@}'
14007 #+END_SRC
14008 @end example
14009
14010 The @code{:noweb-sep} (see @ref{noweb-sep}) header argument holds the string
14011 used to separate accumulate noweb references like those above. By default a
14012 newline is used.
14013
14014 @node noweb-sep, cache, noweb-ref, Specific header arguments
14015 @subsubsection @code{:noweb-sep}
14016
14017 The @code{:noweb-sep} header argument holds the string used to separate
14018 accumulate noweb references (see @ref{noweb-ref}). By default a newline is
14019 used.
14020
14021 @node cache, sep, noweb-sep, Specific header arguments
14022 @subsubsection @code{:cache}
14023
14024 The @code{:cache} header argument controls the use of in-buffer caching of
14025 the results of evaluating code blocks. It can be used to avoid re-evaluating
14026 unchanged code blocks. Note that the @code{:cache} header argument will not
14027 attempt to cache results when the @code{:session} header argument is used,
14028 because the results of the code block execution may be stored in the session
14029 outside of the Org mode buffer. The @code{:cache} header argument can have
14030 one of two values: @code{yes} or @code{no}.
14031
14032 @itemize @bullet
14033 @item @code{no}
14034 The default. No caching takes place, and the code block will be evaluated
14035 every time it is called.
14036 @item @code{yes}
14037 Every time the code block is run a SHA1 hash of the code and arguments
14038 passed to the block will be generated. This hash is packed into the
14039 @code{#+RESULTS:} line and will be checked on subsequent
14040 executions of the code block. If the code block has not
14041 changed since the last time it was evaluated, it will not be re-evaluated.
14042 @end itemize
14043
14044 Code block caches notice if the value of a variable argument
14045 to the code block has changed. If this is the case, the cache is
14046 invalidated and the code block is re-run. In the following example,
14047 @code{caller} will not be re-run unless the results of @code{random} have
14048 changed since it was last run.
14049
14050 @example
14051 #+NAME: random
14052 #+BEGIN_SRC R :cache yes
14053 runif(1)
14054 #+END_SRC
14055
14056 #+RESULTS[a2a72cd647ad44515fab62e144796432793d68e1]: random
14057 0.4659510825295
14058
14059 #+NAME: caller
14060 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var x=random :cache yes
14061 x
14062 #+END_SRC
14063
14064 #+RESULTS[bec9c8724e397d5df3b696502df3ed7892fc4f5f]: caller
14065 0.254227238707244
14066 @end example
14067
14068 @node sep, hlines, cache, Specific header arguments
14069 @subsubsection @code{:sep}
14070
14071 The @code{:sep} header argument can be used to control the delimiter used
14072 when writing tabular results out to files external to Org mode. This is used
14073 either when opening tabular results of a code block by calling the
14074 @code{org-open-at-point} function bound to @kbd{C-c C-o} on the code block,
14075 or when writing code block results to an external file (see @ref{file})
14076 header argument.
14077
14078 By default, when @code{:sep} is not specified output tables are tab
14079 delimited.
14080
14081 @node hlines, colnames, sep, Specific header arguments
14082 @subsubsection @code{:hlines}
14083
14084 Tables are frequently represented with one or more horizontal lines, or
14085 hlines. The @code{:hlines} argument to a code block accepts the
14086 values @code{yes} or @code{no}, with a default value of @code{no}.
14087
14088 @itemize @bullet
14089 @item @code{no}
14090 Strips horizontal lines from the input table. In most languages this is the
14091 desired effect because an @code{hline} symbol is interpreted as an unbound
14092 variable and raises an error. Setting @code{:hlines no} or relying on the
14093 default value yields the following results.
14094
14095 @example
14096 #+TBLNAME: many-cols
14097 | a | b | c |
14098 |---+---+---|
14099 | d | e | f |
14100 |---+---+---|
14101 | g | h | i |
14102
14103 #+NAME: echo-table
14104 #+BEGIN_SRC python :var tab=many-cols
14105 return tab
14106 #+END_SRC
14107
14108 #+RESULTS: echo-table
14109 | a | b | c |
14110 | d | e | f |
14111 | g | h | i |
14112 @end example
14113
14114 @item @code{yes}
14115 Leaves hlines in the table. Setting @code{:hlines yes} has this effect.
14116
14117 @example
14118 #+TBLNAME: many-cols
14119 | a | b | c |
14120 |---+---+---|
14121 | d | e | f |
14122 |---+---+---|
14123 | g | h | i |
14124
14125 #+NAME: echo-table
14126 #+BEGIN_SRC python :var tab=many-cols :hlines yes
14127 return tab
14128 #+END_SRC
14129
14130 #+RESULTS: echo-table
14131 | a | b | c |
14132 |---+---+---|
14133 | d | e | f |
14134 |---+---+---|
14135 | g | h | i |
14136 @end example
14137 @end itemize
14138
14139 @node colnames, rownames, hlines, Specific header arguments
14140 @subsubsection @code{:colnames}
14141
14142 The @code{:colnames} header argument accepts the values @code{yes},
14143 @code{no}, or @code{nil} for unassigned. The default value is @code{nil}.
14144 Note that the behavior of the @code{:colnames} header argument may differ
14145 across languages. For example Emacs Lisp code blocks ignore the
14146 @code{:colnames} header argument entirely given the ease with which tables
14147 with column names may be handled directly in Emacs Lisp.
14148
14149 @itemize @bullet
14150 @item @code{nil}
14151 If an input table looks like it has column names
14152 (because its second row is an hline), then the column
14153 names will be removed from the table before
14154 processing, then reapplied to the results.
14155
14156 @example
14157 #+TBLNAME: less-cols
14158 | a |
14159 |---|
14160 | b |
14161 | c |
14162
14163 #+NAME: echo-table-again
14164 #+BEGIN_SRC python :var tab=less-cols
14165 return [[val + '*' for val in row] for row in tab]
14166 #+END_SRC
14167
14168 #+RESULTS: echo-table-again
14169 | a |
14170 |----|
14171 | b* |
14172 | c* |
14173 @end example
14174
14175 Please note that column names are not removed before the table is indexed
14176 using variable indexing @xref{var, Indexable variable values}.
14177
14178 @item @code{no}
14179 No column name pre-processing takes place
14180
14181 @item @code{yes}
14182 Column names are removed and reapplied as with @code{nil} even if the table
14183 does not ``look like'' it has column names (i.e., the second row is not an
14184 hline)
14185 @end itemize
14186
14187 @node rownames, shebang, colnames, Specific header arguments
14188 @subsubsection @code{:rownames}
14189
14190 The @code{:rownames} header argument can take on the values @code{yes}
14191 or @code{no}, with a default value of @code{no}.
14192
14193 @itemize @bullet
14194 @item @code{no}
14195 No row name pre-processing will take place.
14196
14197 @item @code{yes}
14198 The first column of the table is removed from the table before processing,
14199 and is then reapplied to the results.
14200
14201 @example
14202 #+TBLNAME: with-rownames
14203 | one | 1 | 2 | 3 | 4 | 5 |
14204 | two | 6 | 7 | 8 | 9 | 10 |
14205
14206 #+NAME: echo-table-once-again
14207 #+BEGIN_SRC python :var tab=with-rownames :rownames yes
14208 return [[val + 10 for val in row] for row in tab]
14209 #+END_SRC
14210
14211 #+RESULTS: echo-table-once-again
14212 | one | 11 | 12 | 13 | 14 | 15 |
14213 | two | 16 | 17 | 18 | 19 | 20 |
14214 @end example
14215
14216 Please note that row names are not removed before the table is indexed using
14217 variable indexing @xref{var, Indexable variable values}.
14218
14219 @end itemize
14220
14221 @node shebang, eval, rownames, Specific header arguments
14222 @subsubsection @code{:shebang}
14223
14224 Setting the @code{:shebang} header argument to a string value
14225 (e.g., @code{:shebang "#!/bin/bash"}) causes the string to be inserted as the
14226 first line of any tangled file holding the code block, and the file
14227 permissions of the tangled file are set to make it executable.
14228
14229 @node eval, wrap, shebang, Specific header arguments
14230 @subsubsection @code{:eval}
14231 The @code{:eval} header argument can be used to limit the evaluation of
14232 specific code blocks. The @code{:eval} header argument can be useful for
14233 protecting against the evaluation of dangerous code blocks or to ensure that
14234 evaluation will require a query regardless of the value of the
14235 @code{org-confirm-babel-evaluate} variable. The possible values of
14236 @code{:eval} and their effects are shown below.
14237
14238 @table @code
14239 @item never or no
14240 The code block will not be evaluated under any circumstances.
14241 @item query
14242 Evaluation of the code block will require a query.
14243 @item never-export or no-export
14244 The code block will not be evaluated during export but may still be called
14245 interactively.
14246 @item query-export
14247 Evaluation of the code block during export will require a query.
14248 @end table
14249
14250 If this header argument is not set then evaluation is determined by the value
14251 of the @code{org-confirm-babel-evaluate} variable see @ref{Code evaluation
14252 security}.
14253
14254 @node wrap, , eval, Specific header arguments
14255 @subsubsection @code{:wrap}
14256 The @code{:wrap} header argument is used to mark the results of source block
14257 evaluation. The header argument can be passed a string that will be appended
14258 to @code{#+BEGIN_} and @code{#+END_}, which will then be used to wrap the
14259 results. If not string is specified then the results will be wrapped in a
14260 @code{#+BEGIN/END_RESULTS} block.
14261
14262 @node Results of evaluation, Noweb reference syntax, Header arguments, Working With Source Code
14263 @section Results of evaluation
14264 @cindex code block, results of evaluation
14265 @cindex source code, results of evaluation
14266
14267 The way in which results are handled depends on whether a session is invoked,
14268 as well as on whether @code{:results value} or @code{:results output} is
14269 used. The following table shows the table possibilities. For a full listing
14270 of the possible results header arguments see @ref{results}.
14271
14272 @multitable @columnfractions 0.26 0.33 0.41
14273 @item @tab @b{Non-session} @tab @b{Session}
14274 @item @code{:results value} @tab value of last expression @tab value of last expression
14275 @item @code{:results output} @tab contents of STDOUT @tab concatenation of interpreter output
14276 @end multitable
14277
14278 Note: With @code{:results value}, the result in both @code{:session} and
14279 non-session is returned to Org mode as a table (a one- or two-dimensional
14280 vector of strings or numbers) when appropriate.
14281
14282 @subsection Non-session
14283 @subsubsection @code{:results value}
14284 This is the default. Internally, the value is obtained by wrapping the code
14285 in a function definition in the external language, and evaluating that
14286 function. Therefore, code should be written as if it were the body of such a
14287 function. In particular, note that Python does not automatically return a
14288 value from a function unless a @code{return} statement is present, and so a
14289 @samp{return} statement will usually be required in Python.
14290
14291 This is the only one of the four evaluation contexts in which the code is
14292 automatically wrapped in a function definition.
14293
14294 @subsubsection @code{:results output}
14295 The code is passed to the interpreter as an external process, and the
14296 contents of the standard output stream are returned as text. (In certain
14297 languages this also contains the error output stream; this is an area for
14298 future work.)
14299
14300 @subsection Session
14301 @subsubsection @code{:results value}
14302 The code is passed to an interpreter running as an interactive Emacs inferior
14303 process. Only languages which provide tools for interactive evaluation of
14304 code have session support, so some language (e.g., C and ditaa) do not
14305 support the @code{:session} header argument, and in other languages (e.g.,
14306 Python and Haskell) which have limitations on the code which may be entered
14307 into interactive sessions, those limitations apply to the code in code blocks
14308 using the @code{:session} header argument as well.
14309
14310 Unless the @code{:results output} option is supplied (see below) the result
14311 returned is the result of the last evaluation performed by the
14312 interpreter. (This is obtained in a language-specific manner: the value of
14313 the variable @code{_} in Python and Ruby, and the value of @code{.Last.value}
14314 in R).
14315
14316 @subsubsection @code{:results output}
14317 The code is passed to the interpreter running as an interactive Emacs
14318 inferior process. The result returned is the concatenation of the sequence of
14319 (text) output from the interactive interpreter. Notice that this is not
14320 necessarily the same as what would be sent to @code{STDOUT} if the same code
14321 were passed to a non-interactive interpreter running as an external
14322 process. For example, compare the following two blocks:
14323
14324 @example
14325 #+BEGIN_SRC python :results output
14326 print "hello"
14327 2
14328 print "bye"
14329 #+END_SRC
14330
14331 #+RESULTS:
14332 : hello
14333 : bye
14334 @end example
14335
14336 In non-session mode, the `2' is not printed and does not appear.
14337
14338 @example
14339 #+BEGIN_SRC python :results output :session
14340 print "hello"
14341 2
14342 print "bye"
14343 #+END_SRC
14344
14345 #+RESULTS:
14346 : hello
14347 : 2
14348 : bye
14349 @end example
14350
14351 But in @code{:session} mode, the interactive interpreter receives input `2'
14352 and prints out its value, `2'. (Indeed, the other print statements are
14353 unnecessary here).
14354
14355 @node Noweb reference syntax, Key bindings and useful functions, Results of evaluation, Working With Source Code
14356 @section Noweb reference syntax
14357 @cindex code block, noweb reference
14358 @cindex syntax, noweb
14359 @cindex source code, noweb reference
14360
14361 The ``noweb'' (see @uref{http://www.cs.tufts.edu/~nr/noweb/}) Literate
14362 Programming system allows named blocks of code to be referenced by using the
14363 familiar Noweb syntax:
14364
14365 @example
14366 <<code-block-name>>
14367 @end example
14368
14369 When a code block is tangled or evaluated, whether or not ``noweb''
14370 references are expanded depends upon the value of the @code{:noweb} header
14371 argument. If @code{:noweb yes}, then a Noweb reference is expanded before
14372 evaluation. If @code{:noweb no}, the default, then the reference is not
14373 expanded before evaluation. See the @ref{noweb-ref} header argument for
14374 a more flexible way to resolve noweb references.
14375
14376 It is possible to include the @emph{results} of a code block rather than the
14377 body. This is done by appending parenthesis to the code block name which may
14378 optionally contain arguments to the code block as shown below.
14379
14380 @example
14381 <<code-block-name(optional arguments)>>
14382 @end example
14383
14384 Note: the default value, @code{:noweb no}, was chosen to ensure that
14385 correct code is not broken in a language, such as Ruby, where
14386 @code{<<arg>>} is a syntactically valid construct. If @code{<<arg>>} is not
14387 syntactically valid in languages that you use, then please consider setting
14388 the default value.
14389
14390 Note: if noweb tangling is slow in large Org mode files consider setting the
14391 @code{*org-babel-use-quick-and-dirty-noweb-expansion*} variable to true.
14392 This will result in faster noweb reference resolution at the expense of not
14393 correctly resolving inherited values of the @code{:noweb-ref} header
14394 argument.
14395
14396 @node Key bindings and useful functions, Batch execution, Noweb reference syntax, Working With Source Code
14397 @section Key bindings and useful functions
14398 @cindex code block, key bindings
14399
14400 Many common Org mode key sequences are re-bound depending on
14401 the context.
14402
14403 Within a code block, the following key bindings
14404 are active:
14405
14406 @multitable @columnfractions 0.25 0.75
14407 @kindex C-c C-c
14408 @item @kbd{C-c C-c} @tab @code{org-babel-execute-src-block}
14409 @kindex C-c C-o
14410 @item @kbd{C-c C-o} @tab @code{org-babel-open-src-block-result}
14411 @kindex C-up
14412 @item @kbd{C-@key{up}} @tab @code{org-babel-load-in-session}
14413 @kindex M-down
14414 @item @kbd{M-@key{down}} @tab @code{org-babel-pop-to-session}
14415 @end multitable
14416
14417 In an Org mode buffer, the following key bindings are active:
14418
14419 @multitable @columnfractions 0.45 0.55
14420 @kindex C-c C-v p
14421 @kindex C-c C-v C-p
14422 @item @kbd{C-c C-v p} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-p} @tab @code{org-babel-previous-src-block}
14423 @kindex C-c C-v n
14424 @kindex C-c C-v C-n
14425 @item @kbd{C-c C-v n} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-n} @tab @code{org-babel-next-src-block}
14426 @kindex C-c C-v e
14427 @kindex C-c C-v C-e
14428 @item @kbd{C-c C-v e} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-e} @tab @code{org-babel-execute-maybe}
14429 @kindex C-c C-v o
14430 @kindex C-c C-v C-o
14431 @item @kbd{C-c C-v o} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-o} @tab @code{org-babel-open-src-block-result}
14432 @kindex C-c C-v v
14433 @kindex C-c C-v C-v
14434 @item @kbd{C-c C-v v} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-v} @tab @code{org-babel-expand-src-block}
14435 @kindex C-c C-v u
14436 @kindex C-c C-v C-u
14437 @item @kbd{C-c C-v u} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-u} @tab @code{org-babel-goto-src-block-head}
14438 @kindex C-c C-v g
14439 @kindex C-c C-v C-g
14440 @item @kbd{C-c C-v g} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-g} @tab @code{org-babel-goto-named-src-block}
14441 @kindex C-c C-v r
14442 @kindex C-c C-v C-r
14443 @item @kbd{C-c C-v r} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-r} @tab @code{org-babel-goto-named-result}
14444 @kindex C-c C-v b
14445 @kindex C-c C-v C-b
14446 @item @kbd{C-c C-v b} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-b} @tab @code{org-babel-execute-buffer}
14447 @kindex C-c C-v s
14448 @kindex C-c C-v C-s
14449 @item @kbd{C-c C-v s} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-s} @tab @code{org-babel-execute-subtree}
14450 @kindex C-c C-v d
14451 @kindex C-c C-v C-d
14452 @item @kbd{C-c C-v d} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-d} @tab @code{org-babel-demarcate-block}
14453 @kindex C-c C-v t
14454 @kindex C-c C-v C-t
14455 @item @kbd{C-c C-v t} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-t} @tab @code{org-babel-tangle}
14456 @kindex C-c C-v f
14457 @kindex C-c C-v C-f
14458 @item @kbd{C-c C-v f} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-f} @tab @code{org-babel-tangle-file}
14459 @kindex C-c C-v c
14460 @kindex C-c C-v C-c
14461 @item @kbd{C-c C-v c} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-c} @tab @code{org-babel-check-src-block}
14462 @kindex C-c C-v j
14463 @kindex C-c C-v C-j
14464 @item @kbd{C-c C-v j} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-j} @tab @code{org-babel-insert-header-arg}
14465 @kindex C-c C-v l
14466 @kindex C-c C-v C-l
14467 @item @kbd{C-c C-v l} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-l} @tab @code{org-babel-load-in-session}
14468 @kindex C-c C-v i
14469 @kindex C-c C-v C-i
14470 @item @kbd{C-c C-v i} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-i} @tab @code{org-babel-lob-ingest}
14471 @kindex C-c C-v I
14472 @kindex C-c C-v C-I
14473 @item @kbd{C-c C-v I} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-I} @tab @code{org-babel-view-src-block-info}
14474 @kindex C-c C-v z
14475 @kindex C-c C-v C-z
14476 @item @kbd{C-c C-v z} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-z} @tab @code{org-babel-switch-to-session-with-code}
14477 @kindex C-c C-v a
14478 @kindex C-c C-v C-a
14479 @item @kbd{C-c C-v a} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-a} @tab @code{org-babel-sha1-hash}
14480 @kindex C-c C-v h
14481 @kindex C-c C-v C-h
14482 @item @kbd{C-c C-v h} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-h} @tab @code{org-babel-describe-bindings}
14483 @kindex C-c C-v x
14484 @kindex C-c C-v C-x
14485 @item @kbd{C-c C-v x} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-x} @tab @code{org-babel-do-key-sequence-in-edit-buffer}
14486 @end multitable
14487
14488 @c When possible these keybindings were extended to work when the control key is
14489 @c kept pressed, resulting in the following additional keybindings.
14490
14491 @c @multitable @columnfractions 0.25 0.75
14492 @c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-a} @tab @code{org-babel-sha1-hash}
14493 @c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-b} @tab @code{org-babel-execute-buffer}
14494 @c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-f} @tab @code{org-babel-tangle-file}
14495 @c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-l} @tab @code{org-babel-lob-ingest}
14496 @c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-p} @tab @code{org-babel-expand-src-block}
14497 @c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-s} @tab @code{org-babel-execute-subtree}
14498 @c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-t} @tab @code{org-babel-tangle}
14499 @c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-z} @tab @code{org-babel-switch-to-session}
14500 @c @end multitable
14501
14502 @node Batch execution, , Key bindings and useful functions, Working With Source Code
14503 @section Batch execution
14504 @cindex code block, batch execution
14505 @cindex source code, batch execution
14506
14507 It is possible to call functions from the command line. This shell
14508 script calls @code{org-babel-tangle} on every one of its arguments.
14509
14510 Be sure to adjust the paths to fit your system.
14511
14512 @example
14513 #!/bin/sh
14514 # -*- mode: shell-script -*-
14515 #
14516 # tangle files with org-mode
14517 #
14518 DIR=`pwd`
14519 FILES=""
14520
14521 # wrap each argument in the code required to call tangle on it
14522 for i in $@@; do
14523 FILES="$FILES \"$i\""
14524 done
14525
14526 emacs -Q --batch \
14527 --eval "(progn
14528 (add-to-list 'load-path (expand-file-name \"~/src/org/lisp/\"))
14529 (add-to-list 'load-path (expand-file-name \"~/src/org/contrib/lisp/\" t))
14530 (require 'org)(require 'org-exp)(require 'ob)(require 'ob-tangle)
14531 (mapc (lambda (file)
14532 (find-file (expand-file-name file \"$DIR\"))
14533 (org-babel-tangle)
14534 (kill-buffer)) '($FILES)))" 2>&1 |grep tangled
14535 @end example
14536
14537 @node Miscellaneous, Hacking, Working With Source Code, Top
14538 @chapter Miscellaneous
14539
14540 @menu
14541 * Completion:: M-TAB knows what you need
14542 * Easy Templates:: Quick insertion of structural elements
14543 * Speed keys:: Electric commands at the beginning of a headline
14544 * Code evaluation security:: Org mode files evaluate inline code
14545 * Customization:: Adapting Org to your taste
14546 * In-buffer settings:: Overview of the #+KEYWORDS
14547 * The very busy C-c C-c key:: When in doubt, press C-c C-c
14548 * Clean view:: Getting rid of leading stars in the outline
14549 * TTY keys:: Using Org on a tty
14550 * Interaction:: Other Emacs packages
14551 * org-crypt.el:: Encrypting Org files
14552 @end menu
14553
14554
14555 @node Completion, Easy Templates, Miscellaneous, Miscellaneous
14556 @section Completion
14557 @cindex completion, of @TeX{} symbols
14558 @cindex completion, of TODO keywords
14559 @cindex completion, of dictionary words
14560 @cindex completion, of option keywords
14561 @cindex completion, of tags
14562 @cindex completion, of property keys
14563 @cindex completion, of link abbreviations
14564 @cindex @TeX{} symbol completion
14565 @cindex TODO keywords completion
14566 @cindex dictionary word completion
14567 @cindex option keyword completion
14568 @cindex tag completion
14569 @cindex link abbreviations, completion of
14570
14571 Emacs would not be Emacs without completion, and Org mode uses it whenever it
14572 makes sense. If you prefer an @i{iswitchb}- or @i{ido}-like interface for
14573 some of the completion prompts, you can specify your preference by setting at
14574 most one of the variables @code{org-completion-use-iswitchb}
14575 @code{org-completion-use-ido}.
14576
14577 Org supports in-buffer completion. This type of completion does
14578 not make use of the minibuffer. You simply type a few letters into
14579 the buffer and use the key to complete text right there.
14580
14581 @table @kbd
14582 @kindex M-@key{TAB}
14583 @item M-@key{TAB}
14584 Complete word at point
14585 @itemize @bullet
14586 @item
14587 At the beginning of a headline, complete TODO keywords.
14588 @item
14589 After @samp{\}, complete @TeX{} symbols supported by the exporter.
14590 @item
14591 After @samp{*}, complete headlines in the current buffer so that they
14592 can be used in search links like @samp{[[*find this headline]]}.
14593 @item
14594 After @samp{:} in a headline, complete tags. The list of tags is taken
14595 from the variable @code{org-tag-alist} (possibly set through the
14596 @samp{#+TAGS} in-buffer option, @pxref{Setting tags}), or it is created
14597 dynamically from all tags used in the current buffer.
14598 @item
14599 After @samp{:} and not in a headline, complete property keys. The list
14600 of keys is constructed dynamically from all keys used in the current
14601 buffer.
14602 @item
14603 After @samp{[}, complete link abbreviations (@pxref{Link abbreviations}).
14604 @item
14605 After @samp{#+}, complete the special keywords like @samp{TYP_TODO} or
14606 @samp{OPTIONS} which set file-specific options for Org mode. When the
14607 option keyword is already complete, pressing @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} again
14608 will insert example settings for this keyword.
14609 @item
14610 In the line after @samp{#+STARTUP: }, complete startup keywords,
14611 i.e., valid keys for this line.
14612 @item
14613 Elsewhere, complete dictionary words using Ispell.
14614 @end itemize
14615 @end table
14616
14617 @node Easy Templates, Speed keys, Completion, Miscellaneous
14618 @section Easy Templates
14619 @cindex template insertion
14620 @cindex insertion, of templates
14621
14622 Org mode supports insertion of empty structural elements (like
14623 @code{#+BEGIN_SRC} and @code{#+END_SRC} pairs) with just a few key
14624 strokes. This is achieved through a native template expansion mechanism.
14625 Note that Emacs has several other template mechanisms which could be used in
14626 a similar way, for example @file{yasnippet}.
14627
14628 To insert a structural element, type a @samp{<}, followed by a template
14629 selector and @kbd{@key{TAB}}. Completion takes effect only when the above
14630 keystrokes are typed on a line by itself.
14631
14632 The following template selectors are currently supported.
14633
14634 @multitable @columnfractions 0.1 0.9
14635 @item @kbd{s} @tab @code{#+BEGIN_SRC ... #+END_SRC}
14636 @item @kbd{e} @tab @code{#+BEGIN_EXAMPLE ... #+END_EXAMPLE}
14637 @item @kbd{q} @tab @code{#+BEGIN_QUOTE ... #+END_QUOTE}
14638 @item @kbd{v} @tab @code{#+BEGIN_VERSE ... #+END_VERSE}
14639 @item @kbd{c} @tab @code{#+BEGIN_CENTER ... #+END_CENTER}
14640 @item @kbd{l} @tab @code{#+BEGIN_LaTeX ... #+END_LaTeX}
14641 @item @kbd{L} @tab @code{#+LaTeX:}
14642 @item @kbd{h} @tab @code{#+BEGIN_HTML ... #+END_HTML}
14643 @item @kbd{H} @tab @code{#+HTML:}
14644 @item @kbd{a} @tab @code{#+BEGIN_ASCII ... #+END_ASCII}
14645 @item @kbd{A} @tab @code{#+ASCII:}
14646 @item @kbd{i} @tab @code{#+INDEX:} line
14647 @item @kbd{I} @tab @code{#+INCLUDE:} line
14648 @end multitable
14649
14650 For example, on an empty line, typing "<e" and then pressing TAB, will expand
14651 into a complete EXAMPLE template.
14652
14653 You can install additional templates by customizing the variable
14654 @code{org-structure-template-alist}. See the docstring of the variable for
14655 additional details.
14656
14657 @node Speed keys, Code evaluation security, Easy Templates, Miscellaneous
14658 @section Speed keys
14659 @cindex speed keys
14660 @vindex org-use-speed-commands
14661 @vindex org-speed-commands-user
14662
14663 Single keys can be made to execute commands when the cursor is at the
14664 beginning of a headline, i.e., before the first star. Configure the variable
14665 @code{org-use-speed-commands} to activate this feature. There is a
14666 pre-defined list of commands, and you can add more such commands using the
14667 variable @code{org-speed-commands-user}. Speed keys do not only speed up
14668 navigation and other commands, but they also provide an alternative way to
14669 execute commands bound to keys that are not or not easily available on a TTY,
14670 or on a small mobile device with a limited keyboard.
14671
14672 To see which commands are available, activate the feature and press @kbd{?}
14673 with the cursor at the beginning of a headline.
14674
14675 @node Code evaluation security, Customization, Speed keys, Miscellaneous
14676 @section Code evaluation and security issues
14677
14678 Org provides tools to work with the code snippets, including evaluating them.
14679
14680 Running code on your machine always comes with a security risk. Badly
14681 written or malicious code can be executed on purpose or by accident. Org has
14682 default settings which will only evaluate such code if you give explicit
14683 permission to do so, and as a casual user of these features you should leave
14684 these precautions intact.
14685
14686 For people who regularly work with such code, the confirmation prompts can
14687 become annoying, and you might want to turn them off. This can be done, but
14688 you must be aware of the risks that are involved.
14689
14690 Code evaluation can happen under the following circumstances:
14691
14692 @table @i
14693 @item Source code blocks
14694 Source code blocks can be evaluated during export, or when pressing @kbd{C-c
14695 C-c} in the block. The most important thing to realize here is that Org mode
14696 files which contain code snippets are, in a certain sense, like executable
14697 files. So you should accept them and load them into Emacs only from trusted
14698 sources---just like you would do with a program you install on your computer.
14699
14700 Make sure you know what you are doing before customizing the variables
14701 which take off the default security brakes.
14702
14703 @defopt org-confirm-babel-evaluate
14704 When t (the default), the user is asked before every code block evaluation.
14705 When nil, the user is not asked. When set to a function, it is called with
14706 two arguments (language and body of the code block) and should return t to
14707 ask and nil not to ask.
14708 @end defopt
14709
14710 For example, here is how to execute "ditaa" code (which is considered safe)
14711 without asking:
14712
14713 @example
14714 (defun my-org-confirm-babel-evaluate (lang body)
14715 (not (string= lang "ditaa"))) ; don't ask for ditaa
14716 (setq org-confirm-babel-evaluate 'my-org-confirm-babel-evaluate)
14717 @end example
14718
14719 @item Following @code{shell} and @code{elisp} links
14720 Org has two link types that can directly evaluate code (@pxref{External
14721 links}). These links can be problematic because the code to be evaluated is
14722 not visible.
14723
14724 @defopt org-confirm-shell-link-function
14725 Function to queries user about shell link execution.
14726 @end defopt
14727 @defopt org-confirm-elisp-link-function
14728 Functions to query user for Emacs Lisp link execution.
14729 @end defopt
14730
14731 @item Formulas in tables
14732 Formulas in tables (@pxref{The spreadsheet}) are code that is evaluated
14733 either by the @i{calc} interpreter, or by the @i{Emacs Lisp} interpreter.
14734 @end table
14735
14736 @node Customization, In-buffer settings, Code evaluation security, Miscellaneous
14737 @section Customization
14738 @cindex customization
14739 @cindex options, for customization
14740 @cindex variables, for customization
14741
14742 There are more than 500 variables that can be used to customize
14743 Org. For the sake of compactness of the manual, I am not
14744 describing the variables here. A structured overview of customization
14745 variables is available with @kbd{M-x org-customize}. Or select
14746 @code{Browse Org Group} from the @code{Org->Customization} menu. Many
14747 settings can also be activated on a per-file basis, by putting special
14748 lines into the buffer (@pxref{In-buffer settings}).
14749
14750 @node In-buffer settings, The very busy C-c C-c key, Customization, Miscellaneous
14751 @section Summary of in-buffer settings
14752 @cindex in-buffer settings
14753 @cindex special keywords
14754
14755 Org mode uses special lines in the buffer to define settings on a
14756 per-file basis. These lines start with a @samp{#+} followed by a
14757 keyword, a colon, and then individual words defining a setting. Several
14758 setting words can be in the same line, but you can also have multiple
14759 lines for the keyword. While these settings are described throughout
14760 the manual, here is a summary. After changing any of those lines in the
14761 buffer, press @kbd{C-c C-c} with the cursor still in the line to
14762 activate the changes immediately. Otherwise they become effective only
14763 when the file is visited again in a new Emacs session.
14764
14765 @vindex org-archive-location
14766 @table @kbd
14767 @item #+ARCHIVE: %s_done::
14768 This line sets the archive location for the agenda file. It applies for
14769 all subsequent lines until the next @samp{#+ARCHIVE} line, or the end
14770 of the file. The first such line also applies to any entries before it.
14771 The corresponding variable is @code{org-archive-location}.
14772 @item #+CATEGORY:
14773 This line sets the category for the agenda file. The category applies
14774 for all subsequent lines until the next @samp{#+CATEGORY} line, or the
14775 end of the file. The first such line also applies to any entries before it.
14776 @item #+COLUMNS: %25ITEM .....
14777 @cindex property, COLUMNS
14778 Set the default format for columns view. This format applies when
14779 columns view is invoked in locations where no @code{COLUMNS} property
14780 applies.
14781 @item #+CONSTANTS: name1=value1 ...
14782 @vindex org-table-formula-constants
14783 @vindex org-table-formula
14784 Set file-local values for constants to be used in table formulas. This
14785 line sets the local variable @code{org-table-formula-constants-local}.
14786 The global version of this variable is
14787 @code{org-table-formula-constants}.
14788 @item #+FILETAGS: :tag1:tag2:tag3:
14789 Set tags that can be inherited by any entry in the file, including the
14790 top-level entries.
14791 @item #+DRAWERS: NAME1 .....
14792 @vindex org-drawers
14793 Set the file-local set of additional drawers. The corresponding global
14794 variable is @code{org-drawers}.
14795 @item #+LINK: linkword replace
14796 @vindex org-link-abbrev-alist
14797 These lines (several are allowed) specify link abbreviations.
14798 @xref{Link abbreviations}. The corresponding variable is
14799 @code{org-link-abbrev-alist}.
14800 @item #+PRIORITIES: highest lowest default
14801 @vindex org-highest-priority
14802 @vindex org-lowest-priority
14803 @vindex org-default-priority
14804 This line sets the limits and the default for the priorities. All three
14805 must be either letters A-Z or numbers 0-9. The highest priority must
14806 have a lower ASCII number than the lowest priority.
14807 @item #+PROPERTY: Property_Name Value
14808 This line sets a default inheritance value for entries in the current
14809 buffer, most useful for specifying the allowed values of a property.
14810 @cindex #+SETUPFILE
14811 @item #+SETUPFILE: file
14812 This line defines a file that holds more in-buffer setup. Normally this is
14813 entirely ignored. Only when the buffer is parsed for option-setting lines
14814 (i.e., when starting Org mode for a file, when pressing @kbd{C-c C-c} in a
14815 settings line, or when exporting), then the contents of this file are parsed
14816 as if they had been included in the buffer. In particular, the file can be
14817 any other Org mode file with internal setup. You can visit the file the
14818 cursor is in the line with @kbd{C-c '}.
14819 @item #+STARTUP:
14820 @cindex #+STARTUP:
14821 This line sets options to be used at startup of Org mode, when an
14822 Org file is being visited.
14823
14824 The first set of options deals with the initial visibility of the outline
14825 tree. The corresponding variable for global default settings is
14826 @code{org-startup-folded}, with a default value @code{t}, which means
14827 @code{overview}.
14828 @vindex org-startup-folded
14829 @cindex @code{overview}, STARTUP keyword
14830 @cindex @code{content}, STARTUP keyword
14831 @cindex @code{showall}, STARTUP keyword
14832 @cindex @code{showeverything}, STARTUP keyword
14833 @example
14834 overview @r{top-level headlines only}
14835 content @r{all headlines}
14836 showall @r{no folding of any entries}
14837 showeverything @r{show even drawer contents}
14838 @end example
14839
14840 @vindex org-startup-indented
14841 @cindex @code{indent}, STARTUP keyword
14842 @cindex @code{noindent}, STARTUP keyword
14843 Dynamic virtual indentation is controlled by the variable
14844 @code{org-startup-indented}@footnote{Emacs 23 and Org mode 6.29 are required}
14845 @example
14846 indent @r{start with @code{org-indent-mode} turned on}
14847 noindent @r{start with @code{org-indent-mode} turned off}
14848 @end example
14849
14850 @vindex org-startup-align-all-tables
14851 Then there are options for aligning tables upon visiting a file. This
14852 is useful in files containing narrowed table columns. The corresponding
14853 variable is @code{org-startup-align-all-tables}, with a default value
14854 @code{nil}.
14855 @cindex @code{align}, STARTUP keyword
14856 @cindex @code{noalign}, STARTUP keyword
14857 @example
14858 align @r{align all tables}
14859 noalign @r{don't align tables on startup}
14860 @end example
14861
14862 @vindex org-startup-with-inline-images
14863 When visiting a file, inline images can be automatically displayed. The
14864 corresponding variable is @code{org-startup-with-inline-images}, with a
14865 default value @code{nil} to avoid delays when visiting a file.
14866 @cindex @code{inlineimages}, STARTUP keyword
14867 @cindex @code{noinlineimages}, STARTUP keyword
14868 @example
14869 inlineimages @r{show inline images}
14870 noinlineimages @r{don't show inline images on startup}
14871 @end example
14872
14873 @vindex org-log-done
14874 @vindex org-log-note-clock-out
14875 @vindex org-log-repeat
14876 Logging the closing and reopening of TODO items and clock intervals can be
14877 configured using these options (see variables @code{org-log-done},
14878 @code{org-log-note-clock-out} and @code{org-log-repeat})
14879 @cindex @code{logdone}, STARTUP keyword
14880 @cindex @code{lognotedone}, STARTUP keyword
14881 @cindex @code{nologdone}, STARTUP keyword
14882 @cindex @code{lognoteclock-out}, STARTUP keyword
14883 @cindex @code{nolognoteclock-out}, STARTUP keyword
14884 @cindex @code{logrepeat}, STARTUP keyword
14885 @cindex @code{lognoterepeat}, STARTUP keyword
14886 @cindex @code{nologrepeat}, STARTUP keyword
14887 @cindex @code{logreschedule}, STARTUP keyword
14888 @cindex @code{lognotereschedule}, STARTUP keyword
14889 @cindex @code{nologreschedule}, STARTUP keyword
14890 @cindex @code{logredeadline}, STARTUP keyword
14891 @cindex @code{lognoteredeadline}, STARTUP keyword
14892 @cindex @code{nologredeadline}, STARTUP keyword
14893 @cindex @code{logrefile}, STARTUP keyword
14894 @cindex @code{lognoterefile}, STARTUP keyword
14895 @cindex @code{nologrefile}, STARTUP keyword
14896 @example
14897 logdone @r{record a timestamp when an item is marked DONE}
14898 lognotedone @r{record timestamp and a note when DONE}
14899 nologdone @r{don't record when items are marked DONE}
14900 logrepeat @r{record a time when reinstating a repeating item}
14901 lognoterepeat @r{record a note when reinstating a repeating item}
14902 nologrepeat @r{do not record when reinstating repeating item}
14903 lognoteclock-out @r{record a note when clocking out}
14904 nolognoteclock-out @r{don't record a note when clocking out}
14905 logreschedule @r{record a timestamp when scheduling time changes}
14906 lognotereschedule @r{record a note when scheduling time changes}
14907 nologreschedule @r{do not record when a scheduling date changes}
14908 logredeadline @r{record a timestamp when deadline changes}
14909 lognoteredeadline @r{record a note when deadline changes}
14910 nologredeadline @r{do not record when a deadline date changes}
14911 logrefile @r{record a timestamp when refiling}
14912 lognoterefile @r{record a note when refiling}
14913 nologrefile @r{do not record when refiling}
14914 @end example
14915 @vindex org-hide-leading-stars
14916 @vindex org-odd-levels-only
14917 Here are the options for hiding leading stars in outline headings, and for
14918 indenting outlines. The corresponding variables are
14919 @code{org-hide-leading-stars} and @code{org-odd-levels-only}, both with a
14920 default setting @code{nil} (meaning @code{showstars} and @code{oddeven}).
14921 @cindex @code{hidestars}, STARTUP keyword
14922 @cindex @code{showstars}, STARTUP keyword
14923 @cindex @code{odd}, STARTUP keyword
14924 @cindex @code{even}, STARTUP keyword
14925 @example
14926 hidestars @r{make all but one of the stars starting a headline invisible.}
14927 showstars @r{show all stars starting a headline}
14928 indent @r{virtual indentation according to outline level}
14929 noindent @r{no virtual indentation according to outline level}
14930 odd @r{allow only odd outline levels (1,3,...)}
14931 oddeven @r{allow all outline levels}
14932 @end example
14933 @vindex org-put-time-stamp-overlays
14934 @vindex org-time-stamp-overlay-formats
14935 To turn on custom format overlays over timestamps (variables
14936 @code{org-put-time-stamp-overlays} and
14937 @code{org-time-stamp-overlay-formats}), use
14938 @cindex @code{customtime}, STARTUP keyword
14939 @example
14940 customtime @r{overlay custom time format}
14941 @end example
14942 @vindex constants-unit-system
14943 The following options influence the table spreadsheet (variable
14944 @code{constants-unit-system}).
14945 @cindex @code{constcgs}, STARTUP keyword
14946 @cindex @code{constSI}, STARTUP keyword
14947 @example
14948 constcgs @r{@file{constants.el} should use the c-g-s unit system}
14949 constSI @r{@file{constants.el} should use the SI unit system}
14950 @end example
14951 @vindex org-footnote-define-inline
14952 @vindex org-footnote-auto-label
14953 @vindex org-footnote-auto-adjust
14954 To influence footnote settings, use the following keywords. The
14955 corresponding variables are @code{org-footnote-define-inline},
14956 @code{org-footnote-auto-label}, and @code{org-footnote-auto-adjust}.
14957 @cindex @code{fninline}, STARTUP keyword
14958 @cindex @code{nofninline}, STARTUP keyword
14959 @cindex @code{fnlocal}, STARTUP keyword
14960 @cindex @code{fnprompt}, STARTUP keyword
14961 @cindex @code{fnauto}, STARTUP keyword
14962 @cindex @code{fnconfirm}, STARTUP keyword
14963 @cindex @code{fnplain}, STARTUP keyword
14964 @cindex @code{fnadjust}, STARTUP keyword
14965 @cindex @code{nofnadjust}, STARTUP keyword
14966 @example
14967 fninline @r{define footnotes inline}
14968 fnnoinline @r{define footnotes in separate section}
14969 fnlocal @r{define footnotes near first reference, but not inline}
14970 fnprompt @r{prompt for footnote labels}
14971 fnauto @r{create @code{[fn:1]}-like labels automatically (default)}
14972 fnconfirm @r{offer automatic label for editing or confirmation}
14973 fnplain @r{create @code{[1]}-like labels automatically}
14974 fnadjust @r{automatically renumber and sort footnotes}
14975 nofnadjust @r{do not renumber and sort automatically}
14976 @end example
14977 @cindex org-hide-block-startup
14978 To hide blocks on startup, use these keywords. The corresponding variable is
14979 @code{org-hide-block-startup}.
14980 @cindex @code{hideblocks}, STARTUP keyword
14981 @cindex @code{nohideblocks}, STARTUP keyword
14982 @example
14983 hideblocks @r{Hide all begin/end blocks on startup}
14984 nohideblocks @r{Do not hide blocks on startup}
14985 @end example
14986 @cindex org-pretty-entities
14987 The display of entities as UTF-8 characters is governed by the variable
14988 @code{org-pretty-entities} and the keywords
14989 @cindex @code{entitiespretty}, STARTUP keyword
14990 @cindex @code{entitiesplain}, STARTUP keyword
14991 @example
14992 entitiespretty @r{Show entities as UTF-8 characters where possible}
14993 entitiesplain @r{Leave entities plain}
14994 @end example
14995 @item #+TAGS: TAG1(c1) TAG2(c2)
14996 @vindex org-tag-alist
14997 These lines (several such lines are allowed) specify the valid tags in
14998 this file, and (potentially) the corresponding @emph{fast tag selection}
14999 keys. The corresponding variable is @code{org-tag-alist}.
15000 @item #+TBLFM:
15001 This line contains the formulas for the table directly above the line.
15002 @item #+TITLE:, #+AUTHOR:, #+EMAIL:, #+LANGUAGE:, #+TEXT:, #+DATE:,
15003 @itemx #+OPTIONS:, #+BIND:, #+XSLT:,
15004 @itemx #+DESCRIPTION:, #+KEYWORDS:,
15005 @itemx #+LaTeX_HEADER:, #+STYLE:, #+LINK_UP:, #+LINK_HOME:,
15006 @itemx #+EXPORT_SELECT_TAGS:, #+EXPORT_EXCLUDE_TAGS:
15007 These lines provide settings for exporting files. For more details see
15008 @ref{Export options}.
15009 @item #+TODO: #+SEQ_TODO: #+TYP_TODO:
15010 @vindex org-todo-keywords
15011 These lines set the TODO keywords and their interpretation in the
15012 current file. The corresponding variable is @code{org-todo-keywords}.
15013 @end table
15014
15015 @node The very busy C-c C-c key, Clean view, In-buffer settings, Miscellaneous
15016 @section The very busy C-c C-c key
15017 @kindex C-c C-c
15018 @cindex C-c C-c, overview
15019
15020 The key @kbd{C-c C-c} has many purposes in Org, which are all
15021 mentioned scattered throughout this manual. One specific function of
15022 this key is to add @emph{tags} to a headline (@pxref{Tags}). In many
15023 other circumstances it means something like @emph{``Hey Org, look
15024 here and update according to what you see here''}. Here is a summary of
15025 what this means in different contexts.
15026
15027 @itemize @minus
15028 @item
15029 If there are highlights in the buffer from the creation of a sparse
15030 tree, or from clock display, remove these highlights.
15031 @item
15032 If the cursor is in one of the special @code{#+KEYWORD} lines, this
15033 triggers scanning the buffer for these lines and updating the
15034 information.
15035 @item
15036 If the cursor is inside a table, realign the table. This command
15037 works even if the automatic table editor has been turned off.
15038 @item
15039 If the cursor is on a @code{#+TBLFM} line, re-apply the formulas to
15040 the entire table.
15041 @item
15042 If the current buffer is a capture buffer, close the note and file it.
15043 With a prefix argument, file it, without further interaction, to the
15044 default location.
15045 @item
15046 If the cursor is on a @code{<<<target>>>}, update radio targets and
15047 corresponding links in this buffer.
15048 @item
15049 If the cursor is in a property line or at the start or end of a property
15050 drawer, offer property commands.
15051 @item
15052 If the cursor is at a footnote reference, go to the corresponding
15053 definition, and vice versa.
15054 @item
15055 If the cursor is on a statistics cookie, update it.
15056 @item
15057 If the cursor is in a plain list item with a checkbox, toggle the status
15058 of the checkbox.
15059 @item
15060 If the cursor is on a numbered item in a plain list, renumber the
15061 ordered list.
15062 @item
15063 If the cursor is on the @code{#+BEGIN} line of a dynamic block, the
15064 block is updated.
15065 @item
15066 If the cursor is at a timestamp, fix the day name in the timestamp.
15067 @end itemize
15068
15069 @node Clean view, TTY keys, The very busy C-c C-c key, Miscellaneous
15070 @section A cleaner outline view
15071 @cindex hiding leading stars
15072 @cindex dynamic indentation
15073 @cindex odd-levels-only outlines
15074 @cindex clean outline view
15075
15076 Some people find it noisy and distracting that the Org headlines start with a
15077 potentially large number of stars, and that text below the headlines is not
15078 indented. While this is no problem when writing a @emph{book-like} document
15079 where the outline headings are really section headings, in a more
15080 @emph{list-oriented} outline, indented structure is a lot cleaner:
15081
15082 @example
15083 @group
15084 * Top level headline | * Top level headline
15085 ** Second level | * Second level
15086 *** 3rd level | * 3rd level
15087 some text | some text
15088 *** 3rd level | * 3rd level
15089 more text | more text
15090 * Another top level headline | * Another top level headline
15091 @end group
15092 @end example
15093
15094 @noindent
15095
15096 If you are using at least Emacs 23.2@footnote{Emacs 23.1 can actually crash
15097 with @code{org-indent-mode}} and version 6.29 of Org, this kind of view can
15098 be achieved dynamically at display time using @code{org-indent-mode}. In
15099 this minor mode, all lines are prefixed for display with the necessary amount
15100 of space@footnote{@code{org-indent-mode} also sets the @code{wrap-prefix}
15101 property, such that @code{visual-line-mode} (or purely setting
15102 @code{word-wrap}) wraps long lines (including headlines) correctly indented.
15103 }. Also headlines are prefixed with additional stars, so that the amount of
15104 indentation shifts by two@footnote{See the variable
15105 @code{org-indent-indentation-per-level}.} spaces per level. All headline
15106 stars but the last one are made invisible using the @code{org-hide}
15107 face@footnote{Turning on @code{org-indent-mode} sets
15108 @code{org-hide-leading-stars} to @code{t} and @code{org-adapt-indentation} to
15109 @code{nil}.} - see below under @samp{2.} for more information on how this
15110 works. You can turn on @code{org-indent-mode} for all files by customizing
15111 the variable @code{org-startup-indented}, or you can turn it on for
15112 individual files using
15113
15114 @example
15115 #+STARTUP: indent
15116 @end example
15117
15118 If you want a similar effect in an earlier version of Emacs and/or Org, or if
15119 you want the indentation to be hard space characters so that the plain text
15120 file looks as similar as possible to the Emacs display, Org supports you in
15121 the following way:
15122
15123 @enumerate
15124 @item
15125 @emph{Indentation of text below headlines}@*
15126 You may indent text below each headline to make the left boundary line up
15127 with the headline, like
15128
15129 @example
15130 *** 3rd level
15131 more text, now indented
15132 @end example
15133
15134 @vindex org-adapt-indentation
15135 Org supports this with paragraph filling, line wrapping, and structure
15136 editing@footnote{See also the variable @code{org-adapt-indentation}.},
15137 preserving or adapting the indentation as appropriate.
15138
15139 @item
15140 @vindex org-hide-leading-stars
15141 @emph{Hiding leading stars}@* You can modify the display in such a way that
15142 all leading stars become invisible. To do this in a global way, configure
15143 the variable @code{org-hide-leading-stars} or change this on a per-file basis
15144 with
15145
15146 @example
15147 #+STARTUP: hidestars
15148 #+STARTUP: showstars
15149 @end example
15150
15151 With hidden stars, the tree becomes:
15152
15153 @example
15154 @group
15155 * Top level headline
15156 * Second level
15157 * 3rd level
15158 ...
15159 @end group
15160 @end example
15161
15162 @noindent
15163 @vindex org-hide @r{(face)}
15164 The leading stars are not truly replaced by whitespace, they are only
15165 fontified with the face @code{org-hide} that uses the background color as
15166 font color. If you are not using either white or black background, you may
15167 have to customize this face to get the wanted effect. Another possibility is
15168 to set this font such that the extra stars are @i{almost} invisible, for
15169 example using the color @code{grey90} on a white background.
15170
15171 @item
15172 @vindex org-odd-levels-only
15173 Things become cleaner still if you skip all the even levels and use only odd
15174 levels 1, 3, 5..., effectively adding two stars to go from one outline level
15175 to the next@footnote{When you need to specify a level for a property search
15176 or refile targets, @samp{LEVEL=2} will correspond to 3 stars, etc.}. In this
15177 way we get the outline view shown at the beginning of this section. In order
15178 to make the structure editing and export commands handle this convention
15179 correctly, configure the variable @code{org-odd-levels-only}, or set this on
15180 a per-file basis with one of the following lines:
15181
15182 @example
15183 #+STARTUP: odd
15184 #+STARTUP: oddeven
15185 @end example
15186
15187 You can convert an Org file from single-star-per-level to the
15188 double-star-per-level convention with @kbd{M-x org-convert-to-odd-levels
15189 RET} in that file. The reverse operation is @kbd{M-x
15190 org-convert-to-oddeven-levels}.
15191 @end enumerate
15192
15193 @node TTY keys, Interaction, Clean view, Miscellaneous
15194 @section Using Org on a tty
15195 @cindex tty key bindings
15196
15197 Because Org contains a large number of commands, by default many of
15198 Org's core commands are bound to keys that are generally not
15199 accessible on a tty, such as the cursor keys (@key{left}, @key{right},
15200 @key{up}, @key{down}), @key{TAB} and @key{RET}, in particular when used
15201 together with modifiers like @key{Meta} and/or @key{Shift}. To access
15202 these commands on a tty when special keys are unavailable, the following
15203 alternative bindings can be used. The tty bindings below will likely be
15204 more cumbersome; you may find for some of the bindings below that a
15205 customized workaround suits you better. For example, changing a timestamp
15206 is really only fun with @kbd{S-@key{cursor}} keys, whereas on a
15207 tty you would rather use @kbd{C-c .} to re-insert the timestamp.
15208
15209 @multitable @columnfractions 0.15 0.2 0.1 0.2
15210 @item @b{Default} @tab @b{Alternative 1} @tab @b{Speed key} @tab @b{Alternative 2}
15211 @item @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} @tab @kbd{C-u @key{TAB}} @tab @kbd{C} @tab
15212 @item @kbd{M-@key{left}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x l} @tab @kbd{l} @tab @kbd{@key{Esc} @key{left}}
15213 @item @kbd{M-S-@key{left}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x L} @tab @kbd{L} @tab
15214 @item @kbd{M-@key{right}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x r} @tab @kbd{r} @tab @kbd{@key{Esc} @key{right}}
15215 @item @kbd{M-S-@key{right}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x R} @tab @kbd{R} @tab
15216 @item @kbd{M-@key{up}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x u} @tab @kbd{ } @tab @kbd{@key{Esc} @key{up}}
15217 @item @kbd{M-S-@key{up}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x U} @tab @kbd{U} @tab
15218 @item @kbd{M-@key{down}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x d} @tab @kbd{ } @tab @kbd{@key{Esc} @key{down}}
15219 @item @kbd{M-S-@key{down}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x D} @tab @kbd{D} @tab
15220 @item @kbd{S-@key{RET}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x c} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
15221 @item @kbd{M-@key{RET}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x m} @tab @kbd{ } @tab @kbd{@key{Esc} @key{RET}}
15222 @item @kbd{M-S-@key{RET}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x M} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
15223 @item @kbd{S-@key{left}} @tab @kbd{C-c @key{left}} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
15224 @item @kbd{S-@key{right}} @tab @kbd{C-c @key{right}} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
15225 @item @kbd{S-@key{up}} @tab @kbd{C-c @key{up}} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
15226 @item @kbd{S-@key{down}} @tab @kbd{C-c @key{down}} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
15227 @item @kbd{C-S-@key{left}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x @key{left}} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
15228 @item @kbd{C-S-@key{right}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x @key{right}} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
15229 @end multitable
15230
15231
15232 @node Interaction, org-crypt.el, TTY keys, Miscellaneous
15233 @section Interaction with other packages
15234 @cindex packages, interaction with other
15235 Org lives in the world of GNU Emacs and interacts in various ways
15236 with other code out there.
15237
15238 @menu
15239 * Cooperation:: Packages Org cooperates with
15240 * Conflicts:: Packages that lead to conflicts
15241 @end menu
15242
15243 @node Cooperation, Conflicts, Interaction, Interaction
15244 @subsection Packages that Org cooperates with
15245
15246 @table @asis
15247 @cindex @file{calc.el}
15248 @cindex Gillespie, Dave
15249 @item @file{calc.el} by Dave Gillespie
15250 Org uses the Calc package for implementing spreadsheet
15251 functionality in its tables (@pxref{The spreadsheet}). Org
15252 checks for the availability of Calc by looking for the function
15253 @code{calc-eval} which will have been autoloaded during setup if Calc has
15254 been installed properly. As of Emacs 22, Calc is part of the Emacs
15255 distribution. Another possibility for interaction between the two
15256 packages is using Calc for embedded calculations. @xref{Embedded Mode,
15257 , Embedded Mode, calc, GNU Emacs Calc Manual}.
15258 @item @file{constants.el} by Carsten Dominik
15259 @cindex @file{constants.el}
15260 @cindex Dominik, Carsten
15261 @vindex org-table-formula-constants
15262 In a table formula (@pxref{The spreadsheet}), it is possible to use
15263 names for natural constants or units. Instead of defining your own
15264 constants in the variable @code{org-table-formula-constants}, install
15265 the @file{constants} package which defines a large number of constants
15266 and units, and lets you use unit prefixes like @samp{M} for
15267 @samp{Mega}, etc. You will need version 2.0 of this package, available
15268 at @url{http://www.astro.uva.nl/~dominik/Tools}. Org checks for
15269 the function @code{constants-get}, which has to be autoloaded in your
15270 setup. See the installation instructions in the file
15271 @file{constants.el}.
15272 @item @file{cdlatex.el} by Carsten Dominik
15273 @cindex @file{cdlatex.el}
15274 @cindex Dominik, Carsten
15275 Org mode can make use of the CD@LaTeX{} package to efficiently enter
15276 @LaTeX{} fragments into Org files. See @ref{CDLaTeX mode}.
15277 @item @file{imenu.el} by Ake Stenhoff and Lars Lindberg
15278 @cindex @file{imenu.el}
15279 Imenu allows menu access to an index of items in a file. Org mode
15280 supports Imenu---all you need to do to get the index is the following:
15281 @lisp
15282 (add-hook 'org-mode-hook
15283 (lambda () (imenu-add-to-menubar "Imenu")))
15284 @end lisp
15285 @vindex org-imenu-depth
15286 By default the index is two levels deep---you can modify the depth using
15287 the option @code{org-imenu-depth}.
15288 @item @file{remember.el} by John Wiegley
15289 @cindex @file{remember.el}
15290 @cindex Wiegley, John
15291 Org used to use this package for capture, but no longer does.
15292 @item @file{speedbar.el} by Eric M. Ludlam
15293 @cindex @file{speedbar.el}
15294 @cindex Ludlam, Eric M.
15295 Speedbar is a package that creates a special frame displaying files and
15296 index items in files. Org mode supports Speedbar and allows you to
15297 drill into Org files directly from the Speedbar. It also allows you to
15298 restrict the scope of agenda commands to a file or a subtree by using
15299 the command @kbd{<} in the Speedbar frame.
15300 @cindex @file{table.el}
15301 @item @file{table.el} by Takaaki Ota
15302 @kindex C-c C-c
15303 @cindex table editor, @file{table.el}
15304 @cindex @file{table.el}
15305 @cindex Ota, Takaaki
15306
15307 Complex ASCII tables with automatic line wrapping, column- and row-spanning,
15308 and alignment can be created using the Emacs table package by Takaaki Ota
15309 (@uref{http://sourceforge.net/projects/table}, and also part of Emacs 22).
15310 Org mode will recognize these tables and export them properly. Because of
15311 interference with other Org mode functionality, you unfortunately cannot edit
15312 these tables directly in the buffer. Instead, you need to use the command
15313 @kbd{C-c '} to edit them, similar to source code snippets.
15314
15315 @table @kbd
15316 @orgcmd{C-c ',org-edit-special}
15317 Edit a @file{table.el} table. Works when the cursor is in a table.el table.
15318 @c
15319 @orgcmd{C-c ~,org-table-create-with-table.el}
15320 Insert a @file{table.el} table. If there is already a table at point, this
15321 command converts it between the @file{table.el} format and the Org mode
15322 format. See the documentation string of the command
15323 @code{org-convert-table} for the restrictions under which this is
15324 possible.
15325 @end table
15326 @file{table.el} is part of Emacs since Emacs 22.
15327 @item @file{footnote.el} by Steven L. Baur
15328 @cindex @file{footnote.el}
15329 @cindex Baur, Steven L.
15330 Org mode recognizes numerical footnotes as provided by this package.
15331 However, Org mode also has its own footnote support (@pxref{Footnotes}),
15332 which makes using @file{footnote.el} unnecessary.
15333 @end table
15334
15335 @node Conflicts, , Cooperation, Interaction
15336 @subsection Packages that lead to conflicts with Org mode
15337
15338 @table @asis
15339
15340 @cindex @code{shift-selection-mode}
15341 @vindex org-support-shift-select
15342 In Emacs 23, @code{shift-selection-mode} is on by default, meaning that
15343 cursor motions combined with the shift key should start or enlarge regions.
15344 This conflicts with the use of @kbd{S-@key{cursor}} commands in Org to change
15345 timestamps, TODO keywords, priorities, and item bullet types if the cursor is
15346 at such a location. By default, @kbd{S-@key{cursor}} commands outside
15347 special contexts don't do anything, but you can customize the variable
15348 @code{org-support-shift-select}. Org mode then tries to accommodate shift
15349 selection by (i) using it outside of the special contexts where special
15350 commands apply, and by (ii) extending an existing active region even if the
15351 cursor moves across a special context.
15352
15353 @item @file{CUA.el} by Kim. F. Storm
15354 @cindex @file{CUA.el}
15355 @cindex Storm, Kim. F.
15356 @vindex org-replace-disputed-keys
15357 Key bindings in Org conflict with the @kbd{S-<cursor>} keys used by CUA mode
15358 (as well as @code{pc-select-mode} and @code{s-region-mode}) to select and extend the
15359 region. In fact, Emacs 23 has this built-in in the form of
15360 @code{shift-selection-mode}, see previous paragraph. If you are using Emacs
15361 23, you probably don't want to use another package for this purpose. However,
15362 if you prefer to leave these keys to a different package while working in
15363 Org mode, configure the variable @code{org-replace-disputed-keys}. When set,
15364 Org will move the following key bindings in Org files, and in the agenda
15365 buffer (but not during date selection).
15366
15367 @example
15368 S-UP @result{} M-p S-DOWN @result{} M-n
15369 S-LEFT @result{} M-- S-RIGHT @result{} M-+
15370 C-S-LEFT @result{} M-S-- C-S-RIGHT @result{} M-S-+
15371 @end example
15372
15373 @vindex org-disputed-keys
15374 Yes, these are unfortunately more difficult to remember. If you want
15375 to have other replacement keys, look at the variable
15376 @code{org-disputed-keys}.
15377
15378 @item @file{filladapt.el} by Kyle Jones
15379 @cindex @file{filladapt.el}
15380
15381 Org mode tries to do the right thing when filling paragraphs, list items and
15382 other elements. Many users reported they had problems using both
15383 @file{filladapt.el} and Org mode, so a safe thing to do is to disable it like
15384 this:
15385
15386 @lisp
15387 (add-hook 'org-mode-hook 'turn-off-filladapt-mode)
15388 @end lisp
15389
15390 @item @file{yasnippet.el}
15391 @cindex @file{yasnippet.el}
15392 The way Org mode binds the TAB key (binding to @code{[tab]} instead of
15393 @code{"\t"}) overrules YASnippet's access to this key. The following code
15394 fixed this problem:
15395
15396 @lisp
15397 (add-hook 'org-mode-hook
15398 (lambda ()
15399 (org-set-local 'yas/trigger-key [tab])
15400 (define-key yas/keymap [tab] 'yas/next-field-or-maybe-expand)))
15401 @end lisp
15402
15403 The latest version of yasnippet doesn't play well with Org mode. If the
15404 above code does not fix the conflict, start by defining the following
15405 function:
15406
15407 @lisp
15408 (defun yas/org-very-safe-expand ()
15409 (let ((yas/fallback-behavior 'return-nil)) (yas/expand)))
15410 @end lisp
15411
15412 Then, tell Org mode what to do with the new function:
15413
15414 @lisp
15415 (add-hook 'org-mode-hook
15416 (lambda ()
15417 (make-variable-buffer-local 'yas/trigger-key)
15418 (setq yas/trigger-key [tab])
15419 (add-to-list 'org-tab-first-hook 'yas/org-very-safe-expand)
15420 (define-key yas/keymap [tab] 'yas/next-field)))
15421 @end lisp
15422
15423 @item @file{windmove.el} by Hovav Shacham
15424 @cindex @file{windmove.el}
15425 This package also uses the @kbd{S-<cursor>} keys, so everything written
15426 in the paragraph above about CUA mode also applies here. If you want make
15427 the windmove function active in locations where Org mode does not have
15428 special functionality on @kbd{S-@key{cursor}}, add this to your
15429 configuration:
15430
15431 @lisp
15432 ;; Make windmove work in org-mode:
15433 (add-hook 'org-shiftup-final-hook 'windmove-up)
15434 (add-hook 'org-shiftleft-final-hook 'windmove-left)
15435 (add-hook 'org-shiftdown-final-hook 'windmove-down)
15436 (add-hook 'org-shiftright-final-hook 'windmove-right)
15437 @end lisp
15438
15439 @item @file{viper.el} by Michael Kifer
15440 @cindex @file{viper.el}
15441 @kindex C-c /
15442 Viper uses @kbd{C-c /} and therefore makes this key not access the
15443 corresponding Org mode command @code{org-sparse-tree}. You need to find
15444 another key for this command, or override the key in
15445 @code{viper-vi-global-user-map} with
15446
15447 @lisp
15448 (define-key viper-vi-global-user-map "C-c /" 'org-sparse-tree)
15449 @end lisp
15450
15451 @end table
15452
15453 @node org-crypt.el, , Interaction, Miscellaneous
15454 @section org-crypt.el
15455 @cindex @file{org-crypt.el}
15456 @cindex @code{org-decrypt-entry}
15457
15458 Org-crypt will encrypt the text of an entry, but not the headline, or
15459 properties. Org-crypt uses the Emacs EasyPG library to encrypt and decrypt
15460 files.
15461
15462 Any text below a headline that has a @samp{:crypt:} tag will be automatically
15463 be encrypted when the file is saved. If you want to use a different tag just
15464 customize the @code{org-crypt-tag-matcher} setting.
15465
15466 To use org-crypt it is suggested that you have the following in your
15467 @file{.emacs}:
15468
15469 @example
15470 (require 'org-crypt)
15471 (org-crypt-use-before-save-magic)
15472 (setq org-tags-exclude-from-inheritance (quote ("crypt")))
15473
15474 (setq org-crypt-key nil)
15475 ;; GPG key to use for encryption
15476 ;; Either the Key ID or set to nil to use symmetric encryption.
15477
15478 (setq auto-save-default nil)
15479 ;; Auto-saving does not cooperate with org-crypt.el: so you need
15480 ;; to turn it off if you plan to use org-crypt.el quite often.
15481 ;; Otherwise, you'll get an (annoying) message each time you
15482 ;; start Org.
15483
15484 ;; To turn it off only locally, you can insert this:
15485 ;;
15486 ;; # -*- buffer-auto-save-file-name: nil; -*-
15487 @end example
15488
15489 Excluding the crypt tag from inheritance prevents already encrypted text
15490 being encrypted again.
15491
15492 @node Hacking, MobileOrg, Miscellaneous, Top
15493 @appendix Hacking
15494 @cindex hacking
15495
15496 This appendix covers some aspects where users can extend the functionality of
15497 Org.
15498
15499 @menu
15500 * Hooks:: How to reach into Org's internals
15501 * Add-on packages:: Available extensions
15502 * Adding hyperlink types:: New custom link types
15503 * Context-sensitive commands:: How to add functionality to such commands
15504 * Tables in arbitrary syntax:: Orgtbl for @LaTeX{} and other programs
15505 * Dynamic blocks:: Automatically filled blocks
15506 * Special agenda views:: Customized views
15507 * Extracting agenda information:: Postprocessing of agenda information
15508 * Using the property API:: Writing programs that use entry properties
15509 * Using the mapping API:: Mapping over all or selected entries
15510 @end menu
15511
15512 @node Hooks, Add-on packages, Hacking, Hacking
15513 @section Hooks
15514 @cindex hooks
15515
15516 Org has a large number of hook variables that can be used to add
15517 functionality. This appendix about hacking is going to illustrate the
15518 use of some of them. A complete list of all hooks with documentation is
15519 maintained by the Worg project and can be found at
15520 @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-configs/org-hooks.php}.
15521
15522 @node Add-on packages, Adding hyperlink types, Hooks, Hacking
15523 @section Add-on packages
15524 @cindex add-on packages
15525
15526 A large number of add-on packages have been written by various authors.
15527 These packages are not part of Emacs, but they are distributed as contributed
15528 packages with the separate release available at the Org mode home page at
15529 @uref{http://orgmode.org}. The list of contributed packages, along with
15530 documentation about each package, is maintained by the Worg project at
15531 @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-contrib/}.
15532
15533
15534
15535 @node Adding hyperlink types, Context-sensitive commands, Add-on packages, Hacking
15536 @section Adding hyperlink types
15537 @cindex hyperlinks, adding new types
15538
15539 Org has a large number of hyperlink types built-in
15540 (@pxref{Hyperlinks}). If you would like to add new link types, Org
15541 provides an interface for doing so. Let's look at an example file,
15542 @file{org-man.el}, that will add support for creating links like
15543 @samp{[[man:printf][The printf manpage]]} to show Unix manual pages inside
15544 Emacs:
15545
15546 @lisp
15547 ;;; org-man.el - Support for links to manpages in Org
15548
15549 (require 'org)
15550
15551 (org-add-link-type "man" 'org-man-open)
15552 (add-hook 'org-store-link-functions 'org-man-store-link)
15553
15554 (defcustom org-man-command 'man
15555 "The Emacs command to be used to display a man page."
15556 :group 'org-link
15557 :type '(choice (const man) (const woman)))
15558
15559 (defun org-man-open (path)
15560 "Visit the manpage on PATH.
15561 PATH should be a topic that can be thrown at the man command."
15562 (funcall org-man-command path))
15563
15564 (defun org-man-store-link ()
15565 "Store a link to a manpage."
15566 (when (memq major-mode '(Man-mode woman-mode))
15567 ;; This is a man page, we do make this link
15568 (let* ((page (org-man-get-page-name))
15569 (link (concat "man:" page))
15570 (description (format "Manpage for %s" page)))
15571 (org-store-link-props
15572 :type "man"
15573 :link link
15574 :description description))))
15575
15576 (defun org-man-get-page-name ()
15577 "Extract the page name from the buffer name."
15578 ;; This works for both `Man-mode' and `woman-mode'.
15579 (if (string-match " \\(\\S-+\\)\\*" (buffer-name))
15580 (match-string 1 (buffer-name))
15581 (error "Cannot create link to this man page")))
15582
15583 (provide 'org-man)
15584
15585 ;;; org-man.el ends here
15586 @end lisp
15587
15588 @noindent
15589 You would activate this new link type in @file{.emacs} with
15590
15591 @lisp
15592 (require 'org-man)
15593 @end lisp
15594
15595 @noindent
15596 Let's go through the file and see what it does.
15597 @enumerate
15598 @item
15599 It does @code{(require 'org)} to make sure that @file{org.el} has been
15600 loaded.
15601 @item
15602 The next line calls @code{org-add-link-type} to define a new link type
15603 with prefix @samp{man}. The call also contains the name of a function
15604 that will be called to follow such a link.
15605 @item
15606 @vindex org-store-link-functions
15607 The next line adds a function to @code{org-store-link-functions}, in
15608 order to allow the command @kbd{C-c l} to record a useful link in a
15609 buffer displaying a man page.
15610 @end enumerate
15611
15612 The rest of the file defines the necessary variables and functions.
15613 First there is a customization variable that determines which Emacs
15614 command should be used to display man pages. There are two options,
15615 @code{man} and @code{woman}. Then the function to follow a link is
15616 defined. It gets the link path as an argument---in this case the link
15617 path is just a topic for the manual command. The function calls the
15618 value of @code{org-man-command} to display the man page.
15619
15620 Finally the function @code{org-man-store-link} is defined. When you try
15621 to store a link with @kbd{C-c l}, this function will be called to
15622 try to make a link. The function must first decide if it is supposed to
15623 create the link for this buffer type; we do this by checking the value
15624 of the variable @code{major-mode}. If not, the function must exit and
15625 return the value @code{nil}. If yes, the link is created by getting the
15626 manual topic from the buffer name and prefixing it with the string
15627 @samp{man:}. Then it must call the command @code{org-store-link-props}
15628 and set the @code{:type} and @code{:link} properties. Optionally you
15629 can also set the @code{:description} property to provide a default for
15630 the link description when the link is later inserted into an Org
15631 buffer with @kbd{C-c C-l}.
15632
15633 When it makes sense for your new link type, you may also define a function
15634 @code{org-PREFIX-complete-link} that implements special (e.g., completion)
15635 support for inserting such a link with @kbd{C-c C-l}. Such a function should
15636 not accept any arguments, and return the full link with prefix.
15637
15638 @node Context-sensitive commands, Tables in arbitrary syntax, Adding hyperlink types, Hacking
15639 @section Context-sensitive commands
15640 @cindex context-sensitive commands, hooks
15641 @cindex add-ons, context-sensitive commands
15642 @vindex org-ctrl-c-ctrl-c-hook
15643
15644 Org has several commands that act differently depending on context. The most
15645 important example is the @kbd{C-c C-c} (@pxref{The very busy C-c C-c key}).
15646 Also the @kbd{M-cursor} and @kbd{M-S-cursor} keys have this property.
15647
15648 Add-ons can tap into this functionality by providing a function that detects
15649 special context for that add-on and executes functionality appropriate for
15650 the context. Here is an example from Dan Davison's @file{org-R.el} which
15651 allows you to evaluate commands based on the @file{R} programming language
15652 @footnote{@file{org-R.el} has been replaced by the Org mode functionality
15653 described in @ref{Working With Source Code} and is now obsolete.}. For this
15654 package, special contexts are lines that start with @code{#+R:} or
15655 @code{#+RR:}.
15656
15657 @lisp
15658 (defun org-R-apply-maybe ()
15659 "Detect if this is context for org-R and execute R commands."
15660 (if (save-excursion
15661 (beginning-of-line 1)
15662 (looking-at "#\\+RR?:"))
15663 (progn (call-interactively 'org-R-apply)
15664 t) ;; to signal that we took action
15665 nil)) ;; to signal that we did not
15666
15667 (add-hook 'org-ctrl-c-ctrl-c-hook 'org-R-apply-maybe)
15668 @end lisp
15669
15670 The function first checks if the cursor is in such a line. If that is the
15671 case, @code{org-R-apply} is called and the function returns @code{t} to
15672 signal that action was taken, and @kbd{C-c C-c} will stop looking for other
15673 contexts. If the function finds it should do nothing locally, it returns
15674 @code{nil} so that other, similar functions can have a try.
15675
15676
15677 @node Tables in arbitrary syntax, Dynamic blocks, Context-sensitive commands, Hacking
15678 @section Tables and lists in arbitrary syntax
15679 @cindex tables, in other modes
15680 @cindex lists, in other modes
15681 @cindex Orgtbl mode
15682
15683 Since Orgtbl mode can be used as a minor mode in arbitrary buffers, a
15684 frequent feature request has been to make it work with native tables in
15685 specific languages, for example @LaTeX{}. However, this is extremely
15686 hard to do in a general way, would lead to a customization nightmare,
15687 and would take away much of the simplicity of the Orgtbl mode table
15688 editor.
15689
15690 This appendix describes a different approach. We keep the Orgtbl mode
15691 table in its native format (the @i{source table}), and use a custom
15692 function to @i{translate} the table to the correct syntax, and to
15693 @i{install} it in the right location (the @i{target table}). This puts
15694 the burden of writing conversion functions on the user, but it allows
15695 for a very flexible system.
15696
15697 Bastien added the ability to do the same with lists, in Orgstruct mode. You
15698 can use Org's facilities to edit and structure lists by turning
15699 @code{orgstruct-mode} on, then locally exporting such lists in another format
15700 (HTML, @LaTeX{} or Texinfo.)
15701
15702
15703 @menu
15704 * Radio tables:: Sending and receiving radio tables
15705 * A @LaTeX{} example:: Step by step, almost a tutorial
15706 * Translator functions:: Copy and modify
15707 * Radio lists:: Doing the same for lists
15708 @end menu
15709
15710 @node Radio tables, A @LaTeX{} example, Tables in arbitrary syntax, Tables in arbitrary syntax
15711 @subsection Radio tables
15712 @cindex radio tables
15713
15714 To define the location of the target table, you first need to create two
15715 lines that are comments in the current mode, but contain magic words for
15716 Orgtbl mode to find. Orgtbl mode will insert the translated table
15717 between these lines, replacing whatever was there before. For example:
15718
15719 @example
15720 /* BEGIN RECEIVE ORGTBL table_name */
15721 /* END RECEIVE ORGTBL table_name */
15722 @end example
15723
15724 @noindent
15725 Just above the source table, we put a special line that tells
15726 Orgtbl mode how to translate this table and where to install it. For
15727 example:
15728 @cindex #+ORGTBL
15729 @example
15730 #+ORGTBL: SEND table_name translation_function arguments....
15731 @end example
15732
15733 @noindent
15734 @code{table_name} is the reference name for the table that is also used
15735 in the receiver lines. @code{translation_function} is the Lisp function
15736 that does the translation. Furthermore, the line can contain a list of
15737 arguments (alternating key and value) at the end. The arguments will be
15738 passed as a property list to the translation function for
15739 interpretation. A few standard parameters are already recognized and
15740 acted upon before the translation function is called:
15741
15742 @table @code
15743 @item :skip N
15744 Skip the first N lines of the table. Hlines do count as separate lines for
15745 this parameter!
15746
15747 @item :skipcols (n1 n2 ...)
15748 List of columns that should be skipped. If the table has a column with
15749 calculation marks, that column is automatically discarded as well.
15750 Please note that the translator function sees the table @emph{after} the
15751 removal of these columns, the function never knows that there have been
15752 additional columns.
15753
15754 @item :no-escape t
15755 When non-nil, do not escape special characters @code{&%#_^} when exporting
15756 the table. The default value is nil.
15757 @end table
15758
15759 @noindent
15760 The one problem remaining is how to keep the source table in the buffer
15761 without disturbing the normal workings of the file, for example during
15762 compilation of a C file or processing of a @LaTeX{} file. There are a
15763 number of different solutions:
15764
15765 @itemize @bullet
15766 @item
15767 The table could be placed in a block comment if that is supported by the
15768 language. For example, in C mode you could wrap the table between
15769 @samp{/*} and @samp{*/} lines.
15770 @item
15771 Sometimes it is possible to put the table after some kind of @i{END}
15772 statement, for example @samp{\bye} in @TeX{} and @samp{\end@{document@}}
15773 in @LaTeX{}.
15774 @item
15775 You can just comment the table line-by-line whenever you want to process
15776 the file, and uncomment it whenever you need to edit the table. This
15777 only sounds tedious---the command @kbd{M-x orgtbl-toggle-comment}
15778 makes this comment-toggling very easy, in particular if you bind it to a
15779 key.
15780 @end itemize
15781
15782 @node A @LaTeX{} example, Translator functions, Radio tables, Tables in arbitrary syntax
15783 @subsection A @LaTeX{} example of radio tables
15784 @cindex @LaTeX{}, and Orgtbl mode
15785
15786 The best way to wrap the source table in @LaTeX{} is to use the
15787 @code{comment} environment provided by @file{comment.sty}. It has to be
15788 activated by placing @code{\usepackage@{comment@}} into the document
15789 header. Orgtbl mode can insert a radio table skeleton@footnote{By
15790 default this works only for @LaTeX{}, HTML, and Texinfo. Configure the
15791 variable @code{orgtbl-radio-tables} to install templates for other
15792 modes.} with the command @kbd{M-x orgtbl-insert-radio-table}. You will
15793 be prompted for a table name, let's say we use @samp{salesfigures}. You
15794 will then get the following template:
15795
15796 @cindex #+ORGTBL, SEND
15797 @example
15798 % BEGIN RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
15799 % END RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
15800 \begin@{comment@}
15801 #+ORGTBL: SEND salesfigures orgtbl-to-latex
15802 | | |
15803 \end@{comment@}
15804 @end example
15805
15806 @noindent
15807 @vindex @LaTeX{}-verbatim-environments
15808 The @code{#+ORGTBL: SEND} line tells Orgtbl mode to use the function
15809 @code{orgtbl-to-latex} to convert the table into @LaTeX{} and to put it
15810 into the receiver location with name @code{salesfigures}. You may now
15811 fill in the table---feel free to use the spreadsheet features@footnote{If
15812 the @samp{#+TBLFM} line contains an odd number of dollar characters,
15813 this may cause problems with font-lock in @LaTeX{} mode. As shown in the
15814 example you can fix this by adding an extra line inside the
15815 @code{comment} environment that is used to balance the dollar
15816 expressions. If you are using AUC@TeX{} with the font-latex library, a
15817 much better solution is to add the @code{comment} environment to the
15818 variable @code{LaTeX-verbatim-environments}.}:
15819
15820 @example
15821 % BEGIN RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
15822 % END RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
15823 \begin@{comment@}
15824 #+ORGTBL: SEND salesfigures orgtbl-to-latex
15825 | Month | Days | Nr sold | per day |
15826 |-------+------+---------+---------|
15827 | Jan | 23 | 55 | 2.4 |
15828 | Feb | 21 | 16 | 0.8 |
15829 | March | 22 | 278 | 12.6 |
15830 #+TBLFM: $4=$3/$2;%.1f
15831 % $ (optional extra dollar to keep font-lock happy, see footnote)
15832 \end@{comment@}
15833 @end example
15834
15835 @noindent
15836 When you are done, press @kbd{C-c C-c} in the table to get the converted
15837 table inserted between the two marker lines.
15838
15839 Now let's assume you want to make the table header by hand, because you
15840 want to control how columns are aligned, etc. In this case we make sure
15841 that the table translator skips the first 2 lines of the source
15842 table, and tell the command to work as a @i{splice}, i.e., to not produce
15843 header and footer commands of the target table:
15844
15845 @example
15846 \begin@{tabular@}@{lrrr@}
15847 Month & \multicolumn@{1@}@{c@}@{Days@} & Nr.\ sold & per day\\
15848 % BEGIN RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
15849 % END RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
15850 \end@{tabular@}
15851 %
15852 \begin@{comment@}
15853 #+ORGTBL: SEND salesfigures orgtbl-to-latex :splice t :skip 2
15854 | Month | Days | Nr sold | per day |
15855 |-------+------+---------+---------|
15856 | Jan | 23 | 55 | 2.4 |
15857 | Feb | 21 | 16 | 0.8 |
15858 | March | 22 | 278 | 12.6 |
15859 #+TBLFM: $4=$3/$2;%.1f
15860 \end@{comment@}
15861 @end example
15862
15863 The @LaTeX{} translator function @code{orgtbl-to-latex} is already part of
15864 Orgtbl mode. It uses a @code{tabular} environment to typeset the table
15865 and marks horizontal lines with @code{\hline}. Furthermore, it
15866 interprets the following parameters (see also @pxref{Translator functions}):
15867
15868 @table @code
15869 @item :splice nil/t
15870 When set to t, return only table body lines, don't wrap them into a
15871 tabular environment. Default is nil.
15872
15873 @item :fmt fmt
15874 A format to be used to wrap each field, it should contain @code{%s} for the
15875 original field value. For example, to wrap each field value in dollars,
15876 you could use @code{:fmt "$%s$"}. This may also be a property list with
15877 column numbers and formats, for example @code{:fmt (2 "$%s$" 4 "%s\\%%")}.
15878 A function of one argument can be used in place of the strings; the
15879 function must return a formatted string.
15880
15881 @item :efmt efmt
15882 Use this format to print numbers with exponentials. The format should
15883 have @code{%s} twice for inserting mantissa and exponent, for example
15884 @code{"%s\\times10^@{%s@}"}. The default is @code{"%s\\,(%s)"}. This
15885 may also be a property list with column numbers and formats, for example
15886 @code{:efmt (2 "$%s\\times10^@{%s@}$" 4 "$%s\\cdot10^@{%s@}$")}. After
15887 @code{efmt} has been applied to a value, @code{fmt} will also be
15888 applied. Similar to @code{fmt}, functions of two arguments can be
15889 supplied instead of strings.
15890 @end table
15891
15892 @node Translator functions, Radio lists, A @LaTeX{} example, Tables in arbitrary syntax
15893 @subsection Translator functions
15894 @cindex HTML, and Orgtbl mode
15895 @cindex translator function
15896
15897 Orgtbl mode has several translator functions built-in: @code{orgtbl-to-csv}
15898 (comma-separated values), @code{orgtbl-to-tsv} (TAB-separated values)
15899 @code{orgtbl-to-latex}, @code{orgtbl-to-html}, and @code{orgtbl-to-texinfo}.
15900 Except for @code{orgtbl-to-html}@footnote{The HTML translator uses the same
15901 code that produces tables during HTML export.}, these all use a generic
15902 translator, @code{orgtbl-to-generic}. For example, @code{orgtbl-to-latex}
15903 itself is a very short function that computes the column definitions for the
15904 @code{tabular} environment, defines a few field and line separators and then
15905 hands processing over to the generic translator. Here is the entire code:
15906
15907 @lisp
15908 @group
15909 (defun orgtbl-to-latex (table params)
15910 "Convert the Orgtbl mode TABLE to LaTeX."
15911 (let* ((alignment (mapconcat (lambda (x) (if x "r" "l"))
15912 org-table-last-alignment ""))
15913 (params2
15914 (list
15915 :tstart (concat "\\begin@{tabular@}@{" alignment "@}")
15916 :tend "\\end@{tabular@}"
15917 :lstart "" :lend " \\\\" :sep " & "
15918 :efmt "%s\\,(%s)" :hline "\\hline")))
15919 (orgtbl-to-generic table (org-combine-plists params2 params))))
15920 @end group
15921 @end lisp
15922
15923 As you can see, the properties passed into the function (variable
15924 @var{PARAMS}) are combined with the ones newly defined in the function
15925 (variable @var{PARAMS2}). The ones passed into the function (i.e., the
15926 ones set by the @samp{ORGTBL SEND} line) take precedence. So if you
15927 would like to use the @LaTeX{} translator, but wanted the line endings to
15928 be @samp{\\[2mm]} instead of the default @samp{\\}, you could just
15929 overrule the default with
15930
15931 @example
15932 #+ORGTBL: SEND test orgtbl-to-latex :lend " \\\\[2mm]"
15933 @end example
15934
15935 For a new language, you can either write your own converter function in
15936 analogy with the @LaTeX{} translator, or you can use the generic function
15937 directly. For example, if you have a language where a table is started
15938 with @samp{!BTBL!}, ended with @samp{!ETBL!}, and where table lines are
15939 started with @samp{!BL!}, ended with @samp{!EL!}, and where the field
15940 separator is a TAB, you could call the generic translator like this (on
15941 a single line!):
15942
15943 @example
15944 #+ORGTBL: SEND test orgtbl-to-generic :tstart "!BTBL!" :tend "!ETBL!"
15945 :lstart "!BL! " :lend " !EL!" :sep "\t"
15946 @end example
15947
15948 @noindent
15949 Please check the documentation string of the function
15950 @code{orgtbl-to-generic} for a full list of parameters understood by
15951 that function, and remember that you can pass each of them into
15952 @code{orgtbl-to-latex}, @code{orgtbl-to-texinfo}, and any other function
15953 using the generic function.
15954
15955 Of course you can also write a completely new function doing complicated
15956 things the generic translator cannot do. A translator function takes
15957 two arguments. The first argument is the table, a list of lines, each
15958 line either the symbol @code{hline} or a list of fields. The second
15959 argument is the property list containing all parameters specified in the
15960 @samp{#+ORGTBL: SEND} line. The function must return a single string
15961 containing the formatted table. If you write a generally useful
15962 translator, please post it on @email{emacs-orgmode@@gnu.org} so that
15963 others can benefit from your work.
15964
15965 @node Radio lists, , Translator functions, Tables in arbitrary syntax
15966 @subsection Radio lists
15967 @cindex radio lists
15968 @cindex org-list-insert-radio-list
15969
15970 Sending and receiving radio lists works exactly the same way as sending and
15971 receiving radio tables (@pxref{Radio tables}). As for radio tables, you can
15972 insert radio list templates in HTML, @LaTeX{} and Texinfo modes by calling
15973 @code{org-list-insert-radio-list}.
15974
15975 Here are the differences with radio tables:
15976
15977 @itemize @minus
15978 @item
15979 Orgstruct mode must be active.
15980 @item
15981 Use the @code{ORGLST} keyword instead of @code{ORGTBL}.
15982 @item
15983 The available translation functions for radio lists don't take
15984 parameters.
15985 @item
15986 @kbd{C-c C-c} will work when pressed on the first item of the list.
15987 @end itemize
15988
15989 Here is a @LaTeX{} example. Let's say that you have this in your
15990 @LaTeX{} file:
15991
15992 @cindex #+ORGLST
15993 @example
15994 % BEGIN RECEIVE ORGLST to-buy
15995 % END RECEIVE ORGLST to-buy
15996 \begin@{comment@}
15997 #+ORGLST: SEND to-buy org-list-to-latex
15998 - a new house
15999 - a new computer
16000 + a new keyboard
16001 + a new mouse
16002 - a new life
16003 \end@{comment@}
16004 @end example
16005
16006 Pressing `C-c C-c' on @code{a new house} and will insert the converted
16007 @LaTeX{} list between the two marker lines.
16008
16009 @node Dynamic blocks, Special agenda views, Tables in arbitrary syntax, Hacking
16010 @section Dynamic blocks
16011 @cindex dynamic blocks
16012
16013 Org documents can contain @emph{dynamic blocks}. These are
16014 specially marked regions that are updated by some user-written function.
16015 A good example for such a block is the clock table inserted by the
16016 command @kbd{C-c C-x C-r} (@pxref{Clocking work time}).
16017
16018 Dynamic blocks are enclosed by a BEGIN-END structure that assigns a name
16019 to the block and can also specify parameters for the function producing
16020 the content of the block.
16021
16022 @cindex #+BEGIN:dynamic block
16023 @example
16024 #+BEGIN: myblock :parameter1 value1 :parameter2 value2 ...
16025
16026 #+END:
16027 @end example
16028
16029 Dynamic blocks are updated with the following commands
16030
16031 @table @kbd
16032 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-u,org-dblock-update}
16033 Update dynamic block at point.
16034 @orgkey{C-u C-c C-x C-u}
16035 Update all dynamic blocks in the current file.
16036 @end table
16037
16038 Updating a dynamic block means to remove all the text between BEGIN and
16039 END, parse the BEGIN line for parameters and then call the specific
16040 writer function for this block to insert the new content. If you want
16041 to use the original content in the writer function, you can use the
16042 extra parameter @code{:content}.
16043
16044 For a block with name @code{myblock}, the writer function is
16045 @code{org-dblock-write:myblock} with as only parameter a property list
16046 with the parameters given in the begin line. Here is a trivial example
16047 of a block that keeps track of when the block update function was last
16048 run:
16049
16050 @example
16051 #+BEGIN: block-update-time :format "on %m/%d/%Y at %H:%M"
16052
16053 #+END:
16054 @end example
16055
16056 @noindent
16057 The corresponding block writer function could look like this:
16058
16059 @lisp
16060 (defun org-dblock-write:block-update-time (params)
16061 (let ((fmt (or (plist-get params :format) "%d. %m. %Y")))
16062 (insert "Last block update at: "
16063 (format-time-string fmt (current-time)))))
16064 @end lisp
16065
16066 If you want to make sure that all dynamic blocks are always up-to-date,
16067 you could add the function @code{org-update-all-dblocks} to a hook, for
16068 example @code{before-save-hook}. @code{org-update-all-dblocks} is
16069 written in a way such that it does nothing in buffers that are not in
16070 @code{org-mode}.
16071
16072 You can narrow the current buffer to the current dynamic block (like any
16073 other block) with @code{org-narrow-to-block}.
16074
16075 @node Special agenda views, Extracting agenda information, Dynamic blocks, Hacking
16076 @section Special agenda views
16077 @cindex agenda views, user-defined
16078
16079 @vindex org-agenda-skip-function
16080 @vindex org-agenda-skip-function-global
16081 Org provides a special hook that can be used to narrow down the selection
16082 made by these agenda views: @code{agenda}, @code{todo}, @code{alltodo},
16083 @code{tags}, @code{tags-todo}, @code{tags-tree}. You may specify a function
16084 that is used at each match to verify if the match should indeed be part of
16085 the agenda view, and if not, how much should be skipped. You can specify a
16086 global condition that will be applied to all agenda views, this condition
16087 would be stored in the variable @code{org-agenda-skip-function-global}. More
16088 commonly, such a definition is applied only to specific custom searches,
16089 using @code{org-agenda-skip-function}.
16090
16091 Let's say you want to produce a list of projects that contain a WAITING
16092 tag anywhere in the project tree. Let's further assume that you have
16093 marked all tree headings that define a project with the TODO keyword
16094 PROJECT@. In this case you would run a TODO search for the keyword
16095 PROJECT, but skip the match unless there is a WAITING tag anywhere in
16096 the subtree belonging to the project line.
16097
16098 To achieve this, you must write a function that searches the subtree for
16099 the tag. If the tag is found, the function must return @code{nil} to
16100 indicate that this match should not be skipped. If there is no such
16101 tag, return the location of the end of the subtree, to indicate that
16102 search should continue from there.
16103
16104 @lisp
16105 (defun my-skip-unless-waiting ()
16106 "Skip trees that are not waiting"
16107 (let ((subtree-end (save-excursion (org-end-of-subtree t))))
16108 (if (re-search-forward ":waiting:" subtree-end t)
16109 nil ; tag found, do not skip
16110 subtree-end))) ; tag not found, continue after end of subtree
16111 @end lisp
16112
16113 Now you may use this function in an agenda custom command, for example
16114 like this:
16115
16116 @lisp
16117 (org-add-agenda-custom-command
16118 '("b" todo "PROJECT"
16119 ((org-agenda-skip-function 'my-skip-unless-waiting)
16120 (org-agenda-overriding-header "Projects waiting for something: "))))
16121 @end lisp
16122
16123 @vindex org-agenda-overriding-header
16124 Note that this also binds @code{org-agenda-overriding-header} to get a
16125 meaningful header in the agenda view.
16126
16127 @vindex org-odd-levels-only
16128 @vindex org-agenda-skip-function
16129 A general way to create custom searches is to base them on a search for
16130 entries with a certain level limit. If you want to study all entries with
16131 your custom search function, simply do a search for
16132 @samp{LEVEL>0}@footnote{Note that, when using @code{org-odd-levels-only}, a
16133 level number corresponds to order in the hierarchy, not to the number of
16134 stars.}, and then use @code{org-agenda-skip-function} to select the entries
16135 you really want to have.
16136
16137 You may also put a Lisp form into @code{org-agenda-skip-function}. In
16138 particular, you may use the functions @code{org-agenda-skip-entry-if}
16139 and @code{org-agenda-skip-subtree-if} in this form, for example:
16140
16141 @table @code
16142 @item (org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'scheduled)
16143 Skip current entry if it has been scheduled.
16144 @item (org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'notscheduled)
16145 Skip current entry if it has not been scheduled.
16146 @item (org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'deadline)
16147 Skip current entry if it has a deadline.
16148 @item (org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'scheduled 'deadline)
16149 Skip current entry if it has a deadline, or if it is scheduled.
16150 @item (org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'todo '("TODO" "WAITING"))
16151 Skip current entry if the TODO keyword is TODO or WAITING.
16152 @item (org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'todo 'done)
16153 Skip current entry if the TODO keyword marks a DONE state.
16154 @item (org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'timestamp)
16155 Skip current entry if it has any timestamp, may also be deadline or scheduled.
16156 @anchor{x-agenda-skip-entry-regexp}
16157 @item (org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'regexp "regular expression")
16158 Skip current entry if the regular expression matches in the entry.
16159 @item (org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'notregexp "regular expression")
16160 Skip current entry unless the regular expression matches.
16161 @item (org-agenda-skip-subtree-if 'regexp "regular expression")
16162 Same as above, but check and skip the entire subtree.
16163 @end table
16164
16165 Therefore we could also have written the search for WAITING projects
16166 like this, even without defining a special function:
16167
16168 @lisp
16169 (org-add-agenda-custom-command
16170 '("b" todo "PROJECT"
16171 ((org-agenda-skip-function '(org-agenda-skip-subtree-if
16172 'regexp ":waiting:"))
16173 (org-agenda-overriding-header "Projects waiting for something: "))))
16174 @end lisp
16175
16176 @node Extracting agenda information, Using the property API, Special agenda views, Hacking
16177 @section Extracting agenda information
16178 @cindex agenda, pipe
16179 @cindex Scripts, for agenda processing
16180
16181 @vindex org-agenda-custom-commands
16182 Org provides commands to access agenda information for the command
16183 line in Emacs batch mode. This extracted information can be sent
16184 directly to a printer, or it can be read by a program that does further
16185 processing of the data. The first of these commands is the function
16186 @code{org-batch-agenda}, that produces an agenda view and sends it as
16187 ASCII text to STDOUT@. The command takes a single string as parameter.
16188 If the string has length 1, it is used as a key to one of the commands
16189 you have configured in @code{org-agenda-custom-commands}, basically any
16190 key you can use after @kbd{C-c a}. For example, to directly print the
16191 current TODO list, you could use
16192
16193 @example
16194 emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs -eval '(org-batch-agenda "t")' | lpr
16195 @end example
16196
16197 If the parameter is a string with 2 or more characters, it is used as a
16198 tags/TODO match string. For example, to print your local shopping list
16199 (all items with the tag @samp{shop}, but excluding the tag
16200 @samp{NewYork}), you could use
16201
16202 @example
16203 emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs \
16204 -eval '(org-batch-agenda "+shop-NewYork")' | lpr
16205 @end example
16206
16207 @noindent
16208 You may also modify parameters on the fly like this:
16209
16210 @example
16211 emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs \
16212 -eval '(org-batch-agenda "a" \
16213 org-agenda-span (quote month) \
16214 org-agenda-include-diary nil \
16215 org-agenda-files (quote ("~/org/project.org")))' \
16216 | lpr
16217 @end example
16218
16219 @noindent
16220 which will produce a 30-day agenda, fully restricted to the Org file
16221 @file{~/org/projects.org}, not even including the diary.
16222
16223 If you want to process the agenda data in more sophisticated ways, you
16224 can use the command @code{org-batch-agenda-csv} to get a comma-separated
16225 list of values for each agenda item. Each line in the output will
16226 contain a number of fields separated by commas. The fields in a line
16227 are:
16228
16229 @example
16230 category @r{The category of the item}
16231 head @r{The headline, without TODO keyword, TAGS and PRIORITY}
16232 type @r{The type of the agenda entry, can be}
16233 todo @r{selected in TODO match}
16234 tagsmatch @r{selected in tags match}
16235 diary @r{imported from diary}
16236 deadline @r{a deadline}
16237 scheduled @r{scheduled}
16238 timestamp @r{appointment, selected by timestamp}
16239 closed @r{entry was closed on date}
16240 upcoming-deadline @r{warning about nearing deadline}
16241 past-scheduled @r{forwarded scheduled item}
16242 block @r{entry has date block including date}
16243 todo @r{The TODO keyword, if any}
16244 tags @r{All tags including inherited ones, separated by colons}
16245 date @r{The relevant date, like 2007-2-14}
16246 time @r{The time, like 15:00-16:50}
16247 extra @r{String with extra planning info}
16248 priority-l @r{The priority letter if any was given}
16249 priority-n @r{The computed numerical priority}
16250 @end example
16251
16252 @noindent
16253 Time and date will only be given if a timestamp (or deadline/scheduled)
16254 led to the selection of the item.
16255
16256 A CSV list like this is very easy to use in a post-processing script.
16257 For example, here is a Perl program that gets the TODO list from
16258 Emacs/Org and prints all the items, preceded by a checkbox:
16259
16260 @example
16261 #!/usr/bin/perl
16262
16263 # define the Emacs command to run
16264 $cmd = "emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs -eval '(org-batch-agenda-csv \"t\")'";
16265
16266 # run it and capture the output
16267 $agenda = qx@{$cmd 2>/dev/null@};
16268
16269 # loop over all lines
16270 foreach $line (split(/\n/,$agenda)) @{
16271 # get the individual values
16272 ($category,$head,$type,$todo,$tags,$date,$time,$extra,
16273 $priority_l,$priority_n) = split(/,/,$line);
16274 # process and print
16275 print "[ ] $head\n";
16276 @}
16277 @end example
16278
16279 @node Using the property API, Using the mapping API, Extracting agenda information, Hacking
16280 @section Using the property API
16281 @cindex API, for properties
16282 @cindex properties, API
16283
16284 Here is a description of the functions that can be used to work with
16285 properties.
16286
16287 @defun org-entry-properties &optional pom which
16288 Get all properties of the entry at point-or-marker POM.@*
16289 This includes the TODO keyword, the tags, time strings for deadline,
16290 scheduled, and clocking, and any additional properties defined in the
16291 entry. The return value is an alist. Keys may occur multiple times
16292 if the property key was used several times.@*
16293 POM may also be nil, in which case the current entry is used.
16294 If WHICH is nil or `all', get all properties. If WHICH is
16295 `special' or `standard', only get that subclass.
16296 @end defun
16297 @vindex org-use-property-inheritance
16298 @findex org-insert-property-drawer
16299 @defun org-entry-get pom property &optional inherit
16300 Get value of PROPERTY for entry at point-or-marker POM@. By default,
16301 this only looks at properties defined locally in the entry. If INHERIT
16302 is non-nil and the entry does not have the property, then also check
16303 higher levels of the hierarchy. If INHERIT is the symbol
16304 @code{selective}, use inheritance if and only if the setting of
16305 @code{org-use-property-inheritance} selects PROPERTY for inheritance.
16306 @end defun
16307
16308 @defun org-entry-delete pom property
16309 Delete the property PROPERTY from entry at point-or-marker POM.
16310 @end defun
16311
16312 @defun org-entry-put pom property value
16313 Set PROPERTY to VALUE for entry at point-or-marker POM.
16314 @end defun
16315
16316 @defun org-buffer-property-keys &optional include-specials
16317 Get all property keys in the current buffer.
16318 @end defun
16319
16320 @defun org-insert-property-drawer
16321 Insert a property drawer for the current entry. Also
16322 @end defun
16323
16324 @defun org-entry-put-multivalued-property pom property &rest values
16325 Set PROPERTY at point-or-marker POM to VALUES@. VALUES should be a list of
16326 strings. They will be concatenated, with spaces as separators.
16327 @end defun
16328
16329 @defun org-entry-get-multivalued-property pom property
16330 Treat the value of the property PROPERTY as a whitespace-separated list of
16331 values and return the values as a list of strings.
16332 @end defun
16333
16334 @defun org-entry-add-to-multivalued-property pom property value
16335 Treat the value of the property PROPERTY as a whitespace-separated list of
16336 values and make sure that VALUE is in this list.
16337 @end defun
16338
16339 @defun org-entry-remove-from-multivalued-property pom property value
16340 Treat the value of the property PROPERTY as a whitespace-separated list of
16341 values and make sure that VALUE is @emph{not} in this list.
16342 @end defun
16343
16344 @defun org-entry-member-in-multivalued-property pom property value
16345 Treat the value of the property PROPERTY as a whitespace-separated list of
16346 values and check if VALUE is in this list.
16347 @end defun
16348
16349 @defopt org-property-allowed-value-functions
16350 Hook for functions supplying allowed values for a specific property.
16351 The functions must take a single argument, the name of the property, and
16352 return a flat list of allowed values. If @samp{:ETC} is one of
16353 the values, use the values as completion help, but allow also other values
16354 to be entered. The functions must return @code{nil} if they are not
16355 responsible for this property.
16356 @end defopt
16357
16358 @node Using the mapping API, , Using the property API, Hacking
16359 @section Using the mapping API
16360 @cindex API, for mapping
16361 @cindex mapping entries, API
16362
16363 Org has sophisticated mapping capabilities to find all entries satisfying
16364 certain criteria. Internally, this functionality is used to produce agenda
16365 views, but there is also an API that can be used to execute arbitrary
16366 functions for each or selected entries. The main entry point for this API
16367 is:
16368
16369 @defun org-map-entries func &optional match scope &rest skip
16370 Call FUNC at each headline selected by MATCH in SCOPE.
16371
16372 FUNC is a function or a Lisp form. The function will be called without
16373 arguments, with the cursor positioned at the beginning of the headline.
16374 The return values of all calls to the function will be collected and
16375 returned as a list.
16376
16377 The call to FUNC will be wrapped into a save-excursion form, so FUNC
16378 does not need to preserve point. After evaluation, the cursor will be
16379 moved to the end of the line (presumably of the headline of the
16380 processed entry) and search continues from there. Under some
16381 circumstances, this may not produce the wanted results. For example,
16382 if you have removed (e.g., archived) the current (sub)tree it could
16383 mean that the next entry will be skipped entirely. In such cases, you
16384 can specify the position from where search should continue by making
16385 FUNC set the variable `org-map-continue-from' to the desired buffer
16386 position.
16387
16388 MATCH is a tags/property/todo match as it is used in the agenda match view.
16389 Only headlines that are matched by this query will be considered during
16390 the iteration. When MATCH is nil or t, all headlines will be
16391 visited by the iteration.
16392
16393 SCOPE determines the scope of this command. It can be any of:
16394
16395 @example
16396 nil @r{the current buffer, respecting the restriction if any}
16397 tree @r{the subtree started with the entry at point}
16398 region @r{The entries within the active region, if any}
16399 file @r{the current buffer, without restriction}
16400 file-with-archives
16401 @r{the current buffer, and any archives associated with it}
16402 agenda @r{all agenda files}
16403 agenda-with-archives
16404 @r{all agenda files with any archive files associated with them}
16405 (file1 file2 ...)
16406 @r{if this is a list, all files in the list will be scanned}
16407 @end example
16408 @noindent
16409 The remaining args are treated as settings for the skipping facilities of
16410 the scanner. The following items can be given here:
16411
16412 @vindex org-agenda-skip-function
16413 @example
16414 archive @r{skip trees with the archive tag}
16415 comment @r{skip trees with the COMMENT keyword}
16416 function or Lisp form
16417 @r{will be used as value for @code{org-agenda-skip-function},}
16418 @r{so whenever the function returns t, FUNC}
16419 @r{will not be called for that entry and search will}
16420 @r{continue from the point where the function leaves it}
16421 @end example
16422 @end defun
16423
16424 The function given to that mapping routine can really do anything you like.
16425 It can use the property API (@pxref{Using the property API}) to gather more
16426 information about the entry, or in order to change metadata in the entry.
16427 Here are a couple of functions that might be handy:
16428
16429 @defun org-todo &optional arg
16430 Change the TODO state of the entry. See the docstring of the functions for
16431 the many possible values for the argument ARG.
16432 @end defun
16433
16434 @defun org-priority &optional action
16435 Change the priority of the entry. See the docstring of this function for the
16436 possible values for ACTION.
16437 @end defun
16438
16439 @defun org-toggle-tag tag &optional onoff
16440 Toggle the tag TAG in the current entry. Setting ONOFF to either @code{on}
16441 or @code{off} will not toggle tag, but ensure that it is either on or off.
16442 @end defun
16443
16444 @defun org-promote
16445 Promote the current entry.
16446 @end defun
16447
16448 @defun org-demote
16449 Demote the current entry.
16450 @end defun
16451
16452 Here is a simple example that will turn all entries in the current file with
16453 a tag @code{TOMORROW} into TODO entries with the keyword @code{UPCOMING}.
16454 Entries in comment trees and in archive trees will be ignored.
16455
16456 @lisp
16457 (org-map-entries
16458 '(org-todo "UPCOMING")
16459 "+TOMORROW" 'file 'archive 'comment)
16460 @end lisp
16461
16462 The following example counts the number of entries with TODO keyword
16463 @code{WAITING}, in all agenda files.
16464
16465 @lisp
16466 (length (org-map-entries t "/+WAITING" 'agenda))
16467 @end lisp
16468
16469 @node MobileOrg, History and Acknowledgments, Hacking, Top
16470 @appendix MobileOrg
16471 @cindex iPhone
16472 @cindex MobileOrg
16473
16474 @i{MobileOrg} is the name of the mobile companion app for Org mode, currently
16475 available for iOS and for Android. @i{MobileOrg} offers offline viewing and
16476 capture support for an Org mode system rooted on a ``real'' computer. It
16477 does also allow you to record changes to existing entries.
16478 The @uref{http://mobileorg.ncogni.to/, iOS implementation} for the
16479 @i{iPhone/iPod Touch/iPad} series of devices, was developed by Richard
16480 Moreland. Android users should check out
16481 @uref{http://wiki.github.com/matburt/mobileorg-android/, MobileOrg Android}
16482 by Matt Jones. The two implementations are not identical but offer similar
16483 features.
16484
16485 This appendix describes the support Org has for creating agenda views in a
16486 format that can be displayed by @i{MobileOrg}, and for integrating notes
16487 captured and changes made by @i{MobileOrg} into the main system.
16488
16489 For changing tags and TODO states in MobileOrg, you should have set up the
16490 customization variables @code{org-todo-keywords} and @code{org-tags-alist} to
16491 cover all important tags and TODO keywords, even if individual files use only
16492 part of these. MobileOrg will also offer you states and tags set up with
16493 in-buffer settings, but it will understand the logistics of TODO state
16494 @i{sets} (@pxref{Per-file keywords}) and @i{mutually exclusive} tags
16495 (@pxref{Setting tags}) only for those set in these variables.
16496
16497 @menu
16498 * Setting up the staging area:: Where to interact with the mobile device
16499 * Pushing to MobileOrg:: Uploading Org files and agendas
16500 * Pulling from MobileOrg:: Integrating captured and flagged items
16501 @end menu
16502
16503 @node Setting up the staging area, Pushing to MobileOrg, MobileOrg, MobileOrg
16504 @section Setting up the staging area
16505
16506 MobileOrg needs to interact with Emacs through a directory on a server. If you
16507 are using a public server, you should consider to encrypt the files that are
16508 uploaded to the server. This can be done with Org mode 7.02 and with
16509 @i{MobileOrg 1.5} (iPhone version), and you need an @file{openssl}
16510 installation on your system. To turn on encryption, set a password in
16511 @i{MobileOrg} and, on the Emacs side, configure the variable
16512 @code{org-mobile-use-encryption}@footnote{If you can safely store the
16513 password in your Emacs setup, you might also want to configure
16514 @code{org-mobile-encryption-password}. Please read the docstring of that
16515 variable. Note that encryption will apply only to the contents of the
16516 @file{.org} files. The file names themselves will remain visible.}.
16517
16518 The easiest way to create that directory is to use a free
16519 @uref{http://dropbox.com,Dropbox.com} account@footnote{If you cannot use
16520 Dropbox, or if your version of MobileOrg does not support it, you can use a
16521 webdav server. For more information, check out the documentation of MobileOrg and also this
16522 @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-faq.html#mobileorg_webdav, FAQ entry}.}.
16523 When MobileOrg first connects to your Dropbox, it will create a directory
16524 @i{MobileOrg} inside the Dropbox. After the directory has been created, tell
16525 Emacs about it:
16526
16527 @lisp
16528 (setq org-mobile-directory "~/Dropbox/MobileOrg")
16529 @end lisp
16530
16531 Org mode has commands to put files for @i{MobileOrg} into that directory,
16532 and to read captured notes from there.
16533
16534 @node Pushing to MobileOrg, Pulling from MobileOrg, Setting up the staging area, MobileOrg
16535 @section Pushing to MobileOrg
16536
16537 This operation copies all files currently listed in @code{org-mobile-files}
16538 to the directory @code{org-mobile-directory}. By default this list contains
16539 all agenda files (as listed in @code{org-agenda-files}), but additional files
16540 can be included by customizing @code{org-mobile-files}. File names will be
16541 staged with paths relative to @code{org-directory}, so all files should be
16542 inside this directory. The push operation also creates a special Org file
16543 @file{agendas.org} with all custom agenda view defined by the
16544 user@footnote{While creating the agendas, Org mode will force ID properties
16545 on all referenced entries, so that these entries can be uniquely identified
16546 if @i{MobileOrg} flags them for further action. If you do not want to get
16547 these properties in so many entries, you can set the variable
16548 @code{org-mobile-force-id-on-agenda-items} to @code{nil}. Org mode will then
16549 rely on outline paths, in the hope that these will be unique enough.}.
16550 Finally, Org writes the file @file{index.org}, containing links to all other
16551 files. @i{MobileOrg} first reads this file from the server, and then
16552 downloads all agendas and Org files listed in it. To speed up the download,
16553 MobileOrg will only read files whose checksums@footnote{Checksums are stored
16554 automatically in the file @file{checksums.dat}} have changed.
16555
16556 @node Pulling from MobileOrg, , Pushing to MobileOrg, MobileOrg
16557 @section Pulling from MobileOrg
16558
16559 When @i{MobileOrg} synchronizes with the server, it not only pulls the Org
16560 files for viewing. It also appends captured entries and pointers to flagged
16561 and changed entries to the file @file{mobileorg.org} on the server. Org has
16562 a @emph{pull} operation that integrates this information into an inbox file
16563 and operates on the pointers to flagged entries. Here is how it works:
16564
16565 @enumerate
16566 @item
16567 Org moves all entries found in
16568 @file{mobileorg.org}@footnote{@file{mobileorg.org} will be empty after this
16569 operation.} and appends them to the file pointed to by the variable
16570 @code{org-mobile-inbox-for-pull}. Each captured entry and each editing event
16571 will be a top-level entry in the inbox file.
16572 @item
16573 After moving the entries, Org will attempt to implement the changes made in
16574 @i{MobileOrg}. Some changes are applied directly and without user
16575 interaction. Examples are all changes to tags, TODO state, headline and body
16576 text that can be cleanly applied. Entries that have been flagged for further
16577 action will receive a tag @code{:FLAGGED:}, so that they can be easily found
16578 again. When there is a problem finding an entry or applying the change, the
16579 pointer entry will remain in the inbox and will be marked with an error
16580 message. You need to later resolve these issues by hand.
16581 @item
16582 Org will then generate an agenda view with all flagged entries. The user
16583 should then go through these entries and do whatever actions are necessary.
16584 If a note has been stored while flagging an entry in @i{MobileOrg}, that note
16585 will be displayed in the echo area when the cursor is on the corresponding
16586 agenda line.
16587 @table @kbd
16588 @kindex ?
16589 @item ?
16590 Pressing @kbd{?} in that special agenda will display the full flagging note in
16591 another window and also push it onto the kill ring. So you could use @kbd{?
16592 z C-y C-c C-c} to store that flagging note as a normal note in the entry.
16593 Pressing @kbd{?} twice in succession will offer to remove the
16594 @code{:FLAGGED:} tag along with the recorded flagging note (which is stored
16595 in a property). In this way you indicate that the intended processing for
16596 this flagged entry is finished.
16597 @end table
16598 @end enumerate
16599
16600 @kindex C-c a ?
16601 If you are not able to process all flagged entries directly, you can always
16602 return to this agenda view@footnote{Note, however, that there is a subtle
16603 difference. The view created automatically by @kbd{M-x org-mobile-pull
16604 @key{RET}} is guaranteed to search all files that have been addressed by the
16605 last pull. This might include a file that is not currently in your list of
16606 agenda files. If you later use @kbd{C-c a ?} to regenerate the view, only
16607 the current agenda files will be searched.} using @kbd{C-c a ?}.
16608
16609 @node History and Acknowledgments, Main Index, MobileOrg, Top
16610 @appendix History and acknowledgments
16611 @cindex acknowledgments
16612 @cindex history
16613 @cindex thanks
16614
16615 @section From Carsten
16616
16617 Org was born in 2003, out of frustration over the user interface of the Emacs
16618 Outline mode. I was trying to organize my notes and projects, and using
16619 Emacs seemed to be the natural way to go. However, having to remember eleven
16620 different commands with two or three keys per command, only to hide and show
16621 parts of the outline tree, that seemed entirely unacceptable to me. Also,
16622 when using outlines to take notes, I constantly wanted to restructure the
16623 tree, organizing it parallel to my thoughts and plans. @emph{Visibility
16624 cycling} and @emph{structure editing} were originally implemented in the
16625 package @file{outline-magic.el}, but quickly moved to the more general
16626 @file{org.el}. As this environment became comfortable for project planning,
16627 the next step was adding @emph{TODO entries}, basic @emph{timestamps}, and
16628 @emph{table support}. These areas highlighted the two main goals that Org
16629 still has today: to be a new, outline-based, plain text mode with innovative
16630 and intuitive editing features, and to incorporate project planning
16631 functionality directly into a notes file.
16632
16633 Since the first release, literally thousands of emails to me or to
16634 @email{emacs-orgmode@@gnu.org} have provided a constant stream of bug
16635 reports, feedback, new ideas, and sometimes patches and add-on code.
16636 Many thanks to everyone who has helped to improve this package. I am
16637 trying to keep here a list of the people who had significant influence
16638 in shaping one or more aspects of Org. The list may not be
16639 complete, if I have forgotten someone, please accept my apologies and
16640 let me know.
16641
16642 Before I get to this list, a few special mentions are in order:
16643
16644 @table @i
16645 @item Bastien Guerry
16646 Bastien has written a large number of extensions to Org (most of them
16647 integrated into the core by now), including the @LaTeX{} exporter and the plain
16648 list parser. His support during the early days, when he basically acted as
16649 co-maintainer, was central to the success of this project. Bastien also
16650 invented Worg, helped establishing the Web presence of Org, and sponsored
16651 hosting costs for the orgmode.org website.
16652 @item Eric Schulte and Dan Davison
16653 Eric and Dan are jointly responsible for the Org-babel system, which turns
16654 Org into a multi-language environment for evaluating code and doing literate
16655 programming and reproducible research.
16656 @item John Wiegley
16657 John has contributed a number of great ideas and patches directly to Org,
16658 including the attachment system (@file{org-attach.el}), integration with
16659 Apple Mail (@file{org-mac-message.el}), hierarchical dependencies of TODO
16660 items, habit tracking (@file{org-habits.el}), and encryption
16661 (@file{org-crypt.el}). Also, the capture system is really an extended copy
16662 of his great @file{remember.el}.
16663 @item Sebastian Rose
16664 Without Sebastian, the HTML/XHTML publishing of Org would be the pitiful work
16665 of an ignorant amateur. Sebastian has pushed this part of Org onto a much
16666 higher level. He also wrote @file{org-info.js}, a Java script for displaying
16667 webpages derived from Org using an Info-like or a folding interface with
16668 single-key navigation.
16669 @end table
16670
16671 @noindent See below for the full list of contributions! Again, please
16672 let me know what I am missing here!
16673
16674 @section From Bastien
16675
16676 I (Bastien) have been maintaining Org since January 2011. This appendix
16677 would not be complete without adding a few more acknowledgements and thanks
16678 to Carsten's ones above.
16679
16680 I am first grateful to Carsten for his trust while handing me over the
16681 maintainership of Org. His support as been great since day one of this new
16682 adventure, and it helped a lot.
16683
16684 When I took over maintainership, I knew I would have to make Org more
16685 collaborative than ever, as I would have to rely on people that are more
16686 knowledgeable than I am on many parts of the code. Here is a list of the
16687 persons I could rely on, they should really be considered co-maintainers,
16688 either of the code or the community:
16689
16690 @table @i
16691 @item Eric Schulte
16692 Eric is maintaining the Babel parts of Org. His reactivity here kept me away
16693 from worrying about possible bugs here and let me focus on other parts.
16694
16695 @item Nicolas Goaziou
16696 Nicolas is maintaining the consistency of the deepest parts of Org. His work
16697 on @file{org-element.el} and @file{org-export.el} has been outstanding, and
16698 opened the doors for many new ideas and features.
16699
16700 @item Jambunathan K
16701 Jambunathan contributed the ODT exporter, definitely a killer feature of
16702 Org mode. He also contributed the new HTML exporter, which is another core
16703 feature of Org. Here too, I knew I could rely on him to fix bugs in these
16704 areas and to patiently explain the users what was the problems and solutions.
16705
16706 @item Achim Gratz
16707 Achim rewrote the building process of Org, turning some @emph{ad hoc} tools
16708 into a flexible and conceptually clean process. He patiently coped with the
16709 many hiccups that such a change can create for users.
16710
16711 @item Nick Dokos
16712 The Org mode mailing list would not be such a nice place without Nick, who
16713 patiently helped users so many times. It is impossible to overestimate such
16714 a great help, and the list would not be so active without him.
16715 @end table
16716
16717 I received support from so many users that it is clearly impossible to be
16718 fair when shortlisting a few of them -- but Org's history would not be
16719 complete if the ones above were not mentioned in this manual.
16720
16721 @section List of contributions
16722
16723 @itemize @bullet
16724
16725 @item
16726 @i{Russel Adams} came up with the idea for drawers.
16727 @item
16728 @i{Thomas Baumann} wrote @file{org-bbdb.el} and @file{org-mhe.el}.
16729 @item
16730 @i{Christophe Bataillon} created the great unicorn logo that we use on the
16731 Org mode website.
16732 @item
16733 @i{Alex Bochannek} provided a patch for rounding timestamps.
16734 @item
16735 @i{Jan Böcker} wrote @file{org-docview.el}.
16736 @item
16737 @i{Brad Bozarth} showed how to pull RSS feed data into Org mode files.
16738 @item
16739 @i{Tom Breton} wrote @file{org-choose.el}.
16740 @item
16741 @i{Charles Cave}'s suggestion sparked the implementation of templates
16742 for Remember, which are now templates for capture.
16743 @item
16744 @i{Pavel Chalmoviansky} influenced the agenda treatment of items with
16745 specified time.
16746 @item
16747 @i{Gregory Chernov} patched support for Lisp forms into table
16748 calculations and improved XEmacs compatibility, in particular by porting
16749 @file{nouline.el} to XEmacs.
16750 @item
16751 @i{Sacha Chua} suggested copying some linking code from Planner.
16752 @item
16753 @i{Baoqiu Cui} contributed the DocBook exporter.
16754 @item
16755 @i{Eddward DeVilla} proposed and tested checkbox statistics. He also
16756 came up with the idea of properties, and that there should be an API for
16757 them.
16758 @item
16759 @i{Nick Dokos} tracked down several nasty bugs.
16760 @item
16761 @i{Kees Dullemond} used to edit projects lists directly in HTML and so
16762 inspired some of the early development, including HTML export. He also
16763 asked for a way to narrow wide table columns.
16764 @item
16765 @i{Thomas S. Dye} contributed documentation on Worg and helped integrating
16766 the Org-Babel documentation into the manual.
16767 @item
16768 @i{Christian Egli} converted the documentation into Texinfo format, inspired
16769 the agenda, patched CSS formatting into the HTML exporter, and wrote
16770 @file{org-taskjuggler.el}.
16771 @item
16772 @i{David Emery} provided a patch for custom CSS support in exported
16773 HTML agendas.
16774 @item
16775 @i{Nic Ferrier} contributed mailcap and XOXO support.
16776 @item
16777 @i{Miguel A. Figueroa-Villanueva} implemented hierarchical checkboxes.
16778 @item
16779 @i{John Foerch} figured out how to make incremental search show context
16780 around a match in a hidden outline tree.
16781 @item
16782 @i{Raimar Finken} wrote @file{org-git-line.el}.
16783 @item
16784 @i{Mikael Fornius} works as a mailing list moderator.
16785 @item
16786 @i{Austin Frank} works as a mailing list moderator.
16787 @item
16788 @i{Eric Fraga} drove the development of BEAMER export with ideas and
16789 testing.
16790 @item
16791 @i{Barry Gidden} did proofreading the manual in preparation for the book
16792 publication through Network Theory Ltd.
16793 @item
16794 @i{Niels Giesen} had the idea to automatically archive DONE trees.
16795 @item
16796 @i{Nicolas Goaziou} rewrote much of the plain list code.
16797 @item
16798 @i{Kai Grossjohann} pointed out key-binding conflicts with other packages.
16799 @item
16800 @i{Brian Gough} of Network Theory Ltd publishes the Org mode manual as a
16801 book.
16802 @item
16803 @i{Bernt Hansen} has driven much of the support for auto-repeating tasks,
16804 task state change logging, and the clocktable. His clear explanations have
16805 been critical when we started to adopt the Git version control system.
16806 @item
16807 @i{Manuel Hermenegildo} has contributed various ideas, small fixes and
16808 patches.
16809 @item
16810 @i{Phil Jackson} wrote @file{org-irc.el}.
16811 @item
16812 @i{Scott Jaderholm} proposed footnotes, control over whitespace between
16813 folded entries, and column view for properties.
16814 @item
16815 @i{Matt Jones} wrote @i{MobileOrg Android}.
16816 @item
16817 @i{Tokuya Kameshima} wrote @file{org-wl.el} and @file{org-mew.el}.
16818 @item
16819 @i{Shidai Liu} ("Leo") asked for embedded @LaTeX{} and tested it. He also
16820 provided frequent feedback and some patches.
16821 @item
16822 @i{Matt Lundin} has proposed last-row references for table formulas and named
16823 invisible anchors. He has also worked a lot on the FAQ.
16824 @item
16825 @i{David Maus} wrote @file{org-atom.el}, maintains the issues file for Org,
16826 and is a prolific contributor on the mailing list with competent replies,
16827 small fixes and patches.
16828 @item
16829 @i{Jason F. McBrayer} suggested agenda export to CSV format.
16830 @item
16831 @i{Max Mikhanosha} came up with the idea of refiling.
16832 @item
16833 @i{Dmitri Minaev} sent a patch to set priority limits on a per-file
16834 basis.
16835 @item
16836 @i{Stefan Monnier} provided a patch to keep the Emacs-Lisp compiler
16837 happy.
16838 @item
16839 @i{Richard Moreland} wrote @i{MobileOrg} for the iPhone.
16840 @item
16841 @i{Rick Moynihan} proposed allowing multiple TODO sequences in a file
16842 and being able to quickly restrict the agenda to a subtree.
16843 @item
16844 @i{Todd Neal} provided patches for links to Info files and Elisp forms.
16845 @item
16846 @i{Greg Newman} refreshed the unicorn logo into its current form.
16847 @item
16848 @i{Tim O'Callaghan} suggested in-file links, search options for general
16849 file links, and TAGS.
16850 @item
16851 @i{Osamu Okano} wrote @file{orgcard2ref.pl}, a Perl program to create a text
16852 version of the reference card.
16853 @item
16854 @i{Takeshi Okano} translated the manual and David O'Toole's tutorial
16855 into Japanese.
16856 @item
16857 @i{Oliver Oppitz} suggested multi-state TODO items.
16858 @item
16859 @i{Scott Otterson} sparked the introduction of descriptive text for
16860 links, among other things.
16861 @item
16862 @i{Pete Phillips} helped during the development of the TAGS feature, and
16863 provided frequent feedback.
16864 @item
16865 @i{Martin Pohlack} provided the code snippet to bundle character insertion
16866 into bundles of 20 for undo.
16867 @item
16868 @i{T.V. Raman} reported bugs and suggested improvements.
16869 @item
16870 @i{Matthias Rempe} (Oelde) provided ideas, Windows support, and quality
16871 control.
16872 @item
16873 @i{Paul Rivier} provided the basic implementation of named footnotes. He
16874 also acted as mailing list moderator for some time.
16875 @item
16876 @i{Kevin Rogers} contributed code to access VM files on remote hosts.
16877 @item
16878 @i{Frank Ruell} solved the mystery of the @code{keymapp nil} bug, a
16879 conflict with @file{allout.el}.
16880 @item
16881 @i{Jason Riedy} generalized the send-receive mechanism for Orgtbl tables with
16882 extensive patches.
16883 @item
16884 @i{Philip Rooke} created the Org reference card, provided lots
16885 of feedback, developed and applied standards to the Org documentation.
16886 @item
16887 @i{Christian Schlauer} proposed angular brackets around links, among
16888 other things.
16889 @item
16890 @i{Paul Sexton} wrote @file{org-ctags.el}.
16891 @item
16892 Linking to VM/BBDB/Gnus was first inspired by @i{Tom Shannon}'s
16893 @file{organizer-mode.el}.
16894 @item
16895 @i{Ilya Shlyakhter} proposed the Archive Sibling, line numbering in literal
16896 examples, and remote highlighting for referenced code lines.
16897 @item
16898 @i{Stathis Sideris} wrote the @file{ditaa.jar} ASCII to PNG converter that is
16899 now packaged into Org's @file{contrib} directory.
16900 @item
16901 @i{Daniel Sinder} came up with the idea of internal archiving by locking
16902 subtrees.
16903 @item
16904 @i{Dale Smith} proposed link abbreviations.
16905 @item
16906 @i{James TD Smith} has contributed a large number of patches for useful
16907 tweaks and features.
16908 @item
16909 @i{Adam Spiers} asked for global linking commands, inspired the link
16910 extension system, added support for mairix, and proposed the mapping API.
16911 @item
16912 @i{Ulf Stegemann} created the table to translate special symbols to HTML,
16913 @LaTeX{}, UTF-8, Latin-1 and ASCII.
16914 @item
16915 @i{Andy Stewart} contributed code to @file{org-w3m.el}, to copy HTML content
16916 with links transformation to Org syntax.
16917 @item
16918 @i{David O'Toole} wrote @file{org-publish.el} and drafted the manual
16919 chapter about publishing.
16920 @item
16921 @i{Jambunathan K} contributed the ODT exporter.
16922 @item
16923 @i{Sebastien Vauban} reported many issues with @LaTeX{} and BEAMER export and
16924 enabled source code highlighting in Gnus.
16925 @item
16926 @i{Stefan Vollmar} organized a video-recorded talk at the
16927 Max-Planck-Institute for Neurology. He also inspired the creation of a
16928 concept index for HTML export.
16929 @item
16930 @i{J@"urgen Vollmer} contributed code generating the table of contents
16931 in HTML output.
16932 @item
16933 @i{Samuel Wales} has provided important feedback and bug reports.
16934 @item
16935 @i{Chris Wallace} provided a patch implementing the @samp{QUOTE}
16936 keyword.
16937 @item
16938 @i{David Wainberg} suggested archiving, and improvements to the linking
16939 system.
16940 @item
16941 @i{Carsten Wimmer} suggested some changes and helped fix a bug in
16942 linking to Gnus.
16943 @item
16944 @i{Roland Winkler} requested additional key bindings to make Org
16945 work on a tty.
16946 @item
16947 @i{Piotr Zielinski} wrote @file{org-mouse.el}, proposed agenda blocks
16948 and contributed various ideas and code snippets.
16949 @end itemize
16950
16951
16952 @node Main Index, Key Index, History and Acknowledgments, Top
16953 @unnumbered Concept index
16954
16955 @printindex cp
16956
16957 @node Key Index, Command and Function Index, Main Index, Top
16958 @unnumbered Key index
16959
16960 @printindex ky
16961
16962 @node Command and Function Index, Variable Index, Key Index, Top
16963 @unnumbered Command and function index
16964
16965 @printindex fn
16966
16967 @node Variable Index, , Command and Function Index, Top
16968 @unnumbered Variable index
16969
16970 This is not a complete index of variables and faces, only the ones that are
16971 mentioned in the manual. For a more complete list, use @kbd{M-x
16972 org-customize @key{RET}} and then click yourself through the tree.
16973
16974 @printindex vr
16975
16976 @bye
16977
16978 @c Local variables:
16979 @c fill-column: 77
16980 @c indent-tabs-mode: nil
16981 @c paragraph-start: "\b\\|^@[a-zA-Z]*[ \n]\\|^@x?org\\(key\\|cmd\\)\\|\f\\|[ ]*$"
16982 @c paragraph-separate: "\b\\|^@[a-zA-Z]*[ \n]\\|^@x?org\\(key\\|cmd\\)\\|[ \f]*$"
16983 @c End:
16984
16985
16986 @c LocalWords: webdavhost pre